Module 6

See attached for instructions. Use attached book

Save Time On Research and Writing
Hire a Pro to Write You a 100% Plagiarism-Free Paper.
Get My Paper

Module 6: Weekly Paper
Refer to Ch 9 and 10

a. Discuss the Aaron Beck’s cognitive therapy. What are the basic principles and goals of this form of
therapy?
b. Discuss the concept of a “collaborative relationship” in the CBT model.
c. Discuss the application of exposure therapy for anxiety disorders.
d. Discuss the strengths and limitations of CBT.

California State University, Fullerton
Diplomate in Counseling Psychology
American Board of Professional Psychology
Theory and Practice
of Counseling
and Psychotherapy
G E R A L D C O R E Y
ninth edition
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

About the Author
GERALD COREY is a Professor Emeritus of Human Serv-
ices at California State University at Fullerton and a licensed
psychologist. He received his doctorate in counseling from
the University of Southern California. He is a Diplomate
in Counseling Psychology, American Board of Professional
Psychology; a National Certified Counselor; a Fellow of the
American Psychological Association (Counseling Psychol-
ogy); a Fellow of the American Counseling Association; and
a Fellow of the Association for Specialists in Group Work.
He also holds memberships in the American Group Psycho-
therapy Association; the American Mental Health Counselors Association; the As-
sociation for Spiritual, Ethical, and Religious Values in Counseling; the Associa-
tion for Counselor Education and Supervision; and the Western Association for
Coun selor Education and Supervision.
Along with Marianne Schneider Corey, Jerry received the Lifetime Achieve-
ment Award from the American Mental Health Counselors Association in 2011
and the Eminent Career Award from the Association for Specialists in Group
Work in 2001. Jerry was the recipient of the Outstanding Professor of the Year
Award from California State University at Fullerton in 1991. He teaches both
undergraduate and graduate courses in group counseling, as well as courses
in experiential groups, the theory and practice of counseling, theories of coun-
seling, and professional ethics. He is the author or coauthor of 16 textbooks
in counseling currently in print, 5 student videos/DVDs with workbooks, and
more than 60 articles in professional publications. Theory and Practice of Coun-
seling and Psychotherapy has been translated into the Arabic, Indonesian, Por-
tuguese, Korean, Chinese, and Turkish languages. Theory and Practice of Group
Counseling has been translated into Chinese, Korean, Russian, and Spanish.
Issues and Ethics in the Helping Professions has been translated into Korean, Japa-
nese, and Chinese.
Jerry and Marianne Corey often presents workshop in group counseling. In
the past 35 years the Coreys have conducted group counseling training workshops
for mental health professionals at many universities in the United States as well as
in Korea, Ireland, Germany, Belgium, Scotland, Mexico, China, Hong Kong, and
Canada. The Coreys also frequently give presentations and workshops at state and
national professional conferences. In his leisure time, Jerry likes to travel, hike and
bicycle in the mountains, and drive his 1931 Model A Ford.
A
ss
oc
ia
te
d
Pr
es
s
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

Save Time On Research and Writing
Hire a Pro to Write You a 100% Plagiarism-Free Paper.
Get My Paper

Recent publications by Jerry Corey, all with Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning,
include:
Case Approach to Counseling and Psychotherapy, Eighth Edition (2013)
The Art of Integrative Counseling, Third Edition (2013)
Theory and Practice of Group Counseling (and Student Manual, Eighth Edition,
2012)
Becoming a Helper, Sixth Edition (2011, with Marianne Schneider Corey)
Issues in Ethics in the Helping Professions, Eighth Edition (2011, with Marianne
Schneider Corey and Patrick Callanan)
Groups: Process and Practice, Eighth Edition (2010, with Marianne Schneider
Corey and Cindy Corey)
I Never Knew I Had a Choice, Ninth Edition (2010, with Marianne Schneider
Corey)
Group Techniques, Third Edition (2004, with Marianne Schneider Corey,
Patrick Callanan, and J. Michael Russell)
Jerry is coauthor (with Barbara Herlihy) of Boundary Issues in Counseling: Multiple
Roles and Responsibilities, Second Edition (2006) and ACA Ethical Standards Case-
book, Sixth Edition (2006); he is coauthor (with Robert Haynes, Patrice Moulton,
and Michelle Muratori) of Clinical Supervision in the Helping Professions: A Practi-
cal Guide, Second Edition (2010); he is the author of Creating Your Professional
Path: Lessons From My Journey (2010). All four of these books are published by the
American Counseling Association.
He also has made several educational DVD and video programs on various as-
pects of counseling practice: DVD for Theory and Practice of Counseling and Psycho-
therapy: The Case of Stan and Lecturettes (2013); DVD for Integrative Counseling: The
Case of Ruth and Lecturettes (2013, with Robert Haynes); DVD—Theory and Practice
of Group Counseling (2012); Groups in Action: Evolution and Challenges—DVD and
Workbook (2006, with Marianne Schneider Corey and Robert Haynes); and Ethics
in Action: CD-ROM (2003, with Marianne Schneider Corey and Robert Haynes).
All of these programs are available through Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning.
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.
This is an electronic version of the print textbook. Due to electronic rights restrictions,
some third party content may be suppressed. Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed
content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. The publisher reserves the right
to remove content from this title at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it. For
valuable information on pricing, previous editions, changes to current editions, and alternate
formats, please visit www.cengage.com/highered to search by ISBN#, author, title, or keyword for
materials in your areas of interest.

Theory and Practice of Counseling
and Psychotherapy, Ninth Edition
Gerald Corey

Cengage Learning Customer & Sales Support, 1-800-354-9706.
www.cengage.com/permissions.
permissionrequest@cengage.com
Brooks/Cole
www.cengage.com/global

www.cengage.com/brookscole

www.CengageBrain.com
Printed in the United States of America
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 15 14 13 12 11
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

To Terry Hendrix and in memory of Claire Verduin,
our first editors at Brooks/Cole; they had faith
in the potential of this book and encouraged us to
write early in our careers.
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

P R E FA C E X I I
PA R T 1
Basic Issues in Counseling Practice�3
1 Introduction and Overview�4
Introduction 5
Where I Stand 6
Suggestions for Using the Book 8
Overview of the Theory Chapters 9
Introduction to the Case of Stan 13
2 The Counselor: Person and Professional�17
Introduction 18
The Counselor as a Therapeutic Person 18
Personal Therapy for the Counselor 20
The Counselor’s Values and the Therapeutic Process 22
Becoming an Effective Multicultural Counselor 24
Issues Faced by Beginning Therapists 28
Summary 34
3 Ethical Issues in Counseling Practice�36
Introduction 37
Putting Clients’ Needs Before Your Own 37
Ethical Decision Making 38
The Right of Informed Consent 40
Dimensions of Confidentiality 41
Ethical Issues in a Multicultural Perspective 42
Ethical Issues in the Assessment Process 44
Ethical Aspects of Evidence-Based Practice 46
Contents
vii
C
O
N
T
E
N
T
S
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

Managing Multiple Relationships in Counseling Practice 48
Becoming an Ethical Counselor 51
Summary 52
Where to Go From Here 52
Recommended Supplementary Readings for Part 1 53
References and Suggested Readings for Part 1 55
PA R T 2
Theories and Techniques of Counseling 61
4 Psychoanalytic Therapy 62
Introduction 63
Key Concepts 64
The Therapeutic Process 72
Application: Therapeutic Techniques and Procedures 78
Jung’s Perspective on the Development of Personality 83
Contemporary Trends: Object-Relations Theory,
Self Psychology, and Relational Psychoanalysis 85
Psychoanalytic Therapy From a Multicultural Perspective 91
Psychoanalytic Therapy Applied to the Case of Stan 92
Summary and Evaluation 94
Where to Go From Here 97
Recommended Supplementary Readings 98
References and Suggested Readings 99
5 Adlerian Therapy 101
Introduction 102
Key Concepts 103
The Therapeutic Process 109
Application: Therapeutic Techniques and Procedures 113
Adlerian Therapy From a Multicultural Perspective 123
Adlerian Therapy Applied to the Case of Stan 125
Summary and Evaluation 127
Where to Go From Here 129
Recommended Supplementary Readings 131
References and Suggested Readings 132
6 Existential Therapy 136
Introduction 139
Key Concepts 145
The Therapeutic Process 154
Application: Therapeutic Techniques and Procedures 157
viii
C
O
N
T
E
N
T
S
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

Existential Therapy From a Multicultural Perspective 160
Existential Therapy Applied to the Case of Stan 162
Summary and Evaluation 163
Where to Go From Here 166
Recommended Supplementary Readings 168
References and Suggested Readings 169
7 Person-Centered Therapy 172
Introduction 173
Key Concepts 178
The Therapeutic Process 179
Application: Therapeutic Techniques and Procedures 184
Person-Centered Expressive Arts Therapy 189
Motivational Interviewing 191
Person-Centered Therapy From a Multicultural Perspective 194
Person-Centered Therapy Applied to the Case of Stan 196
Summary and Evaluation 197
Where to Go From Here 203
Recommended Supplementary Readings 205
References and Suggested Readings 206
8 Gestalt Therapy 210
Introduction 212
Key Concepts 213
The Therapeutic Process 219
Application: Therapeutic Techniques and Procedures 224
Gestalt Therapy From a Multicultural Perspective 233
Gestalt Therapy Applied to the Case of Stan 234
Summary and Evaluation 236
Where to Go From Here 239
Recommended Supplementary Readings 241
References and Suggested Readings 241
9 Behavior Therapy 244
Introduction 247
Key Concepts 250
The Therapeutic Process 252
Application: Therapeutic Techniques and Procedures 255
Behavior Therapy From a Multicultural Perspective 274
Behavior Therapy Applied to the Case of Stan 276
Summary and Evaluation 277
Where to Go From Here 281
ix
C
O
N
T
E
N
T
S
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

Recommended Supplementary Readings 282
References and Suggested Readings 282
10 Cognitive Behavior Therapy 287
Introduction 290
Albert Ellis’s Rational Emotive Behavior Therapy 291
Key Concepts 292
The Therapeutic Process 295
Application: Therapeutic Techniques and Procedures 297
Aaron Beck’s Cognitive Therapy 302
Donald Meichenbaum’s Cognitive Behavior Modification 310
Cognitive Behavior Therapy From a Multicultural Perspective 315
Cognitive Behavior Therapy Applied to the Case of Stan 318
Summary and Evaluation 320
Where to Go From Here 324
Recommended Supplementary Readings 327
References and Suggested Readings 327
11 Reality Therapy 333
Introduction 335
Key Concepts 336
The Therapeutic Process 340
Application: Therapeutic Techniques and Procedures 342
Reality Therapy From a Multicultural Perspective 349
Reality Therapy Applied to the Case of Stan 352
Summary and Evaluation 354
Where to Go From Here 356
Recommended Supplementary Readings 357
References and Suggested Readings 358
12 Feminist Therapy 360
Introduction 362
Key Concepts 367
The Therapeutic Process 370
Application: Therapeutic Techniques and Procedures 373
Feminist Therapy From a Multicultural and Social
Justice Perspective 380
Feminist Therapy Applied to the Case of Stan 382
Summary and Evaluation 384
Where to Go From Here 388
Recommended Supplementary Readings 390
References and Suggested Readings 391
x
C
O
N
T
E
N
T
S
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

13 Postmodern Approaches 395
Introduction to Social Constructionism 397
Solution-Focused Brief Therapy 400
Narrative Therapy 410
Postmodern Approaches From a Multicultural Perspective 419
Postmodern Approaches Applied to the Case of Stan 421
Summary and Evaluation 423
Where to Go From Here 426
Recommended Supplementary Readings 429
References and Suggested Readings 429
14 Family Systems Therapy 432
Introduction 434
Development of Family Systems Therapy and Personal
Development of the Family Therapist 437
A Multilayered Process of Family Therapy 445
Family Systems Therapy From a Multicultural Perspective 451
Family Systems Therapy Applied to the Case of Stan 452
Summary and Evaluation 456
Where to Go From Here 458
Recommended Supplementary Readings 458
References and Suggested Readings 459
PA R T 3
Integration and Application�463
15 An Integrative Perspective�464
Introduction 465
The Movement Toward Psychotherapy Integration 465
Issues Related to the Therapeutic Process 477
The Place of Techniques and Evaluation in Counseling 483
Summary 497
Where to Go From Here 498
Recommended Supplementary Readings 499
References and Suggested Readings 499
16 Case Illustration: An Integrative Approach
in Working With Stan 503
Counseling Stan: Integration of Therapies 504
Concluding Comments 521
A U T H O R I N D E X 523
S U B J E C T I N D E X 528
xi
C
O
N
T
E
N
T
S
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

xii
P
R
E
F
A
C
E
This book is intended for counseling courses for undergraduate and graduate stu-
dents in psychology, counselor education, human services, and the mental health
professions. It surveys the major concepts and practices of the contemporary ther-
apeutic systems and addresses some ethical and professional issues in counseling
practice. The book aims to teach students to select wisely from various theories and
techniques and to begin to develop a personal style of counseling.
I have found that students appreciate an overview of the divergent contem-
porary approaches to counseling and psychotherapy. They also consistently say
that the first course in counseling means more to them when it deals with them
personally. Therefore, I stress the practical application of the material and encour-
age reflection. Using this book can be both a personal and an academic learning
experience.
In this ninth edition, every effort has been made to retain the major qualities
that students and professors have found helpful in the previous editions: the suc-
cinct overview of the key concepts of each theory and their implications for prac-
tice, the straightforward and personal style, and the book’s comprehensive scope.
Care has been taken to present the theories in an accurate and fair way. I have at-
tempted to be simple, clear, and concise. Because many students want suggestions
for supplementary reading as they study each therapy approach, I have included an
updated reading list at the end of each chapter.
This edition updates the material and refines existing discussions. Part 1 deals
with issues that are basic to the practice of counseling and psychotherapy. Chapter 1
puts the book into perspective, then students are introduced to the counselor—
as a person and a professional—in Chapter 2. This chapter addresses a number
of topics pertaining to the role of the counselor as a person and the therapeutic
relationship. Chapter 3 introduces students to some key ethical issues in coun-
seling practice, and several of the topics in this chapter have been updated and
expanded.
Part 2 is devoted to a consideration of 11 theories of counseling. Each of the
theory chapters follows a common organizational pattern, and students can easily
compare and contrast the various models. This pattern includes core topics such
as key concepts, the therapeutic process, therapeutic techniques and procedures,
multicultural perspectives, theory applied to the case of Stan, and summary and
evaluation. In this ninth edition, all of the chapters in Part 2 have been revised,
updated, and expanded to reflect recent trends. Revisions were based on the rec-
ommendations of experts in each theory, all of whom are listed in the Acknowledg-
ments section. Both expert and general reviewers provided suggestions for adding,
replacing, and expanding material for this edition. Attention was given to current
Preface
n of 11 theo
zational patt
This pattern
erapeutic t
to the ca
he chapte
trends. R
, all of wh
eviewers
is edition.
f the
nts can easily
ludes core topics such
echniques and procedures,
e of Stan, and summary and
s in Part 2 ha
evisions w
m are li
rovide
Atten
ave been revised,
ere based on the rec-
sted in the Acknowledg-
suggestions for adding,
rental for t
uggestions for addin
on was given to curr
y p
mpare and cont
oncepts, the t
ral perspectiv
n this ninth
expanded to r
s of experts in
Both expert a
expanding m
key c
lticultu
uation.
ated, and
mendatio
ents sectio
replacing, an
up
om
m
g
onship. Chapter 3 in
eling practice, and several
expanded.
Part 2 is devoted to a consid
theory chapters follows a common
st the various m
rapeutic proce
theory applie
ion, all o
c
a
m
e
tion update
with issues that are bas
puts the book into pe
as a person and a pro
of topics p
rela
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

xiii
P
R
E
F
A
C
E
trends and recent developments in the practice of each theoretical approach. For
each chapter in Part 2, the citations have been updated.
Each of the 11 theory chapters summarizes key points and evaluates the con-
tributions, strengths, limitations, and applications of these theories. Special
attention is given to evaluating each theory from a multicultural perspective as
well, with a commentary on the strengths and shortcomings of the theory in
working with diverse client populations. The consistent organization of the sum-
mary and evaluation sections makes comparing theories easier. Students are
given recommendations regarding where to look for further training for all of the
approaches. Updated annotated lists of reading suggestions and extensive refer-
ences at the end of these chapters are offered to stimulate students to expand on
the material and broaden their learning through further reading. In addition, a
list of DVD resources has been added to the ninth edition for each of the theory
chapters.
w h at ’s n e w i n t h i s e d i t i o n
Significant changes for the ninth edition for each of the theory chapters are out-
lined below:
c h a p t e r 4 Psychoanalytic Therapy
Increased emphasis on the role of the relationship in analytic therapy
Increased coverage on contemporary psychodynamic therapy
Broadened discussion of relational psychoanalysis
A new perspective on therapist neutrality and anonymity
More emphasis on the role of termination in analytic therapy
New material on countertransference, its role in psychoanalytic therapy, and
guidelines for effectively dealing with countertransference
Expanded discussion of resistance and how to work with it effectively
Revised and expanded section on brief psychodynamic therapy
c h a p t e r 5 Adlerian Therapy
Revised material on the concept of lifestyle
Expanded discussion of social interest
New material on early recollections
Streamlined discussion of some key concepts
c h a p t e r 6 Existential Therapy
Revised material on existential themes
New and expanded coverage of the contributions of Irvin Yalom and James
Bugental to existential therapy
More attention on international developments of existential therapy
New material on main aims of existential therapy
Revised section on the client–therapist relationship
Revised discussion of strengths of the approach from a diversity perspective
New discussion of integration of existential concepts in other therapies
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

xiv
c h a p t e r 7 Person-Centered Therapy
Expanded coverage on the contributions and influence of Carl Rogers on the
counseling profession
New section on the Abraham Maslow’s contributions to humanistic philosophy
and psychology
New material on Maslow’s concept of self-actualization and relation to person-
centered philosophy
Broadened discussion of clients as active self-healers
Updated coverage of the core conditions of congruence, unconditional positive
regard, and empathy
Recent research on contextual factors as the main predictors of effective therapy
New material on the limitations and criticisms of the approach
New material on the diversity of styles of practicing person-centered therapy
More emphasis on how the basic philosophy of the person-centered approach
can be applied to other therapeutic modalities
Inclusion of emotion-focused therapy, stressing the role of emotions as a route
to change
Revised coverage on person-centered expressive arts
New section on motivational interviewing (person-centered approach with a twist)
Additional coverage of the stages of change as applied to motivational inter-
viewing
c h a p t e r 8 Gestalt Therapy
Revised discussion of the role of experiments in Gestalt therapy
More emphasis on therapist presence
Added description of emotion-focused therapy and its relationship to Gestalt
therapy
More attention to the relational approach to Gestalt practice
c h a p t e r 9 Behavior Therapy
Increased attention to the trends in contemporary behavior therapy
Broadened discussion of the role of the therapeutic relationship in behavior
therapy
Expanded and updated discussion of social skills training
Revision of multimodal therapy section
Revised discussion of systematic desensitization and exposure procedures
Revision of section on EMDR
More attention to the role of mindfulness and acceptance strategies in contem-
porary behavior therapy
New material on mindfulness-based cognitive therapy and stress reduction
Expanded and revised treatment of dialectical behavior therapy
c h a p t e r 1 0 Cognitive Behavior Therapy
Revised and expanded coverage of Aaron Beck’s cognitive therapy
Increased coverage of Judith Beck’s role in the development of cognitive therapy
P
R
E
F
A
C
E
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

xv
Increased attention on Donald Meichenbaum’s influence in the development
of CBT
New material on Meichenbaum’s stress inoculation training
Revised section on Meichenbaum’s constructivist approach to CBT
Increased coverage of relapse prevention
Increased discussion of CBT from a multicultural perspective
New material on the potential limitations of the multicultural applications of CBT
c h a p t e r 1 1 Reality Therapy
Revised discussion of the relationship of choice theory to reality therapy
Expanded discussion of the role of questions in reality therapy
Revision of section on the role of planning in reality therapy
More emphasis on the value of reality therapy with reluctant clients
Additional material on reality therapy from a diversity perspective
c h a p t e r 1 2 Feminist Therapy
Updated treatment of the principles of feminist therapy
Updated discussion of the role of assessment and diagnosis in feminist therapy
Increased attention given to empowerment
New example of applying feminist therapy interventions with the case of Alma
Revised and expanded discussion on therapeutic techniques and strategies
c h a p t e r 1 3 Postmodern Approaches
Additional material on parallels between solution-focused brief therapy and
positive psychology
Broadened discussion of the key concepts of solution-focused brief therapy
(SFBT)
More emphasis on the client-as-expert in the therapy relationship in postmod-
ern approaches
Revision of material on techniques in the postmodern approaches
New material on listening with an open mind in narrative therapy
More emphasis on the collaborative nature of narrative therapy and SFBT
c h a p t e r 1 4 Family Systems Therapy
A reconceptualization and streamlining of the chapter
New section describing the multilayered process of family therapy
More emphasis on the personal development of the family therapist
Addition of reflection questions to assist in the personal application of family
theory
New material on genogram work for understanding the self of the therapist
and clients
Expanded section on recent developments in family therapy
New material on the postmodern perspective on family therapy
More attention given to feminism, multiculturalism, and postmodern constru-
ctionism as applied to family therapy
P
R
E
F
A
C
E
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

xvi
In Part 3 readers are helped to put the concepts together in a meaningful
way through a discussion of the integrative perspective and consideration of a
case study. Chapter 15 (“An Integrative Perspective”) pulls together themes from
all 11 theoretical orientations. This chapter has been revised to expand discus-
sion of the psychotherapy integration movement; revise treatment of the various
integrative approaches; update and expand the section on integration of multi-
cultural issues in counseling; revise the section on integration of spirituality in
counseling; add material on research demonstrating the importance of the thera-
peutic relationship; more discussion on the central role of the client in determin-
ing therapy outcomes; and update coverage of the conclusions from the research
literature on the effectiveness of psychotherapy. Chapter 15 develops the notion
that an integrative approach to counseling practice is in keeping with meeting
the needs of diverse client populations in many different settings. Numerous
tables and other integrating material help students compare and contrast the 11
approaches.
The “Case of Stan” has been retained in Chapter 16 to help readers see the
application of a variety of techniques at various stages in the counseling process
with the same client. This chapter illustrates an integrative approach that draws
from all the therapies and applies a thinking, feeling, and behaving model in
counseling Stan. Applying the various theories to a single case example allows
for a comparison among the approaches. The video program (DVD for Theory
and Practice of Counseling and Psychotherapy: The Case of Stan and Lecturettes) can
be used as an ideal supplement to this chapter. For each of the 13 sessions in the
DVD program in my counseling with Stan, I apply just a few selected techniques
designed to illustrate each theory in action. New to accompany this ninth edition
is a series of lecturettes that I present for each chapter in this textbook. This ex-
panded DVD program now includes both demonstrations of my counseling with
Stan and brief lectures that highlight my perspective on the practical applications
of each theory.
This text can be used in a flexible way. Some instructors will follow my se-
quencing of chapters. Others will prefer to begin with the theory chapters (Part 2)
and then deal later with the student’s personal characteristics and ethical issues.
The topics can be covered in whatever order makes the most sense. Readers are
offered some suggestions for using this book in Chapter 1.
In this edition I have made every effort to incorporate those aspects that have
worked best in the courses on counseling theory and practice that I regularly teach.
To help readers apply theory to practice, I have also revised the Student Manual,
which is designed for experiential work. The Student Manual for Theory and Prac-
tice of Counseling and Psychotherapy still contains open-ended questions, many new
cases for exploration and discussion, structured exercises, self-inventories, and a
variety of activities that can be done both in class and out of class. The ninth edition
features a structured overview, as well as a glossary, for each of the theories, and
chapter quizzes for assessing the level of student mastery of basic concepts.
CourseMate, a new online resource, is available to accompany this textbook. It
contains the video program for Theory and Practice of Counseling and Psychotherapy:
P
R
E
F
A
C
E
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

xvii
The Case of Stan and Lecturettes, as well as a glossary of key terms, interviews with ex-
perts (questions and answers by experts in the various theories), and case examples
for each of the theories illustrating ways of applying these concepts and techniques
to a counseling case.
The newly revised and enlarged Case Approach to Counseling and Psychotherapy
(Eighth Edition) features experts working with the case of Ruth from the vari-
ous therapeutic approaches. The casebook can either supplement this book or
stand alone. An additional chapter covering transactional analysis is available on
WebTutor.® This material is provided in the same format as the 11 theory chapters
in this book and includes experiential exercises that can be completed individually
or in small groups.
Accompanying this ninth edition of the text and Student Manual is a DVD for
Integrative Counseling: The Case of Ruth and Lecturettes, in which I demonstrate an
integrative approach in counseling Ruth (the central character in the casebook).
It contains lecturettes on how I draw from key concepts and techniques from the
various theories presented in the book. This DVD program has been developed for
student purchase and use as a self-study program, and it makes an ideal learning
package that can be used in conjunction with this text and the Student Manual.
The Art of Integrative Counseling (Third Edition), which expands on the material in
Chapter 15 of the textbook, also complements this book.
Some professors have found the textbook and the Student Manual or the online
program (CourseMate) to be ideal companions and realistic resources for a single
course. Others like to use the textbook and the casebook as companions. With
this revision it is now possible to have a unique learning package of several books,
along with the DVD for Integrative Counseling: The Case of Ruth and Lecturettes. The
Case Approach to Counseling and Psychotherapy and the Art of Integrative Counseling
can also be used in a various classes, a few of which include case-management
practicum, fieldwork courses, or counseling techniques courses.
Also available is a revised and updated Instructor’s Resource Manual, which
includes suggestions for teaching the course, class activities to stimulate inter-
est, PowerPoint presentations for all chapters, and a variety of test questions
and final examinations. This instructor’s manual is now geared for the following
learning package: Theory and Practice of Counseling and Psychotherapy, Student
Manual for Theory and Practice of Counseling and Psychotherapy, Case Approach
to Counseling and Psychotherapy, The Art of Integrative Counseling, and two video
programs: DVD for Integrative Counseling: The Case of Ruth and Lecturettes, and
DVD for Theory and Practice of Counseling and Psychotherapy: The Case of Stan and
Lecturettes.
Acknowledgments
The suggestions I received from the many readers of prior editions who took the
time to complete the survey at the end of the book have been most helpful. Many
other people have contributed ideas that have found their way into this ninth
edition. I especially appreciate the time and efforts of the manuscript reviewers,
who offered constructive criticism and supportive commentaries, as well as those
P
R
E
F
A
C
E
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

professors who have used this book and provided me with feedback that has been
most useful in these revisions. Those who reviewed the complete manuscript of
the ninth edition are:
Sylinda Banks, Norfolk State University
Jayne Barnes, Nashua Community College
Eric Bruns, Campbellsville University
Joya Crear, George Mason University
Samantha Daniel, Fayetteville State University
Melodie Frick, West Texas A&M University
Amanda Healey, Sam Houston State University
Paula Nelson, Saint Leo University
Terence Patterson, University of San Francisco
Holly Seirup, Hofstra University
Special thanks are extended to the chapter reviewers, who provided consulta-
tion and detailed critiques. Their insightful and valuable comments have generally
been incorporated into this edition:
Chapter 4 (Psychoanalytic Therapy): William Blau, Copper Mountain College,
Joshua Tree, California; and J. Michael Russell of California State University,
Fullerton
Chapter 5 (Adlerian Therapy): James Robert Bitter, East Tennessee State
University, and I coauthored Chapter 5
Chapter 6 (Existential Therapy): Emmy van Deurzen, New School of Psy-
chotherapy and Counselling, London, England, and University of Sheffield;
J. Michael Russell of California State University, Fullerton; David N. Elkins,
Graduate School of Education and Psychology, Pepperdine University; Bryan
Farha, Oklahoma City College; Jamie Bludworth, private practice, Phoeniz,
Arizona; Kirk Schneider, the Existential-Humanistic Institute; and Victor
Yalom, president, Psychotherapy.Net
Chapter 7 (Person-Centered Therapy): Natalie Rogers, Person-Centered Ex-
pressive Arts Associates, Cotati, California; David N. Elkins, Graduate School
of Education and Psychology, Pepperdine University; and David Cain, Cali-
fornia School of Professional Psychology at Alliant International University,
San Diego
Chapter 8 (Gestalt Therapy): Jon Frew, Private Practice, Vancouver, Washington,
and Pacific University, Oregon; Ansel Woldt, Kent State University
Chapter 9 (Behavior Therapy): Sherry Cormier, West Virginia University;
Frank M. Dattilio, Harvard Medical School, and the University of Pennsylvania
School of Medicine; and Arnold A. Lazarus, Rutgers University, and the Lazarus
Institute
Chapter 10 (Cognitive Behavior Therapy): Sherry Cormier, West Virginia
University; Frank M. Dattilio, Harvard Medical School, and the University of
Pennsylvania School of Medicine; Windy Dryden, Professor of Psychothera-
peutic Studies at Goldsmiths College, London; and Donald Meichenbaum,
Research Director of the Melissa Institute for Violence Prevention
xviii
P
R
E
F
A
C
E
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

Chapter 11 (Reality Therapy): Robert Wubbolding, Center for Reality Therapy,
Cincinnati, Ohio
Chapter 12 (Feminist Therapy): Carolyn Zerbe Enns, Cornell College; Barbara
Herlihy, University of New Orleans, and I coauthored Chapter 12
Chapter 13 (Postmodern Approaches): John Winslade, California State Uni-
versity, San Bernardino; Linda Metcalf, Texas Women’s University, and the
Solution Focused Institute for Education and Training; and John Murphy, Uni-
versity of Central Arkansas
Chapter 14 (Family Systems Therapy): Jon Carlson, Governors State Univer-
sity; James Robert Bitter, East Tennessee State University, and I coauthored
Chapter 14
I want to acknowledge those on the Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning team who are
involved with our projects. These people include Seth Dobrin, editor of counseling,
social work, and human services; Julie Martinez, consulting editor, who monitored
the review process; Caryl Gorska, for her work on the interior design and cover of
this book; Elizabeth Momb, media editor; Naomi Dreyers, supplemental materials
for the book; Michelle Muratori, Johns Hopkins University, for her work on up-
dating the Instructor’s Resource Manual and assisting in developing the other sup-
plements; and Rita Jaramillo, project manager. We thank Ben Kolstad of Cenveo
Publisher Services, who coordinated the production of this book. Special recogni-
tion goes to Kay Mikel, the manuscript editor of this edition, whose exceptional
editorial talents continue to keep this book reader friendly. We appreciate Susan
Cunningham’s work in preparing the index. The efforts and dedication of all of
these people certainly contribute to the high quality of this edition.
– Gerald Corey
xix
P
R
E
F
A
C
E
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

28549_ch01_rev01.indd 2 20/09/11 2:50 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

3
p a r t 1
Basic Issues in
Counseling Practice
1 I n t r o d u c t i o n a n d O v e r v i e w 4
2 Th e Co u n s e lo r : P e r s o n a n d P r o f e s s i o n a l 17
3 E t h i c a l I s s u e s i n Co u n s e l i n g P r a c t i c e 36
R e c o m m e n d e d S u p p l e m e n ta ry R e a d i n g s
f o r Pa r t 1 53
R e f e r e n c e s a n d S u g g e s t e d R e a d i n g s
f o r Pa r t 1 55
28549_ch01_rev01.indd 3 20/09/11 2:50 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

4
i n t r o d u ct i o n
w h e r e i sta n d
s u g g est i o n s f o r u s i n g t h e b o o k
ov e rv i e w o f t h e t h eo ry c h a p t e r s
i n t r o d u ct i o n to t h e c a s e o f sta n
• Intake Interview and Stan’s Autobiography
• Overview of Some Key Themes in Stan’s Life
c h a p t e r 1
Introduction and Overview
4
28549_ch01_rev01.indd 4 20/09/11 2:50 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

i n t r o d u c t i o n
Counseling students can begin to acquire a counseling style tailored to their own
personality by familiarizing themselves with the major approaches to therapeutic
practice. This book surveys 11 approaches to counseling and psychotherapy, pre-
senting the key concepts of each approach and discussing features such as the
therapeutic process (including goals), the client–therapist relationship, and spe-
cifi c procedures used in the practice of counseling. This information will help you
develop a balanced view of the major ideas of each of the theories and acquaint
you with the practical techniques commonly employed by counselors who adhere
to each approach. I encourage you to keep an open mind and to seriously consider
both the unique contributions and the particular limitations of each therapeutic
system presented in Part 2.
You do not gain the knowledge and experience needed to synthesize various
approaches by merely completing an introductory course in counseling theory.
This process will take many years of study, training, and practical counseling ex-
perience. Nevertheless, I recommend a personal integration as a framework for
the professional education of counselors. The danger in presenting one model to
which all students are expected to subscribe is that it can limit their effectiveness
in working with a diverse range of future clients.
An undisciplined mixture of approaches, however, can be an excuse for
failing to develop a sound rationale for systematically adhering to certain con-
cepts and to the techniques that are extensions of them. It is easy to pick and
choose fragments from the various therapies because they support our biases
and preconceptions. By studying the models presented in this book, you will
have a better sense of how to integrate concepts and techniques from differ-
ent approaches when defi ning your own personal synthesis and framework for
counseling.
Each therapeutic approach has useful dimensions. It is not a matter of a theory
being “right” or “wrong,” as every theory offers a unique contribution to under-
standing human behavior and has unique implications for counseling practice.
Accepting the validity of one model does not necessarily imply rejecting other
models. There is a clear place for theoretical pluralism, especially in a society that
is becoming increasingly diverse.
Although I suggest that you remain open to incorporating diverse approaches
into your own personal synthesis—or integrative approach to counseling—let
me caution that you can become overwhelmed and confused if you attempt to
learn everything at once, especially if this is your introductory course in coun-
seling theories. A case can be made for initially getting an overview of the major
theoretical orientations, and then learning a particular approach by becoming
steeped in that approach for some time, rather than superfi cially grasping many
theoretical approaches. An integrative perspective is not developed in a random
fashion; rather, it is an ongoing process that is well thought out. Successfully
integrating concepts and techniques from diverse models requires years of refl ec-
tive practice and a great deal of reading about the various theories. In Chapter 15
5
I
N
T
R
O
D
U
C
T
I
O
N

A
N
D

O
V
E
R
V
I
E
W
28549_ch01_rev01.indd 5 20/09/11 2:50 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

6
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

O
N
E
I discuss in more depth some ways to begin designing your integrative approach
to counseling practice.
See the video program for Chapter 1, DVD for Theory and Practice of
Counseling and Psychotherapy: The Case of Stan and Lecturettes. I suggest
that you view the brief lecturette for each chapter in this book prior to
reading the chapter.
w h e r e i s ta n d
My philosophical orientation is strongly infl uenced by the existential approach.
Because this approach does not prescribe a set of techniques and procedures, I
draw techniques from the other models of therapy that are presented in this book.
I particularly like to use role-playing techniques. When people reenact scenes from
their lives, they tend to become more psychologically engaged than when they
merely report anecdotes about themselves. I also incorporate many techniques
derived from cognitive behavior therapy.
The psychoanalytic emphasis on early psychosexual and psychosocial develop-
ment is useful. Our past plays a crucial role in shaping our current personality and
behavior. I challenge the deterministic notion that humans are the product of their
early conditioning and, thus, are victims of their past. But I believe that an explora-
tion of the past is often useful, particularly to the degree that the past continues to
infl uence present-day emotional or behavioral diffi culties.
I value the cognitive behavioral focus on how our thinking affects the way we
feel and behave. These therapies also emphasize current behavior. Thinking and
feeling are important dimensions, but it can be a mistake to overemphasize them
and not explore how clients are behaving. What people are doing often gives us a
good clue to what they really want. I also like the emphasis on specifi c goals and
on encouraging clients to formulate concrete aims for their own therapy sessions
and in life. Contracts between clients and therapists can be very useful. I frequently
suggest either specifi c homework assignments or ask my clients to devise their own
assignments, or together we develop goals and tasks that guide the therapy process.
More approaches have been developing methods that involve collaboration be-
tween therapist and client, making the therapeutic venture a shared responsibility.
This collaborative relationship, coupled with teaching clients ways to use what they
learn in therapy in their everyday lives, empowers clients to take an active stance
in their world. It is imperative that clients be active, not only in their counseling
sessions but in daily life as well. Homework can be a vehicle for assisting clients in
putting into action what they are learning in therapy.
A related assumption of mine is that we can exercise increasing freedom to cre-
ate our future. The acceptance of personal responsibility does not imply that we can
be anything that we want. Social, environmental, cultural, and biological realities
oftentimes limit our freedom of choice. Being able to choose must be considered
in the sociopolitical contexts that exert pressure or create constraints; oppression
is a reality that can restrict our ability to choose our future. We are also infl uenced
by our social environment, and much of our behavior is a product of learning and
28549_ch01_rev01.indd 6 20/09/11 2:50 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

7
I
N
T
R
O
D
U
C
T
I
O
N

A
N
D

O
V
E
R
V
I
E
W
conditioning. That being said, I believe an increased awareness of these contextual
forces enables us to address these realities. It is crucial to learn how to cope with
the external and internal forces that limit our decisions and behavior.
Feminist therapy has contributed an awareness of how environmental and
social conditions contribute to the problems of women and men and how gender-
role socialization leads to a lack of gender equality. Family therapy teaches us that
it is not possible to understand the individual apart from the context of the system.
Both family therapy and feminist therapy are based on the premise that to un-
derstand the individual it is essential to take into consideration the interpersonal
dimensions and the sociocultural context rather than focusing primarily on the
intrapsychic domain. Thus a comprehensive approach to counseling goes beyond
focusing on our internal dynamics and addresses those environmental and sys-
temic realities that infl uence us.
My philosophy of counseling does not include the assumption that therapy is
exclusively for the “sick” and is aimed at “curing” psychological “ailments.” Such
a focus on the medical model restricts therapeutic practice because it stresses
defi cits rather than strengths. Instead, I agree with the postmodern approaches
(see Chapter 13), which are grounded on the assumption that people have both
internal and external resources to draw upon when constructing solutions to their
problems. Therapists will view these individuals quite differently if they acknowl-
edge that their clients possess competencies rather than pathologies. I view each
individual as having resources and competencies that can be discovered and built
upon in therapy.
Psychotherapy is a process of engagement between two people, both of whom
are bound to change through the therapeutic venture. At its best, this is a collabora-
tive process that involves both the therapist and the client in co-constructing
solutions to concerns. Most of the theories described in this book emphasize the
collaborative nature of the practice of psychotherapy.
Therapists are not in business to change clients, to give them quick advice, or
to solve their problems for them. Instead, counselors facilitate healing through
a process of genuine dialogue with their clients. The kind of person a therapist
is remains the most critical factor affecting the client and promoting change. If
practitioners possess wide knowledge, both theoretical and practical, yet lack
human qualities of compassion, caring, good faith, honesty, presence, realness,
and sensitivity, they are more like technicians. In my judgment those who func-
tion exclusively as technicians do not make a signifi cant difference in the lives of
their clients. It is essential that counselors explore their own values, attitudes, and
beliefs in depth and work to increase their own awareness. Throughout the book,
I encourage you to fi nd ways to personally relate to each of the therapies. Applying
this material to yourself personally takes you beyond a mere academic understand-
ing of theories.
With respect to mastering the techniques of counseling and applying them
appropriately and effectively, it is my belief that you are your own very best tech-
nique. Your reactions to your clients, including sharing how you are affected in
the relationship with them, are useful in moving the therapeutic process along.
28549_ch01_rev01.indd 7 20/09/11 2:50 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

8
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

O
N
E
It is impossible to separate the techniques you use from your personality and the
relationship you have with your clients.
Administering techniques to clients without regard for the relationship var-
iables is ineffective. Techniques cannot substitute for the hard work it takes to
develop a constructive client–therapist relationship. Although you can learn atti-
tudes and skills and acquire certain knowledge about personality dynamics and
the therapeutic process, much of effective therapy is the product of artistry. Coun-
seling entails far more than becoming a skilled technician. It implies that you are
able to establish and maintain a good working relationship with your clients, that
you can draw on your own experiences and reactions, and that you can identify
techniques suited to the needs of your clients.
As a counselor, you need to remain open to your own personal development
and to address your personal problems. The most powerful ways for you to teach
your clients is by the behavior you model and by the ways you connect with
them. I suggest you experience a wide variety of techniques yourself as a client.
Reading about a technique in a book is one thing; actually experiencing it from
the vantage point of a client is quite another. If you have practiced mindfulness
exercises, for example, you will have a much better sense for guiding clients in
the practice of becoming increasingly mindful in daily life. If you have carried
out real-life homework assignments as part of your own self-change program,
you can increase your empathy for clients and their potential problems. Your
own anxiety over self-disclosing and addressing personal concerns can be a most
useful anchoring point as you work with the anxieties of your clients. The cour-
age you display in your therapy will help you appreciate how essential courage is
for your clients.
Your personal characteristics are of primary importance in becoming a coun-
selor, but it is not suffi cient to be merely a good person with good intentions. To
be effective, you also must have supervised experiences in counseling and sound
knowledge of counseling theory and techniques. Further, it is essential to be well
grounded in the various theories of personality and to learn how they are related to
theories of counseling. Your conception of the person and the individual characteris-
tics of your client affect the interventions you will make. Differences between you
and your client may require modifi cation of certain aspects of the theories. Some
practitioners make the mistake of relying on one type of intervention (supportive,
confrontational, information giving) for most clients with whom they work. In
reality, different clients may respond better to one type of intervention than to
another. Even during the course of an individual’s therapy, different interventions
may be needed at different times. Practitioners should acquire a broad base of
counseling techniques that are suitable for individual clients rather than forcing
clients to fi t one approach to counseling.
s u g g e s t i o n s f o r u s i n g t h e b o o k
Here are some specifi c recommendations on how to get the fullest value from this
book. The personal tone of the book invites you to relate what you are reading to your
own experiences. As you read Chapter 2, “The Counselor: Person and Professional,”
28549_ch01_rev01.indd 8 20/09/11 2:50 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

9
I
N
T
R
O
D
U
C
T
I
O
N

A
N
D

O
V
E
R
V
I
E
W
begin the process of refl ecting on your needs, motivations, values, and life expe-
riences. Consider how you are likely to bring the person you are becoming into
your professional work. You will assimilate much more knowledge about the vari-
ous therapies if you make a conscious attempt to apply their key concepts and
techniques to your own personal life. Chapter 2 helps you think about how to use
yourself as your single most important therapeutic instrument, and it addresses a
number of signifi cant ethical issues in counseling practice.
Before you study each therapy in depth in Part 2, I suggest that you at least
briefl y read Chapter 15, which provides a comprehensive review of the key concepts
from all 11 theories presented in this textbook. I try to show how an integration of
these perspectives can form the basis for creating your own personal synthesis to
counseling. In developing an integrative perspective, it is essential to think holisti-
cally. To understand human functioning, it is imperative to account for the physi-
cal, emotional, mental, social, cultural, political, and spiritual dimensions. If any
of these facets of human experience is neglected, a theory is limited in explaining
how we think, feel, and act.
To provide you with a consistent framework for comparing and contrasting
the various therapies, the 11 theory chapters share a common format. This format
includes a few notes on the personal history of the founder or another key fi gure;
a brief historical sketch showing how and why each theory developed at the time
it did; a discussion of the approach’s key concepts; an overview of the therapeutic
process, including the therapist’s role and client’s work; therapeutic techniques
and procedures; applications of the theory from a multicultural perspective;
application of the theory to the case of Stan; a summary and evaluation; sugges-
tions of how to continue your learning about each approach; and suggestions for
further reading.
Refer to the preface for a complete description of other resources that fi t as a
package and complement this textbook, including Student Manual for Theory and
Practice of Counseling and Psychotherapy and DVD for Integrative Counseling: The
Case of Ruth and Lecturettes. In addition, in DVD for Theory and Practice of Coun-
seling and Psychotherapy: The Case of Stan and Lecturettes, I demonstrate my way of
counseling Stan from the various theoretical approaches in 13 sessions and present
my perspective on the key concepts of each theory in a brief lecture, with emphasis
on the practical application of the theory.
o v e r v i e w o f t h e t h e o ry c h a p t e r s
I have selected 11 therapeutic approaches for this book. Table 1.1 presents an over-
view of these approaches, which are explored in depth in Chapters 4 through 14. I
have grouped these approaches into four general categories.
First are the psychodynamic approaches. Psychoanalytic therapy is based largely
on insight, unconscious motivation, and reconstruction of the personality. The
psychoanalytic model appears fi rst because it has had a major infl uence on all of
the other formal systems of psychotherapy. Some of the therapeutic models are ba-
sically extensions of psychoanalysis, others are modifi cations of analytic concepts
and procedures, and still others are positions that emerged as a reaction against
28549_ch01_rev01.indd 9 20/09/11 2:50 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

10
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

O
N
E
TA B L E 1 .1 Overview of Contemporary Counseling Models
Psychodynamic Approaches
Psychoanalytic therapy Founder: Sigmund Freud. A theory of personality
development, a philosophy of human nature, and a method
of psychotherapy that focuses on unconscious factors that
motivate behavior. Attention is given to the events of the fi rst
6 years of life as determinants of the later development of
personality.
Adlerian therapy Founder: Alfred Adler. Key Figure: Following Adler, Rudolf
Dreikurs is credited with popularizing this approach in the
United States. This is a growth model that stresses assuming
responsibility, creating one’s own destiny, and fi nding meaning
and goals to create a purposeful life. Key concepts are used in
most other current therapies.
Experiential and Relationship-Oriented Therapies
Existential therapy Key fi gures: Viktor Frankl, Rollo May, and Irvin Yalom.
Reacting against the tendency to view therapy as a system of
well-defi ned techniques, this model stresses building therapy
on the basic conditions of human existence, such as choice,
the freedom and responsibility to shape one’s life, and self-
determination. It focuses on the quality of the person-to-person
therapeutic relationship.
Person-centered therapy Founder: Carl Rogers. Key fi gure: Natalie Rogers. This approach
was developed during the 1940s as a nondirective reaction
against psychoanalysis. Based on a subjective view of human
experiencing, it places faith in and gives responsibility to the
client in dealing with problems and concerns.
Gestalt therapy Founders: Fritz and Laura Perls. Key fi gures: Miriam and
Erving Polster. An experiential therapy stressing awareness and
integration; it grew as a reaction against analytic therapy.
It integrates the functioning of body and mind.
Cognitive Behavioral Approaches
Behavior therapy Key fi gures: B. F. Skinner, Arnold Lazarus, and Albert Bandura.
This approach applies the principles of learning to the
resolution of specifi c behavioral problems. Results are subject
to continual experimentation. The methods of this approach are
always in the process of refi nement.
Cognitive behavior therapy Key fi gure: A. T. Beck founded cognitive therapy, which gives
a primary role to thinking as it infl uences behavior; Judith
Beck continues to develop CBT. Donald Meichenbaum is
a prominent contributor to the development of cognitive
behavior therapy.
28549_ch01_rev01.indd 10 20/09/11 2:50 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

11
I
N
T
R
O
D
U
C
T
I
O
N

A
N
D

O
V
E
R
V
I
E
W
psychoanalysis. Many theories of counseling and psychotherapy have borrowed
and integrated principles and techniques from psychoanalytic approaches.
Adlerian therapy differs from psychoanalytic theory in many respects, but it can
broadly be considered an analytic perspective. Adlerians focus on meaning, goals,
purposeful behavior, conscious action, belonging, and social interest. Although
Adlerian theory accounts for present behavior by studying childhood experiences,
it does not focus on unconscious dynamics.
The second category comprises the experiential and relationship-oriented thera-
pies: the existential approach, the person-centered approach, and Gestalt therapy.
The existential approach stresses a concern for what it means to be fully human.
Rational emotive
behavior therapy
Key fi gure: Albert Ellis founded rational emotive behavior
therapy, a highly didactic, cognitive, action-oriented model of
therapy that stresses the role of thinking and belief systems as
the root of personal problems.
Reality therapy Founder: William Glasser. Key fi gure: Robert Wubbolding. This
short-term approach is based on choice theory and focuses on
the client assuming responsibility in the present. Through the
therapeutic process, the client is able to learn more effective
ways of meeting her or his needs.
Systems and Postmodern Approaches
Feminist therapy This approach grew out of the efforts of many women, a few
of whom are Jean Baker Miller, Carolyn Zerbe Enns, Oliva
Espin, and Laura Brown. A central concept is the concern
for the psychological oppression of women. Focusing on
the constraints imposed by the sociopolitical status to which
women have been relegated, this approach explores women’s
identity development, self-concept, goals and aspirations, and
emotional well-being.
Postmodern approaches A number of key fi gures are associated with the development of
these various approaches to therapy. Steve de Shazer and Insoo
Kim Berg are the co-founders of solution-focused brief therapy.
Michael White and David Epston are the major fi gures associated
with narrative therapy. Social constructionism, solution-focused
brief therapy, and narrative therapy all assume that there is
no single truth; rather, it is believed that reality is socially
constructed through human interaction. These approaches
maintain that the client is an expert in his or her own life.
Family systems therapy A number of signifi cant fi gures have been pioneers of the
family systems approach, including Alfred Adler, Murray
Bowen, Virginia Satir, Carl Whitaker, Salvador Minuchin, Jay
Haley, and Cloé Madanes. This systemic approach is based
on the assumption that the key to changing the individual is
understanding and working with the family.
28549_ch01_rev01.indd 11 20/09/11 2:50 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

12
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

O
N
E
It suggests certain themes that are part of the human condition, such as freedom
and responsibility, anxiety, guilt, awareness of being fi nite, creating meaning in
the world, and shaping one’s future by making active choices. This approach is not
a unifi ed school of therapy with a clear theory and a systematic set of techniques.
Rather, it is a philosophy of counseling that stresses the divergent methods of
understanding the subjective world of the person. The person-centered approach,
which is rooted in a humanistic philosophy, places emphasis on the basic attitudes
of the therapist. It maintains that the quality of the client–therapist relationship
is the prime determinant of the outcomes of the therapeutic process. Philosophi-
cally, this approach assumes that clients have the capacity for self-direction without
active intervention and direction on the therapist’s part. Another experiential ap-
proach is Gestalt therapy, which offers a range of experiments to help clients gain
awareness of what they are experiencing in the here and now—that is, the present.
In contrast to person-centered therapists, Gestalt therapists tend to take an active
role, yet they follow the leads provided by their clients. These approaches tend to
emphasize emotion as a route to bringing about change, and in a sense, they can
be considered emotion-focused therapies.
Third are the cognitive behavioral approaches, sometimes known as the action-
oriented therapies, because they all emphasize translating insights into behav-
ioral action. These approaches include reality therapy, behavior therapy, rational
emotive behavior therapy, and cognitive therapy. Reality therapy focuses on cli-
ents’ current behavior and stresses developing clear plans for new behaviors.
Like reality therapy, behavior therapy puts a premium on doing and on taking
steps to make concrete changes. A current trend in behavior therapy is toward
paying increased attention to cognitive factors as an important determinant of
behavior. Rational emotive behavior therapy and cognitive therapy highlight the
necessity of learning how to challenge inaccurate beliefs and automatic thoughts
that lead to behavioral problems. These cognitive behavioral approaches are used
to help people modify their inaccurate and self-defeating assumptions and to
develop new patterns of acting.
The fourth general approach encompasses the systems and postmodern perspec-
tives. Feminist therapy and family therapy are systems approaches, but they also
share postmodern notions. The systems orientation stresses the importance of
understanding individuals in the context of the surroundings that infl uence their
development. To bring about individual change, it is essential to pay attention to
how the individual’s personality has been affected by his or her gender-role sociali-
zation, culture, family, and other systems.
The postmodern approaches include social constructionism, solution-focused
brief therapy, and narrative therapy. These newer approaches challenge the basic
assumptions of most of the traditional approaches by assuming that there is no sin-
gle truth and that reality is socially constructed through human interaction. Both
the postmodern and the systemic theories focus on how people produce their own
lives in the context of systems, interactions, social conditioning, and discourse.
In my view, practitioners need to pay attention to what their clients are think-
ing, feeling, and doing, and a complete therapy system must address all three of
28549_ch01_rev01.indd 12 20/09/11 2:50 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

13
I
N
T
R
O
D
U
C
T
I
O
N

A
N
D

O
V
E
R
V
I
E
W
these facets. Some of the therapies included here highlight the role that cognitive
factors play in counseling. Others place emphasis on the experiential aspects of
counseling and the role of feelings. Still others emphasize putting plans into action
and learning by doing. Combining all of these dimensions provides the basis
for a comprehensive therapy. If any of these dimensions is excluded, the therapy
approach is incomplete.
i n t r o d u c t i o n to t h e c a s e o f s ta n
You will learn a great deal by seeing a theory in action, preferably in a live
demonstration or as part of experiential activities in which you function in the
alternating roles of client and counselor. An online program (available in DVD
format as well) demonstrates one or two techniques from each of the theories.
As Stan’s counselor, I show how I would apply some of the principles of each
of the theories you are studying to Stan. Many of my students fi nd this case
history of the hypothetical client (Stan) helpful in understanding how various
techniques are applied to the same person. Stan’s case, which describes his life
and struggles, is presented here to give you signifi cant background material to
draw from as you study the applications of the theories. Each of the 11 theory
chapters in Part 2 includes a discussion of how a therapist with the orientation
under discussion is likely to proceed with Stan. We examine the answers to
questions such as these:
• What themes in Stan’s life merit special attention in therapy?
• What concepts would be useful to you in working with Stan on his problems?
• What are the general goals of Stan’s therapy?
• What possible techniques and methods would best meet these goals?
• What are some characteristics of the relationship between Stan and his therapist?
• How might the therapist proceed?
• How might the therapist evaluate the process and treatment outcomes of therapy?
In Chapter 16 (which I recommend you read early) I present how I would work
with Stan, suggesting concepts and techniques I would draw on from many of the
models (forming an integrative approach).
A single case illustrates both contrasts and parallels among the approaches.
It also will help you understand the practical applications of the 11 models and
provide a basis for integrating them. A summary of the intake interview with Stan,
his autobiography, and some key themes in his life are presented next to provide
a context for making sense of the way therapists with various theoretical orienta-
tions might work with Stan. Try to fi nd attributes of each approach that you can
incorporate into a personalized style of counseling.
Intake Interview and Stan’s Autobiography
The setting is a community mental health agency where both individual and group
counseling are available. Stan comes to counseling because of his drinking. He
was convicted of driving under the infl uence, and the judge determined that he
needed professional help. Stan recognizes that he does have problems, but he is
28549_ch01_rev01.indd 13 20/09/11 2:50 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

14
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

O
N
E
not convinced that he is addicted to alcohol. Stan arrives for an intake interview
and provides the counselor with this information:
At the present time I work in construction. I like building houses, but probably won’t stay
in construction for the rest of my life. When it comes to my personal life, I’ve always had
diffi culty in getting along with people. I could be called a “loner.” I like people in my life,
but I don’t seem to know how to stay close to people. It probably has a lot to do with why I
drink. I’m not very good at making friends or getting close to people. Probably the reason I
sometimes drink a bit too much is because I’m so scared when it comes to socializing. Even
though I hate to admit it, when I drink, things are not quite so overwhelming. When I look
at others, they seem to know the right things to say. Next to them I feel dumb. I’m afraid
that people don’t fi nd me very interesting. I’d like to turn my life around, but I just don’t
know where to begin. That’s why I went back to school. I’m a part-time college student ma-
joring in psychology. I want to better myself. In one of my classes, Psychology of Personal
Adjustment, we talked about ourselves and how people change. We also had to write an
autobiographical paper.
That is the essence of Stan’s introduction. The counselor says that she would
like to read his autobiography. Stan hopes it will give her a better understanding
of where he has been and where he would like to go. He brings her the autobiog-
raphy, which reads as follows:
Where am I currently in my life? At 35 I feel that I’ve wasted most of my life. I should be
fi nished with college and into a career by now, but instead I’m only a junior. I can’t afford
to really commit myself to pursuing college full time because I need to work to support
myself. Even though construction work is hard, I like the satisfaction I get when I look at
what I have done.
I want to get into a profession where I could work with people. Someday, I’m hoping to get
a master’s degree in counseling or in social work and eventually work as a counselor with
kids who are in trouble. I know I was helped by someone who cared about me, and I would
like to do the same for someone else.
I have few friends and feel scared around most people. I feel good with kids. But I wonder
if I’m smart enough to get through all the classes I’ll need to become a counselor. One of
my problems is that I frequently get drunk. This happens when I feel alone and when I’m
scared of the intensity of my feelings. At fi rst drinking seemed to help, but later on I felt
awful. I have abused drugs in the past also.
I feel overwhelmed and intimidated when I’m around attractive women. I feel cold, sweaty,
and terribly nervous. I think they may be judging me and see me as not much of a man.
I’m afraid I just don’t measure up to being a real man. When I am sexually intimate with a
woman, I am anxious and preoccupied with what she is thinking about me.
I feel anxiety much of the time. I often feel as if I’m dying inside. I think about committing
suicide, and I wonder who would care. I can see my family coming to my funeral feeling
sorry for me. I feel guilty that I haven’t worked up to my potential, that I’ve been a failure,
that I’ve wasted much of my time, and that I let people down a lot. I get down on myself and
wallow in guilt and feel very depressed. At times like this I feel hopeless and that I’d be better
off dead. For all these reasons, I fi nd it diffi cult to get close to anyone.
There are a few bright spots. I did put a lot of my shady past behind me, and did get into
college. I like this determination in me—I want to change. I’m tired of feeling the way I do.
I know that nobody is going to change my life for me. It’s up to me to get what I want. Even
though I feel scared at times, I like that I’m willing to take risks.
What was my past like? A major turning point for me was the confi dence my supervisor
had in me at the youth camp where I worked the past few summers. He helped me get my
28549_ch01_rev01.indd 14 20/09/11 2:50 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

15
I
N
T
R
O
D
U
C
T
I
O
N

A
N
D

O
V
E
R
V
I
E
W
job, and he also encouraged me to go to college. He said he saw a lot of potential in me for
being able to work well with young people. That was hard for me to believe, but his faith
inspired me to begin to believe in myself. Another turning point was my marriage and
divorce. This marriage didn’t last long. It made me wonder about what kind of man I was!
Joyce was a strong and dominant woman who kept repeating how worthless I was and how
she did not want to be around me. We had sex only a few times, and most of the time I was
not very good at it. That was hard to take. It made me afraid to get close to a woman. My
parents should have divorced. They fought most of the time. My mother (Angie) constantly
criticized my father (Frank Sr.). I saw him as weak and passive. He would never stand up
to her. There were four of us kids. My parents compared me unfavorably with my older
sister (Judy) and older brother (Frank Jr.). They were “perfect” children, successful honors
students. My younger brother (Karl) and I fought a lot. They spoiled him. It was all very
hard for me.
In high school I started using drugs. I was thrown into a youth rehabilitation facility for
stealing. Later I was expelled from regular school for fi ghting, and I landed in a continua-
tion high school, where I went to school in the mornings and had afternoons for on-the-job
training. I got into auto mechanics, was fairly successful, and even managed to keep myself
employed for 3 years as a mechanic.
I can still remember my father asking me: “Why can’t you be like your sister and brother?
Why can’t you do anything right?” And my mother treated me much the way she treated my
father. She would say: “Why do you do so many things to hurt me? Why can’t you grow up
and be a man? Things are so much better around here when you’re gone.” I recall crying
myself to sleep many nights, feeling terribly alone. There was no talk of religion in my house,
nor was there any talk of sex. In fact, I fi nd it hard to imagine my folks ever having sex.
Where would I like to be 5 years from now? What kind of person do I want to become? Most
of all, I would like to start feeling better about myself. I would like to be able to stop drink-
ing altogether and still feel good. I want to like myself much more than I do now. I hope
I can learn to love at least a few other people, most of all, a woman. I want to lose my fear
of women. I would like to feel equal with others and not always have to feel apologetic for
my existence. I want to let go of my anxiety and guilt. I want to become a good counselor
for kids. I’m not certain how I’ll change or even what all the changes are I hope for. I do
know that I want to be free of my self-destructive tendencies and learn how to trust people
more. Perhaps when I begin to like myself more, I’ll be able to trust that others will fi nd
something about me to like.
Effective therapists, regardless of their theoretical orientation, would pay atten-
tion to suicidal thoughts. In his autobiography Stan says, “I think about commit-
ting suicide.” At times he doubts that he will ever change and wonders if he’d be
“better off dead.” Before embarking on the therapeutic journey, the therapist would
need to make an assessment of Stan’s current ego strength (or his ability to manage
life realistically), which would include a discussion of his suicidal thoughts.
Overview of Some Key Themes in Stan’s Life
A number of themes appear to represent core struggles in Stan’s life. Here are
some of the statements we can assume that he may make at various points in his
therapy and themes that will be addressed from the theoretical perspectives in
Chapters 4 through 14:
• Although I’d like to have people in my life, I just don’t seem to know how to go
about making friends or getting close to people.
• I’d like to turn my life around, but I have no sense of direction.
28549_ch01_rev01.indd 15 20/09/11 2:50 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

16
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

O
N
E
• I want to make a difference.
• I am afraid of failure.
• I know that when I feel alone, scared, and overwhelmed, I drink heavily to feel
better.
• I am afraid of women.
• Sometimes at night I feel a terrible anxiety and feel as if I’m dying.
• I often feel guilty that I’ve wasted my life, that I’ve failed, and that I’ve let people
down. At times like this, I get depressed.
• I like it that I have determination and that I really want to change.
• I’ve never really felt loved or wanted by my parents.
• I’d like to get rid of my self-destructive tendencies and learn to trust people more.
• I put myself down a lot, but I’d like to feel better about myself.
In Chapters 4 through 14, I write about how I would apply selected concepts
and techniques of the particular theory in counseling Stan. In addition, in these
chapters you are asked to think about how you would continue counseling Stan
from each of these different perspectives. In doing so, refer to the introductory
material given here and to Stan’s autobiography as well. To make the case of Stan
come alive for each theory, I highly recommend that you view and study the video
program, DVD for Theory and Practice of Counseling and Psychotherapy: The Case of
Stan and Lecturettes. In this video program I counsel Stan from each of the various
theories and provide brief lectures that highlight each theory.
28549_ch01_rev01.indd 16 20/09/11 2:50 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

17
i n t r o d u ct i o n
t h e co u n s e lo r a s
a t h e r a p e u t i c p e r s o n
p e r s o n a l t h e r a p y
f o r t h e co u n s e lo r
t h e co u n s e lo r ’s va l u es
a n d t h e t h e r a p e u t i c p r o c es s
b eco m i n g a n e f f ect i v e
m u lt i c u lt u r a l co u n s e lo r
issues faced by beginning
therapists
s u m m a ry
c h a p t e r 2
The Counselor: Person
and Professional
b eco m i n g a n
m u lt i c u lt u r
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

18
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
W
O
i n t r o d u c t i o n
One of the most important instruments you have to work with as a counselor is
yourself as a person. In preparing for counseling, you will acquire knowledge about
the theories of personality and psychotherapy, learn assessment and intervention
techniques, and discover the dynamics of human behavior. Such knowledge and
skills are essential, but by themselves they are not suffi cient for establishing and
maintaining effective therapeutic relationships. To every therapy session we bring
our human qualities and the experiences that have infl uenced us. In my judg-
ment, this human dimension is one of the most powerful infl uences on the thera-
peutic process.
A good way to begin your study of contemporary counseling theories is by
refl ecting on the personal issues raised in this chapter. By remaining open to self-
evaluation, you not only expand your awareness of self but also build the founda-
tion for developing your abilities and skills as a professional. The theme of this
chapter is that the person and the professional are intertwined facets that cannot be
separated in reality. We know, clinically and scientifi cally, that the person of the
therapist and the therapeutic relationship contribute to therapy outcome at least
as much as the particular treatment method used (Duncan, Miller, Wampold, &
Hubble, 2010; Norcross, 2011; Norcross & Guy, 2007).
See the DVD program for Chapter 2, DVD for Theory and Practice of Counseling
and Psychotherapy: The Case of Stan and Lecturettes. I suggest that you view
the brief lecture for each chapter prior to reading the chapter.
t h e c o u n s e lo r a s a
t h e r a p e u t i c p e r s o n
Because counseling is an intimate form of learning, it demands a practitioner who
is willing to be an authentic person in the therapeutic relationship. It is within the
context of such a person-to-person connection that the client experiences growth.
If we hide behind the safety of our professional role, our clients will likely keep
themselves hidden from us. If we strive for technical expertise alone, and leave our
own reactions and self out of our work, the result is likely to be ineffective coun-
seling. Our own genuineness can have a signifi cant effect on our relationship with
our clients. If we are willing to look at our lives and make the changes we want, we
can model that process by the way we reveal ourselves and respond to our clients.
If we are inauthentic, our clients will probably pick that up and be discouraged
by it. Our clients can be encouraged by our way of being with them. If we model
authenticity by engaging in appropriate self-disclosure, our clients will tend to be
honest with us as well.
I believe that who the psychotherapist is directly relates to his or her ability
to establish and maintain effective therapy relationships with clients. But what
does the research reveal about the role of the counselor as a person and the thera-
peutic relationship on psychotherapy outcome? Abundant research indicates the
centrality of the person of the therapist as a primary factor in successful therapy
28549_ch02_rev01.indd 18 20/09/11 2:49 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

19
T
H
E

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
O
R
:

P
E
R
S
O
N

A
N
D

P
R
O
F
E
S
S
I
O
N
A
L
(Norcross & Lambert, 2011; Norcross & Wampold, 2011). Clients place more value
on the personality of the therapist than on the specifi c techniques used (Lambert,
2011). Norcross and Lambert (2011) cite considerable evidence indicating that the
person of the psychotherapist is inextricably intertwined with the outcome of psy-
chotherapy. Indeed, evidence-based psychotherapy relationships are critical to the
psychotherapy endeavor.
Techniques themselves have limited importance in the therapeutic process.
Wampold (2001) conducted a meta-analysis of many research studies on therapeu-
tic effectiveness and found that the personal and interpersonal components are es-
sential to effective psychotherapy, whereas techniques have relatively little effect on
therapeutic outcome. The contextual factors—the alliance, the relationship, the per-
sonal and interpersonal skills of the therapist, client agency, and extra-therapeutic
factors—are the primary determinants of therapeutic outcome. This research sup-
ports what humanistic psychologists have maintained for years: “It is not theories
and techniques that heal the suffering client but the human dimension of therapy
and the ‘meetings’ that occur between therapist and client as they work together”
(Elkins, 2009, p. 82). In short, both the therapy relationship and the therapy methods
used infl uence the outcomes of treatment, but it is essential that the methods used
support the therapeutic relationship being formed with the client.
Personal Characteristics of Effective Counselors
Particular personal qualities and characteristics of counselors are signifi cant in
creating a therapeutic alliance with clients. My views regarding these personal
characteristics are supported by research on this topic (Norcross, 2011; Skovholt &
Jennings, 2004). I do not expect any therapist to fully exemplify all the traits de-
scribed in the list that follows. Rather, the willingness to struggle to become a
more therapeutic person is the crucial variable. This list is intended to stimulate
you to examine your own ideas about what kind of person can make a signifi cant
difference in the lives of others.
• Effective therapists have an identity. They know who they are, what they are capa-
ble of becoming, what they want out of life, and what is essential.
• Effective therapists respect and appreciate themselves. They can give and receive
help and love out of their own sense of self-worth and strength. They feel ad-
equate with others and allow others to feel powerful with them.
• Effective therapists are open to change. They exhibit a willingness and courage to
leave the security of the known if they are not satisfi ed with the way they are.
They make decisions about how they would like to change, and they work
toward becoming the person they want to become.
• Effective therapists make choices that are life oriented. They are aware of early
decisions they made about themselves, others, and the world. They are not the
victims of these early decisions, and they are willing to revise them if necessary.
They are committed to living fully rather than settling for mere existence.
• Effective therapists are authentic, sincere, and honest. They do not hide behind rigid
roles or facades. Who they are in their personal life and in their professional
work is congruent.
28549_ch02_rev01.indd 19 20/09/11 2:49 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

20
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
W
O
• Effective therapists have a sense of humor. They are able to put the events of life
in perspective. They have not forgotten how to laugh, especially at their own
foibles and contradictions.
• Effective therapists make mistakes and are willing to admit them. They do not dis-
miss their errors lightly, yet they do not choose to dwell on them, either.
• Effective therapists generally live in the present. They are not riveted to the past, nor
are they fi xated on the future. They are able to experience and be present with
others in the “now.”
• Effective therapists appreciate the infl uence of culture. They are aware of the ways
in which their own culture affects them, and they respect the diversity of values
espoused by other cultures. They are sensitive to the unique differences arising
out of social class, race, sexual orientation, and gender.
• Effective therapists have a sincere interest in the welfare of others. This concern is
based on respect, care, trust, and a real valuing of others.
• Effective therapists possess effective interpersonal skills. They are capable of entering
the world of others without getting lost in this world, and they strive to create
collaborative relationships with others. They readily entertain another person’s
perspective and can work together toward consensual goals.
• Effective therapists become deeply involved in their work and derive meaning from it.
They can accept the rewards fl owing from their work, yet they are not slaves to
their work.
• Effective therapists are passionate. They have the courage to pursue their dreams
and passions, and they radiate a sense of energy.
• Effective therapists are able to maintain healthy boundaries. Although they strive to
be fully present for their clients, they don’t carry the problems of their clients
around with them during leisure hours. They know how to say no, which ena-
bles them to maintain balance in their lives.
This picture of the characteristics of effective therapists might appear unreal-
istic. Who could be all those things? Certainly I do not fi t this bill! Do not think of
these personal characteristics from an all-or-nothing perspective; rather, consider
them on a continuum. A given trait may be highly characteristic of you, at one
extreme, or it may be very uncharacteristic of you, at the other extreme. I have pre-
sented this picture of the therapeutic person with the hope that you will examine
it and develop your own concept of what personality traits you think are essential
to strive for to promote your own personal growth. For a more detailed discussion
of the person of the counselor and the role of the therapeutic relationship in out-
comes of treatments, see Psychotherapy Relationships That Work (Norcross, 2011)
and Master Therapists: Exploring Expertise in Therapy and Counseling (Skovholt &
Jennings, 2004).
p e r s o n a l t h e r a p y f o r t h e co u n s e lo r
Discussion of the counselor as a therapeutic person raises another issue debated
in counselor education: Should people be required to participate in counseling or
therapy before they become practitioners? My view is that counselors can benefi t
28549_ch02_rev01.indd 20 20/09/11 2:49 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

21
T
H
E

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
O
R
:

P
E
R
S
O
N

A
N
D

P
R
O
F
E
S
S
I
O
N
A
L
greatly from the experience of being clients at some time, a view that is supported
by research. Some type of self-exploration can increase your level of self-aware-
ness. This experience can be obtained before your training, during it, or both, but I
strongly support some form of personal exploration as vital preparation in learning
to counsel others.
The vast majority of mental health professionals have experienced personal
therapy, typically on several occasions (Geller, Norcross, & Orlinsky, 2005b). A
review of research studies on the outcomes and impacts of the psychotherapist’s
own psychotherapy revealed that more than 90% of mental health professionals
report satisfaction and positive outcomes from their own counseling experiences
(Orlinsky, Norcross, Ronnestad, & Wiseman, 2005). Orlinsky and colleagues sug-
gest that personal therapy contributes to the therapist’s professional work in the
following three ways: (1) as part of the therapist’s training, personal therapy offers
a model of therapeutic practice in which the trainee experiences the work of a more
experienced therapist and learns experientially what is helpful or not helpful; (2) a
benefi cial experience in personal therapy can further enhance a therapist’s inter-
personal skills that are essential to skillfully practicing therapy; and (3) successful
personal therapy can contribute to a therapist’s ability to deal with the ongoing
stresses associated with clinical work.
In his research on personal therapy for mental health professionals, Norcross
(2005) states that lasting lessons practitioners learn from their personal therapy
experiences pertain to interpersonal relationships and the dynamics of psycho-
therapy. Some of these lessons learned are the centrality of warmth, empathy, and
the personal relationship; having a sense of what it is like to be a therapy client;
valuing patience and tolerance; and appreciating the importance of learning how
to deal with transference and countertransference. By participating in personal
therapy, counselors can prevent their potential future countertransference from
harming clients.
Through our work as therapists, we can expect to confront our own unexplored
personal blocks such as loneliness, power, death, and intimate relationships. This
does not mean that we need to be free of confl icts before we can counsel others, but
we should be aware of what these confl icts are and how they are likely to affect us
as persons and as counselors. For example, if we have great diffi culty dealing with
anger or confl ict, we may not be able to assist clients who are dealing with anger or
with relationships in confl ict.
When I began counseling others, old wounds were opened, and feelings I had
not explored in depth came to the surface. It was diffi cult for me to encounter a cli-
ent’s depression because I had failed to come to terms with the way I had escaped
from my own depression. I did my best to cheer up depressed clients by talking
them out of what they were feeling, mainly because of my own inability to deal
with such feelings. In the years I worked as a counselor in a university counseling
center, I frequently wondered what I could do for my clients. I often had no idea
what, if anything, my clients were getting from our sessions. I couldn’t tell if they
were getting better, staying the same, or getting worse. It was very important to me
to note progress and see change in my clients. Because I did not see immediate
28549_ch02_rev01.indd 21 20/09/11 2:49 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

22
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
W
O
results, I had many doubts about whether I could become an effective counselor.
What I did not understand at the time was that my clients needed to struggle to
fi nd their own answers. To see my clients feel better quickly was my need, not
theirs, for then I would know that I was helping them. It never occurred to me
that clients often feel worse for a time as they give up their defenses and open
themselves to their pain. My early experiences as a counselor showed me that I
could benefi t by participating in further personal therapy to better understand how
my personal issues were affecting my professional work. I realized that periodic
therapy, especially early in one’s career, can be most useful.
Personal therapy can be instrumental in healing the healer. If student coun-
selors are not actively involved in the pursuit of healing their psychological wounds,
they will probably have considerable diffi culty entering the world of a client. As
counselors, can we take our clients any further than we have gone ourselves? If we
are not committed personally to the value of examining our own life, how can we
inspire clients to examine their lives? By becoming clients ourselves, we gain an
experiential frame of reference with which to view ourselves. This provides a basis
for understanding and compassion for our clients, for we can draw on our own
memories of reaching impasses in our therapy, of both wanting to go farther and
at the same time resisting change. Our own therapy can help us develop patience
with our patients! We learn what it feels like to deal with anxieties that are aroused
by self-disclosure and self-exploration and how to creatively facilitate deeper levels
of self-exploration in clients. Through our own therapy, we can gain increased
appreciation for the courage our clients display in their therapeutic journey. Being
willing to participate in a process of self-exploration can reduce the chances of
assuming an attitude of arrogance or of being convinced that we are totally healed.
Our own therapy helps us avoid assuming a stance of superiority over others and
makes it less likely that we would treat people as objects to be pitied or disre-
spected. Indeed, experiencing counseling as a client is very different from merely
reading about the counseling process.
For a comprehensive discussion of personal therapy for counselors, see
The Psychotherapist’s Own Psychotherapy: Patient and Clinician Perspectives (Geller,
Norcross, & Orlinsky, 2005a).
t h e c o u n s e lo r ’s va l u e s
a n d t h e t h e r a p e u t i c p r o c e s s
As alluded to in the previous section, the importance of self-exploration for coun-
selors carries over to the values and beliefs they hold. My experience in teaching
and supervising students of counseling shows me how crucial it is that students
be aware of their values, of where and how they acquired them, and of how their
values can infl uence their interventions with clients.
The Role of Values in Counseling
Our values are core beliefs that infl uence how we act, both in our personal and
our professional lives. Personal values infl uence how we view counseling and
the manner in which we interact with clients, including the way we conduct client
28549_ch02_rev01.indd 22 20/09/11 2:49 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

23
T
H
E

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
O
R
:

P
E
R
S
O
N

A
N
D

P
R
O
F
E
S
S
I
O
N
A
L
assessments, our views of the goals of counseling, the interventions we choose, the
topics we select for discussion in a counseling session, how we evaluate progress,
and how we interpret clients’ life situations.
Although total objectivity cannot be achieved, we can strive to avoid being en-
capsulated by our own worldview. As counselors we need to guard against the
tendency to use our power to infl uence the client to accept our values because it is
not our function to persuade clients to accept or adopt our value system From my
perspective, the counselor’s role is to create a climate in which clients can examine
their thoughts, feelings, and actions and to empower them to arrive at their own
solutions to problems they face. The counseling task is to assist individuals in fi nd-
ing answers that are most congruent with their own values. It is not benefi cial to
provide advice or to give clients your answers to their questions.
You may not agree with certain of your clients’ values, but you need to respect
their right to hold divergent values from yours. This is especially true when coun-
seling clients who have a different cultural background and perhaps do not share
your own core cultural values. Your role is to provide a safe and inviting context in
which clients can explore the congruence between their values and their behavior.
If clients acknowledge that what they are doing is not getting them what they want,
it is appropriate to assist them in developing new ways of thinking and behaving to
help them move closer to their goals. This is done with full respect for their right
to decide which values they will use as a framework for living. Individuals seeking
counseling need to clarify their own values and goals, make informed decisions,
choose a course of action, and assume responsibility and accountability for the
decisions they make.
There is a difference between exposing our values and imposing our values
on clients. Value imposition refers to counselors directly attempting to defi ne a
client’s values, attitudes, beliefs, and behaviors. It is possible for counselors to
impose their values either actively or passively. Counselors are cautioned about
not imposing their values on their clients. On this topic, the American Counseling
Association’s Code of Ethics (ACA, 2005) has this standard:
Personal Values. Counselors are aware of their own values, attitudes, beliefs, and behaviors
and avoid imposing values that are inconsistent with counseling goals and respect for the
diversity of clients, trainees, and research participants. (A.4.b.)
Even though therapists should not directly teach the client or impose spe-
cifi c values, therapists do implement a philosophy of counseling, which is, in
effect, a philosophy of life. Counselors communicate their values by the thera-
peutic goals to which they subscribe and by the procedures they employ to reach
these goals.
The Role of Values in Developing Therapeutic Goals
Who should establish the goals of counseling? Almost all theories are in agree-
ment that it is largely the client’s responsibility to decide upon goals, collaborating
with the therapist as therapy proceeds. Counselors have general goals, which are
refl ected in their behavior during the therapy session, in their observations of the
client’s behavior, and in the interventions they make. The general goals of coun-
selors must be congruent with the personal goals of the client.
28549_ch02_rev01.indd 23 20/09/11 2:49 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

24
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
W
O
Setting goals is inextricably related to values. The client and the counselor need
to explore what they hope to obtain from the counseling relationship, whether
they can work with each other, and whether their goals are compatible. Even more
important, it is essential that the counselor be able to understand, respect, and
work within the framework of the client’s world rather than forcing the client to fi t
into the therapist’s scheme of values.
In my view, therapy ought to begin with an exploration of the client’s expecta-
tions and goals. Clients initially tend to have vague ideas of what they expect from
therapy. They may be seeking solutions to problems, they may want to stop hurt-
ing, they may want to change others so they can live with less anxiety, or they may
seek to be different so that some signifi cant persons in their lives will be more
accepting of them. In some cases clients have no goals; they are in the therapist’s
offi ce simply because they were sent for counseling by their parents, probation
offi cer, or teacher.
So where can a counselor begin? The initial interview can be used most pro-
ductively to focus on the client’s goals or lack of them. The therapist may begin
by asking any of these questions: “What do you expect from counseling? Why are
you here? What do you want? What do you hope to leave with? How is what you
are currently doing working for you? What aspects of yourself or your life situation
would you most like to change?”
When a person seeks a counseling relationship with you, it is important to
cooperatively discover what this person is expecting from the relationship. If you
try to fi gure out in advance how to proceed with a client, you may be depriving the
client of the opportunity to become an active partner in her or his own therapy.
Why is this person coming in for counseling? It is the client’s place to decide on
the goals of therapy. It is important to keep this focus in mind so that the client’s
agenda is addressed rather than an agenda of your own.
b e c o m i n g a n e f f e c t i v e
m u lt i c u lt u r a l c o u n s e lo r
Part of the process of becoming an effective counselor involves learning how to
recognize diversity issues and shaping one’s counseling practice to fi t the client’s
worldview. It is an ethical obligation for counselors to develop sensitivity to cultural
differences if they hope to make interventions that are consistent with the values
of their clients. The therapist’s role is to assist clients in making decisions that are
congruent with their worldview, not to live by the therapist’s values.
Diversity in the therapeutic relationship is a two-way street. As a counselor,
you bring your own heritage with you to your work, so you need to recognize the
ways in which cultural conditioning has infl uenced the directions you take with
your clients. Unless the social and cultural context of clients and counselors
are taken into consideration, it is diffi cult to appreciate the nature of clients’
struggles. Counseling students often hold values—such as making their own
choices, expressing what they are feeling, being open and self-revealing, and
striving for independence—that differ from the values of clients from different
28549_ch02_rev01.indd 24 20/09/11 2:49 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

25
T
H
E

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
O
R
:

P
E
R
S
O
N

A
N
D

P
R
O
F
E
S
S
I
O
N
A
L
cultural backgrounds. Some clients may be very slow to disclose and have dif-
ferent expectations about counseling than the therapist has. Counselors need
to become aware of how clients from diverse cultures may perceive them as
therapists, as well as how clients may perceive the value of formal helping. It is
the task of counselors to determine whether the assumptions they have made
about the nature and functioning of therapy are appropriate for culturally di-
verse clients.
Clearly, effective counseling must take into account the impact of culture on
the client’s functioning, including the client’s degree of acculturation. Culture is,
quite simply, the values and behaviors shared by a group of individuals. It is im-
portant to realize that culture refers to more than ethnic or racial heritage; culture
also includes factors such as age, gender, religion, sexual orientation, physical and
mental ability, and socioeconomic status.
Acquiring Competencies in Multicultural Counseling
Effective counselors understand their own cultural conditioning, the condition-
ing of their clients, and the sociopolitical system of which they are a part. Acquir-
ing this understanding begins with counselors’ awareness of the cultural origins
of any values, biases, and attitudes they may hold. Counselors from all cultural
groups must examine their expectations, attitudes, biases, and assumptions about
the counseling process and about persons from diverse groups. Recognizing our
biases and prejudices takes courage because most of us do not want to acknowl-
edge that we have cultural biases. Everyone has biases, but being unaware of the
biased attitudes we hold is an obstacle to client care. It takes a concerted effort and
vigilance to monitor our biases, attitudes, and values so that they do not interfere
with establishing and maintaining successful counseling relationships.
A major part of becoming a diversity-competent counselor involves challeng-
ing the idea that the values we hold are automatically true for others. We also need
to understand how our values are likely to infl uence our practice with diverse cli-
ents who embrace different values. Furthermore, becoming a diversity-competent
practitioner is not something that we arrive at once and for all; rather, it is an
ongoing process.
Sue, Arredondo, and McDavis (1992) and Arredondo and her colleagues
(1996) have developed a conceptual framework for competencies and standards
in multicultural counseling. Their dimensions of competency involve three areas:
(1) beliefs and attitudes, (2) knowledge, and (3) skills. For an in-depth treatment of
multicultural counseling and therapy competence, refer to Counseling the Cultur-
ally Diverse: Theory and Practice (D. W. Sue & Sue, 2008).
b e l i e f s a n d at t i t u d e s First, effective counselors have moved from being
culturally unaware to ensuring that their personal biases, values, or problems will
not interfere with their ability to work with clients who are culturally different from
them. They believe cultural self-awareness and sensitivity to one’s own cultural her-
itage are essential for any form of helping. Counselors are aware of their positive and
negative emotional reactions toward persons from other racial and ethnic groups
that may prove detrimental to establishing collaborative helping relationships.
28549_ch02_rev01.indd 25 20/09/11 2:49 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

26
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
W
O
They seek to examine and understand the world from the vantage point of their
clients. They respect clients’ religious and spiritual beliefs and values. They are
comfortable with differences between themselves and others in terms of race, eth-
nicity, culture, and beliefs. Rather than maintaining that their cultural heritage
is superior, they are able to accept and value cultural diversity. They realize that
traditional theories and techniques may not be appropriate for all clients or for all
problems. Culturally skilled counselors monitor their functioning through consul-
tation, supervision, and further training or education.
k n o w l e d g e Second, culturally effective practitioners possess certain knowl-
edge. They know specifi cally about their own racial and cultural heritage and
how it affects them personally and professionally. Because they understand the
dynamics of oppression, racism, discrimination, and stereotyping, they are in a
position to detect their own racist attitudes, beliefs, and feelings. They understand
the worldview of their clients, and they learn about their clients’ cultural back-
grounds. They do not impose their values and expectations on their clients from
differing cultural backgrounds and avoid stereotyping clients. Culturally skilled
counselors understand that external sociopolitical forces infl uence all groups, and
they know how these forces operate with respect to the treatment of minorities.
These practitioners are aware of the institutional barriers that prevent minorities
from utilizing the mental health services available in their communities. They pos-
sess knowledge about the historical background, traditions, and values of the client
populations with whom they work. They know about minority family structures,
hierarchies, values, and beliefs. Furthermore, they are knowledgeable about com-
munity characteristics and resources. Those who are culturally skilled know how
to help clients make use of indigenous support systems. In areas where they are
lacking in knowledge, they seek resources to assist them. The greater their depth
and breadth of knowledge of culturally diverse groups, the more likely they are to
be effective practitioners.
s k i l l s a n d i n t e r v e n t i o n s t r at e g i e s Third, effective counselors
have acquired certain skills in working with culturally diverse populations. Coun-
selors take responsibility for educating their clients about the therapeutic process,
including matters such as setting goals, appropriate expectations, legal rights, and
the counselor’s orientation. Multicultural counseling is enhanced when practition-
ers use methods and strategies and defi ne goals consistent with the life experiences
and cultural values of their clients. Such practitioners modify and adapt their in-
terventions to accommodate cultural differences. They do not force their clients
to fi t within one counseling approach, and they recognize that counseling tech-
niques may be culture-bound. They are able to send and receive both verbal and
nonverbal messages accurately and appropriately. They become actively involved
with minority individuals outside the offi ce (community events, celebrations, and
neighborhood groups). They are willing to seek out educational, consultative, and
training experiences to enhance their ability to work with culturally diverse client
populations. They consult regularly with other multiculturally sensitive profession-
als regarding issues of culture to determine whether referral may be necessary.
28549_ch02_rev01.indd 26 20/09/11 2:49 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

27
T
H
E

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
O
R
:

P
E
R
S
O
N

A
N
D

P
R
O
F
E
S
S
I
O
N
A
L
Incorporating Culture in Counseling Practice
It is unrealistic to expect a counselor to know everything about the cultural back-
ground of a client, but some understanding of the client’s cultural and ethnic
background is essential. There is much to be said for letting clients teach coun-
selors about relevant aspects of their culture. It is a good idea for counselors to
ask clients to provide them with the information they will need to work effectively.
Incorporating culture into the therapeutic process is not limited to working with
clients from a certain ethnic or cultural background. It is critical that therapists
take into account the worldview and background of every client. Failing to do this
seriously restricts the potential impact of the therapeutic endeavor.
In the case of individuals who have lived in more than one culture, it is useful
to assess the degree of acculturation and identity development that has taken place.
Clients often have allegiance to their culture of origin, and yet they may fi nd cer-
tain characteristics of their new culture attractive. They may experience confl icts
in integrating the two cultures in which they live. Different rates of acculturation
among family members is a common complaint of clients who are experiencing
family problems. These core struggles can be explored productively in the thera-
peutic context if the counselor understands and respects this cultural confl ict.
w e lc o m i n g d i v e r s i t y Counseling is by its very nature diverse in a multi-
cultural society, so it is easy to see that there are no ideal therapeutic approaches.
Instead, different theories have distinct features that have appeal for different cul-
tural groups. Some theoretical approaches have limitations when applied to certain
populations. Effective multicultural practice demands an open stance on the part
of the practitioner, fl exibility, and a willingness to modify strategies to fi t the needs
and the situation of the individual client. Practitioners who truly respect their cli-
ents will be aware of clients’ hesitations and will not be too quick to misinterpret
this behavior. Instead, they will patiently attempt to enter the world of their clients
as much as they can. Although practitioners may not have had the same experi-
ences as their clients, the empathy shown by counselors for the feelings and strug-
gles of their clients is essential to good therapeutic outcomes. We are more often
challenged by our differences than by our similarities to look at what we are doing.
p r a c t i c a l g u i d e l i n e s i n a d d r e s s i n g c u lt u r e If the counseling
process is to be effective, it is essential that cultural concerns be addressed with all
clients. Here are some guidelines that may increase your effectiveness when work-
ing with clients from diverse backgrounds:
• Learn more about how your own cultural background has infl uenced your think-
ing and behaving. Take steps to increase your understanding of other cultures.
• Identify your basic assumptions, especially as they apply to diversity in culture,
ethnicity, race, gender, class, spirituality, religion, and sexual orientation. Think
about how your assumptions are likely to affect your professional practice.
• Examine where you obtained your knowledge about culture.
• Remain open to ongoing learning of how the various dimensions of culture
may affect therapeutic work. Realize that this skill does not develop quickly or
without effort.
28549_ch02_rev01.indd 27 20/09/11 2:49 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

28
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
W
O
• Be willing to identify and examine your own personal worldview and any preju-
dices you may hold about other racial/ethnic groups.
• Learn to pay attention to the common ground that exists among people of diverse
backgrounds.
• Be fl exible in applying the methods you use with clients. Don’t be wedded to a
specifi c technique if it is not appropriate for a given client.
• Remember that practicing from a multicultural perspective can make your job
easier and can be rewarding for both you and your clients.
It takes time, study, and experience to become an effective multicultural coun-
selor. Multicultural competence cannot be reduced simply to cultural awareness
and sensitivity, to a body of knowledge, or to a specifi c set of skills. Instead, it re-
quires a combination of all of these factors.
i s s u e s fa c e d by b e g i n n i n g
t h e r a p i s t s
In this section I identify some of the major issues that most of us typically face,
particularly during the beginning stages of learning how to be therapists. When
you complete formal course work and begin facing clients, you will be challenged
to integrate and to apply what you have learned. At that point some real concerns
are likely to arise about your adequacy as a person and as a professional. Here are
some useful guidelines for your refl ection on becoming an effective counselor.
Dealing With Your Anxieties
Most beginning counselors have ambivalent feelings when meeting their fi rst cli-
ents. A certain level of anxiety demonstrates that you are aware of the uncertainties
of the future with your clients and of your abilities to really be there for them. A
willingness to recognize and deal with these anxieties, as opposed to denying them,
is a positive sign. That we have self-doubts is normal; it is how we deal with them
that matters. One way is to openly discuss our self-doubts with a supervisor and
peers. The possibilities are rich for meaningful exchanges and for gaining support
from fellow interns who probably have many of the same concerns and anxieties.
Being Yourself and Self-Disclosure
Because you may be self-conscious and anxious when you begin counseling, you
may have a tendency to be overly concerned with what the books say and with the
mechanics of how to proceed. Inexperienced therapists too often fail to appreciate
the values inherent in simply being themselves. If we are able to be ourselves in
our therapeutic work and appropriately disclose our reactions in counseling ses-
sions, we increase the chances of being authentic. It is this level of genuineness
and presence that enables us to connect with our clients and to establish an effec-
tive therapeutic relationship with them.
It is possible to err by going to extremes in two different directions. At one end
are counselors who lose themselves in their fi xed role and hide behind a profes-
sional facade. These counselors are so caught up in maintaining stereotyped role
expectations that little of their personal selves shows through. Counselors who
28549_ch02_rev01.indd 28 20/09/11 2:49 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

29
T
H
E

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
O
R
:

P
E
R
S
O
N

A
N
D

P
R
O
F
E
S
S
I
O
N
A
L
adopt this behavior will likely remain anonymous to clients, and clients may per-
ceive them as hiding behind a professional role.
At the other end of the spectrum is engaging in too much self-disclosure. Some
counselors make the mistake of inappropriately burdening their clients with their
spontaneous impressions about their clients. Judging the appropriate amount of
self-disclosure can be a problem even for seasoned counselors, and it is often espe-
cially worrisome for new counselors. In determining the appropriateness of self-
disclosure, consider what to reveal, when to reveal, and how much to reveal. It may
be useful to mention something about ourselves from time to time, but we must
be aware of our motivations for making ourselves known in this way. Assess the
readiness of a client to hear these disclosures as well as the impact doing so might
have on the client. Remain observant during any self-disclosure to get a sense of
how the client is being affected by it.
The most productive form of self-disclosure is related to what is going on
between the counselor and the client within the counseling session. The skill of
immediacy involves revealing what we are thinking or feeling in the here and now
with the client, but be careful to avoid pronouncing judgments about the client.
When done in a timely way, sharing persistent reactions can facilitate therapeutic
progress and improve the quality of our relationship with the client. Even when
we are talking about reactions based on the therapeutic relationship, caution is
necessary, and discretion and sensitivity are required in deciding what reactions
we might share.
Avoiding Perfectionism
Perhaps one of the most common self-defeating beliefs with which we burden
ourselves is that we must never make a mistake. Although we may well know inte-
llectually that humans are not perfect, emotionally we often feel that there is little
room for error. To be sure, you will make mistakes, whether you are a beginning or
a seasoned therapist. If our energies are tied up presenting an image of perfection,
this will affect our ability to be present for our clients. I tell students to question
the notion that they should know everything and be perfectly skilled. I encourage
them to share their mistakes or what they perceive as errors during their supervi-
sion meetings. Students willing to risk making mistakes in supervised learning
situations and willing to reveal their self-doubts will fi nd a direction that leads
to growth.
Being Honest About Your Limitations
You cannot realistically expect to succeed with every client. It takes honesty to
admit that you cannot work successfully with every client. It is important to learn
when and how to make a referral for clients when your limitations prevent you
from helping them. However, there is a delicate balance between learning your
realistic limits and challenging what you sometimes think of as being “limits.”
Before deciding that you do not have the life experiences or the personal qualities
to work with a given population, try working in a setting with a population you do
not intend to specialize in. This can be done through diversifi ed fi eld placements
or visits to agencies.
28549_ch02_rev01.indd 29 20/09/11 2:49 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

30
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
W
O
Understanding Silence
Silent moments during a therapeutic session may seem like silent hours to a
beginning therapist, yet this silence can have many meanings. The client may be
quietly thinking about some things that were discussed earlier or evaluating some
insight just acquired. The client may be waiting for the therapist to take the lead
and decide what to say next, or the therapist may be waiting for the client to do
this. Either the client or the therapist may be distracted or preoccupied, or neither
may have anything to say for the moment. The client and the therapist may be
communicating without words. The silence may be refreshing, or the silence may
be overwhelming. Perhaps the interaction has been on a surface level, and both
persons have some fear or hesitancy about getting to a deeper level. When silence
occurs, acknowledge and explore with your client the meaning of the silence.
Dealing With Demands From Clients
A major issue that puzzles many beginning counselors is how to deal with clients
who seem to make constant demands. Because therapists feel they should extend
themselves in being helpful, they often burden themselves with the unrealistic
idea that they should give unselfi shly, regardless of how great clients’ demands
may be. These demands may manifest themselves in a variety of ways. Clients
may want to see you more often or for a longer period than you can provide.
They may want to see you socially. Some clients may expect you to continually
demonstrate how much you care or demand that you tell them what to do and
how to solve a problem. One way of heading off these demands is to make your
expectations and boundaries clear during the initial counseling sessions or in the
disclosure statement.
Dealing With Clients Who Lack Commitment
Involuntary clients may be required by a court order to obtain therapy, and you
may be challenged in your attempt to establish a working relationship with them.
It is possible to do effective work with mandated clients, but practitioners must
begin by openly discussing the nature of the relationship. Counselors who omit
preparation and do not address clients’ thoughts and feelings about coming to
counseling are likely to encounter resistance. It is critical that therapists not prom-
ise what they cannot or will not deliver. It is good practice to make clear the limits
of confi dentiality as well as any other factors that may affect the course of therapy.
In working with involuntary clients, it is especially important to prepare them for
the process; doing so can go a long way toward lessening resistance.
Tolerating Ambiguity
Many beginning therapists experience the anxiety of not seeing immediate results.
They ask themselves: “Am I really doing my client any good? Is the client perhaps
getting worse?” I hope you will learn to tolerate the ambiguity of not knowing for
sure whether your client is improving, at least during the initial sessions. Realize
that oftentimes clients may seemingly “get worse” before they show therapeutic
gains. Also, realize that the fruitful effects of the joint efforts of the therapist and
the client may manifest themselves after the conclusion of therapy.
28549_ch02_rev01.indd 30 20/09/11 2:49 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

31
T
H
E

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
O
R
:

P
E
R
S
O
N

A
N
D

P
R
O
F
E
S
S
I
O
N
A
L
Becoming Aware of Your Countertransference
Working with clients can affect you in personal ways, and your own vulnerabili-
ties and countertransference are bound to surface. If you are unaware of your
personal dynamics, you are in danger of being overwhelmed by a client’s emo-
tional experiences. Beginning counselors need to learn how to “let clients go”
and not carry around their problems until we see them again. The most thera-
peutic thing is to be as fully present as we are able to be during the therapy hour,
but to let clients assume the responsibility of their living and choosing outside of
the session. If we become lost in clients’ struggles and confusion, we cease being
effective agents in helping them fi nd solutions to their problems. If we accept
responsibility for our clients’ decisions, we are blocking rather than fostering
their growth.
Countertransference, defi ned broadly, includes any of our projections that in-
fl uence the way we perceive and react to a client. This phenomenon occurs when
we are triggered into emotional reactivity, when we respond defensively, or when
we lose our ability to be present in a relationship because our own issues become
involved. Recognizing the manifestations of our countertransference reactions is
an essential step in becoming competent counselors. Unless we are aware of our
own confl icts, needs, assets, and liabilities, we can use the therapy hour more for
our own purposes than for being available for our clients. Because it is not appro-
priate for us to use clients’ time to work through our reactions to them, it is all the
more important that we be willing to work on ourselves in our own sessions with
another therapist, supervisor, or colleague. If we do not engage in this kind of self-
exploration, we increase the danger of losing ourselves in our clients and using
them to meet our unfulfi lled needs.
The emotionally intense relationships we develop with clients can be expected
to tap into our own unresolved problem areas. Our clients’ stories and pain are
bound to affect us; we will be touched by their stories and can express compassion
and empathy. However, we have to realize that it is their pain and not carry it for
them lest we become overwhelmed by their life stories and thus render ourselves
ineffective in working with them. Although we cannot completely free ourselves
from any traces of countertransference or ever fully resolve all personal confl icts
from the past, we can become aware of ways these realities infl uence our profes-
sional work. Our personal therapy can be instrumental in enabling us to recognize
and manage our countertransference reactions.
Developing a Sense of Humor
Therapy is a responsible endeavor, but it need not be deadly serious. Both clients
and counselors can enrich a relationship through humor. What a welcome relief
when we can admit that pain is not our exclusive domain. It is important to recog-
nize that laughter or humor does not mean that clients are not respected or work
is not being accomplished. There are times, of course, when laughter is used to
cover up anxiety or to escape from the experience of facing threatening material.
The therapist needs to distinguish between humor that distracts and humor that
enhances the situation.
28549_ch02_rev01.indd 31 20/09/11 2:49 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

32
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
W
O
Sharing Responsibility With the Client
You might struggle with fi nding the optimum balance in sharing responsibility
with your clients. One mistake is to assume full responsibility for the direction
and outcomes of therapy. This will lead to taking from your clients their rightful
responsibility of making their own decisions. It could also increase the likelihood
of your early burnout. Another mistake is for you to refuse to accept the responsi-
bility for making accurate assessments and designing appropriate treatment plans
for your clients. How responsibility will be shared should be addressed early in
the course of counseling. It is your responsibility to discuss specifi c matters such
as length and overall duration of the sessions, confi dentiality, general goals, and
methods used to achieve goals. (Informed consent is discussed in Chapter 3.)
It is important to be alert to your clients’ efforts to get you to assume respon-
sibility for directing their lives. Many clients seek a “magic answer” as a way of
escaping the anxiety of making their own decisions. It is not your role to assume
responsibility for directing your clients’ lives. Collaboratively designing contracts
and homework assignments with your clients can be instrumental in your clients’
increasingly fi nding direction within themselves. Perhaps the best measure of our
effectiveness as counselors is the degree to which clients are able to say to us,
“I appreciate what you have been to me, and because of your faith in me, and what
you have taught me, I am confi dent that I can go it alone.” Eventually, if we are
effective, we will be out of business!
Declining to Give Advice
Quite often clients who are suffering come to a therapy session seeking and even
demanding advice. They want more than direction; they want a wise counselor to
make a decision or resolve a problem for them. However, counseling should not be
confused with dispensing information. Therapists help clients discover their own
solutions and recognize their own freedom to act. Even if we, as therapists, were
able to resolve clients’ struggles for them, we would be fostering their dependence
on us. They would continually need to seek our counsel for every new twist in their
diffi culties. Our task is to help clients make independent choices and accept the
consequences of their choices. The habitual practice of giving advice does not work
toward this end.
Defining Your Role as a Counselor
One of your challenges as a counselor will be to defi ne and clarify your professional
role. As you read about the various theoretical orientations in Part 2, you will discover
the many different roles of counselors that are related to these diverse theories. As a
counselor, you will likely be expected to function with a diverse range of roles.
From my perspective, the central function of counseling is to help clients rec-
ognize their own strengths, discover what is preventing them from using their
resources, and clarify what kind of life they want to live. Counseling is a process by
which clients are invited to look honestly at their behavior and make certain deci-
sions about how they want to modify the quality of their life. In this framework
counselors provide support and warmth yet care enough to challenge clients so that
they will be able to take the actions necessary to bring about signifi cant change.
28549_ch02_rev01.indd 32 20/09/11 2:49 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

33
T
H
E

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
O
R
:

P
E
R
S
O
N

A
N
D

P
R
O
F
E
S
S
I
O
N
A
L
Keep in mind that the professional roles you assume are likely to be dependent
on factors such as the client populations with whom you are working, the specifi c
therapeutic services you are providing, the particular stage of counseling, and the
setting in which you work. Your role will not be defi ned once and for all. You will
have to reassess the nature of your professional commitments and redefi ne your
role at various times.
Learning to Use Techniques Appropriately
When you are at an impasse with a client, you may have a tendency to look for a
technique to get the sessions moving. As discussed in Chapter 1, relying on tech-
niques too much can lead to mechanical counseling. Ideally, therapeutic tech-
niques should evolve from the therapeutic relationship and the material presented,
and they should enhance the client’s awareness or suggest possibilities for experi-
menting with new behavior. Know the theoretical rationale for each technique you
use, and be sure the techniques are appropriate for the goals of therapy. This does
not mean that you need to restrict yourself to drawing on procedures within a sin-
gle model; quite the contrary. However, it is important to avoid using techniques
in a hit-or-miss fashion, to fi ll time, to meet your own needs, or to get things mov-
ing. Your methods need to be thoughtfully chosen as a way to help clients make
therapeutic progress.
Developing Your Own Counseling Style
Be aware of the tendency to copy the style of a supervisor, therapist, or some other
model. There is no one way to conduct therapy, and wide variations in approach
can be effective. You will inhibit your potential effectiveness in reaching others if
you attempt to imitate another therapist’s style or if you fi t most of your behavior
during the session into the procrustean bed of some expert’s theory. Your coun-
seling style will be infl uenced by your teachers, therapists, and supervisors, but
don’t blur your potential uniqueness by trying to imitate them. I advocate borrow-
ing from others, yet at the same time, doing it in a way that is distinctive to you.
Maintaining Your Vitality as a Person and as a Professional
Ultimately, your single most important instrument is the person you are, and your
most powerful technique is your ability to model aliveness and realness. It is of
paramount importance that we take care of ourselves, for how can we take care of
others if we are not taking care of ourselves? We need to work at dealing with those
factors that threaten to drain life from us and render us helpless. I encourage you
to consider how you can apply the theories you will be studying to enhance your
life from both a personal and a professional standpoint.
Learn to look within yourself to determine what choices you are making (and not
making) to keep yourself vital. If you are aware of the factors that sap your vitality
as a person, you are in a better position to prevent the condition known as profes-
sional burnout. You have considerable control over whether you become burned out
or not. You cannot always control stressful events, but you do have a great deal of
control over how you interpret and react to these events. It is important to realize
that you cannot continue to give and give while getting little in return. There is a
28549_ch02_rev01.indd 33 20/09/11 2:49 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

34
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
W
O
price to pay for always being available and for assuming responsibility over the
lives and destinies of others. Become attuned to the subtle signs of burnout rather
than waiting for a full-blown condition of emotional and physical exhaustion to
set in. You would be wise to develop your own strategy for keeping yourself alive
personally and professionally.
Self-monitoring is a crucial fi rst step in self-care. If you make an honest
inventory of how well you are taking care of yourself in specifi c domains, you will
have a framework for deciding what you may want to change. By making periodic
assessments of the direction of your own life, you can determine whether you are
living the way you want to live. If not, decide what you are willing to actually do to
make changes occur. By being in tune with yourself, by having the experience of
centeredness and solidness, and by feeling a sense of personal power, you have
the foundation for integrating your life experiences with your professional experi-
ences. Such an awareness can provide the basis for retaining your physical and
psychological vitality and for being an effective professional.
Counseling professionals tend to be caring people who are good at taking care
of others, but often we do not treat ourselves with the same level of care. Self-care
is not a luxury but an ethical mandate. If we neglect to care for ourselves, our cli-
ents will not be getting the best of us. If we are physically drained and psychologi-
cally depleted, we will not have much to give to those with whom we work. It is not
possible to provide nourishment to our clients if we are not nourishing ourselves.
Mental health professionals often comment that they do not have time to take
care of themselves. My question to them is, “Can you afford not to take care of
yourself?” To successfully meet the demands of our professional work, we must
take care of ourselves physically, psychologically, intellectually, socially, and spir-
itually. Ideally, our self-care should mirror the care we provide for others. If we
hope to have the vitality and stamina required to stay focused on our professional
goals, we need to incorporate a wellness perspective into our daily living. Wellness
is the result of our conscious commitment to a way of life that leads to zest, peace,
vitality, and happiness.
Wellness and self-care are being given increased attention in professional jour-
nals (see Counseling Today, January 2011) and at professional conferences. When
reading about self-care and wellness, refl ect on what you can do to put what you
know into action. If you are interested in learning more about therapist self-care,
I highly recommend Leaving It at the Offi ce: A Guide to Psychotherapist Self-Care
(Norcross & Guy, 2007) and Empathy Fatigue: Healing the Mind, Body, and Spirit
of Professional Counselors (Stebnicki, 2008). For more on the topic of the counselor
as a person and as a professional, see Creating Your Professional Path: Lessons From
My Journey (Corey, 2010).
s u m m a ry
One of the basic issues in the counseling profession concerns the signifi cance
of the counselor as a person in the therapeutic relationship. In your professional
work, you are asking people to take an honest look at their lives and to make choices
concerning how they want to change, so it is critical that you do this in your own
28549_ch02_rev01.indd 34 20/09/11 2:49 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

35
T
H
E

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
O
R
:

P
E
R
S
O
N

A
N
D

P
R
O
F
E
S
S
I
O
N
A
L
life. Ask yourself questions such as “What do I personally have to offer others who
are struggling to fi nd their way?” and “Am I doing in my own life what I may be
urging others to do?”
You can acquire an extensive theoretical and practical knowledge and can make
that knowledge available to your clients. But to every therapeutic session you also
bring yourself as a person. If you are to promote change in your clients, you need
to be open to change in your own life. This willingness to attempt to live in accord-
ance with what you teach and thus to be a positive model for your clients is what
makes you a “therapeutic person.”
28549_ch02_rev01.indd 35 20/09/11 2:49 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

36
i n t r o d u ct i o n
p u t t i n g c l i e n t s ’ n e e ds
b e f o r e yo u r o w n
e t h i c a l d ec i s i o n m a k i n g
• The Role of Ethics Codes as a Catalyst for
Improving Practice
• Some Steps in Making Ethical Decisions
t h e r i g h t o f i n f o r m e d co n s e n t
d i m e n s i o n s o f co n f i d e n t i a l i t y
e t h i c a l i s s u es i n a m u lt i c u lt u r a l
p e r s p ect i v e
• Are Current Theories Adequate in Working
With Culturally Diverse Populations?
• Is Counseling Culture Bound?
• Focusing on Both Individual and
Environmental Factors
e t h i c a l i s s u es i n t h e
a s s es s m e n t p r o c es s
• The Role of Assessment and Diagnosis in
Counseling
e t h i c a l a s p ect s o f e v i d e n c e –
b a s e d p r act i c e
m a n ag i n g m u lt i p l e r e l at i o n s h i p s
i n co u n s e l i n g p r act i c e
• Perspectives on Multiple Relationships
b eco m i n g a n e t h i c a l co u n s e lo r
s u m m a ry
w h e r e to g o f r o m h e r e
c h a p t e r 3
Ethical Issues in
Counseling Practice
36
oth Individu
mental Factors
Are Current Theories Adeq
With Culturally Diverse Pop
• Is Counseling Culture Bou
• Focusing on
Enviro
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 36 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

E
T
H
I
C
A
L

I
S
S
U
E
S

I
N

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
I
N
G

P
R
A
C
T
I
C
E
37
i n t r o d u c t i o n
This chapter introduces some of the ethical principles and issues that will be a ba-
sic part of your professional practice. Its purpose is to stimulate you to think about
ethical practice so that you can form a sound basis for making ethical decisions.
To help you make these decisions, you can consult with colleagues, keep yourself
informed about laws affecting your practice, keep up to date in your specialty fi eld,
stay abreast of developments in ethical practice, refl ect on the impact your values
have on your practice, and be willing to engage in honest self-examination. Top-
ics addressed include balancing clients’ needs against your own needs, ways of
making good ethical decisions, educating clients about their rights, parameters
of confi dentiality, ethical concerns in counseling diverse client populations, ethi-
cal issues involving diagnosis, evidence-based practice, and dealing with multiple
relationships.
At times students think of ethics in a negative way, merely as a list of rules
and prohibitions that result in sanctions and malpractice actions if practitioners
do not follow them. Mandatory ethics is the view of ethical practice that deals with
the minimum level of professional practice, whereas aspirational ethics is a higher
level of ethical practice that addresses doing what is in the best interests of clients.
Ethics is more than a list of things to avoid for fear of punishment. Ethics is a way
of thinking about becoming the best practitioner possible. Positive ethics is an ap-
proach taken by practitioners who want to do their best for clients rather than sim-
ply meet minimum standards to stay out of trouble (Knapp & VandeCreek, 2006).
See the video program for Chapter 3, DVD for Theory and Practice of
Counseling and Psychotherapy: The Case of Stan and Lecturettes. I suggest that
you view the brief lecture for each chapter prior to reading the chapter.
p u t t i n g c l i e n t s ’ n e e d s
b e f o r e yo u r o w n
As counselors we cannot always keep our personal needs completely separate from
our relationships with clients. Ethically, it is essential that we become aware of
our own needs, areas of unfi nished business, potential personal problems, and
especially our sources of countertransference. We need to realize how such factors
could interfere with effectively and ethically serving our clients.
Our professional relationships with our clients exist for their benefi t. A useful
question to frequently ask yourself is this: “Whose needs are being met in this
relationship, my client’s or my own?” It takes considerable professional maturity
to make an honest appraisal of how your behavior affects your clients. It is not
unethical for us to meet our personal needs through our professional work, but it
is essential that these needs be kept in perspective. An ethical problem exists when
we meet our needs, in either obvious or subtle ways, at the expense of our clients’
needs. It is crucial that we avoid exploiting or harming clients.
We all have certain blind spots and distortions of reality. As helping profes-
sionals, we have responsibilities to work actively toward expanding our own
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 37 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

38
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
H
R
E
E
self-awareness and to learn to recognize areas of prejudice and vulnerability. If
we are aware of our personal problems and are willing to work through them,
there is less chance that we will project them onto clients. If certain problem
areas surface and old confl icts become reactivated, we have an ethical obligation
to do whatever it takes to avoid harming our clients.
We must also examine other, less obviously harmful personal needs that can
get in the way of creating growth-producing relationships, such as the need for
control and power; the need to be nurturing and helpful; the need to change others
in the direction of our own values; the need for feeling adequate, particularly when
it becomes overly important that the client confi rm our competence; and the need
to be respected and appreciated. It is crucial that we do not meet our needs at the
expense of our clients. For an expanded discussion of this topic, see M. Corey and
Corey (2011, chap. 1).
e t h i c a l d e c i s i o n m a k i n g
The ready-made answers to ethical dilemmas provided by professional organiza-
tions typically contain only broad guidelines for responsible practice. As a practi-
tioner, ultimately you will have to apply the ethics codes of your profession to the
many practical problems you face. Professionals are expected to exercise prudent
judgment when it comes to interpreting and applying ethical principles to specifi c
situations. Although you are responsible for making ethical decisions, you do not
have to do so alone. Part of the process of making ethical decisions involves learn-
ing about the resources from which you can draw when you are dealing with an
ethical question. You should also be aware of the consequences of practicing in
ways that are not sanctioned by organizations of which you are a member or the
state in which you are licensed to practice.
The Role of Ethics Codes as a Catalyst
for Improving Practice
Professional codes of ethics serve a number of purposes. They educate counseling
practitioners and the general public about the responsibilities of the profession.
They provide a basis for accountability, and through their enforcement, clients
are protected from unethical practices. Perhaps most important, ethics codes can
provide a basis for refl ecting on and improving your professional practice. Self-
monitoring is a better route for professionals to take than being policed by an
outside agency (Herlihy & Corey, 2006a).
From my perspective, one of the unfortunate trends is for ethics codes to in-
creasingly take on legalistic dimensions. Many practitioners are so anxious to
avoid becoming embroiled in a lawsuit that they gear their practices mainly toward
fulfi lling legal minimums rather than thinking of what is right for their clients. If
we are too concerned with being sued, it is unlikely that we will be very creative
or effective in our work. In this era of litigation, it makes sense to be aware of the
legal aspects of practice and to do what is possible to reduce a malpractice suit, but
it is a mistake to equate behaving legally with being ethical. Although following
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 38 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

39
E
T
H
I
C
A
L

I
S
S
U
E
S

I
N

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
I
N
G

P
R
A
C
T
I
C
E
the law is part of ethical behavior, being an ethical practitioner involves far more.
One of the best ways to prevent being sued for malpractice rests in demonstrating
respect for clients, having their welfare as a central concern, and practicing within
the framework of professional codes.
No code of ethics can delineate what would be the appropriate or best course
of action in each problematic situation a professional will face. In my view, ethics
codes are best used as guidelines to formulate sound reasoning and serve practi-
tioners in making the best judgments possible. A number of professional organi-
zations and their websites are listed at the end of this chapter; each has its own
code of ethics, which you can access through its website. Compare your profes-
sional organization’s code of ethics to several others to understand their similari-
ties and differences.
Some Steps in Making Ethical Decisions
There are a number of different models for ethical decision making; most tend to
focus on the application of principles to ethical dilemmas. After reviewing a few
of these models, my colleagues and I have identifi ed a series of procedural steps
to help you think through ethical problems (see Corey, Corey, & Callanan, 2011):
• Identify the problem or dilemma. Gather information that will shed light on the
nature of the problem. This will help you decide whether the problem is mainly
ethical, legal, professional, clinical, or moral.
• Identify the potential issues. Evaluate the rights, responsibilities, and welfare of
all those who are involved in the situation.
• Look at the relevant ethics codes for general guidance on the matter. Consider
whether your own values and ethics are consistent with or in confl ict with the
relevant guidelines.
• Consider the applicable laws and regulations, and determine how they may have
a bearing on an ethical dilemma.
• Seek consultation from more than one source to obtain various perspectives on
the dilemma, and document in the client’s record what suggestions you received
from this consultation.
• Brainstorm various possible courses of action. Continue discussing options
with other professionals. Include the client in this process of considering
options for action. Again, document the nature of this discussion with your
client.
• Enumerate the consequences of various decisions, and refl ect on the implica-
tions of each course of action for your client.
• Decide on what appears to be the best possible course of action. Once the course
of action has been implemented, follow up to evaluate the outcomes and to
determine whether further action is necessary. Document the reasons for the
actions you took as well as your evaluation measures.
In reasoning through any ethical dilemma, there is rarely just one course of
action to follow, and practitioners may make different decisions. The more sub-
tle the ethical dilemma, the more complex and demanding the decision-making
process.
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 39 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

40
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
H
R
E
E
Professional maturity implies that you are open to questioning and discussing
your quandaries with colleagues. In seeking consultation, it is generally possible to
protect the identity of your client and still get useful input that is critical to making
sound ethical decisions. Because ethics codes do not make decisions for you, it is a
good practice to demonstrate a willingness to explore various aspects of a problem,
raise questions, discuss ethical concerns with others, and continually clarify your
values and examine your motivations. To the degree that it is possible, include the
client in all phases of the ethical decision-making process. Again, it is essential
to document how you included your client as well as the steps you took to ensure
ethical practice.
t h e r i g h t o f i n f o r m e d c o n s e n t
Regardless of your theoretical framework, informed consent is an ethical and legal
requirement that is an integral part of the therapeutic process. It also establishes
a basic foundation for creating a working alliance and a collaborative partnership
between the client and the therapist. Informed consent involves the right of clients
to be informed about their therapy and to make autonomous decisions pertaining to
it. Providing clients with information they need to make informed choices tends to
promote the active cooperation of clients in their counseling plan. By educating
your clients about their rights and responsibilities, you are both empowering them
and building a trusting relationship with them. Seen in this light, informed con-
sent is something far broader than simply making sure clients sign the appropriate
forms. It is a positive approach that helps clients become active partners and true
collaborators in their therapy. Some aspects of the informed consent process in-
clude the general goals of counseling, the responsibilities of the counselor toward
the client, the responsibilities of clients, limitations of and exceptions to confi den-
tiality, legal and ethical parameters that could defi ne the relationship, the qualifi ca-
tions and background of the practitioner, the fees involved, the services the client
can expect, and the approximate length of the therapeutic process. Further areas
might include the benefi ts of counseling, the risks involved, and the possibility
that the client’s case will be discussed with the therapist’s colleagues or supervi-
sors. This process of educating the client begins with the initial counseling session
and continues for the duration of counseling.
The challenge of fulfi lling the spirit of informed consent is to strike a balance
between giving clients too much information and giving them too little. For exam-
ple, it is too late to tell minors that you intend to consult with their parents after
they have disclosed that they are considering an abortion. In such a case the young
people involved have a right to know about the limitations of confi dentiality before
they make such highly personal disclosures. Clients can be overwhelmed, how-
ever, if counselors go into too much detail initially about the interventions they are
likely to make. It takes both intuition and skill for practitioners to strike a balance.
Informed consent in counseling can be provided in written form, orally, or
some combination of both. If it is done orally, therapists must make an entry in
the client’s clinical record documenting the nature and extent of informed consent
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 40 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

41
E
T
H
I
C
A
L

I
S
S
U
E
S

I
N

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
I
N
G

P
R
A
C
T
I
C
E
(Nagy, 2011). I think it is a good idea to have basic information about the therapy
process in writing, as well as to discuss with clients topics that will enable them to
get the maximum benefi t from their counseling experience. Written information
protects both clients and therapists and enables clients to think about the informa-
tion and bring up questions at the following session. For a more complete discus-
sion of informed consent and client rights, see Issues and Ethics in the Helping
Professions (Corey, Corey, & Callanan, 2011, chap. 5), Ethical, Legal, and Professional
Issues in Counseling (Remley & Herlihy, 2010), and Essential Ethics for Psychologists
(Nagy, 2011, chap. 5).
d i m e n s i o n s o f c o n f i d e n t i a l i t y
Confi dentiality and privileged communication are two related but somewhat dif-
ferent concepts. Both of these concepts are rooted in a client’s right to privacy.
Confi dentiality is an ethical concept, and in most states it is the legal duty of thera-
pists not to disclose information about a client. Privileged communication is a
legal concept that generally bars the disclosure of confi dential communications
in a legal proceeding (Committee on Professional Practice and Standards, 2003).
All states have enacted into law some form of psychotherapist–client privilege, but
the specifi cs of this privilege vary from state to state. These laws ensure that disclo-
sures clients make in therapy will be protected from exposure by therapists in legal
proceedings. Generally speaking, the legal concept of privileged communication
does not apply to group counseling, couples counseling, family therapy, or child
and adolescent therapy. However, the therapist is still bound by confi dentiality
with respect to circumstances not involving a court proceeding.
Confi dentiality is central to developing a trusting and productive client–therapist
relationship. Because no genuine therapy can occur unless clients trust in the privacy
of their revelations to their therapists, professionals have the responsibility to defi ne
the degree of confi dentiality that can be promised. Counselors have an ethical and
legal responsibility to discuss the nature and purpose of confi dentiality with their
clients early in the counseling process. In addition, clients have a right to know that
their therapist may be discussing certain details of the relationship with a supervisor
or a colleague.
Although most counselors agree on the essential value of confi dentiality, they
realize that it cannot be considered an absolute. There are times when confi dential
information must be divulged, and there are many instances in which keeping or
breaking confi dentiality becomes a cloudy issue. In determining when to breach
confi dentiality, therapists must consider the requirements of the law, the institu-
tion in which they work, and the clientele they serve. Because these circumstances
are frequently not clearly defi ned by accepted ethics codes, counselors must exer-
cise professional judgment.
There is a legal requirement to break confi dentiality in cases involving child
abuse, abuse of the elderly, abuse of dependent adults, and danger to self or oth-
ers. All mental health practitioners and interns need to be aware of their duty
to report in these situations and to know the limitations of confi dentiality. Here
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 41 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

42
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
H
R
E
E
are some other circumstances in which information must legally be reported by
counselors:
• When the therapist believes a client under the age of 16 is the victim of incest,
rape, child abuse, or some other crime
• When the therapist determines that the client needs hospitalization
• When information is made an issue in a court action
• When clients request that their records be released to them or to a third party
In general, the counselor’s primary obligation is to protect client disclosures
as a vital part of the therapeutic relationship. Informing clients about the limits of
confi dentiality does not necessarily inhibit successful counseling.
For a more complete discussion of confi dentiality, see Issues and Ethics in the
Helping Professions (Corey, Corey, & Callanan, 2011, chap. 6), The Ethical and Pro-
fessional Practice of Counseling and Psychotherapy (Sperry, 2007, chap. 6), and Es-
sential Ethics for Psychologists (Nagy, 2011, chap. 6).
e t h i c a l i s s u e s i n a
m u lt i c u lt u r a l p e r s p e c t i v e
Ethical practice requires that we take the client’s cultural context into account in
counseling practice. In this section we look at how it is possible for practitioners to
practice unethically if they do not address cultural differences in counseling practice.
Are Current Theories Adequate in Working
With Culturally Diverse Populations?
I believe current theories need to be, and can be, expanded to include a multicul-
tural perspective. With respect to many of the traditional theories, assumptions
made about mental health, optimum human development, the nature of psycho-
pathology, and the nature of effective treatment may have little relevance for some
clients. For traditional theories to be relevant in a multicultural and diverse soci-
ety, they must incorporate an interactive person-in-the-environment focus. That is,
individuals are best understood by taking into consideration salient cultural and
environmental variables. It is essential for therapists to create therapeutic strate-
gies that are congruent with the range of values and behaviors that are characteris-
tic of a pluralistic society.
Is Counseling Culture Bound?
Historically, therapists have relied on Western therapeutic models to guide their
practice and to conceptualize problems that clients present in mental health set-
tings. Value assumptions made by culturally different counselors and clients have
resulted in culturally biased counseling and have led to underuse of mental health
services by diverse populations (Pedersen, 2000; D. W. Sue & Sue, 2008). Mul-
ticultural specialists have asserted that theories of counseling and psychotherapy
represent different worldviews, each with its own values, biases, and assump-
tions about human behavior. Some of these approaches may not be applicable to
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 42 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

43
E
T
H
I
C
A
L

I
S
S
U
E
S

I
N

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
I
N
G

P
R
A
C
T
I
C
E
clients from different racial, ethnic, and cultural backgrounds. Western models
of counseling have some limitations when applied to special populations and
cultural groups such as Asian and Pacifi c Islanders, Latinos, Native Americans,
and African Americans. A therapist’s methods often need to be modifi ed when
working with clients from diverse cultural backgrounds.
Contemporary therapy approaches are grounded on a core set of values,
which are neither value-neutral nor applicable to all cultures. For example, the
values implicit in most traditional counseling theories include an emphasis on
individualism, the separate existence of the self, individuation as the foundation
for maturity, and decision making and responsibility resting with the individual
rather than the group. These values of individual choice and autonomy do not
have universal applicability. In some cultures the key values are collectivist, and
primary consideration is given to what is good for the group. Regardless of the
therapist’s orientation, it is crucial to listen to clients and determine why they
are seeking help and how best to deliver the help that is appropriate for them.
Unskilled clinicians may inappropriately apply certain techniques that are not
relevant to particular clients. Competent therapists understand themselves as
social and cultural beings and possess at least a minimum level of knowledge
and skill that they can bring to bear on any counseling situation. These prac-
titioners understand what their clients need and avoid forcing clients into a
preconceived mold.
The attitudes, values, and behaviors counselors and clients bring to the therapy
relationship can vary widely. Denying the importance of these cultural variables
or overemphasizing cultural differences both can result in counselors losing their
spontaneity and failing to be present for their clients. Counselors need to under-
stand and accept clients who have a different set of assumptions about life, and
they need to be alert to the possibility of imposing their own worldview. In working
with clients from different cultural backgrounds and life experiences, it is impor-
tant that counselors resist making value judgments for them.
Focusing on Both Individual and Environmental Factors
A theoretical orientation provides practitioners with a map to guide them in a
productive direction with their clients. It is hoped that the theory orients them
but does not control what they attend to in the therapeutic venture. Counselors
who operate from a multicultural framework also have certain assumptions and a
focus that guides their practice. They view individuals in the context of the family
and the culture, and their aim is to facilitate social action that will lead to change
within the client’s community rather than merely increasing the individual’s
insight. Both multicultural practitioners and feminist therapists maintain that
therapeutic practice will be effective only to the extent that interventions are tai-
lored toward social action aimed at changing those factors that are creating the
client’s problem rather than blaming the client for his or her condition. These
topics are developed in more detail in later chapters.
An adequate theory of counseling does deal with the social and cultural factors
of an individual’s problems. However, there is something to be said for helping
clients deal with their response to environmental realities. Counselors may well be
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 43 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

44
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
H
R
E
E
at a loss in trying to bring about social change when they are sitting with a client
who is in pain because of social injustice. By using techniques from many of the
traditional therapies, counselors can help clients increase their awareness of their
options in dealing with barriers and struggles. However, it is essential to focus on
both individual and social factors if change is to occur, as the feminist, postmod-
ern, and family systems approaches to therapy teach us. Indeed, the person-in-the-
environment perspective acknowledges this interactive reality. For a more detailed
treatment of the ethical issues in multicultural counseling, see Corey, Corey, and
Callanan (2011, chap. 4).
e t h i c a l i s s u e s i n t h e
a s s e s s m e n t p r o c e s s
Both clinical and ethical issues are associated with the use of assessment and
diagnostic procedures. As you will see when you study the various theories of
counseling, some approaches place heavy emphasis on the role of assessment as
a prelude to the treatment process; other approaches fi nd assessment less useful
in this regard.
The Role of Assessment and Diagnosis in Counseling
Assessment and diagnosis are integrally related to the practice of counseling
and psychotherapy, and both are often viewed as essential for planning treat-
ment. For some approaches, a comprehensive assessment of the client is the
initial step in the therapeutic process. The rationale is that specifi c counseling
goals cannot be formulated and appropriate treatment strategies cannot be
designed until a client’s past and present functioning is understood. Regardless
of their theoretical orientation, therapists need to engage in assessment, which
is generally an ongoing part of the therapeutic process. This assessment may be
subject to revision as the clinician gathers further data during therapy sessions.
Some practitioners consider assessment as a part of the process that leads to a
formal diagnosis.
Assessment consists of evaluating the relevant factors in a client’s life to iden-
tify themes for further exploration in the counseling process. Diagnosis, which is
sometimes part of the assessment process, consists of identifying a specifi c mental
disorder based on a pattern of symptoms. Both assessment and diagnosis can be
understood as providing direction for the treatment process.
Diagnosis may include an explanation of the causes of the client’s diffi cul-
ties, an account of how these problems developed over time, a classifi cation of
any disorders, a specifi cation of preferred treatment procedure, and an estimate
of the chances for a successful resolution. The purpose of diagnosis in coun-
seling and psychotherapy is to identify disruptions in a client’s present behavior
and lifestyle. Once problem areas are clearly identifi ed, the counselor and client
are able to establish the goals of the therapy process, and then a treatment plan
can be tailored to the unique needs of the client. A diagnosis provides a working
hypothesis that guides the practitioner in understanding the client. The therapy
sessions provide useful clues about the nature of the client’s problems. Thus
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 44 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

45
E
T
H
I
C
A
L

I
S
S
U
E
S

I
N

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
I
N
G

P
R
A
C
T
I
C
E
diagnosis begins with the intake interview and continues throughout the dura-
tion of therapy.
The classic book for guiding practitioners in making diagnostic assessments is
the fourth edition of the American Psychiatric Association’s (2000) Diagnostic and
Statistical Manual of Mental Disorders, Text Revision (also known as the DSM-IV-TR),
which is presently being revised. The DSM-5 is scheduled to be published in 2013.
Clinicians who work in community mental health agencies, private practice, and
other human service settings are generally expected to assess client problems
within this framework. This manual advises practitioners that it represents only
an initial step in a comprehensive evaluation and that it is necessary to gain infor-
mation about the person being evaluated beyond that required for a DSM-IV-TR
diagnosis.
Although some clinicians view diagnosis as central to the counseling process,
others view it as unnecessary, as a detriment, or as discriminatory against ethnic
minorities and women. As you will see when you study the therapeutic models in
this book, some approaches do not use diagnosis as a precursor to treatment.
c o n s i d e r i n g e t h n i c a n d c u lt u r a l fa c t o r s i n a s s e s s m e n t
a n d d i a g n o s i s A danger of the diagnostic approach is the possible failure
of counselors to consider ethnic and cultural factors in certain patterns of behav-
ior. The DSM-IV-TR emphasizes the importance of being aware of unintentional
bias and keeping an open mind to the presence of distinctive ethnic and cultural
patterns that could infl uence the diagnostic process. Unless cultural variables are
considered, some clients may be subjected to erroneous diagnoses. Certain be-
haviors and personality styles may be labeled neurotic or deviant simply because
they are not characteristic of the dominant culture. Counselors who work with
diverse client populations may erroneously conclude that a client is repressed,
inhibited, passive, and unmotivated, all of which are seen as undesirable by West-
ern standards.
a s s e s s m e n t a n d d i a g n o s i s f r o m va r i o u s t h e o r e t i c a l
p e r s p e c t i v e s The theory from which you operate infl uences your thinking
about the use of a diagnostic framework in your therapeutic practice. Many practi-
tioners who use the cognitive behavioral approaches and the medical model place
heavy emphasis on the role of assessment as a prelude to the treatment process.
The rationale is that specifi c therapy goals cannot be designed until a clear picture
emerges of the client’s past and present functioning. Counselors who base their prac-
tices on the relationship-oriented approaches tend to view the process of assessment
and diagnosis as external to the immediacy of the client– counselor relationship,
impeding their understanding of the subjective world of the client. As you will see
in Chapter 12, feminist therapists contend that traditional diagnostic practices are
often oppressive and that such practices are based on a White, male-centered, West-
ern notion of mental health and mental illness. Both the feminist perspective and
the postmodern approaches (Chapter 13) charge that these diagnoses ignore societal
contexts. Therapists with a feminist, social constructionist, solution-focused, or nar-
rative therapy orientation challenge many DSM-IV-TR diagnoses. However, these
practitioners do make assessments and draw conclusions about client problems and
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 45 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

46
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
H
R
E
E
strengths. Regardless of the particular theory espoused by a therapist, both clinical
and ethical issues are associated with the use of assessment procedures and possibly
a diagnosis as part of a treatment plan.
a c o m m e n ta ry o n a s s e s s m e n t a n d d i a g n o s i s Most practition-
ers and many writers in the fi eld consider assessment and diagnosis to be a contin-
uing process that focuses on understanding the client. The collaborative perspec-
tive that involves the client as an active participant in the therapy process implies
that both the therapist and the client are engaged in a search-and-discovery process
from the fi rst session to the last. Even though some practitioners may avoid formal
diagnostic procedures and terminology, making tentative hypotheses and sharing
them with clients throughout the process is a form of ongoing diagnosis. This per-
spective on assessment and diagnosis is consistent with the principles of feminist
therapy, an approach that is critical of traditional diagnostic procedures.
Ethical dilemmas may be created when diagnosis is done strictly for insur-
ance purposes, which often entails arbitrarily assigning a client to a diagnostic
classifi cation. However, it is a clinical, legal, and ethical obligation of therapists to
screen clients for life-threatening problems such as organic disorders, schizophre-
nia, bipolar disorder, and suicidal types of depression. Students need to learn the
clinical skills necessary to do this type of screening, which is a form of diagnostic
thinking.
It is essential to assess the whole person, which includes assessing dimensions
of mind, body, and spirit. Therapists need to take into account the biological proc-
esses as possible underlying factors of psychological symptoms and work closely
with physicians. Clients’ values can be instrumental resources in the search for
solutions to their problems, and spiritual and religious values often illuminate cli-
ent concerns.
For a more detailed discussion of assessment and diagnosis in counseling
practice as it is applied to a single case, consult Case Approach to Counseling and
Psychotherapy (Corey, 2013b), in which theorists from 12 different theoretical ori-
entations share their diagnostic perspectives on the case of Ruth.
e t h i c a l a s p e c t s o f
e v i d e n c e – b a s e d p r a c t i c e
Mental health practitioners are faced with the task of choosing the best interven-
tions with a particular client. For many practitioners this choice is based on their
theoretical orientation. In recent years, however, a shift has occurred toward pro-
moting the use of specifi c interventions for specifi c problems or diagnoses based
on empirically supported treatments (APA Presidential Task Force on Evidence-
based Practice, 2006; Cukrowicz et al., 2005; Deegear & Lawson, 2003; Edwards,
Dattilio, & Bromley, 2004).
This trend toward specifi c, empirically supported treatment is referred to as
evidence-based practice (EBP): “the integration of the best available research with
clinical expertise in the context of patient characteristics, culture, and prefer-
ences” (APA Presidential Task Force on Evidence-based Practice, 2006, p. 273).
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 46 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

47
E
T
H
I
C
A
L

I
S
S
U
E
S

I
N

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
I
N
G

P
R
A
C
T
I
C
E
Increasingly, those practitioners who work in a behavioral health care system
must cope with the challenges associated with evidence-based practice. Norcross,
Hogan, and Koocher (2008) advocate for inclusive evidence-based practices that
incorporate the three pillars of EBP: looking for the best available research, rely-
ing on clinical expertise, and taking into consideration the client’s characteristics,
culture, and preferences. The central aim of evidence-based practice is to require
psychotherapists to base their practice on techniques that have empirical evidence
to support their effi cacy. Research studies empirically analyze the most effective
and effi cient treatments, which then can be widely implemented in clinical prac-
tice (Norcross, Beutler, & Levant, 2006).
Evidence-based practice is a potent force in psychotherapeutic practice today,
and it may mandate the types of treatments therapists can offer in the future
(Wampold & Bhati, 2004). In many mental health settings, clinicians are pres-
sured to use interventions that are both brief and standardized. In such settings,
treatments are operationalized by reliance on a treatment manual that identifi es
what is to be done in each therapy session and how many sessions will be required
(Edwards et al., 2004). Edwards and his colleagues point out that psychological
assessment and treatment is a business involving fi nancial gain and reputation.
In seeking to specify the treatment for a specifi c diagnosis as precisely as possi-
ble, health insurance companies are concerned with determining the minimum
amount of treatment that can be expected to be effective. This raises ethical ques-
tions about whether the insurance company’s need to save money is being placed
above the needs of clients.
Many practitioners believe this approach is mechanistic and does not take into
full consideration the relational dimensions of the psychotherapy process and indi-
vidual variability. Indeed, relying exclusively on standardized treatments for specifi c
problems may raise another set of ethical concerns because the reliability and valid-
ity of these empirically based techniques is questionable. Human change is com-
plex and diffi cult to measure beyond such a simplistic level that the change may be
meaningless. Furthermore, not all clients come to therapy with clearly defi ned psy-
chological disorders. Many clients have existential concerns that do not fi t with any
diagnostic category and do not lend themselves to clearly specifi ed symptom-based
outcomes. EBP may have something to offer mental health professionals who work
with individuals with specifi c emotional, cognitive, and behavioral disorders, but it
does not have a great deal to offer practitioners working with individuals who want
to pursue more meaning and fulfi llment in their lives.
Counseling is not merely a technique that needs to be empirically validated.
Many aspects of treatment—the therapy relationship, the therapist’s personality
and therapeutic style, the client, and environmental factors—are vital contribu-
tors to the success of psychotherapy. Evidence-based practices tend to emphasize
only one of these aspects—interventions based on the best available research.
Norcross and his colleagues (2006) argue for the centrality of the therapeutic rela-
tionship as a determinant of therapy outcomes. They add, however, that the client
actually accounts for more of the treatment outcome than either the relationship
or the method employed.
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 47 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

48
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
H
R
E
E
Norcross and his colleagues (2006) believe the call for accountability in mental
health care is here to stay and that all mental health professionals are challenged
by the mandate to demonstrate the effi ciency, effi cacy, and safety of the services
they provide. They emphasize that the overarching goal of EBP is to enhance the
effectiveness of client services and to improve public health and warn that mental
health professionals need to take a proactive stance to make sure this goal is kept
in focus. They realize there is potential for misuse and abuse by third-party payers
who could selectively use research fi ndings as cost-containment measures rather
than ways of improving the quality of services delivered.
Miller, Duncan, and Hubble (2004) are critical of the EBP movement and
argue that “signifi cant improvements in client retention and outcome have been
shown where therapists have feedback on the client’s experience of the alliance
and progress in treatment. Rather than evidence-based practice, therapists tailor
their work through practice-based evidence” (p. 2). Practice-based evidence involves
using data generated during treatment to inform the process and outcome of treat-
ment. This topic is discussed in more detail in Chapter 15.
For further reading on the topic of evidence-based practice, I recommend
Clinician’s Guide to Evidence-based Practice (Norcross, Hogan, & Koocher, 2008).
m a n a g i n g m u lt i p l e r e l at i o n s h i p s
i n c o u n s e l i n g p r a c t i c e
Dual or multiple relationships, either sexual or nonsexual, occur when coun-
selors assume two (or more) roles simultaneously or sequentially with a client.
This may involve assuming more than one professional role or combining pro-
fessional and nonprofessional roles. The term multiple relationship is more often
used than the term dual relationship because of the complexities involved in these
relationships. The terms dual relationships and multiple relationships are used
interchangeably in various professional codes of ethics, and the ACA (2005) uses
the term nonprofessional relationships. In this section I use the broader term of
multiple relationships to encompass both dual relationships and nonprofessional
relationships.
When clinicians blend their professional relationship with another kind of
relationship with a client, ethical concerns must be considered. Many forms of
nonprofessional interactions or nonsexual multiple relationships pose a challenge
to practitioners. Some examples of nonsexual dual or multiple relationships are
combining the roles of teacher and therapist or of supervisor and therapist; barter-
ing for goods or therapeutic services; borrowing money from a client; providing
therapy to a friend, an employee, or a relative; engaging in a social relationship with
a client; accepting an expensive gift from a client; or going into a business venture
with a client. Some multiple relationships are clearly exploitative and do serious
harm both to the client and to the professional. For example, becoming emotionally
or sexually involved with a current client is clearly unethical, unprofessional, and
illegal. Sexual involvement with a former client is unwise, can be exploitative, and is
generally considered unethical.
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 48 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

49
E
T
H
I
C
A
L

I
S
S
U
E
S

I
N

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
I
N
G

P
R
A
C
T
I
C
E
Because nonsexual multiple relationships are necessarily complex and multi-
dimensional, there are few simple and absolute answers to resolve them. It is not
always possible to play a single role in your work as a counselor, nor is it always
desirable. You may have to deal with managing multiple roles, regardless of the
setting in which you work or the client population you serve. It is a wise practice to
give careful thought to the complexities of multiple roles and relationships before
embroiling yourself in ethically questionable situations.
Ethical reasoning and judgment come into play when ethics codes are applied
to specifi c situations. The ACA Code of Ethics (ACA, 2005) stresses that counseling
professionals must learn how to manage multiple roles and responsibilities in
an ethical way. This entails dealing effectively with the power differential that is
inherent in counseling rela tionships and training relationships, balancing bound-
ary issues, addressing nonprofessional relationships, and striving to avoid using
power in ways that might cause harm to clients, students, or super visees (Herlihy &
Corey, 2006b).
Although multiple relationships do carry inherent risks, it is a mistake to con-
clude that these relationships are always unethical and necessarily lead to harm
and exploitation. Some of these relationships can be benefi cial to clients if they are
implemented thoughtfully and with integrity (Zur, 2007). An excellent resource
on the ethical and clinical dimensions of multiple relationships is Boundaries in
Psychotherapy: Ethical and Clinical Explorations (Zur, 2007).
Perspectives on Multiple Relationships
What makes multiple relationships so problematic? Herlihy and Corey (2006b)
contend that some of the problematic aspects of engaging in multiple relation-
ships are that they are pervasive; they can be diffi cult to recognize; they are una-
voidable at times; they are potentially harmful, but not necessarily always harmful;
they can be benefi cial; and they are the subject of confl icting advice from various
experts. A review of the literature reveals that dual and multiple relationships are
hotly debated. Except for sexual intimacy with current clients, which is unequivo-
cally unethical, there is not much consensus regarding the appropriate way to deal
with multiple relationships.
Some of the codes of the professional organizations advise against forming
multiple relationships, mainly because of the potential for misusing power, ex-
ploiting the client, and impairing objectivity. When multiple relationships exploit
clients, or have signifi cant potential to harm clients, they are unethical. The eth-
ics codes do not mandate avoidance of all such relationships, however; nor do
the codes imply that nonsexual multiple relationships are unethical. The current
focus of ethics codes is to remain alert to the possibilities of harm to clients and
to develop safeguard to protect clients. Although codes can provide some gener-
al guidelines, good judgment, the willingness to refl ect on one’s practices, and
being aware of one’s motivations are critical dimensions of an ethical practitioner.
It bears repeating that multiple relationship issues cannot be resolved with ethics
codes alone; counselors must think through all of the ethical and clinical dimen-
sions involved in a wide range of boundary concerns.
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 49 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

50
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
H
R
E
E
A consensus of many writers is that multiple relationships are inevitable and
unavoidable in some situations and that a global prohibition is not a realistic
answer. Because interpersonal boundaries are not static but undergo redefi nition
over time, the challenge for practitioners is to learn how to manage boundary fl uc-
tuations and to deal effectively with overlapping roles (Herlihy & Corey, 2006b).
One key to learning how to manage multiple relationships is to think of ways to
minimize the risks involved.
ways o f m i n i m i z i n g r i s k In determining whether to proceed with a
multiple relationship, it is critical to consider whether the potential benefi t to the
client of such a relationship outweighs its potential harm. Some relationships may
have more potential benefi ts to clients than potential risks. It is your responsibility
to develop safeguards aimed at reducing the potential for negative consequences.
Herlihy and Corey (2006b) identify the following guidelines:
• Set healthy boundaries early in the therapeutic relationship. Informed consent
is essential from the beginning and throughout the therapy process.
• Involve clients in ongoing discussions and in the decision-making process, and
document your discussions. Discuss with your clients what you expect of them
and what they can expect of you.
• Consult with fellow professionals as a way to maintain objectivity and identify
unanticipated diffi culties. Realize that you don’t need to make a decision alone.
• When multiple relationships are potentially problematic, or when the risk for
harm is high, it is always wise to work under supervision. Document the nature
of this supervision and any actions you take in your records.
• Self-monitoring is critical throughout the process. Ask yourself whose needs are
being met and examine your motivations for considering becoming involved in
a dual or multiple relationship.
In working through a multiple relationship concern, it is best to begin by ascertain-
ing whether such a relationship can be avoided. Nagy (2011) points out that multi-
ple relationships cannot always be avoided, especially in small towns. Nor should
every multiple relationship be considered unethical. However, when a therapist’s
objectivity and competence are compromised, the therapist may fi nd that personal
needs surface and diminish the quality of the therapist’s professional work. Some-
times nonprofessional interactions are avoidable and your involvement would put
the client needlessly at risk. In other cases multiple relationships are unavoidable.
One way of dealing with any potential problems is to adopt a policy of completely
avoiding any kind of nonprofessional interaction. As a general guideline, Nagy
(2011) recommends avoiding multiple relationships to the extent this is possi-
ble. Therapists should document precautions taken to protect clients when such
relationships are unavoidable. Another alternative is to deal with each dilemma
as it develops, making full use of informed consent and at the same time seeking
consultation and supervision in dealing with the situation. This second alternative
includes a professional requirement for self-monitoring. It is one of the hallmarks
of professionalism to be willing to grapple with these ethical complexities of day-
to-day practice.
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 50 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

51
E
T
H
I
C
A
L

I
S
S
U
E
S

I
N

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
I
N
G

P
R
A
C
T
I
C
E
establishing personal and professional boundaries Establish-
ing and maintaining consistent yet fl exible boundaries is necessary if you are to
effectively counsel clients. If you have diffi culty establishing and maintaining
boundaries in your personal life, you are likely to fi nd that you will have diffi –
culty when it comes to managing boundaries in your professional life. Developing
appropriate and effective boundaries in your counseling practice is the fi rst step
to learning how to manage multiple relationships. There is a relationship between
developing appropriate boundaries in the personal and professional realms. If you
are successful in establishing boundaries in various aspects of your personal life,
you have a good foundation for creating sound boundaries with clients.
One important aspect of maintaining appropriate professional boundaries is to
recognize boundary crossings and prevent them from becoming boundary viola-
tions. A boundary crossing is a departure from a commonly accepted practice that
could potentially benefi t a client. For example, attending the wedding of a client
may be extending a boundary, but it could be benefi cial for the client. In contrast,
a boundary violation is a serious breach that harms the client and is therefore
unethical. A boundary violation is a boundary crossing that takes the practitioner
out of the professional role, which generally involves exploitation and results in
harm to a client (Gutheil & Brodsky, 2008). Flexible boundaries can be useful in the
counseling process when applied ethically. Some boundary crossings pose no ethi-
cal problems and may enhance the counseling relationship. Other boundary cross-
ings may lead to a pattern of blurred professional roles and become problematic.
b e c o m i n g a n e t h i c a l c o u n s e lo r
Knowing and following your profession’s code of ethics is part of being an ethi-
cal practitioner, but these codes do not make decisions for you. As you become
involved in counseling, you will fi nd that interpreting the ethical guidelines of your
professional organization and applying them to particular situations demand the
utmost ethical sensitivity. Even responsible practitioners differ over how to apply
established ethical principles to specifi c situations. In your professional work you
will deal with questions that do not always have obvious answers. You will have
to assume responsibility for deciding how to act in ways that will further the best
interests of your clients.
Throughout your professional life you will need to reexamine the ethical ques-
tions raised in this chapter. You can benefi t from both formal and informal op-
portunities to discuss ethical dilemmas during your training program. Even if you
resolve some ethical matters while completing a graduate program, there is no guar-
antee that these matters have been settled once and for all. These topics are bound
to take on new dimensions as you gain more experience. Oftentimes students bur-
den themselves unnecessarily with the expectation that they should resolve all poten-
tial ethical problem areas before they begin to practice. Throughout your profession-
al life, seek consultation from trusted colleagues and supervisors whenever you face
an ethical dilemma. Ethical decision-making is an evolutionary process that requires
you to be continually open and self-refl ective. Becoming an ethical practitioner is not
a fi nal destination but a journey that will continue throughout your career.
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 51 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

52
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
H
R
E
E
s u m m a ry
It is essential that you learn a process for thinking about and dealing with ethical
dilemmas, keeping in mind that most ethical issues are complex and defy simple
solutions. A sign of good faith is your willingness to share your struggles with
colleagues. Such consultation can be helpful in clarifying issues by giving you an-
other perspective on a situation. The task of developing a sense of professional
and ethical responsibility is never really fi nished, and new issues are constantly
surfacing. Positive ethics demands periodic refl ection and an openness to change.
If there is one fundamental question that can serve to tie together all the issues
discussed in this chapter, it is this: “Who has the right to counsel another person?”
This question can be the focal point of your refl ection on ethical and professional
issues. It also can be the basis of your self-examination each day that you meet with
clients. Continue to ask yourself: “What makes me think I have a right to counsel oth-
ers?” “What do I have to offer the people I’m counseling?” “Am I doing in my own life
what I’m encouraging my clients to do?” At times you may feel that you have no ethi-
cal right to counsel others, perhaps because your own life isn’t always the model you
would like it to be for your clients. More important than resolving all of life’s issues is
knowing what kinds of questions to ask and remaining open to refl ection.
This chapter has introduced you to a number of ethical issues that you are
bound to face at some point in your counseling practice. I hope your interest has
been piqued and that you will want to learn more. For further reading on this
important topic, choose some of the books listed in the Recommended Supplemen-
tary Readings section for further study.
w h e r e to g o f r o m h e r e
The following professional organizations provide helpful information about what
each group has to offer, including the code of ethics for the organization.
American Association for Marriage and www.aamft.org
Family Therapy (AAMFT)
American Counseling Association (ACA) www.counseling.org
American Mental Health Counselors www.amhca.org
Association (AMHCA)
American Music Therapy Association www.musictherapy.org
American Psychological Association (APA) www.apa.org
American School Counselor www.schoolcounselor.org
Association (ASCA)
Commission on Rehabilitation Counselor www.crccertifi cation.com
Certifi cation (CRCC)
National Association of Alcohol and www.naadac.org
Drug Abuse Counselors (NAADAC)
National Association of Social Workers www.socialworkers.org
(NASW)
National Organization for Human www.nationalhumanservices.org
Services (NOHS)
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 52 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

Free Podcasts for ACA Members
You can download ACA Podcasts (prerecorded interviews) relevant to topics
discussed in Chapter 3 by going to www.counseling.org, clicking on the Resource
button, and selecting the Podcast Series:
Multicultural and Diversity (Dr. Courtland Lee)
The Counselor and the Law: A Guide to Legal and Ethical Practice
(Drs. Nancy Wheeler and Burt Bertram)
The Ethics of Confi dentiality, Who Needs to Know What?
(Larry Freeman)
The Death of Dual Relationships, or Relationships with Clients, Benefi cial
Versus Harmful (Dr. Rocco Cottone)
Clinical Supervision in the Helping Professions (Drs. Gerald Corey, Robert
Haynes, Patrice Moulton, and Michelle Muratori)
For interviews on topics introduced in subsequent chapters, see the following
podcasts:
Chapter 5: Adlerian Theory and Practice (Dr. Jon Carlson)
Chapter 6: Existential Therapy (Dr. Gerald Corey)
Chapter 7: Carl Rogers and the Person-Centered Approach (Dr. Howard
Kirschenbaum)
Chapter 11: Reality Therapy, Choice Theory: What’s the Difference?
(Dr. Robert Wubbolding)
Chapter 13: Solution-Focused Counseling in Schools (Dr. John Murphy)
Chapter 13: Narrative Therapy: Remembering Lives, Conversations With
the Dying and Bereaved (Lorraine Hedtke, MSW, LCSW, and Dr. John
Winslade)
Recommended Supplementary
Readings for Part 1
Leaving It at the Offi ce: A Guide to Psychotherapist Self-Care (Norcross & Guy,
2007) addresses 12 self-care strategies that are supported by empirical evidence.
The authors develop the position that self-care is personally essential and profes-
sionally ethical. This is one of the most useful books on therapist self-care and on
prevention of burnout.
Psychotherapy Relationships That Work: Evidence-based Responsiveness (Norcross,
2011) is a comprehensive treatment of the effective elements of the therapy
relationship. Many different contributors address ways of tailoring the therapy
relationship to individual clients. Implications from research for effective clinical
practice are presented.
Ethics Desk Reference for Counselors (Barnett & Johnson, 2010) is a practical guide
to understanding and applying the ACA Code of Ethics. It is a reference that is
easy to read, interesting, and has appeal for both students and practitioners.
53
E
T
H
I
C
A
L

I
S
S
U
E
S

I
N

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
I
N
G

P
R
A
C
T
I
C
E
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 53 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

The Gift of Therapy: An Open Letter to a New Generation of Therapists and Their
Patients (Yalom, 2003) is a highly readable, insightful, and useful resource. It
includes 85 short chapters on a wide variety of topics that pertain to the counselor
as a person and as a professional.
ACA Ethical Standards Casebook (Herlihy & Corey, 2006a) contains a variety of
useful cases that are geared to the ACA Code of Ethics. The examples illustrate and
clarify the meaning and intent of the standards.
Boundary Issues in Counseling: Multiple Roles and Responsibilities (Herlihy & Corey,
2006b) puts the multiple-relationship controversy into perspective. The book
focuses on dual relationships in a variety of work settings.
Boundaries in Psychotherapy: Ethical and Clinical Explorations (Zur, 2007) ex-
amines the complex nature of boundaries in professional practice by offering a
decision-making process to help practitioners deal with a range of topics such as
gifts, nonsexual touch, home visits, bartering, and therapist self-disclosure.
Issues and Ethics in the Helping Professions (Corey, Corey, & Callanan, 2011) is devoted
entirely to the issues that were introduced briefl y in Chapter 3. The book is designed
to involve readers in a personal and active way, and many open-ended cases are pre-
sented to help readers formulate their thoughts on a wide range of ethical issues.
Becoming a Helper (M. Corey & Corey, 2011) has separate chapters that expand
on issues dealing with the personal and professional lives of helpers and ethical
issues in counseling practice.
Ethics in Action: CD-ROM (Corey, Corey, & Haynes, 2003) is a self-instructional
program divided into three parts: (1) ethical decision making, (2) values and the
helping relationship, and (3) boundary issues and multiple relationships. The
program includes video clips of vignettes demonstrating ethical situations aimed
at stimulating discussion.
Student Manual for Theory and Practice of Counseling and Psychotherapy (Corey,
2013c) is designed to help you integrate theory with practice and to make the
concepts covered in this book come alive. It consists of self-inventories, overview
summaries of the theories, a glossary of key concepts, study questions, issues
and questions for personal application, activities and exercises, comprehension
checks and quizzes, and case examples. The manual is fully coordinated with the
textbook to make it a personal study guide.
Case Approach to Counseling and Psychotherapy (Corey, 2013b) provides case ap-
plications of how each of the theories presented in this book works in action.
A hypothetical client, Ruth, experiences counseling from all of the therapeutic
vantage points.
The Art of Integrative Counseling (Corey, 2013a) is a presentation of concepts and
techniques from the various theories of counseling. The book provides guidelines
for readers in developing their own approaches to counseling practice.
54
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
H
R
E
E
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 54 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

DVD for Theory and Practice of Counseling and Psychotherapy: The Case of Stan
and Lecturettes (Corey, 2013) is an interactive self-study tool that consists of two
programs. Part 1 includes 13 sessions in which Gerald Corey counsels Stan us-
ing a few selected techniques from each theory. Part 2 consists of brief lectures
by the author for each chapter in Theory and Practice of Counseling and Psycho-
therapy. Both programs emphasize the practical applications of the various
theories.
DVD for Integrative Counseling: The Case of Ruth and Lecturettes (Corey & Haynes,
2013) is an interactive self-study tool that contains video segments and interac-
tive questions designed to teach students ways of working with a client (Ruth)
by drawing concepts and techniques from diverse theoretical approaches. The
topics in this video program parallel the topics in the book The Art of Integrative
Counseling.
Creating Your Professional Path: Lessons From My Journey (Corey, 2010) is a per-
sonal book that deals with a range of topics pertaining to the counselor as a person
and as a professional. In addition to the author’s discussion of his personal and
professional journey, 18 contributors share their personal stories regarding turn-
ing points in their lives and lessons they learned.
The Counselor as Person and Professional (DVD) elaborates on the themes in Chap-
ter 2 and is available from the American Counseling Association. This program is
a keynote address that was given by Gerald Corey at the ACA conference in 2010
in Pittsburgh.
References and Suggested Readings
for Part 1
55
E
T
H
I
C
A
L

I
S
S
U
E
S

I
N

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
I
N
G

P
R
A
C
T
I
C
E
*Books and articles marked with an asterisk are suggested for further study.
American Counseling Association.
(2005). ACA code of ethics. Alexandria,
VA: Author.
American Psychiatric Association. (2000).
Diagnostic and statistical manual of mental
disorders, text revision (4th ed.). Washington,
DC: Author.
American Psychological Association. (2002).
Ethical principles of psychologists and code
of conduct. American Psychologist, 57(12),
1060–1073.
American Psychological Association. (2003).
Guidelines on multicultural education, training,
research, practice, and organizational change
for psychologists. American Psychologist, 58(5),
377–402.
*American Psychological Association
Presidential Task Force on Evidence-Based
Practice. (2006). Evidence-based practice in
psychology. American Psychologist, 61, 271–285.
Arredondo, P., Toporek, R., Brown, S., Jones,
J., Locke, D., Sanchez, J., & Stadler, H. (1996).
Operationalization of multicultural counseling
competencies. Journal of Multicultural Coun-
seling and Development, 24(1), 42–78.
*Baker, E. K. (2003). Caring for ourselves: A
therapist’s guide to personal and professional
well-being. Washington, DC: American
Psychological Association.
*Barnett, J. E., & Johnson, W. B. (2008). Ethics
desk reference for psychologists. Washington, DC:
American Psychological Association.
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 55 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

56
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
H
R
E
E
*Barnett, J. E., & Johnson, W. B. (2010). Ethics
desk reference for counselors. Alexandria, VA:
American Counseling Association.
Cardemil, E. V., & Battle, C. L. (2003). Guess
who’s coming to therapy? Getting comfortable
with conversations about race and ethnic-
ity in psychotherapy. Professional Psychology:
Research and Practice, 34(3), 278–286.
Codes of Ethics for the Helping Professions
(4Th Ed.). (2011). Belmont, CA: Brooks/Cole,
Cengage Learning.
Comas-Diaz, L. (2011). Multicultural ap-
proaches to psychotherapy. In J. C. Norcross,
G. R. Vandenbos, & D. K. Freedheim (Eds.),
History of psychotherapy (2nd ed., pp. 243–
268). Washington, DC: American
Psychological Association.
Committee on Professional Practice and
Standards. (2003). Legal issues in the profes-
sional practice of psychology. Professional Psy-
chology: Research and Practice, 34(6), 595–600.
*Corey, G. (2010). Creating your professional
path: Lessons from my journey. Alexandria,
Va: American Counseling Association.
*Corey, G. (2013a). The art of integrative coun-
seling (3rd ed.). Belmont, CA: Brooks/Cole,
Cengage Learning.
*Corey, G. (2013b). Case approach to counseling
and psychotherapy (8th ed.). Belmont, CA:
Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning.
*Corey, G. (2013c). Student manual for theory
and practice of counseling and psychotherapy
(9th ed.). Belmont, CA: Brooks/Cole,
Cengage Learning.
*Corey, G., & Corey, M. (2010). I never knew
I had a choice (9th ed.). Belmont, CA: Brooks/
Cole, Cengage Learning.
*Corey, G., Corey, M., & Callanan, P. (2011).
Issues and ethics in the helping professions (8th ed.).
Belmont, CA: Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning.
*Corey, G., Corey, M., & Haynes, R. (2003).
Ethics in action: CD-ROM. Belmont, CA: Brooks/
Cole, Cengage Learning.
*Corey, G., & Haynes, R. (2013). DVD for inte-
grative counseling: The case of Ruth and
lecturettes. Belmont, CA: Brooks/Cole,
Cengage Learning.
*Corey, M., & Corey, G. (2011). Becoming a
helper (6th ed.). Belmont, CA: Brooks/Cole,
Cengage Learning.
Cukrowicz, K. C., White, B. A., Reitzel, L. R.,
Burns, A. B., Driscoll, K. A., Kemper, T. S., &
Joiner, T. E. (2005). Improved treatment out-
come associated with the shift to empirically
supported treatments in a graduate training
clinic. Professional Psychology: Research and
Practice, 36(3), 330–337.
Deegear, J., & Lawson, D. M. (2003). The
utility of empirically supported treatments.
Professional Psychology: Research and Practice,
34(3), 271–277.
*Duncan, B. L., Miller, S. D., & Sparks, J. A.
(2004). The heroic client: A revolutionary way
to improve effectiveness through client-directed,
outcome-informed therapy. San Francisco:
Jossey-Bass.
*Duncan, B. L., Miller, S. D., Wampold, B. E. &
Hubble, M. A. (Eds.). (2010). The heart and
soul of change: Delivering what works in therapy
(2nd ed.). Washington, DC: American Psycho-
logical Association.
Edwards, J. A., Dattilio, F. M., & Bromley,
D. B. (2004). Developing evidence-based
practice: The role of case-based research.
Professional Psychology: Research and Practice,
35(6), 589–597.
Elkins, D. N. (2009). Humanistic psychology:
A clinical manifesto. Colorado Springs, CO:
University of the Rockies Press.
*Falender, C. A., & Shafranske, E. P. (2004).
Clinical supervision: A competency-based
approach. Washington, DC: American
Psychological Association.
*Geller, J. D., Norcross, J. C., & Orlinsky,
D. E. (Eds.). (2005a). The psychotherapist’s
own psychotherapy: Patient and clinician
perspectives. New York: Oxford
University Press.
*Geller, J. D., Norcross, J. C., & Orlinsky, D. E.
(2005b). The question of personal therapy:
Introduction and prospectus. In J. D. Geller,
J. C. Norcross, & D. E. Orlinsky (Eds.), The
psychotherapist’s own psychotherapy: Patient
and clinician perspectives (pp. 3–11). New York:
Oxford University Press.
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 56 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

57
E
T
H
I
C
A
L

I
S
S
U
E
S

I
N

C
O
U
N
S
E
L
I
N
G

P
R
A
C
T
I
C
E
Gutheil, T. G., & Brodsky, A. (2008). Prevent-
ing boundary violations in clinical practice. New
York: Guilford Press.
*Herlihy, B., & Corey, G. (2006a). ACA ethical
standards casebook (6th ed.). Alexandria, VA:
American Counseling Association.
*Herlihy, B., & Corey, G. (2006b). Boundary
issues in counseling: Multiple roles and respon-
sibilities (2nd ed.). Alexandria, VA: American
Counseling Association.
*Knapp, S. J., & Vandecreek, L. (2006).
Practical ethics for psychologists: A positive
approach. Washington, DC: American
Psychological Association.
Lambert, M. J. (2011). Psychotherapy research
and its achievements. In J. C. Norcross, G. R.
Vandenbos, & D. K. Freedheim (Eds.), His-
tory of psychotherapy (2nd ed., pp. 299–332).
Washington, DC: American Psychological
Association.
*Lazarus, A. A., & Zur, O. (2002). Dual relation-
ships and psychotherapy. New York: Springer.
*Lum, D. (2011). Culturally competent practice: A
framework for understanding diverse groups and
justice issues (4th ed.). Belmont, CA: Brooks/
Cole, Cengage Learning.
*Miller, S. D., Duncan, B. L., & Hubble, M. A.
(2004) Beyond integration: The triumph of
outcome over process in clinical practice.
Psychotherapy in Australia, 10(2), 2–19.
*Nagy, T. F. (2011). Essential ethics for psycholo-
gists: A primer for understanding and master-
ing core issues. Washington, DC: American
Psychological Association.
*Norcross, J. C. (2005). The psychotherapist’s
own psychotherapy: Educating and developing
psychologists. American Psychologist, 60(8),
840–850.
*Norcross, J. C. (Ed.). (2011). Psychotherapy
relationships that work: Evidence-based respon-
siveness (2nd ed.). New York: Oxford University
Press.
Norcross, J. C., Beutler, L. E., & Levant, R. F.
(2006). Evidence-based practices in mental
health: Debate and dialogue on the fundamental
questions. Washington, DC: American Psycho-
logical Association.
*Norcross, J. C., & Goldfried, M. R. (Eds.).
(2005). Handbook of psychotherapy
integration (2nd ed.). New York: Oxford
University Press.
*Norcross, J. C., & Guy, J. D. (2007). Leaving it at
the office: Psychotherapist self-care. New York:
Guilford Press.
*Norcross, J. C., Hogan, T. P., & Koocher,
G. P. (2008). Clinician’s guide to evidence-based
practices. New York: Oxford University Press.
Norcross, J. C., & Lambert, M. J. (2011).
Evidence-based therapy relationships. In J.C.
Norcross (Ed.), Psychotherapy relationships that
work: Evidence-based responsiveness (2nd ed.,
pp. 3–21). New York: Oxford University Press.
Norcross, J. C., Vandenbos, G. R., &
Freedheim, D. K. (2011). History of psycho-
therapy (2nd ed.). Washington, DC: American
Psychological Association.
Norcross, J. C., & Wampold, B. E. (2011).
Evidence-based therapy relationships:
Research conclusions and clinical practices. In
J.C. Norcross (Ed.), Psychotherapy relationships
that work: Evidence-based responsiveness
(2nd ed., pp. 423–430). New York: Oxford
University Press.
Orlinsky, D. E., Norcross, J. C., Ronnestad,
M. H., & Wiseman, H. (2005). Outcomes
and impacts of the psychotherapists’ own
psychotherapy. In J. D. Geller, J. C. Norcross, &
D. E. Orlinsky (Eds.), The psychotherapist’s own
psychotherapy: Patient and clinician perspectives
(pp. 214–230). New York: Oxford University
Press.
*Pedersen, P. (2000). A handbook for develop-
ing multicultural awareness (3rd ed.). Alexan-
dria, VA: American Counseling Association.
*Remley, T. P., & Herlihy, B. (2010). Ethical,
legal, and professional issues in counseling
(3rd ed.). Upper Saddle River, NJ: Merrill/
Prentice-Hall.
*Schank, J. A., & Skovholt, T. M. (2006). Ethi-
cal practice in small communities: Challenges
and rewards for psychologists. Washington, DC:
American Psychological Association.
Shallcross, L. (2010). Putting clients ahead of
personal values. Counseling Today, 53(5), 32–34.
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 57 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

58
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

T
H
R
E
E
Shallcross, L. (2011). Taking care of
yourself as a counselor. Counseling Today,
53(7), 30–37.
*Skovholt, T. M., & Jennings, L. (2004). Master
therapists: Exploring expertise in therapy and
counseling. Boston: Pearson Education.
*Sperry, L. (2007). The ethical and professional
practice of counseling and psychotherapy. Bos-
ton: Allyn & Bacon (Pearson).
*Stebnicki, M. A. (2008). Empathy fatigue:
Healing the mind, body, and spirit of professional
counselors. New York: Springer.
Sue, D. W., Arredondo, P., & Mcdavis, R. J.
(1992). Multicultural counseling competen-
cies and standards. A call to the profession.
Journal of Counseling and Development, 70(4),
477–486.
*Sue, D. W., & Sue, D. (2008). Counseling the
culturally diverse: Theory and practice (5th ed.).
New York: Wiley.
Toporek, R. L., Gerstein, L. H., Fouad, N. A.,
Roysircar, G., & Israel, T. (2006). Handbook for
social justice counseling in counseling psychology:
Leadership, vision, and action. Thousand Oaks,
CA: Sage.
Wampold, B. E. (2001). The great psycho-
therapy debate: Models, methods, and findings.
Hillsdale, NJ: Erlbaum.
Wampold, B. E., & Bhati, K. S. (2004). Attend-
ing to the omissions: A historical examina-
tion of evidence-based practice movements.
Professional Psychology: Research and Practice,
35(6), 563–570.
*Yalom, I. D. (2003). The gift of therapy: An
open letter to a new generation of therapists and
their patients. New York: HarperCollins
(Perennial).
*Zur, O. (2007). Boundaries in psychotherapy:
Ethical and clinical explorations. Washington,
DC: American Psychological Association.
28549_ch03_rev01.indd 58 20/09/11 1:33 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

59
p a r t 2
Theories and Techniques
of Counseling
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

61
p a r t 2
Theories and Techniques
of Counseling
4 P s yc h oa n a ly t i c Th e r a p y 62
5 A d l e r i a n Th e r a p y 101
6 E x i s t e n t i a l Th e r a p y 136
7 P e r s o n – C e n t e r e d Th e r a p y 172
8 G e s ta lt Th e r a p y 210
9 B e h av i o r Th e r a p y 244
1 0 Co g n i t i v e B e h av i o r Th e r a p y 287
1 1 R e a l i t y Th e r a p y 333
1 2 Fe m i n i s t Th e r a p y 360
1 3 Po s t m o d e r n A p p r oa c h e s 395
1 4 Fa m i ly Sy s t e m s Th e r a p y 432
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

62
i n t r o d u ct i o n
k e y co n c e p t s
t h e t h e r a p e u t i c p r o c es s
a p p l i c at i o n : t h e r a p e u t i c
t ec h n i q u es a n d p r o c e d u r es
j u n g ’s p e r s p ect i v e o n t h e
d e v e lo p m e n t o f p e r s o n a l i t y
co n t e m p o r a ry t r e n d s : o b j ect-
r e l at i o n s t h eo ry, s e l f
p syc h o lo gy, a n d r e l at i o n a l
p syc h oa n a lys i s
p syc h oa n a ly t i c t h e r a p y f r o m
a m u lt i c u lt u r a l p e r s p ect i v e
p syc h oa n a ly t i c t h e r a p y
a p p l i e d to t h e c a s e o f sta n
s u m m a ry a n d e va l u at i o n
w h e r e to g o f r o m h e r e
c h a p t e r 4
Psychoanalytic Therapy
w h e r r e
ect i v e o n
o f p e r s o n
p e r s p
m e n t
62
e
t y
j u n g ’
d e v e l
a p p l i c at i o n : t h e r a p e
t ec h n i q u es a n d p r o c
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

63
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Sigmund Freud
S I G M U N D F R E U D (1856–
1939) was the firstborn in
a Viennese family of three
boys and five girls. His father,
like many others of his time
and place, was very authori-
tarian. Freud’s family back-
ground is a factor to consider
in understanding the devel-
opment of his theory.
Even though Freud’s family had limited financ-
es and was forced to live in a crowded apartment,
his parents made every effort to foster his obvious
intellectual capacities. Freud had many interests,
but his career choices were restricted because of
his Jewish heritage. He finally settled on medicine.
Only 4 years after earning his medical degree from
the University of Vienna at the age of 26, he at-
tained a prestigious position there as a lecturer.
Freud devoted most of his life to formulat-
ing and extending his theory of psychoanalysis.
Interestingly, the most creative phase of his life
corresponded to a period when he was experienc-
ing severe emotional problems of his own. During
his early 40s, Freud had numerous psychosomatic
disorders, as well as exaggerated fears of dying and
other phobias, and was involved in the difficult task
of self-analysis. By exploring the meaning of his
own dreams, he gained insights into the dynamics
of personality development. He first examined his
childhood memories and came to realize the intense
hostility he had felt for his father. He also recalled his
childhood sexual feelings for his mother, who was
attractive, loving, and protective. He then clinically
formulated his theory as he observed his patients
work through their own problems in analysis.
Freud had very little tolerance for colleagues
who diverged from his psychoanalytic doctrines.
He attempted to keep control over the movement
by expelling those who dared to disagree. Carl
Jung and Alfred Adler, for example, worked closely
with Freud, but each founded his own therapeutic
school after repeated disagreements with Freud on
theoretical and clinical issues.
Freud was highly creative and productive,
frequently putting in 18-hour days. His col-
lected works fill 24 volumes. Freud’s productivity
remained at this prolific level until late in his life
when he contracted cancer of the jaw. During his
last two decades, he underwent 33 operations and
was in almost constant pain. He died in London
in 1939.
As the originator of psychoanalysis, Freud
distinguished himself as an intellectual giant. He
pioneered new techniques for understanding
human behavior, and his efforts resulted in the
most comprehensive theory of personality and
psychotherapy ever developed.
i n t r o d u c t i o n
In
de
x
St
oc
k
Im
ag
er
y/
Ph
ot
oL
ib
ra
ry
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

64
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
O
U
R
the
See the DVD program for Chapter 4, DVD for Theory and Practice of Counseling
and Psychotherapy: The Case of Stan and Lecturettes. I suggest that you view
the brief lecture for each chapter prior to reading the chapter.
k e y c o n c e p t s
View of Human Nature
libido
life instincts
death instincts,
Structure of Personality
id
ego
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

65
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
superego,
t h e i d id
pleasure principle,
t h e e g o ego
reality principle,
t h e s u p e r e g o superego
Consciousness and the Unconscious
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

66
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
O
U
R
unconscious
Anxiety
Anxiety
Reality anxiety
Neurotic anxiety
Moral anxiety
Ego-Defense Mechanisms
Ego-defense mechanisms
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

67
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
TA B L E 4 .1 Ego-Defense Mechanisms
D E F E N S E U S E S F O R B E H A V I O R
Repression
Denial
Reaction
formation
Projection
Displacement
Rationalization
(continues)
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

68
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
O
U
R
Sublimation
Regression
Introjection
Identification
Compensation
Development of Personality
i m p o r ta n c e o f e a r ly d e v e lo p m e n t
psychosexual stages
TA B L E 4 .1 Ego-Defense Mechanisms (continued)
D E F E N S E U S E S F O R B E H A V I O R
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

oral stage,
anal stage,
phallic stage,
e r i k s o n ’s p s yc h o s o c i a l p e r s p e c t i v e
psychosocial stages
crisis
Classical psychoanalysis id psychol-
ogy,
Contemporary
psychoanalysis ego psychology,
69
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

70
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
O
U
R
TA B L E 4 . 2 Comparison of Freud’s Psychosexual Stages and Erikson’s
Psychosocial Stages
P E R I O D
O F L I F E

F R E U D

E R I K S O N
First year of life Oral stage Infancy: Trust versus mistrust
Ages 1–3 Anal stage Early childhood: Autonomy versus
shame and doubt
Ages 3–6 Phallic stage
Oedipus complex,
Electra complex,
Preschool age: Initiative versus guilt
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

71
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Ages 6–12 Latency stage School age: Industry versus inferiority
Ages 12–18 Genital stage Adolescence: Identity versus role confusion
Ages 18–35 Genital stage continues Young adulthood: Intimacy versus
isolation.
Ages 35–60 Genital stage continues Middle age: Generativity versus
stagnation.
Ages 60+ Genital stage continues Later life: Integrity versus despair
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

72
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
O
U
R
c o u n s e l i n g i m p l i c at i o n s
t h e t h e r a p e u t i c p r o c e s s
Therapeutic Goals
Therapist’s Function and Role
“blank-screen” approach
transference relationship,
projections
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

73
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Client’s Experience in Therapy
free
association;
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

74
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
O
U
R
not
classical psychoanalysis
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

75
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Relationship Between Therapist and Client
Transference
working-through
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

76
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
O
U
R
countertransference
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

77
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
lose their objectivity in a relationship because their own conflicts are triggered.
Wolitzky (2011b) states that over the years this traditional view of countertrans-
ference has broadened to include all of the therapist’s reactions, not only to the
client’s transference but to all aspects of the client’s personality and behavior.
In this broader perspective, countertransference involves the therapist’s total
emotional response to a client. In today’s psychoanalytic practice, countertrans-
ference is manifested in the form of subtle nonverbal, tonal, and attitudinal
actions that inevitably affect clients, either consciously or unconsciously (Curtis &
Hirsch, 2011).
It is critical that therapists become aware of their countertransference so that
their reactions toward clients do not interfere with their objectivity. For example,
a male client may become excessively dependent on his female therapist. The cli-
ent may look to her to direct him and tell him how to live, and he may look to her
for the love and acceptance that he felt he was unable to secure from his mother.
The therapist herself may have unresolved needs to nurture, to foster a dependent
relationship, and to be told that she is significant, and she may be meeting her
own needs by in some way keeping her client dependent. Unless she is aware of
her own needs as well as her own dynamics, it is very likely that her dynamics will
interfere with the progress of therapy.
Not all countertransference reactions are detrimental to therapeutic progress.
Indeed, countertransference reactions are often the strongest source of data for
understanding the world of the client and for self-understanding on the therapist’s
part. The therapist’s countertransference reactions are inevitable because all ther-
apists have unresolved conflicts, personal vulnerabilities, and unconscious “soft
spots” that are activated through their professional work (Curtis & Hirsch, 2011;
Hayes, Gelso, & Hummel, 2011; Wolitkzy, 2011a). Hayes (2004) reports that most
research on countertransference has dealt with its deleterious effects and how to
manage these reactions. Hayes adds that it would be useful to undertake system-
atic study of the potential therapeutic benefits of countertransference.
Although countertransference can greatly benefit the therapeutic work, this
is true only if therapists study their internal reactions and use them to under-
stand their clients (Ainslie, 2007; Gelso & Hayes, 2002; Wolitzky, 2011a, 2011b).
It is critical that therapists monitor their own feelings during therapy sessions and
use their responses as a source for increased self-awareness and understanding of
their clients.
A therapist who pays attention to his or her countertransference reactions and
observations to a particular client may use this as a part of the therapy. The thera-
pist who notes a countertransference mood of irritability, for instance, may learn
something about a client’s pattern of being demanding, which can be explored in
therapy. Viewed in this more positive way, countertransference can become a key
avenue for helping the client gain self-understanding.
Psychoanalytic therapists vary in the manner in which they use their observa-
tions of countertransference. In some instances the feelings may be shared with
the client, but traditional analytic therapists strive to minimize their expression of
countertransference while silently learning from its inevitable occurrence. Hayes,
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

78
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
O
U
R
a p p l i c at i o n : t h e r a p e u t i c
t e c h n i q u e s a n d p r o c e d u r e s
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

79
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Case Approach to Counseling and Psychotherapy
Maintaining the Analytic Framework
Maintaining the analytic frame-
work
Free Association
free association,
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

80
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
O
U
R
Interpretation
Interpretation
Dream Analysis
Dream analysis
Latent
content
manifest content,
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

81
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
dream work
Analysis and Interpretation of Resistance
Resistance,
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

82
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
O
U
R
Analysis and Interpretation of Transference
Application to Group Counseling
think
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

83
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Theory and Practice of Group
Counseling
Psychodynamic Group Psychotherapy
j u n g ’s p e r s p e c t i v e o n t h e
d e v e lo p m e n t o f p e r s o n a l i t y
analytical psychology
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

84
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
O
U
R
Memories, Dreams, Reflections
individuation
collective unconscious
archetypes
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

85
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
persona
animus anima
shadow
Memories, Dreams,
Reflections Living With Paradox: An Introduction to Jungian Psy-
chology
c o n t e m p o r a ry t r e n d s : o b j e c t-
r e l at i o n s t h e o ry, s e l f p s yc h o lo gy,
a n d r e l at i o n a l p s yc h oa n a lys i s
Ego psychology
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

86
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
O
U
R
Object-relations theory
object
other
Self-psychology,
relational model
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

87
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
s u m m a ry o f s ta g e s o f d e v e lo p m e n t
normal infantile autism
symbiosis,
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

88
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
O
U
R
separation–individuation
narcissistic
narcissistic personality
borderline personality disorder
separation–individuation
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

89
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
t r e at i n g b o r d e r l i n e a n d n a r c i s s i s t i c d i s o r d e r s
Psychotherapy for Borderline Personality
some directions of contemporary psychodynamic therapy
the trend toward brief, time-limited psychodynamic therapy
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

90
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
O
U
R
brief psychodynamic therapy (BPT)
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

91
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Brief Dynamic Therapy
p s yc h oa n a ly t i c t h e r a p y f r o m a
m u lt i c u lt u r a l p e r s p e c t i v e
Strengths From a Diversity Perspective
Shortcomings From a Diversity Perspective
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

after
In each of the chapters in Part 2, the
case of Stan is used to demonstrate
the practical applications of the theory
in question. To give you a focus on Stan’s central
concerns, refer to the end of Chapter 1, where
his biography is given. I also recommend that
you at least skim Chapter 16, which deals with
an integrative approach as applied to Stan.
The psychoanalytic approach focuses on the
unconscious psychodynamics of Stan’s behavior.
Considerable attention is given to material that
he has repressed. At the extreme Stan demon-
strated a self-destructive tendency, which is a
way of inflicting punishment on himself. Instead
of directing his hostility toward his parents and
siblings, he turned it inward toward himself.
Stan’s preoccupation with drinking could be
hypothesized as evidence of an oral fixation.
Because he never received love and acceptance
during his early childhood, he is still suffering
from this deprivation and continues to desper-
ately search for approval and acceptance from
others. Stan’s gender-role identification was
fraught with difficulties. He learned the basis
of female–male relationships through his early
experiences with his parents. What he saw was
fighting, bickering, and discounting. His father
was the weak one who always lost, and his
mother was the strong, domineering force who
could and did hurt men. Stan generalized his fear
of his mother to all women. It could be further
hypothesized that the woman he married was
similar to his mother, both of whom reinforced
his feelings of impotence.
The opportunity to develop a transference
relationship and work through it is the core of
the therapy process. Stan will eventually relate to
me, as his therapist, as he did to his father, and
this process will be a valuable means of gaining
insight into the origin of Stan’s difficulties in
relating to others. The analytic process stresses
an intensive exploration of Stan’s past. Stan
devotes much therapy time to reliving and
exploring his early past. As he talks, he gains
increased understanding of the dynamics of his
behavior. He begins to see connections between
his present problems and early experiences in his
childhood. Stan explores memories of relation-
ships with his siblings and with his mother and
father and also explores how he has generalized
his view of women and men from his view of
these family members. It is expected that he will
reexperience old feelings and uncover buried
feelings related to traumatic events. From anoth-
er perspective, apart from whatever conscious
insight Stan may acquire, the goal is for him to
Psychoanalytic Therapy Applied to the Case of Stan
92
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

have a more integrated self, where feelings split
off as foreign (the id) become more a part of what
he is comfortable with (the ego). In Stan’s relation-
ship with me, his old feelings can have different
outcomes from his past experiences with significant
others and can result in deep personality growth.
I am likely to explore some of these ques-
tions with Stan: “What did you do when you felt
unloved?” “As a child, what did you do with your
negative feelings?” “As a child, could you express
your anger, hurt, and fears?” “What effects did your
relationship with your mother and father have on
you?” “What did this teach you about women and
about men?” Brought into the here and now of the
transference relationship, I might ask, “When have
you felt anything like you felt with your parents?”
The analytic process focuses on key influ-
ences in Stan’s developmental years, some-
times explicitly, sometimes in terms of how those
earlier events are being relived in the present
analytic relationship. As he comes to understand
how he has been shaped by these past experi-
ences, he is increasingly able to exert control
over his present functioning. Many of Stan’s fears
become conscious, and then his energy does not
have to remain fixed on defending himself from
unconscious feelings. Instead, he can make new
decisions about his current life. He can do this
only if he works through the transference rela-
tionship, however, for the depth of his endeav-
ors in therapy largely determine the depth and
extent of his personality changes.
If I am operating from a contemporary
object-relations psychoanalytic orientation,
my focus may well be on Stan’s developmental
sequences. Particular attention is paid to un-
derstanding his current behavior in the world as
largely a repetition of one of his earlier develop-
mental phases. Because of his dependency, it is
useful in understanding his behavior to see that
he is now repeating patterns that he formed
with his mother during his infancy. Viewed from
this perspective, Stan has not accomplished the
task of separation and individuation. He is still
“stuck” in the symbiotic phase on some levels.
He is unable to obtain his confirmation of worth
from himself, and he has not resolved the
dependence–independence struggle. Looking
at his behavior from the viewpoint of self
psychology can shed light on his difficulties in
forming intimate relationships.
Follow-Up: You Continue as
Stan’s Psychoanalytic Therapist
With each of the 11 theoretical orientations, you
will be encouraged to try your hand at applying
the principles and techniques you have just stud-
ied in the chapter to working with Stan from that
particular perspective. The information presented
about Stan from each of these theory chapters will
provide you with some ideas of how you might
continue working with him if he were referred to
you. Do your best to stay within the general spirit
of each theory by identifying specific concepts
you would draw from and techniques that you
might use in helping him explore the struggles he
identifies. Here are a series of questions to provide
some structure in your thinking about his case:
How much interest would you have in Stan’s
early childhood? What are some ways you’d
help him see patterns between his childhood
issues and his current problems?
Consider the transference relationship that is
likely to be established between you and Stan.
How might you react to his making you into a
significant person in his life?
In working with Stan, what countertransfer-
ence issues might arise for you?
What resistances and defenses might you
predict in your work with Stan? From a psy-
choanalytic perspective, how would you inter-
pret and work with this resistance?
Which of the various forms of psychoanalytic
therapy—classical, relational, or object relations—
would you be most inclined to apply in work-
ing with Stan?
See DVD for Theory and Practice of
Counseling and Psychotherapy: The Case
of Stan and Lecturettes (Session 1, an initial
session with Stan, and Session 2, on psycho-
analytic therapy) for a demonstration of my
approach to counseling Stan from this perspec-
tive. The first session consists of the intake
and assessment process. The second session
focuses on Stan’s resistance and dealing with
transference.
93
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

94
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
O
U
R
s u m m a ry a n d e va l u at i o n
Summary

Contributions of the Psychoanalytic Approach
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

95
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Contributions of Modern Psychoanalytic Approaches
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

96
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
O
U
R
Limitations and Criticisms of the Psychoanalytic Approach
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

97
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
w h e r e to g o f r o m h e r e
DVD for Integrative Counseling: The Case of Ruth and
Lecturettes,
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

Psychoanalytic Therapy Relational
Psychotherapy Psychoanalytic Therapy Over Time
Integrative Relational Psychotherapy Brief Dynamic Therapy
Over Time
Otto Kernberg: Live Case Consultation Psychoanalytic Psychotherapy for Personal-
ity Disorders: An Interview with Otto Kernberg, MD
American Psychoanalytic Association
309 East 49th Street, New York, NY 10017-1601
Telephone: (212) 752-0450
Fax: (212) 593–0571
Website: www.apsa.org
Recommended Supplementary Readings
Psychoanalytic Theory: An Introduction
Brief Dynamic Therapy
Psychodynamic Psychiatry in Clinical Practice
Object Relations and Self Psychology: An Introduction
98
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
O
U
R
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

References and Suggested Readings
*Ainslie, R. (2007). Psychoanalytic psycho-
therapy. In A. B. Rochlen (Ed.), Applying coun-
seling theories: An online case-based approach
(pp. 5–20). Upper Saddle River, NJ: Pearson
Prentice-Hall.
Atkinson, D. R., Thompson, C. E., & Grant,
S. K. (1993). A three-dimensional model for
counseling racial/ethnic minorities. The Coun-
seling Psychologist, 2(2), 257–277.
Clarkin, J., Yeomans, F., & Kernberg, O.
(2006). Psychotherapy for borderline personality:
Focusing on object relations. Washington DC:
American Psychiatric Press.
Corey, G. (2012). Theory and practice of group
counseling (8th ed.). Belmont, CA: Brooks/
Cole, Cengage Learning.
*Corey, G. (2013). Case approach to counseling
and psychotherapy (8th ed.). Belmont, CA:
Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning.
*Curtis, R. C., & Hirsch, I. (2011). Relational
psychoanalytic psychotherapy. In S. B. Messer
& A. S. Gurman, (Eds.), Essential psychothera-
pies: Theory and practice (3rd ed., pp. 72–104).
New York: Guilford Press.
*Elliot, A. (1994). Psychoanalytic theory: An
introduction. Oxford UK & Cambridge USA:
Blackwell.
Enns, C. Z. (1993). Twenty years of feminist
counseling and therapy: From naming biases
to implementing multifaceted practice. The
Counseling Psychologist, 21(1), 3–87.
*Erikson, E. H. (1963). Childhood and society
(2nd ed.). New York: Norton.
Freud, S. (1949). An outline of psychoanalysis.
New York: Norton.
*Freud, S. (1955). The interpretation of dreams.
London: Hogarth Press.
*Gabbard, G. (2005). Psychodynamic psychiatry
in clinical practice (4th ed.). Washington, DC:
American Psychiatric Press.
*Gelso, C. J., & Hayes, J. A. (2002). The man-
agement of countertransference.
In J. C. Norcross (Ed.), Psychotherapy relation-
ships that work (pp. 267–283). New York:
Oxford University Press.
*Harris, A. S. (1996). Living with paradox: An
introduction to Jungian psychology. Belmont,
CA: Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning.
Hayes, J. A., (2004). Therapist know thyself:
Recent research on countertransference. Psy-
chotherapy Bulletin, 39(4), 6– 12.
Hayes, J. A., Gelso, C. J., & Hummel, A. M.
(2011). Management of countertransference.
In J.C. Norcross (Ed.), Psychotherapy relation-
ships that work: Evidence-based responsiveness
(2nd ed., pp. 239–258). New York: Oxford
University Press.
*Hedges, L. E. (1983). Listening perspectives in
psychotherapy. New York: Aronson.
*Jung, C. G. (1961). Memories, dreams, reflec-
tions. New York: Vintage.
Kernberg, O. F. (1975). Borderline conditions
and pathological narcissism. New York: Aronson.
Kernberg, O. F. (1976). Object-relations theory
and clinical psychoanalysis. New York: Aronson.
Kernberg, O. F. (1997). Convergences and
divergences in contemporary psychoanalytic
technique and psychoanalytic psychotherapy.
In J. K. Zeig (Ed.), The evolution of psychothera-
py: The third conference (pp. 3–22). New York:
Brunner/Mazel.
Kernberg, O. F., Yeomans, F. E., Clarkin, J. F.,
& Levy, K. N. (2008). Transference focused
psychotherapy: Overview and update. Interna-
tional Journal of Psychoanalysis, 89, 601–620.
Klein, M. (1975). The psychoanalysis of children.
New York: Dell.
Kohut, H. (1971). The analysis of self.
New York: International Universities Press.
Kohut, H. (1977). Restoration of the self.
New York: International Universities Press.
Kohut, H. (1984). How does psychoanalysis
cure? Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
99
P
S
Y
C
H
O
A
N
A
L
Y
T
I
C

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

*Levenson, H. (2007). Time-limited dynamic
psychotherapy. In A. B. Rochlen (Ed.), Apply-
ing counseling theories: An online case-based
approach (pp. 75–90). Upper Saddle River, NJ:
Pearson Prentice-Hall.
Levenson, H. (2010). Brief dynamic therapy.
Washington, DC: American Psychological
Association.
Linehan, M. M. (1993a). Cognitive-behavioral
treatment of borderline personality disorder.
New York: Guilford Press.
Linehan, M. M. (1993b). Skills training manual
for treating borderline personality disorder.
New York: Guilford Press.
*Luborsky, E. B., O’Reilly-Landry, M., & Arlow,
J. A. (2011). Psychoanalysis. In R. J. Corsini &
D. Wedding (Eds.), Current psychotherapies
(9th ed., pp. 15–66). Belmont, CA: Brooks/
Cole, Cengage Learning.
Mahler, M. S. (1968). On human symbiosis or
the vicissitudes of individuation. New York: Inter-
national Universities Press.
Masterson, J. F. (1976). Psychotherapy of the
borderline adult: A developmental approach.
New York: Brunner/Mazel.
Messer, S. B., & Gurman, A. S. (2011). Essential
psychotherapies: Theory and practice (3rd ed.).
New York: Guilford Press.
Messer, S. B., & Warren, C. S. (2001). Brief
psychodynamic therapy. In R. J. Corsini (Ed.),
Handbook of innovative therapies (2nd ed.,
pp. 67–85). New York: Wiley.
Mitchell, S. A. (1988). Relational concepts in
psychoanalysis: An integration. Cambridge, MA:
Harvard University Press.
*Mitchell, S. A. (2000). Relationality: From
attachment to intersubjectivity. Hillsdale, NJ:
The Analytic Press.
Mitchell, S. A., & Black, M. J. (1995). Freud
and beyond: A history of modern psychoanalytic
thought. New York: Basic Books.
Prochaska, J. O., & Norcross, J. C. (2010).
Systems of psychotherapy: A transtheoretical
analysis (7th ed.). Belmont, CA: Brooks/Cole,
Cengage Learning.
Reik, T. (1948). Listening with the third ear.
New York: Pyramid.
*Rutan, J. S., Stone, W. N., & Shay, J. J. (2007).
Psychodynamic group psychotherapy (4th ed.).
New York: Guilford Press.
*Schultz, D., & Schultz, S. E. (2009). Theories of
personality (9th ed.). Belmont, CA: Wadsworth,
Cengage Learning.
Smith, L. (2005). Psychotherapy, classism,
and the poor. American Psychologist, 60(7),
687–696.
*St. Clair, M. (with Wigren, J.). (2004). Object
relations and self psychology: An introduction
(4th ed.). Belmont, CA: Brooks/Cole, Cengage
Learning.
Stern, D. N. (1985). The interpersonal world
of the infant: A view from psychoanalysis and
developmental psychology. New York: Basic
Books.
Strupp, H. H. (1992). The future of psychody-
namic psychotherapy. Psychotherapy, 29(l),
21–27.
Wolitzsky, D. L. (2011a). Contemporary
Freudian psychoanalytic psychotherapy. In
S. B. Messer & A. S. Gurman (Eds.), Essential
psychotherapies: Theory and practice (3rd ed.,
pp. 33–71). New York: Guilford Press.
Wolitzsky, D. L. (2011b). Psychoanalytic
theories in psychotherapy. In J. C. Norcross,
G. R. Vandenbos, & D. K. Freedheim (Eds.),
History of psychotherapy (2nd ed., pp. 65–100).
Washington, DC: American Psychological
Association.
Yalom, I. D. (2003). The gift of therapy: An
open letter to a new generation of therapists and
their patients. New York: HarperCollins
(Perennial).
100
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
O
U
R
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

101
i n t r o d u ct i o n
k e y co n c e p t s
t h e t h e r a p e u t i c p r o c es s
a p p l i c at i o n : t h e r a p e u t i c
t ec h n i q u es a n d p r o c e d u r es
a l d e r i a n t h e r a p y f r o m a
m u lt i c u lt u r a l p e r s p ect i v e
a d l e r i a n t h e r a p y a p p l i e d
to t h e c a s e o f sta n
s u m m a ry a n d e va l u at i o n
w h e r e to g o f r o m h e r e
c h a p t e r 5
Adlerian Therapy
Coauthored by Gerald Corey and James Robert Bitter
a p p l i c at i o n :
t ec h n i q u es
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

102
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
I
V
E
A L F R E D A D L E R (1870–
1937) grew up in a Vienna
family of six boys and two
girls. His younger brother
died at a very young age
in the bed next to Alfred.
Adler’s early childhood was
not a happy time. He was
sickly and very much aware
of death. At age 4 he almost died of pneumonia.
He heard the doctor tell his father that “Alfred is
lost.” Adler associated this time with his decision
to become a physician. Because he was ill so much
during the first few years of his life, Adler was
pampered by his mother. He developed a trusting
relationship with his father, but did not feel very
close to his mother. He was extremely jealous of
his older brother, Sigmund, which led to a strained
relationship between the two during childhood and
adolescence. When we consider Adler’s strained
relationship with Sigmund Freud, one cannot help
but suspect that patterns from his early family
constellation were repeated in this relationship
with Freud.
Adler’s early childhood experiences had an
impact on the formation of his theory. Adler is an
example of a person who shaped his own life as
opposed to having it determined by fate. Adler
was a poor student. His teacher advised his father
to prepare Adler to be a shoemaker, but not much
else. With determined effort Adler eventually rose
to the top of his class. He went on to study medi-
cine at the University of Vienna, entering private
practice as an ophthalmologist, and then shifting to
general medicine. He eventually specialized in neu-
rology and psychiatry, and he had a keen interest in
incurable childhood diseases.
Adler had a passionate concern for the com-
mon person and was outspoken about child-rearing
practices, school reforms, and prejudices that
resulted in conflict. He spoke and wrote in simple,
nontechnical language so that the general popula-
tion could understand and apply the principles
of his approach in a practical way, which helped
people meet the challenges of daily life. Adler’s
(1927/1959) Understanding Human Nature was
the first major psychology book to sell hundreds
of thousands of copies in the United States. After
serving in World War I as a medical officer, Adler
created 32 child guidance clinics in the Vienna
public schools and began training teachers, social
workers, physicians, and other professionals. He
pioneered the practice of teaching profession-
als through live demonstrations with parents and
children before large audiences, now called “open-
forum” family counseling. The clinics he founded
grew in number and in popularity, and he was inde-
fatigable in lecturing and demonstrating his work.
Although Adler had an overcrowded work
schedule most of his professional life, he still
took some time to sing, enjoy music, and be with
friends. In the mid-1920s he began lecturing in the
United States, and he later made frequent visits
and tours. He ignored the warning of his friends
to slow down, and on May 28, 1937, while taking
a walk before a scheduled lecture in Aberdeen,
Scotland, Adler collapsed and died of heart failure.
If you have an interest in learning more about
Adler’s life, see Edward Hoffman’s (1996) excellent
biography, The Drive for Self.
Alfred Adler
i n t r o d u c t i o n
Along with Freud and Jung, Alfred Adler was a major contributor to the initial
development of the psychodynamic approach to therapy. After 8 to 10 years of col-
laboration, Freud and Adler parted company, with Freud taking the position that
Adler was a heretic who had deserted him. Adler resigned as president of the Vien-
na Psychoanalytic Society in 1911 and founded the Society for Individual Psychology
in 1912. Freud then asserted that it was not possible to support Adlerian concepts
and still remain in good standing as a psychoanalyst.
H
ul
to
n
A
rc
hi
ve
/G
et
ty
Im
ag
es
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 102 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

103
A
D
L
E
R
I
A
N

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Later, a number of other psychoanalysts deviated from Freud’s orthodox
position (see Chapter 4). These Freudian revisionists—including Karen Horney,
Erich Fromm, and Harry Stack Sullivan—agreed that relational, social, and cul-
tural factors were of great signifi cance in shaping personality. Even though these
three therapists are typically called neo-Freudians, it would be more appropri-
ate, as Heinz Ansbacher (1979) has suggested, to refer to them as neo-Adlerians
because they moved away from Freud’s biological and deterministic point of view
and toward Adler’s social-psychological and teleological (or goal-oriented) view of
human nature.
Adler stresses the unity of personality, contending that people can only be
understood as integrated and complete beings. This view also espouses the pur-
poseful nature of behavior, emphasizing that where we have come from is not as
important as where we are striving to go. Adler saw humans as both the creators
and the creations of their own lives; that is, people develop a unique style of liv-
ing that is both a movement toward and an expression of their selected goals. In
this sense, we create ourselves rather than merely being shaped by our childhood
experiences.
After Adler’s death in 1937, Rudolf Dreikurs was the most signifi cant fi gure
in bringing Adlerian psychology to the United States, especially as its principles
applied to education, individual and group therapy, and family counseling.
Dreikurs is credited with giving impetus to the idea of child guidance centers and
to training professionals to work with a wide range of clients.
See the DVD program for Chapter 5, DVD for Theory and Practice of Coun-
seling and Psychotherapy: The Case of Stan and Lecturettes. I suggest that you
view the brief lecture for each chapter prior to reading the chapter.
k e y c o n c e p t s
View of Human Nature
Adler abandoned Freud’s basic theories because he believed Freud was exces-
sively narrow in his emphasis on biological and instinctual determination. Adler
believed that the individual begins to form an approach to life somewhere in the
fi rst 6 years of living. He focused on the person’s past as perceived in the present
and how an individual’s interpretation of early events continued to infl uence that
person’s present behavior. According to Adler, humans are motivated primarily
by social relatedness rather than by sexual urges; behavior is purposeful and goal-
directed; and consciousness, more than unconsciousness, is the focus of therapy.
Adler stressed choice and responsibility, meaning in life, and the striving for suc-
cess, completion, and perfection. Adler and Freud created very different theories,
even though both men grew up in the same city in the same era and were educated
as physicians at the same university. Their individual and distinct childhood
experiences, their personal struggles, and the populations with whom they worked
were key factors in the development of their particular views of human nature
(Schultz & Schultz, 2009).
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 103 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

104
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
I
V
E
Adler’s theory starts with a consideration of inferiority feelings, which he saw
as a normal condition of all people and as a source of all human striving. Rather
than being considered a sign of weakness or abnormality, inferiority feelings can
be the wellspring of creativity. They motivate us to strive for mastery, success
(superiority), and completion. We are driven to overcome our sense of inferiority
and to strive for increasingly higher levels of development (Ansbacher & Ansbacher,
1956/1964). Indeed, at around 6 years of age our fi ctional vision of ourselves as
perfect or complete begins to form into a life goal. The life goal unifi es the person-
ality and becomes the source of human motivation; every striving and every effort
to overcome inferiority is now in line with this goal.
From the Adlerian perspective, human behavior is not determined solely by
heredity and environment. Instead, we have the capacity to interpret, infl uence,
and create events. Adler asserted that genetics and heredity are not as important
as what we choose to do with the abilities and limitations we possess. Although
Adlerians reject a deterministic stance, they do not go to the other extreme and
maintain that individuals can become whatever they want to be. Adlerians recog-
nize that biological and environmental conditions limit our capacity to choose and
to create.
Adlerians put the focus on reeducating individuals and reshaping society.
Adler was the forerunner of a subjective approach to psychology that focuses on
internal determinants of behavior such as values, beliefs, attitudes, goals, interests,
and the individual perception of reality. He was a pioneer of an approach that is
holistic, social, goal oriented, systemic, and humanistic. Adler also was the fi rst
systemic therapist: he maintained that it is essential to understand people within
the systems in which they live.
Subjective Perception of Reality
Adlerians attempt to view the world from the client’s subjective frame of reference,
an orientation described as phenomenological. Paying attention to the individual
way in which people perceive their world, referred to as “subjective reality,” includes
the individual’s perceptions, thoughts, feelings, values, beliefs, convictions, and
conclusions. Behavior is understood from the vantage point of this subjective per-
spective. From the Adlerian perspective, objective reality is less important than how
we interpret reality and the meanings we attach to what we experience.
As you will see in subsequent chapters, many contemporary theories have
incorporated this notion of the client’s subjective worldview as a basic factor ex-
plaining behavior, including existential therapy, person-centered therapy, Gestalt
therapy, the cognitive behavioral therapies, reality therapy, feminist therapy, and
the postmodern approaches.
Unity and Patterns of Human Personality
Adler chose the name Individual Psychology (from the Latin individuum, meaning
indivisible) for his theoretical approach because he wanted to avoid reductionism.
Adler emphasized the unity and indivisibility of the person and stressed under-
standing the whole person in the context of his or her life—how all dimensions
of a person are interconnected components, and how all of these components
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 104 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

105
A
D
L
E
R
I
A
N

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
are unifi ed by the individual’s movement toward a life goal. This holistic concept
implies that we cannot be understood in parts; rather, all aspects of ourselves must
be understood in relationship (Carlson & Englar-Carlson, 2008). The focus is on
understanding whole persons within their socially embedded contexts of family,
culture, school, and work. We are social, creative, decision-making beings who act
with purpose and cannot be fully known outside the contexts that have meaning in
our lives (Sherman & Dinkmeyer, 1987).
The human personality becomes unifi ed through development of a life goal.
An individual’s thoughts, feelings, beliefs, convictions, attitudes, character, and
actions are expressions of his or her uniqueness, and all refl ect a plan of life that
allows for movement toward a self-selected life goal. An implication of this holistic
view of personality is that the client is an integral part of a social system. There is
more emphasis on interpersonal relationships than on the individual’s internal
psychodynamics.
b e h av i o r a s p u r p o s e f u l a n d g oa l o r i e n t e d Individual Psychol-
ogy assumes that all human behavior has a purpose. The concept of the purposeful
nature of behavior is perhaps the cornerstone of Adler’s theory. Adler replaced
deterministic explanations with teleological (purposive, goal-oriented) ones. A basic
assumption of Individual Psychology is that we can only think, feel, and act in rela-
tion to our goal; we can be fully understood only in light of knowing the purposes
and goals toward which we are striving. Although Adlerians are interested in the
future, they do not minimize the importance of past infl uences. They assume that
most decisions are based on the person’s experiences, on the present situation, and
on the direction in which the person is moving—with the latter being the most
important. They look for continuity by paying attention to themes running through
a person’s life.
Adler was infl uenced by the philosopher Hans Vaihinger (1965), who noted
that people often live by fi ctions (or views of how the world should be). Many Adle-
rians use the term fi ctional fi nalism to refer to an imagined life goal that guides a
person’s behavior. It should be noted, however, that Adler ceased using this term
and replaced it with “guiding self-ideal” and “goal of perfection” to account for our
striving toward superiority or perfection (Watts & Holden, 1994). Very early in life,
we begin to envision what we might be like if we were successful, complete, whole,
or perfect. Applied to human motivation, a guiding self-ideal might be expressed
in this way: “Only when I am perfect can I be secure” or “Only when I am impor-
tant can I be accepted.” The guiding self-ideal represents an individual’s image of
a goal of perfection, for which he or she strives in any given situation. Because of
our subjective fi nal goal, we have the creative power to choose what we will accept
as truth, how we will behave, and how we will interpret events.
s t r i v i n g f o r s i g n i f i c a n c e a n d s u p e r i o r i t y Adler stressed that
the recognition of inferiority feelings and the consequent striving for perfection
or mastery are innate (Ansbacher & Ansbacher, 1979)—they are two sides of the
same coin. To understand human behavior, it is essential to grasp the ideas of
basic inferiority and compensation. From our earliest years, we recognize that
we are helpless in many ways, which is characterized by feelings of inferiority.
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 105 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

106
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
I
V
E
This inferiority is not a negative factor in life. According to Adler, the moment we
experience inferiority we are pulled by the striving for superiority. He maintained
that the goal of success pulls people forward toward mastery and enables them to
overcome obstacles. The goal of superiority contributes to the development of hu-
man community. However, it is important to note that “superiority,” as used by
Adler, does not necessarily mean superiority over others. Rather, it means moving
from a perceived lower (or minus) position to a perceived better (or plus) position.
People cope with feelings of helplessness by striving for competence, mastery,
and perfection. They can seek to change a weakness into a strength, for example,
or strive to excel in one area to compensate for defects in other areas. The unique
ways in which people develop a style of striving for competence is what constitutes
individuality or lifestyle. The manner in which Adler reacted to his childhood and
adolescent experiences is a living example of this aspect of his theory.
l i f e s t y l e The movement from a felt minus to a desired plus results in the devel-
opment of a life goal, which in turn unifi es the personality and the individual’s core
beliefs and assumptions. These core beliefs and assumptions guide each person’s
movement through life and organize his or her reality, giving meaning to life events.
Adler called this life movement the individual’s “lifestyle.” Synonyms for this term
include “plan of life,” “style of life,” “strategy for living,” and “road map of life.” Life-
style includes the connecting themes and rules of interaction that give meaning to
our actions. Lifestyle is often described as our perceptions regarding self, others, and
the world. It includes an individual’s characteristic way of thinking, acting, feeling,
living, and striving toward long-term goals (Mosak & Maniacci, 2011).
Adler saw us as actors, creators, and artists. Understanding one’s lifestyle is
somewhat like understanding the style of a composer: “We can begin wherever
we choose: every expression will lead us in the same direction—toward the one
motive, the one melody, around which the personality is built” (Adler, as cited in
Ansbacher & Ansbacher, 1956/1964, p. 332).
People are viewed as adopting a proactive, rather than a reactive, approach
to their social environment. Although events in the environment infl uence the
development of personality, such events are not the causes of what people become;
rather, it is our interpretation of these events that shape personality. Faulty in-
terpretations may lead to mistaken notions in our private logic, which will sig-
nifi cantly infl uence present behavior. Once we become aware of the patterns and
continuity of our lives, we are in a position to modify those faulty assumptions and
make basic changes. We can reframe childhood experiences and consciously create
a new style of living.
Social Interest and Community Feeling
Social interest and community feeling (Gemeinschaftsgefühl) are probably Adler’s
most signifi cant and distinctive concepts (Ansbacher, 1992). These terms refer to
individuals’ awareness of being part of the human community and to individuals’
attitudes in dealing with the social world.
Social interest is the action line of one’s community feeling, and it involves
being as concerned about others as one is about onself. This concept involves the
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 106 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

107
A
D
L
E
R
I
A
N

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
capacity to cooperate and contribute (Milliren & Clemmer, 2006). Social interest
requires that we have enough contact with the present to make a move toward a
meaningful future, that we are willing to give and to take, and that we develop our
capacity for contributing to the welfare of others and striving for the betterment of
humanity. The socialization process associated with social interest begins in child-
hood and involves helping children to fi nd a place in society and acquire a sense of
belonging, as well as the ability to make a contribution (Kefi r, 1981). While Adler
considered social interest to be innate, he also believed that it must be learned,
developed, and used.
Adler equated social interest with a sense of identifi cation and empathy
with others: “to see with the eyes of another, to hear with the ears of another, to feel
with the heart of another” (as cited in Ansbacher & Ansbacher, 1979, p. 42). Social
interest is the central indicator of mental health. Those with social interest tend to
direct the striving toward the healthy and socially useful side of life. From the Adle-
rian perspective, as social interest develops, feelings of inferiority and alienation
diminish. People express social interest through shared activity and mutual respect.
Individual Psychology rests on a central belief that our happiness and success
are largely related to this social connectedness. Because we are embedded in a
society, and indeed in the whole of humanity, we cannot be understood in isola-
tion from that social context. We are primarily motivated by a desire to belong.
Community feeling embodies the feeling of being connected to all of humanity—
past, present, and future—and to being involved in making the world a better place.
Those who lack this community feeling become discouraged and end up on the
useless side of life. We seek a place in the family and in society to fulfi ll basic needs
for security, acceptance, and worthiness. Many of the problems we experience are
related to the fear of not being accepted by the groups we value. If our sense of
belonging is not fulfi lled, anxiety is the result. Only when we feel united with oth-
ers are we able to act with courage in facing and dealing with our problems (Adler,
1938/1964).
Adler taught that we must successfully master three universal life tasks: build-
ing friendships (social task), establishing intimacy (love–marriage task), and con-
tributing to society (occupational task). All people need to address these tasks,
regardless of age, gender, time in history, culture, or nationality. Each of these
tasks requires the development of psychological capacities for friendship and be-
longing, for contribution and self-worth, and for cooperation (Bitter, 2006). These
basic life tasks are so fundamental to human living that impairment in any one of
them is often an indicator of a psychological disorder (American Psychiatric As-
sociation, 2000). More often than not, when people seek therapy, it is because they
are struggling unsuccessfully to meet one or more of these life tasks. The aim of
therapy is to assist clients in modifying their lifestyle so they can more effectively
navigate each of these tasks (Carlson & Englar-Carlson, 2008).
Birth Order and Sibling Relationships
The Adlerian approach is unique in giving special attention to the relationships
between siblings and the psychological birth position in one’s family. Adler
identifi ed fi ve psychological positions, or vantage points, from which children
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 107 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

108
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
I
V
E
tend to view life: oldest, second of only two, middle, youngest, and only. Birth
order is not a deterministic concept but does increase an individual’s probability
of having a certain set of experiences. Actual birth order is less important than
the individual’s interpretation of his or her place in the family. Because Adle-
rians view most human problems as social in nature, they emphasize relation-
ships within the family as our earliest and, perhaps, our most infl uential social
system.
Adler (1931/1958) observed that many people wonder why children in the
same family often differ so widely, and he pointed out that it is a fallacy to assume
that children of the same family are formed in the same environment. Although
siblings share aspects in common in the family constellation, the psychological
situation of each child is different from that of the others due to birth order. The
following description of the infl uence of birth order is based on Ansbacher and
Ansbacher (1964), Dreikurs (1953), and Adler (1931/1958).
1. The oldest child generally receives a good deal of attention, and during the time
she is the only child, she is typically somewhat spoiled as the center of attention.
She tends to be dependable and hard working and strives to keep ahead. When a
new brother or sister arrives on the scene, however, she fi nds herself ousted from
her favored position. She is no longer unique or special. She may readily believe
that the newcomer (or intruder) will rob her of the love to which she is accustomed.
Most often, she reasserts her position by becoming a model child, bossing younger
children, and exhibiting a high achievement drive.
2. The second child of only two is in a different position. From the time she is born,
she shares the attention with another child. The typical second child behaves as
if she were in a race and is generally under full steam at all times. It is as though
this second child were in training to surpass the older brother or sister. This com-
petitive struggle between the fi rst two children infl uences the later course of their
lives. The younger child develops a knack for fi nding out the elder child’s weak
spots and proceeds to win praise from both parents and teachers by achieving
successes where the older sibling has failed. If one is talented in a given area, the
other strives for recognition by developing other abilities. The second-born is often
opposite to the fi rstborn.
3. The middle child often feels squeezed out. This child may become convinced
of the unfairness of life and feel cheated. This person may assume a “poor me”
attitude and can become a problem child. However, especially in families charac-
terized by confl ict, the middle child may become the switchboard and the peace-
maker, the person who holds things together. If there are four children in a family,
the second child will often feel like a middle child and the third will be more easy-
going, more social, and may align with the fi rstborn.
4. The youngest child is always the baby of the family and tends to be the most
pampered one. Because of being pampered or spoiled, he may develop helpless-
ness into an art form and become expert at putting others in his service. Youngest
children tend to go their own way, often developing in ways no others in the family
have attempted and may outshine everyone.
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 108 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

109
A
D
L
E
R
I
A
N

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
5. The only child has a problem of her own. Although she shares some of the char-
acteristics of the oldest child (for example, a high achievement drive), she may not
learn to share or cooperate with other children. She will learn to deal with adults
well, as they make up her original familial world. Often, the only child is pampered
by her parents and may become dependently tied to one or both of them. She may
want to have center stage all of the time, and if her position is challenged, she will
feel it is unfair.
Birth order and the interpretation of one’s position in the family have a great
deal to do with how adults interact in the world. Individuals acquire a certain style
of relating to others in childhood and form a defi nite picture of themselves that
they carry into their adult interactions. In Adlerian therapy, working with family
dynamics, especially relationships among siblings, assumes a key role. Although
it is important to avoid stereotyping individuals, it does help to see how certain
personality trends that began in childhood as a result of sibling rivalry infl uence
individuals throughout life.
t h e t h e r a p e u t i c p r o c e s s
Therapeutic Goals
Adlerian counseling rests on a collaborative arrangement between the client and
the counselor. In general, the therapeutic process includes forming a relationship
based on mutual respect; a holistic psychological investigation or lifestyle assess-
ment; and disclosing mistaken goals and faulty assumptions within the person’s style
of living. This is followed by a reeducation or reorientation of the client toward
the useful side of life. The main aim of therapy is to develop the client’s sense
of belonging and to assist in the adoption of behaviors and processes character-
ized by community feeling and social interest. This is accomplished by increasing
the client’s self-awareness and challenging and modifying his or her fundamental
premises, life goals, and basic concepts (Dreikurs, 1967, 1997). Milliren, Evans,
and Newbauer (2007), identify this goal of Adlerian therapy: “to assist clients to
understand their unique lifestyles . . . and to act in such a way as to meet the tasks
of life with courage and social interest” (p. 145).
Adlerians do not view clients as being “sick” and in need of being “cured.”
They favor the growth model of personality rather than the medical model. As
Mosak and Maniacci (2011) put it: “The Adlerian is interested not in curing sick
individuals or a sick society but in reeducating individuals and in reshaping soci-
ety” (p. 78). Rather than being stuck in some kind of pathology, Adlerians contend
that clients are often discouraged. The counseling process focuses on providing
information, teaching, guiding, and offering encouragement to discouraged cli-
ents. Encouragement is the most powerful method available for changing a per-
son’s beliefs, for it helps clients build self-confi dence and stimulates courage.
Courage is the willingness to act even when fearful in ways that are consistent with
social interest. Fear and courage go hand in hand; without fear, there would be no
need for courage. The loss of courage, or discouragement, results in mistaken and
dysfunctional behavior. Discouraged people do not act in line with social interest.
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 109 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

110
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
I
V
E
Adlerian counselors provide clients with an opportunity to view things from
a different perspective, yet it is up to the clients to decide whether to accept an
alternative perspective. Adlerians work collaboratively with clients to help them
reach their self-defi ned goals. Adlerians educate clients in new ways of looking at
themselves, others, and life. Through the process of providing clients with a new
“cognitive map,” a fundamental understanding of the purpose of their behavior,
counselors assist them in changing their perceptions. Mosak and Maniacci (2011)
lists these goals for the educational process of therapy:
• Fostering social interest
• Helping clients overcome feelings of discouragement and inferiority
• Modifying clients’ views and goals—that is, changing their lifestyle
• Changing faulty motivation
• Encouraging the individual to recognize equality among people
• Helping people to become contributing members of society
Therapist’s Function and Role
Adlerian counselors realize that clients can become discouraged and function
ineffectively because of mistaken beliefs, faulty values, and useless or self-absorbed
goals. These therapists operate on the assumption that clients will feel and behave
better once they discover and correct their basic mistakes. Therapists tend to look
for major mistakes in thinking and valuing such as mistrust, selfi shness, unrealis-
tic ambitions, and lack of confi dence.
Adlerians assume a nonpathological perspective and thus do not label clients
with pathological diagnoses. One way of looking at the role of Adlerian therapists
is that they assist clients in better understanding, challenging, and changing their
life story. “When individuals develop a life story that they fi nd limiting and prob-
lem saturated, the goal is to free them from that story in favor of a preferred and
equally viable alternative story” (Disque & Bitter, 1998, p. 434).
A major function of the therapist is to make a comprehensive assessment of
the client’s functioning. Therapists often gather information about the individual’s
style of living by means of a questionnaire on the client’s family constellation,
which includes parents, siblings, and others living in the home, life tasks, and
early recollections. When summarized and interpreted, this questionnaire gives a
picture of the individual’s early social world. From this information on the family
constellation, the therapist is able to get a perspective on the client’s major areas
of success and failure and on the critical infl uences that have had a bearing on the
role the client has assumed in the world.
The counselor also uses early recollections as an assessment procedure. Early
recollections (ERs) are defi ned as “stories of events that a person says occurred
[one time] before he or she was 10 years of age” (Mosak & Di Pietro, 2006, p. 1).
ERs are specifi c incidents that clients recall, along with the feelings and thoughts
that accompanied these childhood incidents. These recollections are quite useful
in getting a better understanding of the client (Clark, 2002). After these early rec-
ollections are summarized and interpreted, the therapist identifi es some of the
major successes and mistakes in the client’s life. The aim is to provide a point of
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 110 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

111
A
D
L
E
R
I
A
N

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
departure for the therapeutic venture. ERs are particularly useful as a functional
assessment device because they indicate what clients do and how they think in
both adaptive and maladaptive ways (Mosak & Di Pietro, 2006). The process of
gathering early memories is part of what is called a lifestyle assessment, which
involves learning to understand the goals and motivations of the client. When this
process is completed, the therapist and the client have targets for therapy.
Mosak and Maniacci (2011) consider dreams to be a useful part of the assess-
ment process. Freud assumed that dreams were wish fulfi llment, or, in some
instances, an attempt at solving an old problem; Adler, on the other hand, viewed
dreams as a rehearsal for possible future actions. Just as early recollections refl ect
a client’s long-range goals, dreams suggest possible answers to a client’s present
problems. In interpreting dreams, the therapist considers their purposive func-
tion. Mosak and Maniacci (2011) assert that “dreams serve as weather vanes for
treatment, bringing problems to the surface and pointing to the patient’s move-
ment” (p. 88).
Client’s Experience in Therapy
How do clients maintain their lifestyle, and why do they resist changing it? A per-
son’s style of living serves the individual by staying stable and constant. In other
words, it is predictable. It is, however, also resistant to change throughout most of
one’s life. Generally, people fail to change because they do not recognize the errors
in their thinking or the purposes of their behaviors, do not know what to do differ-
ently, and are fearful of leaving old patterns for new and unpredictable outcomes.
Thus, even though their ways of thinking and behaving are not successful, they
tend to cling to familiar patterns (Sweeney, 2009). Clients in Adlerian counseling
focus their work on desired outcomes and a resilient lifestyle that can provide a
new blueprint for their actions.
In therapy, clients explore what Adlerians call private logic, the concepts about
self, others, and life that constitute the philosophy on which an individual’s life-
style is based. Private logic involves our convictions and beliefs that get in the way
of social interest and that do not facilitate useful, constructive belonging (Carlson,
Watts, & Maniacci, 2006). Clients’ problems arise because the conclusions based
on their private logic often do not conform to the requirements of social living. The
heart of therapy is helping clients to discover the purposes of behaviors or symp-
toms and the basic mistakes associated with their personal coping. Learning how
to correct faulty assumptions and conclusions is central to therapy.
To provide a concrete example, think of a chronically depressed middle-aged
man who begins therapy. After a lifestyle assessment is completed, these basic
mistakes are identifi ed:
• He has convinced himself that nobody could really care about him.
• He rejects people before they have a chance to reject him.
• He is harshly critical of himself, expecting perfection.
• He has expectations that things will rarely work out well.
• He burdens himself with guilt because he is convinced he is letting everyone
down.
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 111 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

112
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
I
V
E
Even though this man may have developed these mistaken ideas about himself and
life when he was young, he is still clinging to them as rules for living. His expecta-
tions, most of which are pessimistic, tend to be fulfi lled because on some level he
is seeking to validate his beliefs. Indeed, his depression will eventually serve the
purpose of helping him avoid contact with others, a life task at which he expects
to fail. In therapy, this man will learn how to challenge the structure of his private
logic. In his case the syllogism goes as follows:
• “I am basically unlovable.”
• “The world is fi lled with people who are likely to be rejecting.”
• “Therefore, I must keep to myself so I won’t be hurt.”
This person holds onto several basic mistakes, and his private logic offers a psy-
chological focus for treatment. A central theme or convictions in this client’s life
might be: “I must control everything in my life.” “I must be perfect in everything
I do.”
It is easy to see how depression might follow from this thinking, but Adlerians
also know that the depression serves as an excuse for this man’s retreat from life.
It is important for the therapist to listen for the underlying purposes of this cli-
ent’s behavior. Adlerians see feelings as being aligned with thinking and as the
fuel for behaving. First we think, then we feel, and then we act. Because emotions
and cognitions serve a purpose, a good deal of therapy time is spent in discover-
ing and understanding this purpose and in reorienting the client toward effective
ways of being. Because the client is not perceived by the therapist to be mentally
ill or emotionally disturbed, but as mainly discouraged, the therapist will offer the
client encouragement so that change is possible. Through the therapeutic proc-
ess, the client will discover that he or she has resources and options to draw on in
dealing with signifi cant life issues and life tasks.
Relationship Between Therapist and Client
Adlerians consider a good client–therapist relationship to be one between equals
that is based on cooperation, mutual trust, respect, confi dence, collaboration, and
alignment of goals. They place special value on the counselor’s modeling of com-
munication and acting in good faith. From the beginning of therapy, the relation-
ship is a collaborative one, characterized by two persons working equally toward
specifi c, agreed-upon goals. Adlerian therapists strive to establish and maintain
an egalitarian therapeutic alliance and a person-to-person relationship with their
clients. Developing a strong therapeutic relationship is essential to successful out-
comes (Carlson et al., 2006). Dinkmeyer and Sperry (2000) maintain that at the
outset of counseling clients should begin to formulate a plan, or contract, detailing
what they want, how they plan to get where they are heading, what is preventing
them from successfully attaining their goals, how they can change nonproductive
behavior into constructive behavior, and how they can make full use of their assets
in achieving their purposes. This therapeutic contract sets forth the goals of the
counseling process and specifi es the responsibilities of both therapist and client.
Developing a contract is not a requirement of Adlerian therapy, but a contract can
bring a tight focus to therapy.
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 112 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

113
A
D
L
E
R
I
A
N

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
a p p l i c at i o n : t h e r a p e u t i c
t e c h n i q u e s a n d p r o c e d u r e s
Adlerian counseling is structured around four central objectives that correspond to
the four phases of the therapeutic process (Dreikurs, 1967). These phases are not
linear and do not progress in rigid steps; rather, they can best be understood as a
weaving that leads to a tapestry. These phases are as follows:
1. Establish the proper therapeutic relationship.
2. Explore the psychological dynamics operating in the client (an assessment).
3. Encourage the development of self-understanding (insight into purpose).
4. Help the client make new choices (reorientation and reeducation).
Dreikurs (1997) incorporated these phases into what he called minor psycho-
therapy in the context and service of holistic medicine. His approach to therapy
has been elaborated in what is now called Adlerian brief therapy, or ABT (Bitter,
Christensen, Hawes, & Nicoll, 1998). This way of working is discussed in the fol-
lowing sections.
Phase 1: Establish the Relationship
The Adlerian practitioner works in a collaborative way with clients, and this rela-
tionship is based on a sense of interest that grows into caring, involvement, and
friendship. Therapeutic progress is possible only when there is an alignment of
clearly defi ned goals between therapist and client. The counseling process, to be
effective, must deal with the personal issues the client recognizes as signifi cant
and is willing to explore and change. The therapeutic effi cacy in the later phases of
Adlerian therapy is predicated upon the development and continuation of a solid
therapeutic relationship during this fi rst phase of therapy (Watts, 2000; Watts &
Pietrzak, 2000).
Adlerian therapists focus on making person-to-person contact with clients
rather than starting with “the problem.” Clients’ concerns surface rather quickly
in therapy, but the initial focus should be on the person, not the problem. One way
to create effective contact is for counselors to help clients become aware of their
assets and strengths rather than dealing continually with their defi cits and lia-
bilities. During the initial phase, a positive relationship is created by listening;
responding; demonstrating respect for clients’ capacity to understand purpose and
seek change; and exhibiting faith, hope, and caring. When clients enter therapy,
they typically have a diminished sense of self-worth and self-respect. They lack faith
in their ability to cope with the tasks of life. Therapists provide support, which is
an antidote to despair and discouragement. For some people, therapy may be one
of the few times in which they have truly experienced a caring human relationship.
Adlerians pay more attention to the subjective experiences of the client than
they do to using techniques. They fi t their techniques to the needs of each client.
During the initial phase of counseling, the main techniques are attending and
listening with empathy, following the subjective experience of the client as closely
as possible, identifying and clarifying goals, and suggesting initial hunches about
purpose in client’s symptoms, actions, and interactions. Adlerian counselors are
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 113 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

114
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
I
V
E
generally active, especially during the initial sessions. They provide structure and
assist clients to defi ne personal goals, they conduct psychological assessments,
and they offer interpretations (Carlson et al., 2006). Adlerians attempt to grasp
both the verbal and nonverbal messages of the client; they want to access the core
patterns in the client’s life. If the client feels deeply understood and accepted, the
client is likely to focus on what he or she wants from therapy and thus establish
goals. At this stage the counselor’s function is to provide a wide-angle perspective
that will eventually help the client view his or her world differently.
Phase 2: Explore the Individual’s Psychological Dynamics
The aim of the second phase of Adlerian counseling is to get a deeper understand-
ing of an individual’s lifestyle. During this assessment phase, the focus is on the
individual’s social and cultural context. Rather than attempting to fi t clients into a
preconceived model, Adlerian practitioners allow salient cultural identity concepts
to emerge in the therapy process, and these issues are then addressed (Carlson &
Englar-Carlson, 2008). This assessment phase proceeds from two interview forms:
the subjective interview and the objective interview (Dreikurs, 1997). In the subjective
interview, the counselor helps the client to tell his or her life story as completely as
possible. This process is facilitated by a generous use of empathic listening and
responding. Active listening, however, is not enough. The subjective interview
must follow from a sense of wonder, fascination, and interest. What the client
says will spark an interest in the counselor and lead, naturally, to the next most
signifi cant question or inquiry about the client and his or her life story. Indeed,
the best subjective interviews treat clients as experts in their own lives, allowing
clients to feel completely heard. Throughout the subjective interview, the Adlerian
counselor is listening for clues to the purposive aspects of the client’s coping and
approaches to life. “The subjective interview should extract patterns in the person’s
life, develop hypotheses about what works for the person, and determine what
accounts for the various concerns in the client’s life” (Bitter et al., 1998, p. 98).
Toward the end of this part of the interview, Adlerian brief therapists ask, “Is there
anything else you think I should know to understand you and your concerns?”
An initial assessment of the purpose that symptoms, actions, or diffi culties
serve in a person’s life can be gained from what Dreikurs (1997) calls “The Ques-
tion.” Adlerians often end a subjective interview with this question: “How would
your life be different, and what would you be doing differently, if you did not have
this symptom or problem?” Adlerians use this question to help with differential
diagnosis. More often, the symptoms or problems experienced by the client help
the client avoid something that is perceived as necessary but from which the per-
son wishes to retreat, usually a life task: “If it weren’t for my depression, I would
get out more and see my friends.” Such a statement betrays the client’s concern
about the possibility of being a good friend or being welcomed by his or her friends.
“I need to get married, but how can I with these panic attacks?” indicates the per-
son’s worry about being a partner in a marriage. Depression can serve as the cli-
ent’s solution when faced with problems in relationships. If a client reports that
nothing would be different, especially with physical symptoms, Adlerians suspect
that the problem may be organic and require medical intervention.
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 114 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

115
A
D
L
E
R
I
A
N

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
The objective interview seeks to discover information about (a) how problems
in the client’s life began; (b) any precipitating events; (c) a medical history, includ-
ing current and past medications; (d) a social history; (e) the reasons the client
chose therapy at this time; (f) the person’s coping with life tasks; and (g) a lifestyle
assessment. Mozdzierz and his colleagues (1986) describe the counselor as a “life-
style investigator” during this phase of therapy. Based on interview approaches
developed by Adler and Dreikurs, the lifestyle assessment starts with an investiga-
tion of the person’s family constellation and early childhood history (Powers &
Griffi th, 1987; Shulman & Mosak, 1988). Counselors also interpret the person’s
early memories, seeking to understand the meaning that she or he has attached
to life experiences. They operate on the assumption that it is the interpretations
people develop about themselves, others, the world, and life that govern what they
do. Lifestyle assessment seeks to develop a holistic narrative of the person’s life, to
make sense of the way the person copes with life tasks, and to uncover the private
interpretations and logic involved in that coping. For example, if Jenny has lived
most of her life in a critical environment, and now she believes she must be perfect
to avoid even the appearance of failure, the assessment process will highlight the
restricted living that fl ows from this perspective.
t h e fa m i ly c o n s t e l l at i o n Adler considered the family of origin as having
a central impact on an individual’s personality. Adler suggested that it was through
the family constellation that each person forms his or her unique view of self, others,
and life. Factors such as cultural and familial values, gender-role expectations, and
the nature of interpersonal relationships are all infl uenced by a child’s observation
of the interactional patterns within the family. Adlerian assessment relies heavily on
an exploration of the client’s family constellation, including the client’s evaluation
of conditions that prevailed in the family when the person was a young child (family
atmosphere), birth order, parental relationship and family values, and extended fam-
ily and culture. Some of these questions are almost always explored:
• Who was the favorite child?
• What was your father’s relationship with the children? Your mother’s?
• Which child was most like your father? Your mother? In what respects?
• Who among the siblings was most different from you? In what ways?
• Who among the siblings was most like you? In what ways?
• What were you like as a child?
• How did your parents get along? In what did they both agree? How did they
handle disagreements? How did they discipline the children?
An investigation of family constellation is far more comprehensive than these few
questions, but these questions give an idea of the type of information the counselor
is seeking. The questions are always tailored to the individual client with the goal
of eliciting the client’s perceptions of self and others, of development, and of the
experiences that have affected that development.
e a r ly r e c o l l e c t i o n s As you will recall, another assessment procedure used
by Adlerians is to ask the client to provide his or her earliest memories, including the
age of the person at the time of the remembered events and the feelings or reactions
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 115 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

116
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
I
V
E
associated with the recollections. Early recollections are one-time occurrences, usu-
ally before the age of 9, pictured by the client in clear detail. Adler reasoned that out
of the millions of early memories we might have we select those special memories
that project the essential convictions and even the basic mistakes of our lives. Early
recollections are a series of small mysteries that can be woven together into a tapes-
try that leads to an understanding of how we view ourselves, how we see the world,
what our life goals are, what motivates us, what we value and believe in, and what we
anticipate for our future (Clark, 2002; Mosak & Di Pietro, 2006).
Early memories cast light on the “story of our life” because they represent met-
aphors for our current views. From the thousands of experiences we have before
the age of 9, we tend to remember only 6 to 12 memories. By understanding why
we retain these memories and what they tell us about how we see ourselves, others,
and life in the present, it is possible to get a clear sense of our mistaken notions,
present attitudes, social interests, and possible future behavior. Early recollections
are specifi c instances that clients tell therapists, and they are very useful in under-
standing those who are sharing a story (Mosak & Di Pietro, 2006). Exploring early
recollections involves discovering how mistaken notions based on faulty goals and
values continue to create problems in a client’s life.
To tap such recollections, the counselor might proceed as follows: “I would like
to hear about your early memories. Think back to when you were very young, as
early as you can remember (before the age of 10), and tell me something that hap-
pened one time.” After receiving each memory, the counselor might also ask: “What
part stands out to you? What was the most vivid part of your early memory? If
you played the whole memory like a movie and stopped it at one frame, what would
be happening? Putting yourself in that moment, what are you feeling? What’s your
reaction?” Three memories are usually considered a minimum to assess a pattern,
and some counselors ask for as many as a dozen memories.
Adlerian therapists use early recollections as a projective technique (Clark, 2002;
Hood & Johnson, 2007) and to (a) assess the client’s convictions about self, others,
life, and ethics; (b) assess the client’s stance in relation to the counseling session
and the counseling relationship; (c) verify the client’s coping patterns; and (d) assess
individual strengths, assets, and interfering ideas (Bitter et al., 1998, p. 99).
In interpreting these early recollections, Adlerians may consider questions
such as these:
• What part does the client take in the memory? Is the client an observer or a
participant?
• Who else is in the memory? What position do others take in relation to the client?
• What are the dominant themes and overall patterns of the memories?
• What feelings are expressed in the memories?
• Why does the client choose to remember this event? What is the client trying to
convey?
i n t e g r at i o n a n d s u m m a ry Once material has been gathered from both
subjective and objective interviews with the client, integrated summaries of the
data are developed. Different summaries are prepared for different clients, but
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 116 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

117
A
D
L
E
R
I
A
N

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
common ones are a narrative summary of the person’s subjective experience and
life story; a summary of family constellation and developmental data; a summa-
ry of early recollections, personal strengths or assets, and interfering ideas; and
a summary of coping strategies. The summaries are presented to the client and
discussed in the session, with the client and the counselor together refi ning
specifi c points. This information provides the client with the chance to discuss
specifi c topics and to raise questions.
Mosak and Maniacci (2011) believe lifestyle can be conceived of as a personal
mythology. People behave as if the myths were true because, for them, they are
true. Mosak and Maniacci list fi ve basic mistakes in what is essentially an integra-
tion of Adlerian psychology and cognitive behavioral theory: overgeneralizations,
false or impossible goals of security, misperceptions of life and life’s demands,
minimization or denial of one’s basic worth, and faulty values.
In addition to the concept of basic mistakes, Adlerian theory is useful in as-
sisting clients to identify and examine some of their common fears. These fears
include being imperfect, being vulnerable, being disapproved of, and suffering
from past regrets (Carlson & Englar-Carlson, 2008).
The Student Manual that accompanies this textbook includes a concrete
example of the lifestyle assessment as it is applied to the case of Stan. In Case
Approach to Counseling and Psychotherapy (Corey, 2013, chap. 3), Drs. Jim Bitter
and Bill Nicoll present a lifestyle assessment of another hypothetical client, Ruth.
Phase 3: Encourage Self-Understanding and Insight
During this third phase, Adlerian therapists interpret the fi ndings of the assess-
ment as an avenue for promoting self-understanding and insight. Mosak and
Maniacci (2011) defi ne insight as “understanding translated into constructive action”
(p. 89). When Adlerians speak of insight, they are referring to an understanding of
the motivations that operate in a client’s life. Self-understanding is only possible
when hidden purposes and goals of behavior are made conscious. Adlerians con-
sider insight as a special form of awareness that facilitates a meaningful understand-
ing within the therapeutic relationship and acts as a foundation for change. Insight
is a means to an end, and not an end in itself. People can make rapid and signifi cant
changes without much insight.
Disclosure and well-timed interpretations are techniques that facilitate the proc-
ess of gaining insight. Interpretation deals with clients’ underlying motives for
behaving the way they do in the here and now. Adlerian disclosures and interpreta-
tions are concerned with creating awareness of one’s direction in life, one’s goals
and purposes, one’s private logic and how it works, and one’s current behavior.
Adlerian interpretations are suggestions presented tentatively in the form of
open-ended questions that can be explored in the sessions. They are hunches or
guesses, and they often begin with phrases such as “I could be wrong, but I am
wondering if . . . ,” “Could it be that . . . ,” or “Is it possible that . . .” Because inter-
pretations are presented in this manner, clients are not led to defend themselves,
and they feel free to discuss and even argue with the counselor’s hunches and
impressions. Through this process, both counselor and client eventually come to
understand the client’s motivations, the ways in which these motivations are now
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 117 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

118
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
I
V
E
contributing to the maintenance of the problem, and what the client can do to
correct the situation. During this phase of therapy, the counselor helps the client
understand the limitations of the style of life the client has chosen.
Phase 4: Reorientation and Reeducation
The fi nal stage of the therapeutic process is the action-oriented phase known as
reorientation and reeducation: putting insights into practice. This phase focuses
on helping clients discover a new and more functional perspective. Clients are
both encouraged and challenged to develop the courage to take risks and make
changes in their life. During this phase, clients can choose to adopt a new style of
life based on the insights they gained in the earlier phases of therapy.
Adlerians are interested in more than changes in behavior. Reorientation
involves shifting rules of interaction, process, and motivation. These shifts are
facilitated through changes in awareness, which often occur during the therapy ses-
sion and which are transformed into action outside of the therapy offi ce (Bitter &
Nicoll, 2004). In addition, especially at this phase of therapy, Adlerians focus on
reeducation (see the section on therapeutic goals).
In some cases, signifi cant changes are needed if clients are to overcome discour-
agement and fi nd a place for themselves in this life. More often, however, clients
merely need to be reoriented toward the useful side of life. The useful side involves a
sense of belonging and being valued, having an interest in others and their welfare,
courage, the acceptance of imperfection, confi dence, a sense of humor, a willing-
ness to contribute, and an outgoing friendliness. The useless side of life is charac-
terized by self-absorption, withdrawal from life tasks, self-protection, or acts against
one’s fellow human beings. People acting on the useless side of life become less
functional and are more susceptible to psychopathology. Adlerian therapy stands
in opposition to self-depreciation, isolation, and retreat, and it seeks to help clients
gain courage and to connect to strengths within themselves, to others, and to life.
Throughout this phase, no intervention is more important than encouragement.
t h e e n c o u r a g e m e n t p r o c e s s Encouragement is the most distinctive
Adlerian procedure, and it is central to all phases of counseling and therapy. It
is especially important as people consider change in their lives. Encouragement
literally means “to build courage.” Courage develops when people become aware
of their strengths, when they feel they belong and are not alone, and when they
have a sense of hope and can see new possibilities for themselves and their daily
living. Encouragement entails showing faith in people, expecting them to assume
responsibility for their lives, and valuing them for who they are (Carlson et al.,
2006). Carlson and Englar-Carlson (2008) note that encouragement involves
acknowledging that life can be diffi cult, yet it is critical to instill a sense of faith in
clients that they can make changes in life. Milliren, Evans, and Newbauer (2007)
consider encouragement key in promoting and activating social interest. They add
that encouragement is the universal therapeutic intervention for Adlerian coun-
selors, that it is a fundamental attitude rather than a technique. Because clients
often do not recognize or accept their positive qualities, strengths, or internal
resources, one of the counselor’s main tasks is to help them do so.
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 118 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

119
A
D
L
E
R
I
A
N

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Adlerians believe discouragement is the basic condition that prevents people
from functioning, and they see encouragement as the antidote. As a part of the
encouragement process, Adlerians use a variety of relational, cognitive, behavioral,
emotional, and experiential techniques to help clients identify and challenge self-
defeating cognitions, generate perceptional alternatives, and make use of assets,
strengths, and resources (Ansbacher & Ansbacher, 1964; Dinkmeyer & Sperry,
2000; Watts & Pietrzak, 2000; Watts & Shulman, 2003).
Encouragement takes many forms, depending on the phase of the coun-
seling process. In the relationship phase, encouragement results from the mutual
respect the counselor seeks to engender. In the assessment phase, which is partially
designed to illuminate personal strengths, clients are encouraged to recognize that
they are in charge of their own lives and can make different choices based on new
understandings. During reorientation, encouragement comes when new possibili-
ties are generated and when clients are acknowledged and affi rmed for taking posi-
tive steps to change their lives for the better.
c h a n g e a n d t h e s e a r c h f o r n e w p o s s i b i l i t i e s During the reo-
rientation phase of counseling, clients make decisions and modify their goals. They
are encouraged to act as if they were the people they want to be, which can serve
to challenge self-limiting assumptions. Clients are asked to catch themselves in the
process of repeating old patterns that have led to ineffective behavior. Commitment
is an essential part of reorientation. If clients hope to change, they must be willing
to set tasks for themselves in everyday life and do something specifi c about their
problems. In this way, clients translate their new insights into concrete actions. Bit-
ter and Nicoll (2004) emphasize that real change happens between sessions, and
not in therapy itself. They state that arriving at a strategy for change is an important
fi rst step, and stress that it takes courage and encouragement for clients to apply
what they have learned in therapy to daily living.
This action-oriented phase is a time for solving problems and making deci-
sions. The counselor and the client consider possible alternatives and their con-
sequences, evaluate how these alternatives will meet the client’s goals, and decide
on a specifi c course of action. The best alternatives and new possibilities are those
generated by the client, and the counselor must offer the client a great deal of sup-
port and encouragement during this stage of the process.
m a k i n g a d i f f e r e n c e Adlerian counselors seek to make a difference in the
lives of their clients. That difference may be manifested by a change in behavior or
attitude or perception. Adlerians use many different techniques to promote change,
some of which have become common interventions in other therapeutic models.
Techniques that go by the names of immediacy, advice, humor, silence, paradoxi-
cal intention, acting as if, spitting in the client’s soup, catching oneself, the push-
button technique, externalization, reauthoring, avoiding the traps, confrontation, use
of stories and fables, early recollection analysis, lifestyle assessment, encouraging,
task setting and commitment, giving homework, and terminating and summariz-
ing have all been used (Carlson & Slavik, 1997; Carlson et al., 2006; Dinkmeyer &
Sperry, 2000; Disque & Bitter, 1998; Mosak & Maniacci, 2011; Mozdzierz, Peluso, &
Lisiecki, 2009). Adlerian practitioners can creatively employ a wide range of other
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 119 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

120
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
I
V
E
techniques, as long as these methods are philosophically consistent with the basic
theoretical premises of Adlerian psychology (Milliren et al., 2007). Adlerians are prag-
matic when it comes to using techniques that are appropriate for a given client. In
general, however, Adlerian practitioners focus on motivation modifi cation more than
behavior change and encourage clients to make holistic changes on the useful side of
living. All counseling is a cooperative effort, and making a difference depends on the
counselor’s ability to win the client’s cooperation.
Areas of Application
Adler anticipated the future direction of the helping professions by calling upon
therapists to become social activists and by addressing the prevention and reme-
diation of social conditions that were contrary to social interest and resulted in
human problems. Adler’s pioneering efforts on prevention services in mental health
led him to increasingly advocate for the role of Individual Psychology in schools and
families. Because Individual Psychology is based on a growth model, not a medical
model, it is applicable to such varied spheres of life as child guidance; parent–child
counseling; couples counseling; family counseling and therapy; group counseling
and therapy; individual counseling with children, adolescents, and adults; cultural
confl icts; correctional and rehabilitation counseling; and mental health institutions.
Adler’s basic ideas have been incorporated into the practices of school psychology,
school counseling, the community mental health movement, and parent education.
Adlerian principles have been widely applied to substance abuse programs, social
problems to combat poverty and crime, problems of the aged, school systems, reli-
gion, and business.
a p p l i c at i o n t o e d u c at i o n Adler (1930/1978) advocated training both
teachers and parents in effective practices that foster the child’s social interests and
result in a sense of competence and self-worth. Adler had a keen interest in apply-
ing his ideas to education, especially in fi nding ways to remedy faulty lifestyles of
schoolchildren. He initiated a process to work with students in groups and to edu-
cate parents and teachers. By providing teachers with ways to prevent and correct
basic mistakes of children, he sought to promote social interest and mental health.
Adler was ahead of his time in advocating for schools to take an active role in de-
veloping social skills and character education as well as teaching the basics. Many
of the major teacher education models are based on principles of Adlerian psychol-
ogy (see Albert, 1996). Besides Adler, the main proponent of Individual Psychol-
ogy as a foundation for the teaching–learning process was Dreikurs (1968, 1971).
a p p l i c at i o n t o pa r e n t e d u c at i o n Parent education seeks to im-
prove the relationship between parent and child by promoting greater understand-
ing and acceptance. Parents are taught how to recognize the mistaken goals of chil-
dren and to use logical and natural consequences to guide children toward more
productive behavior. Adlerian parent education also stresses listening to children,
helping children accept the consequences of their behavior, applying emotion
coaching, holding family meetings, and using encouragement. Two of the leading
parent education programs in the United States—STEP (Dinkmeyer & McKay,
1997) and Active Parenting (Popkin, 1993)—are based on Adlerian principles.
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 120 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

121
A
D
L
E
R
I
A
N

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
a p p l i c at i o n t o c o u p l e s c o u n s e l i n g Adlerian therapy with couples
is designed to assess a couple’s beliefs and behaviors while educating them in
more effective ways of meeting their relational goals. Clair Hawes has developed
an approach to couples counseling within the Adlerian brief therapy model. In addi-
tion to addressing the compatibility of lifestyles, Hawes looks at the early recollections
of the marriage and each partner’s relationship to a broad set of life tasks, including
occupation, social relationships, intimate relationships, spirituality, self-care, and
self-worth (Bitter et al., 1998; Hawes, 1993; Hawes & Blanchard, 1993). Carlson,
Watts, and Maniacci (2006) describe how Adlerians achieve the goals of brief
couples therapy: they foster social interest, assist couples in decreasing feelings
of inferiority and overcoming discouragement, help couples modify their views
and goals, help couples to feel a sense of quality in their relationships, and pro-
vide skill-building opportunities. Therapists aim to create solutions for problems,
increase choices of couples, and help clients discover and use their individual and
collective resources.
The full range of techniques applicable to other forms of counseling can be used
when working with couples. In couples counseling, couples are taught specifi c
techniques that enhance communication and cooperation. Some of these tech-
niques are listening, paraphrasing, giving feedback, having marriage conferences,
listing expectations, doing homework, and enacting problem solving. Adlerians
use psychoeducational methods and skills training in counseling couples. For use-
ful books on this topic, see Carlson and Dinkmeyer (2003) and Sperry, Carlson,
and Peluso (2006).
Adlerians will sometimes see clients as a couple, sometimes individually, and
then alternately as a couple and as individuals. Rather than looking for who is at fault
in the relationship, the therapist considers the lifestyles of the partners and the inter-
action of the two lifestyles. Emphasis is given to helping them decide if they want to
maintain their relationship, and, if so, what changes they are willing to make.
a p p l i c at i o n t o fa m i ly c o u n s e l i n g With its emphasis on the fam-
ily constellation, holism, and the freedom of the therapist to improvise, Adler’s
approach contributed to the foundation of the family therapy perspective. Adleri-
ans working with families focus on the family atmosphere, the family constellation,
and the interactive goals of each member (Bitter, 2009). The family atmosphere is
the climate characterizing the relationship between the parents and their attitudes
toward life, gender roles, decision making, competition, cooperation, dealing with
confl ict, responsibility, and so forth. This atmosphere, including the role models
the parents provide, infl uences the children as they grow up. The therapeutic proc-
ess seeks to increase awareness of the interaction of the individuals within the
family system. Those who practice Adlerian family therapy strive to understand
the goals, beliefs, and behaviors of each family member and the family as an entity
in its own right. Adler’s and Dreikurs’s infl uence on family therapy is covered in
more depth in Chapter 14.
a p p l i c at i o n t o g r o u p c o u n s e l i n g Adler and his coworkers used
a group approach in their child guidance centers in Vienna as early as 1921
(Dreikurs, 1969). Dreikurs extended and popularized Adler’s work with groups
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 121 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

122
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
I
V
E
and used group psychotherapy in his private practice for more than 40 years.
Although Dreikurs introduced group therapy into his psychiatric practice as a way
to save time, he quickly discovered some unique characteristics of groups that
made them an effective way of helping people change. Inferiority feelings can be
challenged and counteracted effectively in groups, and the mistaken concepts and
values that are at the root of social and emotional problems can be deeply infl u-
enced because the group is a value-forming agent (Sonstegard & Bitter, 2004).
The rationale for Adlerian group counseling is based on the premise that our
problems are mainly of a social nature. The group provides the social context in
which members can develop a sense of belonging, social connectedness, and com-
munity. Sonstegard and Bitter (2004) write that group participants come to see
that many of their problems are interpersonal in nature, that their behavior has
social meaning, and that their goals can best be understood in the framework
of social purposes.
The use of early recollections is a unique feature of Adlerian group counseling.
As mentioned earlier, from a series of early memories, individuals can get a clear
sense of their mistaken notions, current attitudes, social interests, and possible fu-
ture behavior. Through the mutual sharing of these early recollections, members
develop a sense of connection with one another, and group cohesion is increased.
The group becomes an agent of change because of the improved interpersonal
relationships among members and the emergence of hope.
We particularly value the way Adlerian group counselors implement action
strategies at each of the group sessions and especially during the reorientation
stage when new decisions are made and goals are modifi ed. To challenge self-
limiting assumptions, members are encouraged to act as if they were the persons
they want to be. They are asked to “catch themselves” in the process of repeating
old patterns that have led to ineffective or self-defeating behavior. The mem-
bers come to appreciate that if they hope to change, they need to set tasks for
themselves, apply group lessons to daily life, and take steps in fi nding solutions
to their problems. This fi nal stage is characterized by group leaders and mem-
bers working together to challenge erroneous beliefs about self, life, and others.
During this stage, members are considering alternative beliefs, behaviors, and
attitudes.
Adlerian group counseling can be considered a brief approach to treatment.
The core characteristics associated with brief group therapy include rapid estab-
lishment of a strong therapeutic alliance, clear problem focus and goal alignment,
rapid assessment, emphasis on active and directive therapeutic interventions, a
focus on strengths and abilities of clients, an optimistic view of change, a focus
on both the present and the future, and an emphasis on tailoring treatment to
the unique needs of clients in the most time-effi cient manner possible (Carlson
et al., 2006).
Adlerian brief group therapy is addressed by Sonstegard, Bitter, Pelonis-
Peneros, and Nicoll (2001). For more on the Adlerian approach to group coun-
seling, refer to Theory and Practice of Group Counseling (Corey, 2012, chap. 7) and
Sonstegard and Bitter (2004).
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 122 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

123
A
D
L
E
R
I
A
N

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
a d l e r i a n t h e r a p y f r o m
a m u lt i c u lt u r a l p e r s p e c t i v e
Strengths From a Diversity Perspective
Adlerian theory addressed social equality issues and social embeddedness of
humans long before multiculturalism assumed central importance in the profes-
sion (Watts & Pietrzak, 2000). Adler introduced notions with implications toward
multiculturalism that have as much or more relevance today as they did during
Adler’s time (Pedersen, as cited in Nystul, 1999b). Some of these ideas include
(1) the importance of the cultural context, (2) the emphasis on health as opposed
to pathology, (3) a holistic perspective on life, (4) the value of understanding indi-
viduals in terms of their core goals and purposes, (5) the ability to exercise freedom
within the context of societal constraints, and (6) the focus on prevention and the
development of a proactive approach in dealing with problems. Adler’s holistic per-
spective is an articulate expression of what Pedersen calls a “culture-centered” or
multicultural approach to counseling. Carlson and Englar-Carlson (2008) maintain
that Adlerian theory is well suited to counseling diverse populations and doing so-
cial justice work. They assert: “Perhaps Adler’s greatest contribution is that he de-
veloped a theory that recognizes and stresses the effects of social class, racism, sex,
and gender on the behavior of individuals. His ideas, therefore, are well received by
those living in today’s global society” (p. 134).
Although the Adlerian approach is called Individual Psychology, its focus is on
the person in a social context. Thus clients are encouraged to defi ne themselves
within their social environments. Adlerians allow broad concepts of age, ethnicity,
lifestyle, sexual/affectional orientations, and gender differences to emerge in ther-
apy. The therapeutic process is grounded within a client’s culture and worldview
rather than attempting to fi t clients into preconceived models.
In their analysis of the various theoretical approaches to counseling, Arciniega
and Newlon (2003) state that Adlerian theory holds a great deal of promise for
addressing diversity issues. They note a number of characteristics of Adlerian the-
ory that are congruent with the values of many racial, cultural, and ethnic groups,
including the emphasis on understanding the individual in a familial and socio-
cultural context; the role of social interest and contributing to others; and the focus
on belonging and the collective spirit. Cultures that stress the welfare of the social
group and emphasize the role of the family will fi nd the basic assumptions of Adle-
rian psychology to be consistent with their values.
Adlerian therapists tend to focus on cooperation and socially oriented values
as opposed to competitive and individualistic values (Carlson & Carlson, 2000).
Native American clients, for example, tend to value cooperation over competition.
One such client told a story about a group of boys who were in a race. When one
boy got ahead of the others, he would slow down and allow the others to catch up,
and they all made it to the fi nish line at the same time. Although the coach tried
to explain that the point of the race was for an individual to fi nish fi rst, these boys
were socialized to work together cooperatively as a group. Adlerian therapy is easily
adaptable to cultural values that emphasize community.
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 123 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

124
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
I
V
E
Not only is Adlerian theory congruent with the values of people from diverse
cultural groups, but the approach offers fl exibility in applying a range of cognitive
and action-oriented techniques to helping clients explore their practical problems
in a cultural context. Adlerian practitioners are not wedded to any particular set
of procedures. Instead, they are conscious of the value of fi tting their techniques
to each client’s situation. Although they utilize a diverse range of methods, most
of them do conduct a lifestyle assessment. This assessment is heavily focused on
the structure and dynamics within the client’s family. Because of their cultural
background, many clients have been conditioned to respect their family heritage
and to appreciate the impact of their family on their own personal development. It
is essential that counselors be sensitive to the confl icting feelings and struggles of
their clients. If counselors demonstrate an understanding of these cultural values,
it is likely that these clients will be receptive to an exploration of their lifestyle.
Such an exploration will involve a detailed discussion of their own place within
their family.
It should be noted that Adlerians investigate culture in much the same way
that they approach birth order and family atmosphere. Culture is a vantage point
from which life is experienced and interpreted; it is also a background of values,
history, convictions, beliefs, customs, and expectations that must be addressed by
the individual. Culture provides a way of grasping the subjective and experien-
tial perspective of an individual. Although culture infl uences each person, it is
expressed within each individual differently, according to the perception, evalua-
tion, and interpretation of culture that the person holds. Contemporary Adlerians
appreciate the role of spirituality and religion in the lives of clients because these
factors are manifestations of social interest and responsibility to others (Carlson &
Englar-Carlson, 2008).
Adler was one of the fi rst psychologists at the turn of the century to advocate
equality for women. He recognized that men and women were different in many
ways, but he felt that the two genders were deserving of equal value and respect.
This respect and appreciation for difference extends to culture as well as gender.
Adlerians fi nd in different cultures opportunities for viewing the self, others, and
the world in multidimensional ways.
Shortcomings From a Diversity Perspective
As is true of most Western models, the Adlerian approach tends to focus on the
self as the locus of change and responsibility. Because other cultures have differ-
ent conceptions, this primary emphasis on changing the autonomous self may be
problematic for many clients. Assumptions about the Western nuclear family are
built into the Adlerian concepts of birth order and family constellation. For people
brought up in extended family contexts, some of these ideas may be less relevant
or at least may need to be reconfi gured.
Adlerian theory has some potential drawbacks for clients from those cultures
who are not interested in exploring past childhood experiences, early memories,
family experiences, and dreams. This approach also has limited effectiveness with
clients who do not understand the purpose of exploring the details of a lifestyle
analysis when dealing with life’s current problems (Arciniega & Newlon, 2003).
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 124 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

In addition, the culture of some clients may contribute to their viewing the coun-
selor as the “expert” and expecting that the counselor will provide them with solu-
tions to their problems. For these clients, the role of the Adlerian therapist may
pose problems because Adlerian therapists are not experts in solving other people’s
problems. Instead, they view it as their function to collaboratively teach people
alternative methods of coping with life concerns.
Many clients who have pressing problems are likely to be hesitant to discuss
areas of their lives that they may not see as connected to the struggles that bring
them into therapy. Individuals may believe that it is inappropriate to reveal family
information. On this point Carlson and Carlson (2000) suggest that a therapist’s
sensitivity and understanding of a client’s culturally constructed beliefs about dis-
closing family information are critical. If the therapist is able to demonstrate an
understanding of a client’s cultural values, it is likely that this person will be more
open to the assessment and treatment process.
The basic aims of an Adlerian thera-
pist working with Stan are fourfold
and correspond to the four stages
of counseling: (1) establishing and maintain-
ing a good working relationship with Stan,
(2) exploring Stan’s dynamics, (3) encouraging
Stan to develop insight and understanding, and
(4) helping Stan see new alternatives and make
new choices.
To develop mutual trust and respect, I pay
close attention to Stan’s subjective experience
and attempt to get a sense of how he has
reacted to the turning points in his life. During
the initial session, Stan reacts to me as the
expert who has the answers. He is convinced
that when he makes decisions he generally ends
up regretting the results. Stan approaches me
out of desperation. Because I view counseling
as a relationship between equals, I initially focus
on his feeling of being unequal to most other
people. A good place to begin is exploring his
feelings of inferiority, which he says he feels in
most situations. The goals of counseling are
developed mutually, and I avoid deciding for
Stan what his goals should be. I also resist
giving Stan the simple formula he is
requesting.
I prepare a lifestyle assessment based on a
questionnaire that taps information about Stan’s
early years, especially his experiences in his
family. (See the Student Manual for Theory and
Practice of Counseling and Psychotherapy for a
complete description of this lifestyle assessment
form as it is applied to Stan.) This assessment
includes a determination of whether he poses
a danger to himself because Stan did mention
suicidal ideation. During the assessment phase,
which might take a few sessions, I explore with
Stan his social relationships, his relationships
with members of his family, his work responsi-
bilities, his role as a man, and his feelings about
himself. I place considerable emphasis on Stan’s
goals in life and his priorities. I do not pay a great
deal of attention to his past, except to show him
the consistency between his past and present as
he moves toward the future.
As an Adlerian counselor, I place value on
exploring early recollections as a source of
understanding his goals, motivations, and
values. I ask Stan to report his earliest
memories. He replies as follows:
I was about 6. I went to school, and I was
scared of the other kids and the teacher. When I
came home, I cried and told my mother I didn’t
want to go back to school. She yelled at me and
called me a baby. After that I felt horrible and
even more scared.
Adlerian Therapy Applied to the Case of Stan
125
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 125 21/09/11 5:11 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

Another of Stan’s early recollections was at
age 8:
My family was visiting my grandparents. I was
playing outside, and some neighborhood kid
hit me for no reason. We started fighting, and
my mother came out and scolded me for being
such a rough kid. She wouldn’t believe me when
I told her he started the fight. I felt angry and
hurt that she didn’t believe me.
Based on these early recollections, I suggest
that Stan sees life as frightening and unpredict-
ably hostile and that he feels he cannot count on
women; they are likely to be harsh, unbelieving,
and uncaring.
Having gathered the data based on the lifestyle
assessment about his family constellation and his
early recollections, I assist Stan in the process of
summarizing and interpreting this information. I
give particular attention to identifying basic mis-
takes, which are faulty conclusions about life and
self-defeating perceptions. Here are some of the
mistaken conclusions Stan has reached:
• “I must not get close to people, because they
will surely hurt me.”
• “Because my own parents didn’t want me and
didn’t love me, I’ll never be desired or loved by
anybody.”
• “If only I could become perfect, maybe people
would acknowledge and accept me.”
• “Being a man means not showing emotions.”
The information I summarize and interpret
leads to insight and increased self-understanding
on Stan’s part. He gains increased awareness of
his need to control his world so that he can keep
painful feelings in check. He sees more clearly
some of the ways he tries to gain control over
his pain: through the use of alcohol, avoiding
interpersonal situations that are threatening, and
being unwilling to count on others for psycholog-
ical support. Through continued emphasis on his
beliefs, goals, and intentions, Stan comes to see
how his private logic is inaccurate. In his case, a
syllogism for his style of life can be explained in
this way: (1) “I am unloved, insignificant, and do
not count”; (2) “The world is a threatening place
to be, and life is unfair”; (3) “Therefore, I must
find ways to protect myself and be safe.” During
this phase of the process, I make interpretations
centering on his lifestyle, his current direction,
his goals and purposes, and how his private logic
works. Of course, Stan is expected to carry out
homework assignments that assist him in trans-
lating his insights into new behavior. In this way
he is an active participant in his therapy.
In the reorientation phase of therapy, Stan
and I work together to consider alternative atti-
tudes, beliefs, and actions. By now Stan sees that
he does not have to be locked into past patterns,
feels encouraged, and realizes that he has the
power to change his life. He accepts that he will
not change merely by gaining insights and knows
that he will have to make use of these insights by
carrying out an action-oriented plan. Stan begins
to feel that he can create a new life for himself
and not remain the victim of circumstances.
Follow-Up: You Continue as
Stan’s Adlerian Therapist
Use these questions to help you think about how
you would counsel Stan using an Adlerian approach:
• What are some ways you would attempt to
establish a relationship with Stan based on trust
and mutual respect? Can you imagine any diffi-
culties in developing this relationship with him?
• What aspects of Stan’s lifestyle particularly
interest you? In counseling him, how would
these be explored?
• The Adlerian therapist identified four of Stan’s
mistaken conclusions. Can you identify with
any of these basic mistakes? If so, do you think
this would help or hinder your therapeutic
effectiveness with him?
• How might you assist Stan in discovering his
social interest and going beyond a preoccupa-
tion with his own problems?
• What strengths and resources in Stan might
you draw on to support his determination and
commitment to change?
See the DVD for Theory and Practice
of Counseling and Psychotherapy: The
Case of Stan and Lecturettes (Session 3 on
Adlerian therapy) for a demonstration of my
approach to counseling Stan by focusing on his
early recollections.
126
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
I
V
E
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 126 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

127
A
D
L
E
R
I
A
N

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
s u m m a ry a n d e va l u at i o n
Summary
Adler was far ahead of his time, and most contemporary therapies have incorpo-
rated at least some of his ideas. Individual Psychology assumes that people are
motivated by social factors; are responsible for their own thoughts, feelings, and
actions; are the creators of their own lives, as opposed to being helpless victims;
and are impelled by purposes and goals, looking more toward the future than back
to the past.
The basic goal of the Adlerian approach is to help clients identify and change
their mistaken beliefs about, self, others, and life and thus to participate more
fully in a social world. Clients are not viewed as psychologically sick but as dis-
couraged. The therapeutic process helps individuals become aware of their pat-
terns and make some basic changes in their style of living, which lead to changes
in the way they feel and behave. The role of the family in the development of the
individual is emphasized. Therapy is a cooperative venture that challenges clients
to translate their insights into action in the real world. Contemporary Adlerian
theory is an integrative approach, combining cognitive, constructivist, existential,
psychodynamic, and systems perspectives. Some of these common characteristics
include an emphasis on establishing a respectful client–therapist relationship,
an emphasis on clients’ strengths and resources, and an optimistic and future
orientation.
The Adlerian approach gives practitioners a great deal of freedom in work-
ing with clients. Major Adlerian contributions have been made in the following
areas: elementary education, consultation groups with teachers, parent education
groups, couples and family therapy, and group counseling.
Contributions of the Adlerian Approach
A strength of the Adlerian approach is its fl exibility and its integrative nature.
Adlerian therapists can be both theoretically integrative and technically eclectic
(Watts & Shulman, 2003). This therapeutic approach allows for the use of a variety
of relational, cognitive, behavioral, emotive, and experiential techniques. Adlerian
therapists are resourceful and fl exible in drawing on many methods, which can be
applied to a diverse range of clients in a variety of settings and formats. Therapists
are mainly concerned with doing what is in the best interests of clients rather than
squeezing clients into one theoretical framework (Watts, 1999, 2000; Watts &
Pietrzak, 2000; Watts & Shulman, 2003).
Another contribution of the Adlerian approach is that it is suited to brief, time-
limited therapy. Adler was a proponent of time-limited therapy, and the techniques
used by many contemporary brief therapeutic approaches are very similar to
interventions created by or commonly used by Adlerian practitioners (Carlson et
al., 2006). Adlerian therapy and contemporary brief therapy have in common a
number of characteristics, including quickly establishing a strong therapeutic alli-
ance, a clear problem focus and goal alignment, rapid assessment and application
to treatment, an emphasis on active and directive intervention, a psychoeducational
focus, a present and future orientation, a focus on clients’ strengths and abilities
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 127 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

128
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
I
V
E
and an optimistic expectation of change, and a time sensitivity that tailors treatment
to the unique needs of the client (Carlson et al., 2006). According to Mosak and
Di Pietro (2006), early recollections are a signifi cant assessment intervention in
brief therapy. They claim that early recollections are often useful in minimizing
the number of therapy sessions. This procedure takes little time to administer and
interpret and provides a direction for therapists to pursue.
Bitter and Nicoll (2000) identify fi ve characteristics that form the basis for an
integrative framework in brief therapy: time limitation, focus, counselor directive-
ness, symptoms as solutions, and the assignment of behavioral tasks. Bringing a
time-limitation process to therapy conveys to clients the expectation that change
will occur in a short period of time. When the number of sessions is specifi ed,
both client and therapist are motivated to stay focused on desired outcomes and
to work as effi ciently as possible. Because there is no assurance that a future ses-
sion will occur, brief therapists tend to ask themselves this question: “If I had only
one session to be useful in this person’s life, what would I want to accomplish?”
(p. 38).
The Adlerian concepts I (Jerry Corey) draw on most in my professional work are
(1) the importance of looking to one’s life goals, including assessing how these goals
infl uence an individual; (2) the focus on the individual’s interpretation of early expe-
riences in the family, with special emphasis on their current impact; (3) the clinical
use of early recollections in both assessment and treatment; (4) the use of dreams as
rehearsals for future action; (5) the need to understand and confront basic mistakes;
(6) the cognitive emphasis, which holds that emotions and behaviors are largely
infl uenced by one’s beliefs and thinking processes; (7) the idea of working out an
action plan designed to help clients make changes; (8) the collaborative relation-
ship, whereby the client and therapist work toward mutually agreed-upon goals;
and (9) the emphasis given to encouragement during the entire counseling proc-
ess. Several Adlerian concepts have implications for personal development. One
of these notions that has helped me to understand the direction of my life is the
assumption that feelings of inferiority are linked to a striving for superiority
(Corey, 2010).
It is diffi cult to overestimate the contributions of Adler to contemporary thera-
peutic practice. Many of his ideas were revolutionary and far ahead of his time. His
infl uence went beyond counseling individuals, extending into the community men-
tal health movement (Ansbacher, 1974). Abraham Maslow, Viktor Frankl, Rollo
May, Paul Watzlawick, Karen Horney, Erich Fromm, Aaron T. Beck, and Albert Ellis
have all acknowledged their debt to Adler. Both Frankl and May see him as a fore-
runner of the existential movement because of his position that human beings
are free to choose and are entirely responsible for what they make of themselves.
This view also makes him a forerunner of the subjective approach to psychology,
which focuses on the internal determinants of behavior: values, beliefs, attitudes,
goals, interests, personal meanings, subjective perceptions of reality, and strivings
toward self-realization. Bitter (2008) and his colleagues (Bitter, Robertson, Healey, &
Cole, 2009) have drawn attention to the link between Adlerian thinking and femi-
nist therapy approaches.
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 128 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

129
A
D
L
E
R
I
A
N

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
One of Adler’s most important contributions was his infl uence on other therapy
systems. Many of his basic ideas have found their way into most of the other psy-
chological schools, a few of which include existential therapy, cognitive behavior
therapy, rational emotive behavior therapy, reality therapy, solution-focused ther-
apy, and family therapy. In many respects, Adler seems to have paved the way for
current developments in both the cognitive and constructivist therapies (Watts,
2003). Adlerians’ basic premise is that if clients can change their thinking then
they can change their feelings and behavior. A study of contemporary counseling
theories reveals that many of Adler’s notions have reappeared in these modern
approaches with different nomenclature, and often without giving Adler the credit
that is due to him (Watts, 1999; Watts & Pietrzak, 2000; Watts & Shulman, 2003).
It is clear that there are signifi cant linkages between Adlerian theory and most of
the present-day theories, especially those that view the person as purposive, self-
determining, and striving for growth. Carlson and Englar-Carlson (2008) assert
that Adlerians face the challenge of continuing to develop their approach so that it
meets the needs of contemporary global society: “Whereas Adlerian ideas are alive
in other theoretical approaches, there is a question about whether Adlerian theory
as a stand-alone approach is viable in the long term” (p. 133). These authors believe
that for the Adlerian model to survive and thrive it will be necessary to fi nd ways
to strive for signifi cance.
Limitations and Criticisms of the
Adlerian Approach
Adler had to choose between devoting his time to formalizing his theory and teach-
ing others the basic concepts of Individual Psychology. He placed practicing and
teaching before organizing and presenting a well-defi ned and systematic theory.
As a result, his written presentations are often diffi cult to follow, and many of
them are transcripts of lectures he gave. Initially, many people considered his ide-
as somewhat loose and too simplistic.
Research supporting the effectiveness of Adlerian theory is limited but has
improved over the last 25 years (Watts & Shulman, 2003). However, a large part of
the theory still requires empirical testing and comparative analysis. This is especial-
ly true in the conceptual areas that Adlerians accept as axiomatic: for example, the
development of lifestyle; the unity of the personality and an acceptance of a sin-
gular view of self; the rejection of the prominence of heredity in determining
behavior, especially pathological behavior; and the usefulness of the multiple inter-
ventions used by various Adlerians.
w h e r e to g o f r o m h e r e
Refer to the DVD for Integrative Counseling: The Case of Ruth and Lecturettes, Ses-
sion 6 (“Cognitive Focus in Counseling”), which illustrates Ruth’s striving to live
up to expectations and measure up to perfectionist standards. In this particular
therapy session with Ruth, you will see how I draw upon cognitive concepts and
apply them in practice.
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 129 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

130
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
I
V
E
Free Podcasts for ACA Members
You can download ACA Podcasts (prerecorded interviews) by going to www.
counseling.org and then clicking on the Resource button, and then the Podcast
Series. For Chapter 5, look for Podcast 11, Adlerian Therapy, by Dr. Jon Carlson.
Other Resources
Videos from Psychotherapy.net demonstrate Adlerian therapy with adults, fami-
lies, and children, and are available to students and professionals at their website,
www.Psychotherapy.net. New articles, interviews, blogs, therapy cartoons, and vid-
eos are published monthly. For this chapter, see the following:
Carlson, J. (1997). Adlerian Therapy (Psychotherapy with the Experts Series)
Carlson, J. (2001). Adlerian Parent Consultation (Child Therapy with the Experts
Series)
Kottman, T. (2001). Adlerian Play Therapy (Child Therapy with the Experts Series)
If your thinking is allied with the Adlerian approach, you might consider seeking
training in Individual Psychology or becoming a member of the North American
Society of Adlerian Psychology (NASAP). To obtain information on NASAP and a
list of Adlerian organizations and institutes, contact:
North American Society of Adlerian Psychology (NASAP)
614 Old West Chocolate Avenue
Hershey, PA 17033
Telephone: (717) 579-8795
Fax: (717) 533-8616
E-mail: nasap@msn.com
Website: www.alfredadler.org
The society publishes a newsletter and a quarterly journal and maintains a list of
institutes, training programs, and workshops in Adlerian psychology. The Jour-
nal of Individual Psychology presents current scholarly and professional research.
Columns on counseling, education, and parent and family education are regular
features. Information about subscriptions is available by contacting the society.
If you are interested in pursuing training, postgraduate study, continuing edu-
cation, or a degree, contact NASAP for a list of Adlerian organizations and institutes.
A few training institutes are listed here:
Adler School of Professional Psychology
65 East Wacker Place, Suite 2100
Chicago, IL 60601-7298
Telephone: (312) 201-5900
Fax: (312) 201-5917
E-mail: admissions@adler.edu
Website: www.adler.edu
Adler Graduate School
1550 East 78th Street
Richfield, MN 55423
Telephone: 612-861-7554
Fax: 612-861-7559
E-mail:info@alfredadler.edu
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 130 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

Adler School of Professional Psychology, Vancouver Campus
595 Burrard Street, Suite 753
P.O. Box 49104
Vancouver, BC, Canada V7X 1G4
Telephone: (604) 482-5510
Fax: (604) 874-4634
Adlerian Training Institute, Inc.
Dr. Bill Nicoll, Coordinator
P.O. Box 881581
Port St. Lucie, FL 34988
Telephone/Fax: (772) 807-4141
Cell Phone: (954) 650-0637
E-mail: adleriantraining@aol.com
Website: www.adleriantraining.com
The Alfred Adler Institute of Northwestern Washington
2565 Mayflower Lane
Bellingham, WA 98226
Telephone: (360) 647-5670
E-mail: HTStein@att.net
Website: http://ourworld.compuserv.com/homepages/hstein/
Alfred Adler Institute of San Francisco
266 Bemis Street
San Francisco, CA 94131
Telephone: (415) 584-3833
E-mail: DPienkow@msn.com
The International Committee of Adlerian
Summer Schools and Institutes
Michael Balla, ICASSI Administrator
257 Billings Avenue
Ottawa, Ontario, Canada K1H 5L1
Fax: (613) 733-0289
E-mail: mjballa@sympatico.ca
Website: www.icassi.net
Recommended Supplementary Readings
Adlerian Therapy: Theory and Practice (Carlson, Watts, & Maniacci, 2006) clearly
presents a comprehensive overview of Adlerian therapy in contemporary practice.
There are chapters on the therapeutic relationship, brief individual therapy, brief
couples therapy, group therapy, play therapy, and consultation. This book lists
Adlerian intervention videos that are available.
Adlerian Counseling and Psychotherapy: A Practitioner’s Approach (Sweeney, 2009)
is one of the most comprehensive books written on the wide range of Adlerian
applications to therapy and wellness.
131
A
D
L
E
R
I
A
N

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 131 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

Adlerian Psychotherapy: An Advanced Approach to Individual Psychology (Oberst &
Stewart, 2003) is an up-to-date and in-depth presentation of Adlerian psychother-
apeutic process, including chapters on family therapy and the relevance of this
model to postmodern approaches.
Early Recollections: Interpretative Method and Application (Mosak & Di Pietro,
2006) is an extensive review of the use of early recollections as a way to under-
stand an individual’s dynamics and behavioral style. This book addresses the
theory, research, and clinical applications of early recollections.
Understanding Life-Style: The Psycho-Clarity Process (Powers & Griffi th, 1987) is a
useful source of information for doing a lifestyle assessment. Separate chapters
deal with interview techniques, lifestyle assessment, early recollections, the fam-
ily constellation, and methods of summarizing and interpreting information.
References and Suggested Readings
132
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
I
V
E
*Books and articles marked with an asterisk are suggested for further study.
Adler, A. (1958). What life should mean to you.
New York: Capricorn. (Original work published
1931)
Adler, A. (1959). Understanding human nature.
New York: Premier Books. (Original work
published 1927)
Adler, A. (1964). Social interest. A challenge to
mankind. New York: Capricorn. (Original work
published 1938)
Adler, A. (1978). The education of children.
Chicago: Regnery Publishing. (Original work
published 1930)
Albert, L. (1996). Cooperative discipline. Circle
Pines, MN: American Guidance Service.
American Psychiatric Association. (2000).
Diagnostic and statistical manual of mental
disorders, text revision (4th ed.). Washington,
DC: Author.
Ansbacher, H. L. (1974). Goal-oriented individ-
ual psychology: Alfred Adler’s theory. In
A. Burton (Ed.), Operational theories of
personality (pp. 99–142). New York: Brunner/
Mazel.
*Ansbacher, H. L. (1979). The increasing
recognition of Adler. In. H. L. Ansbacher & R. R.
Ansbacher (Eds.), Superiority and social interest.
Alfred Adler, A collection of his later writings
(3rd rev. ed., pp. 3–20). New York: Norton.
*Ansbacher, H. L. (1992). Alfred Adler’s
concepts of community feeling and social
interest and the relevance of community
feeling for old age. Individual Psychology,
48(4), 402–412.
*Ansbacher, H. L., & Ansbacher, R. R. (Eds.).
(1964). The individual psychology of Alfred Adler.
New York: Harper & Row/Torchbooks.
(Original work published 1956)
*Ansbacher, H. L., & Ansbacher, R. R. (Eds.).
(1979). Superiority and social interest. Alfred
Adler: A collection of his later writings
(3rd rev. ed.). New York: Norton.
Arciniega, G. M., & Newlon, B. J. (2003).
Counseling and psychotherapy: Multicultural
considerations. In D. Capuzzi & D. F. Gross
(Eds.), Counseling and psychotherapy: Theories
and interventions (3rd ed., pp. 417–441).
Upper Saddle River, NJ: Merrill/
Prentice-Hall.
Bitter, J. R. (2006, May 25). Am I an Adlerian?
Ansbacher Lecture, 54th annual convention
of the North American Society of Adlerian
Psychology (NASAP), Chicago, IL.
Bitter, J. R. (2008). Reconsidering narcissism:
An Adlerian-feminist response to the articles
in the special section of the Journal of Individu-
al Psychology, volume 63, number 2. Journal of
Individual Psychology, 64(3), 270–279.
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 132 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

133
A
D
L
E
R
I
A
N

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Bitter, J. R. (2009). Theory and practice of
family therapy and counseling. Belmont, CA:
Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning.
*Bitter, J. R., Christensen, O. C., Hawes, C., &
Nicoll, W. G. (1998). Adlerian brief therapy
with individuals, couples, and families.
Directions in Clinical and Counseling Psychology,
8(8), 95–111.
*Bitter, J. R., & Nicoll, W. G. (2000). Adlerian
brief therapy with individuals: Process and
practice. Journal of Individual Psychology, 56(1),
31–44.
*Bitter, J. R., & Nicoll, W. G. (2004). Relational
strategies: Two approaches to Adlerian brief
therapy. Journal of Individual Psychology, 60(1),
42–66.
Bitter, J. R., Robertson, P. E., Healey, A., &
Cole, L. (2009). Reclaiming a pro-feminist
orientation in Adlerian therapy. Journal of
Individual Psychology, 65(1), 13–33.
*Carlson, J. M., & Carlson, J. D. (2000). The
application of Adlerian psychotherapy with
Asian-American clients. Journal of Individual
Psychology, 56(2), 214–225.
Carlson, J., & Dinkmeyer, D. (2003). Time
for a better marriage. Atascadero, CA: Impact
Publishers.
*Carlson, J. D., & Englar-Carlson, M. (2008).
Adlerian therapy. In J. Frew & M. D. Spiegler
(Eds.), Contemporary psychotherapies for a
diverse world (pp. 93–140). Boston: Lahaska Press.
*Carlson, J., & Slavik, S. (Eds.). (1997). Tech-
niques in Adlerian psychology. Philadelphia, PA:
Taylor & Francis.
*Carlson, J., Watts, R. E., & Maniacci, M.
(2006). Adlerian therapy: Theory and practice.
Washington DC: American Psychological
Association.
Clark, A. (2002). Early recollections: Theory
and practice in counseling and psychotherapy.
New York: Brunner Routledge.
*Corey, G. (2010). Creating your professional
path: Lessons from my journey. Alexandria, VA:
American Counseling Association.
*Corey, G. (2012). Theory and practice of group
counseling (8th ed.). Belmont, CA: Brooks/
Cole, Cengage Learning.
*Corey, G. (2013). Case approach to counseling
and psychotherapy (8th ed.). Belmont, CA:
Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning.
Dinkmeyer, D. C., & Mc Kay, G. D. (1997).
Systematic training for effective parenting [STEP].
Circle Pines, MN: American Guidance Service.
Dinkmeyer, D., Jr., & Sperry, L. (2000).
Counseling and psychotherapy: An integrated
Individual Psychology approach (3rd ed.). Upper
Saddle River, NJ: Merrill/Prentice-Hall.
*Disque, J. G., & Bitter, J. R. (1998). Integrat-
ing narrative therapy with Adlerian lifestyle
assessment: A case study. Journal of Individual
Psychology, 54(4), 431–450.
Dreikurs, R. (1953). Fundamentals of Adlerian
psychology. Chicago: Alfred Adler Institute.
Dreikurs, R. (1967). Psychodynamics, psy-
chotherapy, and counseling. Collected papers.
Chicago: Alfred Adler Institute.
Dreikurs, R. (1968). Psychology in the class-
room (2nd ed.). New York: Harper & Row.
Dreikurs, R. (1969). Group psychotherapy from
the point of view of Adlerian psychology. In
H. M. Ruitenbeck (Ed.), Group therapy today: Styles,
methods, and techniques (pp. 37–48). New York:
Aldine-Atherton. (Original work published 1957)
Dreikurs, R. (1971). Social equality: The chal-
lenge of today. Chicago: Regnery.
Dreikurs, R. (1997). Holistic medicine.
Individual Psychology, 53(2), 127–205.
Hawes, E. C. (1993). Marriage counseling
and enrichment. In O. C. Christensen (Ed.),
Adlerian family counseling (Rev. ed., pp.
125–163). Minneapolis, MN: Educational
Media Corporation.
Hawes, C., & Blanchard, L. M. (1993). Life
tasks as an assessment technique in marital
counseling. Individual Psychology, 49, 306–317.
Hoffman, E. (1996). The drive for self: Alfred
Adler and the founding of Individual Psychology.
Reading, MA: Addison-Wesley.
Hood, A. B., & Johnson, R. W. (2007).
Assessment in counseling: A guide to the use of
psychological assessment procedures (4th ed.).
Alexandria, VA: American Counseling
Association.
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 133 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

134
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

F
I
V
E
Kefir, N. (1981). Impasse/priority therapy. In
R. J. Corsini (Ed.), Handbook of innovative psy-
chotherapies (pp. 401–415). New York: Wiley.
Milliren, A. P., & Clemmer, F. (2006). Intro-
duction to Adlerian psychology: Basic princi-
ples and methodology. In S. Slavik & J. Carlson
(Eds.), Readings in the theory and practice of
Individual Psychology (pp. 17–43). New York:
Routledge (Taylor & Francis).
Milliren, A. P., Evans, T. D., & Newbauer, J. F.
(2007). Adlerian theory. In D. Capuzzi & D.
R. Gross (Eds.), Counseling and psychotherapy:
Theories and interventions (4th ed., pp. 123–163).
Upper Saddle River, NJ: Merrill Prentice-Hall.
*Mosak, H. H., & Di Pietro, R. (2006). Early rec-
ollections: Interpretative method and application.
New York: Routledge.
*Mosak, H. H., & Maniacci, M. P. (2011).
Adlerian psychotherapy. In R. J. Corsini & D.
Wedding (Eds.), Current psychotherapies
(9th ed., pp. 67–112). Belmont, CA: Brooks/
Cole, Cengage Learning.
Mosak, H. H., & Shulman, B. H. (1988).
Lifestyle inventory. Muncie, IN: Accelerated
Development.
Mozdzierz, G. J., Lisiecki, J., Bitter, J. R., &
Williams, A. L. (1986). Role-functions for
Adlerian therapists. Individual Psychology,
42(2), 154–177.
Mozdzierz, G. J., Peluso, P. R., & Lisiecki, J.
(2009). Principles of counseling and psycho-
therapy: Learning the essential domains and
non-linear thinking of master practitioners.
New York: Routledge.
Nystul, M. S. (1999a). An interview with
Gerald Corey. Journal of Individual Psychology,
55(1), 15–25.
Nystul, M. S. (1999b). An interview with
Paul Pedersen. Journal of Individual Psychology,
55(2), 216–224.
Oberst, U. E., & Stewart, A. E. (2003).
Adlerian psychotherapy: An advanced approach
to individual psychology. New York: Brunner-
Routledge.
Popkin, M. (1993). Active parenting today.
Atlanta, GA: Active Parenting.
*Powers, R. L., & Griffith, J. (1987). Under-
standing life-style. The psycho-clarity process.
Chicago: Americas Institute of Adlerian
Studies.
Powers, R. L., & Griffith, J. (1995). IPCW: The
individual psychology client workbook with sup-
plements. Chicago: Americas Institute of
Adlerian Studies. (Original work published
1986)
Schultz, D., & Schultz, S. E. (2009). Theories of
personality (9th ed.). Belmont, CA: Wadsworth,
Cengage Learning.
Sherman, R., & Dinkmeyer, D. (1987). Systems
of family therapy. An Adlerian integration.
New York: Brunner/Mazel.
Shulman, B. H., & Mosak, H. H. (1988).
Manual for life style assessment. Muncie,
IN: Accelerated Development.
*Sonstegard, M. A., & Bitter, J. R. (with
Pelonis, P.). (2004). Adlerian group counseling
and therapy: Step-by-step. New York: Brunner/
Routledge (Taylor & Francis).
Sonstegard, M. A., Bitter, J. R., Pelonis-
Peneros, P. P., & Nicoll, W. G. (2001). Adlerian
group psychotherapy: A brief therapy
approach. Directions in Clinical and Counseling
Psychology, 11(2), 11–12.
*Sperry, L., Carlson, J., & Peluso, P. (2006).
Couples therapy. Denver, CO: Love.
Sweeney, T. J. (2009). Adlerian counseling
and psychotherapy: A practitioner’s approach
(5th ed.). New York: Routledge (Taylor &
Francis).
Vaihinger, H. (1965). The philosophy of “as if.”
London: Routledge & Kegan Paul.
Watts, R. E. (1999). The vision of Adler: An
introduction. In R. E. Watts & J. Carlson (Eds.),
Interventions and strategies in counseling and
psychotherapy (pp. 1–13). Philadelphia, PA:
Accelerated Development (Taylor & Francis).
Watts, R. E. (2000). Entering the new millen-
nium: Is Individual Psychology still relevant?
Journal of Individual Psychology, 56(1), 21–30.
Watts, R. E. (2003). Adlerian, cognitive, and
constructivist therapies: An integrative dialogue.
New York: Springer.
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 134 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

135
A
D
L
E
R
I
A
N

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
*Watts, R. E., & Holden, J. M. (1994). Why
continue to use “fictional finalism”? Individual
Psychology, 50, 161–163.
Watts, R. E., Peluso, P. R., & Lewis, T. F.
(2005). Expanding the acting as if technique:
An Adlerian/constructive integration. Journal
of Individual Psychology, 61(4), 380–387.
Watts, R. E., & Pietrzak, D. (2000). Adlerian
“encouragement” and the therapeutic process
of solution-focused brief therapy. Journal
of Counseling and Development, 78(4),
442–447.
Watts, R. E., & Shulman, B. H. (2003). Inte-
grating Adlerian and constructive therapies:
An Adlerian perspective. In R. E. Watts (Ed.),
Adlerian, cognitive, and constructivist therapies:
An integrative dialogue (pp. 9–37). New York:
Springer.
28549_ch05_rev01.indd 135 20/09/11 3:19 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

136
i n t r o d u ct i o n
• Historical Background in Philosophy
and Existentialism
• Key Figures in Contemporary Existential
Psychotherapy
k e y co n c e p t s
• View of Human Nature
• Proposition 1: The Capacity for Self-Awareness
• Proposition 2: Freedom and Responsibility
• Proposition 3: Striving for Identity and
Relationship to Others
• Proposition 4: The Search for Meaning
• Proposition 5: Anxiety as a Condition
of Living
• Proposition 6: Awareness of Death and
Nonbeing
t h e t h e r a p e u t i c p r o c es s
• Therapeutic Goals
• Therapist’s Function and Role
• Client’s Experience in Therapy
• Relationship Between Therapist and Client
a p p l i c at i o n : t h e r a p e u t i c
t ec h n i q u es a n d p r o c e d u r es
• Phases of Existential Counseling
• Clients Appropriate for Existential Counseling
• Application to Brief Therapy
• Application to Group Counseling
e x i st e n t i a l t h e r a p y f r o m a
m u lt i c u lt u r a l p e r s p ect i v e
• Strengths From a Diversity Perspective
• Shortcoming From a Diversity Perspective
e x i st e n t i a l t h e r a p y a p p l i e d to
t h e c a s e o f sta n
s u m m a ry a n d e va l u at i o n
• Summary
• Contributions of the Existential Approach
• Limitations and Criticisms of the Existential
Approach
w h e r e to g o f r o m h e r e
• Recommended Supplementary Readings
• References and Suggested Readings
c h a p t e r 6
Existential Therapy

• Refer
y Read
ed Readings
136
t i c p r o
eutic Goals
rapist’s Function and Role
ent’s Experience in Therapy
lationship Between Therapist and Cl
a C
Living
• Proposition 6: Awareness o
Nonbeing
t h e t h e r a
• Thera
• Th
• C
• Re
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 136 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

137
E
X
I
S
T
E
N
T
I
A
L

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Viktor Frankl / Rollo May / Irvin Yalom
V I K TO R F R A N K L (1905–
1997) was born and educat-
ed in Vienna. He founded the
Youth Advisement Centers
there in 1928 and directed
them until 1938. From 1942
to 1945 Frankl was a pris-
oner in the Nazi concentra-
tion camps at Auschwitz
and Dachau, where his parents, brother, wife, and
children died. He vividly remembered his horrible
experiences in these camps, yet he was able to
use them in a constructive way and did not allow
them to dampen his love and enthusiasm for life.
He traveled all around the world, giving lectures
in Europe, Latin America, Southeast Asia, and the
United States.
Frankl received his MD in 1930 and his PhD
in philosophy in 1949, both from the University of
Vienna. He became an associate professor at the
University of Vienna and later was a distinguished
speaker at the United States International University
in San Diego. He was a visiting professor at Har-
vard, Stanford, and Southern Methodist universi-
ties. Frankl’s works have been translated into more
than 20 languages, and his ideas continue to have
a major impact on the development of existential
therapy. His compelling book Man’s Search for Mean-
ing (1963) has been a best-seller around the world.
Although Frankl had begun to develop an exis-
tential approach to clinical practice before his grim
years in the Nazi death camps, his experiences
there confirmed his views. Frankl (1963) observed
and personally experienced the truths expressed
by existential philosophers and writers who hold
that we have choices in every situation. Even in
terrible circumstances, he believed, we could
preserve a vestige of spiritual freedom and inde-
pendence of mind. He learned experientially that
everything could be taken from a person except
one thing: “the last of human freedoms—to choose
one’s attitude in any given set of circumstances, to
choose one’s own way” (p. 104). ). Frankl believed
that the essence of being human lies in searching
for meaning and purpose. He believed that love
is the highest goal to which humans can aspire and
that our salvation is through love. We can discover
this meaning through our actions and deeds, by
experiencing a value (such as love or achievements
through work), and by suffering.
Frankl knew and read Freud and attended
some of the meetings of Freud’s psychoanalytic
group. Frankl acknowledged his indebtedness
to Freud, although he disagreed with the rigidity
of Freud’s psychoanalytic system. Frankl often
remarked that Freud was a depth psychologist and
that he is a height psychologist who built
on Freud’s foundations. Reacting against most of
Freud’s deterministic notions, Frankl developed
his own theory and practice of psychotherapy,
which emphasized the concepts of freedom,
responsibility, meaning, and the search for values.
He established his international reputation as the
founder of what has been called “The Third School
of Viennese Psychoanalysis,” the other two being
Sigmund Freud’s psychoanalysis and Alfred Adler’s
Individual Psychology.
I have selected Frankl as one of the key figures
of the existential approach because of the dramatic
way in which his theories were tested by the trag-
edies of his life. His life was an illustration of his
theory, for he lived what his theory espouses.
IM
A
G
N
O
/V
ik
to
rF
ra
nk
lA
rc
hi
v
R O L LO M AY (1909–1994)
first lived in Ohio and then
moved to Michigan as a
young child along with his
five brothers and a sister.
He remembered his home
life as being unhappy, a
situation that contributed
to his interest in psychol-
ogy and counseling. In his personal life May
struggled with his own existential concerns and the
failure of two marriages.
Despite his unhappy life experiences, he gradu-
ated from Oberlin College in 1930 and then went
to Greece as a teacher. During his summers in
Greece he traveled to Vienna to study with Alfred
Adler. After receiving a degree in theology from
Union Theological Seminary, May decided that the Hu
lto
n
A
rc
hi
ve
/G
et
ty
Im
ag
es
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 137 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

138
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
I
X
best way to reach out and help people was through
psychology instead of theology. He completed his
doctorate in clinical psychology at Columbia Uni-
versity and started a private practice in New York;
he also became a supervisory training analyst for
the William Alanson Institute.
While May was pursuing his doctoral program,
he came down with tuberculosis, which resulted in
a 2-year stay in a sanitarium. During his recovery
period, May spent much time learning firsthand
about the nature of anxiety. He also spent time
reading, and he studied the works of Søren Kierke-
gaard, which was the catalyst for his recognizing
the existential dimensions of anxiety. This study
resulted in his book The Meaning of Anxiety (1950).
His popular book Love and Will (1969) reflects his
own personal struggles with love and intimate rela-
tionships and mirrors Western society’s question-
ing of its values pertaining to sex and marriage.
The greatest personal influence on Rollo May
was the existential theologian Paul Tillich (author
of The Courage to Be, 1952), who became his men-
tor and a personal friend. The two spent much
time together discussing philosophical, religious,
and psychological topics. Most of May’s
writings reflect a concern with the nature of
human experience, such as recognizing and deal-
ing with power, accepting freedom and respon-
sibility, and discovering one’s identity. He draws
from his rich knowledge based on the classics and
his existential perspective.
Rollo May was one of the main proponents
of humanistic approaches to psychotherapy, and
he was the principal American spokesperson of
European existential thinking as it is applied to
psychotherapy. He believed psychotherapy should
be aimed at helping people discover the mean-
ing of their lives and should be concerned with
the problems of being rather than with problem
solving. Questions of being include learning to
deal with issues such as sex and intimacy, growing
old, facing death, and taking action in the world.
According to May, the real challenge is for people
to be able to live in a world where they are alone
and where they will eventually have to face death.
He contends that our individualism should be
balanced by what Adler refers to as social inter-
est. It is the task of therapists to help individuals
find ways to contribute to the betterment of the
society in which they live.
I RV I N YA LO M (b. 1931- )
was born of parents who
immigrated from Russia
shortly after World War I.
During his early childhood,
Yalom lived in the inner city
of Washington, D.C., in a
poor neighborhood. Life on
the streets was perilous,
and Yalom took refuge indoors reading novels and
other works. Twice a week he made the hazardous
bicycle trek to the library to stock up on reading
supplies. He found an alternative and satisfying
world in reading fiction, which was a source of
inspiration and wisdom to him. Early in his life he
decided that writing a novel was the very finest
thing a person could do, and subsequently he has
written several teaching novels.
Irvin Yalom is professor emeritus of psychia-
try at the Stanford University School of Medicine.
A psychiatrist and author, Yalom has been a
major figure in the field of group psychotherapy
since publication in 1970 of his influential book
The Theory and Practice of Group Psychotherapy
(1970/2005), which has been translated into 12
languages and is currently in its fifth edition. His
pioneering work, Existential Psychotherapy, written
in 1980, is a classic and authoritative textbook on
existential therapy. Drawing on his clinical experi-
ence and on empirical research, philosophy, and
literature, Yalom developed an existential approach
to psychotherapy that addresses four “givens of
existence” or ultimate human concerns: freedom
and responsibility, existential isolation, meaning-
lessness, and death. These existential themes deal
with the client’s existence, or being-in-the-world.
Yalom urges all therapists, regardless of theoretical
orientation, to develop a sensibility to existential
issues because generally these issues emerge in all
courses of therapy.
Psychotherapy has been endlessly intriguing
for Yalom, who has approached all of his patients
with a sense of wonderment at the stories they
reveal. He believes that a different therapy must be
Ph
ot
o
co
ur
te
sy
of
Jo
se
ph
Si
ro
ke
r.
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 138 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

139
E
X
I
S
T
E
N
T
I
A
L

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
designed for each client because each has a unique
story. He advocates using the here and now of
the therapeutic relationship to explore the client’s
interpersonal world, and he believes the therapist
must be transparent, especially regarding his or
her experience of the client. His basic philosophy
is existential and interpersonal, which he applies to
both individual and group therapy.
Irvin Yalom has authored many stories and
novels related to psychotherapy, including Love’s
Executioner (1987), When Nietzsche Wept (1992),
Lying on the Couch (1997), Momma and the Meaning
of Life (2000), and The Schopenhauer Cure (2005a).
His 2008 nonfiction book, Staring at the Sun:
Overcoming the Terror of Death, is a treatise on the
role of death anxiety in psychotherapy, illustrating
how death and the meaning of life are foundational
themes associated with in-depth therapeutic
work. Yalom’s works, translated into more than 20
languages, have been widely read by therapists and
laypeople alike.
Yalom’s wife, Marilyn, has a PhD in compara-
tive literature and has had a successful career as
a university professor and writer. His four children
have chosen a variety of careers—medicine, pho-
tography, creative writing, theater directing, and
clinical psychology. He has five grandchildren and
is still counting.
i n t r o d u c t i o n
Existential therapy is more a way of thinking, or an attitude about psychotherapy,
than a particular style of practicing psychotherapy. It is neither an independent
nor separate school of therapy, nor is it a clearly defi ned model with specifi c tech-
niques. Existential therapy can best be described as a philosophical approach that
infl uences a counselor’s therapeutic practice. Yalom and Josselson (2011) capture
the essence of this approach:
Existential psychotherapy is an attitude toward human suffering [that] has no manual. It
asks deep questions about the nature of the human being and the nature of anxiety, despair,
grief, loneliness, isolation, and anomie. It also deals centrally with the questions of mean-
ing, creativity, and love. (p. 310)
Existential therapy focuses on exploring themes such as mortality, meaning, free-
dom, responsibility, anxiety, and aloneness as these relate to a person’s current
struggle. The goal of existential therapy is to assist clients in their exploration of
the existential “givens of life,” how these are sometimes ignored or denied, and
how addressing them can ultimately lead to a deeper, more refl ective and mean-
ingful existence. Clients are invited to refl ect on life, to recognize their range of
alternatives, and to decide among them.
The existential approach rejects the deterministic view of human nature es-
poused by traditional psychoanalysis and radical behaviorism. Psychoanalysis sees
the individual as primarily determined by unconscious forces, irrational drives,
and past events; behaviorists see the individual as primarily determined by socio-
cultural conditioning. Although deterministic forces affect us and we sometimes
cannot control external events thrust upon us, existential therapists believe we
retain the freedom to choose how we respond to such events. Existential therapy
is grounded on the assumption that we are free and therefore responsible for our
choices and actions. We are the authors of our lives, and we design the pathways
we follow. This chapter addresses some of the existential concepts and themes that
have signifi cant implications for the existentially oriented practitioner.
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 139 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

140
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
I
X
A basic existential premise is that we are not victims of circumstance because,
to a large extent, we are what we choose to be. Once clients begin the process of
recognizing the ways in which they have passively accepted circumstances and
surrendered control, they can start down a path of consciously shaping their own
lives. The fi rst step in the therapeutic journey is for clients to accept responsibility.
As Yalom (2003) puts it, “Once individuals recognize their role in creating their
own life predicament, they also realize that they, and only they, have the power to
change that situation” (p. 141). One of the aims of existential therapy is to challenge
people to stop deceiving themselves regarding their lack of responsibility for what
is happening to them and their excessive demands on life (van Deurzen, 2002b).
Emmy van Deurzen (2002a), a key contributor to British existential psychol-
ogy, writes that existential counseling is not designed to “cure” people of illness in
the tradition of the medical model. She does not view clients as being sick, but as
“sick of life or clumsy at living” (p. 18) and unable to live a productive life.
See the DVD program for Chapter 6, DVD for Theory and Practice of Counseling
and Psychotherapy: The Case of Stan and Lecturettes. I suggest that you view
the brief lecture for each chapter prior to reading the chapter.
Historical Background in Philosophy and Existentialism
The existential therapy movement was not founded by any particular person or
group; many streams of thought contributed to it. Drawing from a major orienta-
tion in philosophy, existential therapy arose spontaneously in different parts of Eu-
rope and among different schools of psychology and psychiatry in the 1940s and
1950s. Many Europeans found that their lives had been devastated by World War
II, and they struggled with existential issues including feelings of isolation, aliena-
tion, and meaninglessness. Early writers focused on the individual’s experience
of being alone in the world and facing the anxiety of this situation. The European
existential perspective focused on human limitations and the tragic dimensions of
life (Sharp & Bugental, 2001).
The thinking of existential psychologists and psychiatrists was infl uenced by a
number of philosophers and writers during the 19th century. To understand the
philosophical underpinnings of modern existential psychotherapy, one must have
some awareness of such fi gures as Søren Kierkegaard, Friedrich Nietzsche, Martin
Heidegger, Jean-Paul Sartre, and Martin Buber. These major fi gures of existential-
ism and existential phenomenology and their cultural, philosophical, and religious
writings provided the basis for the formation of existential therapy. Ludwig Bin-
swanger and Medard Boss are also included in this section because both were early
existential psychoanalysts who contributed key ideas to existential psychotherapy.
s ø r e n k i e r k e g a a r d ( 1 8 1 3 – 1 8 5 5 ) A Danish philosopher and Chris-
tian theologian, Kierkegaard was particularly concerned with angst—a Danish and
German word whose meaning lies between the English words dread and anxiety—
and he addressed the role of anxiety and uncertainty in life. Existential anxiety
is associated with making basic decisions about how we want to live, and it is
not pathological. Kierkegaard believed that anxiety is the school in which we are
educated to be a self. Without the experience of angst, we may go through life as
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 140 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

141
E
X
I
S
T
E
N
T
I
A
L

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
sleepwalkers. But many of us, especially in adolescence, are awakened into real life
by a terrible uneasiness. Life is one contingency after another, with no guarantees
beyond the certainty of death. This is by no means a comfortable state, but it is
necessary to our becoming human. Kierkegaard believed that “the sickness unto
death” arises when we are not true to ourselves. What is needed is the willingness
to risk a leap of faith in making choices. Becoming human is a project, and our task
is not so much to discover who we are as to create ourselves.
f r i e d r i c h n i e t z s c h e ( 1 8 4 4 – 1 9 0 0 ) The German philosopher Nietzsche
is the iconoclastic counterpart to Kierkegaard, expressing a revolutionary approach to
the self, to ethics, and to society. Like Kierkegaard, he emphasized the importance
of subjectivity. Nietzsche set out to prove that the ancient defi nition of humans
as rational was entirely misleading. We are far more creatures of will than we are
impersonal intellects. But where Kierkegaard emphasized the “subjective truth” of
an intense concern with God, Nietzsche located values within the individual’s “will to
power.” We give up an honest acknowledgment of this source of value when society
invites us to rationalize powerlessness by advocating other worldly concerns. If, like
sheep, we acquiesce in “herd morality,” we will be nothing but mediocrities. But if
we release ourselves by giving free rein to our will to power, we will tap our poten-
tiality for creativity and originality. Kierkegaard and Nietzsche, with their pioneer-
ing analyses of anxiety, depression, subjectivity, and the authentic self, together are
generally considered to be the originators of the existential perspective (Sharp &
Bugental, 2001).
m a r t i n h e i d e g g e r ( 1 8 8 9 – 1 9 7 6 ) Heidegger’s phenomenological exis-
tentialism reminds us that we exist “in the world” and should not try to think of
ourselves as beings apart from the world into which we are thrown. The way we
fi ll our everyday life with superfi cial conversation and routine shows that we often
assume we are going to live forever and can afford to waste day after day. Our
moods and feelings (including anxiety about death) are a way of understanding
whether we are living authentically or whether we are inauthentically constructing
our lives around the expectations of others. When we translate this wisdom from
vague feeling to explicit awareness, we may develop a more positive resolve about
how we want to be. Phenomenological existentialism, as presented by Heidegger,
provides a view of human history that does not focus on past events but motivates
individuals to look forward to “authentic experiences” that are yet to come.
m a r t i n b u b e r ( 1 8 7 8 – 1 9 6 5 ) Leaving Germany to live in the new state of
Israel, Buber took a less individualistic stand than most of the other existentialists.
He said that we humans live in a kind of betweenness; that is, there is never just an
I, but always an other. The I, the person who is the agent, changes depending on
whether the other is an it or a Thou. But sometimes we make the serious mistake
of reducing another person to the status of a mere object, in which case the rela-
tionship becomes I/it. Although Buber recognizes that of necessity we must have
many I/it interactions (in everyday life), we are seriously limited if we live only in
the world of the I/it. Buber stresses the importance of presence, which has three
functions: (1) it enables true I/Thou relationships; (2) it allows for meaning to exist
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 141 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

142
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
I
X
in a situation; and (3) it enables an individual to be responsible in the here and now
(Gould, 1993). In a famous dialogue with Carl Rogers, Buber argued that the thera-
pist and client could never be on the same footing because the latter comes to the
former for help. When the relationship is fully mutual, we have become “dialogic,”
a fully human condition.
l u d w i g b i n s wa n g e r ( 1 8 8 1 – 1 9 6 6 ) An existential analyst, Binswanger
proposed a holistic model of self that addresses the relationship between the per-
son and his or her environment. He used a phenomenological approach to explore
signifi cant features of the self, including choice, freedom, and caring. He based his
existential approach largely on the ideas of Heidegger and accepted Heidegger’s
notion that we are “thrown into the world.” However, this “thrown-ness” does not
release us from the responsibility of our choices and for planning for the future
(Gould, 1993). Existential analysis (dasein analyse) emphasizes the subjective and
spiritual dimensions of human existence. Binswanger (1975) contended that crises
in therapy were typically major choice points for the client. Although he originally
looked to psychoanalytic theory to shed light on psychosis, he moved toward an exis-
tential view of his patients. This perspective enabled him to understand the worldview
and immediate experience of his patients, as well as the meaning of their behavior, as
opposed to superimposing his view as a therapist on their experience and behavior.
m e da r d b o s s ( 1 9 0 3 – 1 9 9 1 ) Both Binswanger and Boss were early existen-
tial psychoanalysts and signifi cant fi gures in the development of existential psycho-
therapy. They made reference to dasein or being-in-the-world, which pertains to our
ability to refl ect on life events and attribute meaning to these events. They believed
that the therapist must enter the client’s subjective world without presuppositions
that would get in the way of this experiential understanding. Both Binswanger
and Boss were signifi cantly infl uenced by Heidegger’s seminal work, Being and
Time (1962), which provided a broad basis for understanding the individual (May,
1958). Boss was deeply infl uenced by Freudian psychoanalysis, but even more so
by Heidegger. Boss’s major professional interest was applying Heidegger’s phil-
osophical notions to therapeutic practice, and he was especially concerned with
integrating Freud’s methods with Heidegger’s concepts, as described in his book
Daseinanalysis and Psychoanalysis (1963).
j e a n – pa u l s a r t r e ( 1 9 0 5 – 1 9 8 0 ) A philosopher and novelist, Sartre was
convinced, in part by his years in the French Resistance in World War II, that
humans are even more free than earlier existentialists had believed. The existence
of a space—nothingness—between the whole of our past and the now frees us to
choose what we will. Our values are what we choose. The failure to acknowledge
our freedom and choices results in emotional problems. This freedom is hard to
face, so we tend to invent an excuse by saying, “I can’t change now because of
my past conditioning.” Sartre called excuses “bad faith.” No matter what we have
been, we can make choices now and become something quite different. We are
condemned to be free. To choose is to become committed; this is the responsibility
that is the other side of freedom. Sartre’s view was that at every moment, by our
actions, we are choosing who we are being. Our existence is never fi xed or fi nished.
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 142 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

143
E
X
I
S
T
E
N
T
I
A
L

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Every one of our actions represents a fresh choice. When we attempt to pin down
who we are, we engage in self-deception (Russell, 2007).
Key Figures in Contemporary Existential Psychotherapy
Viktor Frankl, Rollo May, Irvin Yalom, and James Bugental all developed their
existential approaches to psychotherapy from strong backgrounds in both existen-
tial and humanistic psychology. Some of their contributions to psychotherapy are
illustrated in the brief sketches that follow.
v i k t o r f r a n k l ( 1 9 0 5 – 1 9 9 7 ) Viktor Frankl was a central fi gure in de-
veloping existential therapy in Europe and also in bringing it to the United States.
As a youth, Frankl was deeply infl uenced by Freud, but he became a student of
Adler. Later, he was infl uenced by the writings of existential philosophers, and he
began developing his own existential philosophy and psychotherapy. He was fond
of quoting Nietzsche: “He who has a why to live for can bear with almost any how”
(as cited in Frankl, 1963, pp. 121, 164). Frankl contended that those words could
be the motto for all psychotherapeutic practice. Another quotation from Nietzsche
seems to capture the essence of his own experience and his writings: “That which
does not kill me, makes me stronger” (as cited in Frankl, 1963, p. 130).
Frankl developed logotherapy, which means “therapy through meaning.”
Frankl’s philosophical model sheds light on what it means to be fully alive. The
central themes running through his works are life has meaning, under all circum-
stances; the central motivation for living is the will to meaning; we have the freedom
to fi nd meaning in all that we think; and we must integrate body, mind, and spirit to be
fully alive. Frankl said that Freud viewed humans as motivated by the “will to pleas-
ure” and that Adler focused on the “will to power.” For Frankl, the most powerful
motivation for humans is the “will to meaning.” Frankl’s writings refl ect the theme
that the modern person has the means to live, but often has no meaning to live for.
The therapeutic process is aimed at challenging individuals to fi nd meaning and
purpose through, among other things, suffering, work, and love (Frankl, 1965).
(For more background information on Viktor Frankl, see his biography at the
beginning of this chapter).
r o l lo m ay ( 1 9 0 9 – 1 9 9 4 ) Along with Frankl, psychologist Rollo May was
deeply infl uenced by the existential philosophers, by the concepts of Freudian psy-
chology, and by many aspects of Alfred Adler’s Individual Psychology. May was
one of the key fi gures responsible for bringing existentialism from Europe to the
United States and for translating key concepts into psychotherapeutic practice. His
writings have had a signifi cant impact on existentially oriented practitioners. Of
primary importance in introducing existential therapy to the United States was
the book Existence: A New Dimension in Psychiatry and Psychology (May, Angel, &
Ellenberger, 1958). According to May, it takes courage to “be,” and our choices
determine the kind of person we become. There is a constant struggle within us.
Although we want to grow toward maturity and independence, we realize that
expansion is often a painful process. Hence, the struggle is between the security of
dependence and the joys and pains of growth. (For more background information
on Rollo May, see his biography at the beginning of this chapter).
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 143 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

144
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
I
X
i r v i n ya lo m ( 1 9 3 1 – ) Irvin Yalom is a signifi cant contemporary existential
therapist in the United States. He acknowledges the contributions of both Euro-
pean and American psychologists and psychiatrists who have infl uenced the devel-
opment of existential thinking and practice (Yalom, 1980). Yalom has developed
his approach to individual and group psychotherapy based on the notion that
existentialism deals with basic “givens of existence”: isolation and relationship with
others; death and living fully; and meaninglessness and meaning. Yalom believes
the vast majority of experienced therapists, regardless of their theoretical orienta-
tion, employ many of the core existential themes. He also contends that how we
address these existential themes has a good deal to do with the design and quality
of our lives. Yalom recognizes Frankl as an eminently pragmatic thinker who has
had an impact on his writing and practice. He also acknowledges the infl uence on
his writings of several novelists and philosophers. More specifi cally, he draws on
the following themes from those philosophers discussed earlier:
• From Kierkegaard: creative anxiety, despair, fear and dread, guilt, and nothingness
• From Nietzsche: death, suicide, and will
• From Heidegger: authentic being, caring, death, guilt, individual responsibility,
and isolation
• From Sartre: meaninglessness, responsibility, and choice
• From Buber: interpersonal relationships, I/Thou perspective in therapy, and
self-transcendence
(For more background information on Irvin Yalom, see his biography at the
beginning of this chapter.)
ja m e s b u g e n ta l ( 1 9 1 5 – 2 0 0 8 ) James Bugental coined the term “existen-
tial-humanistic” psychotherapy, and he was a leading spokesman for this approach.
His philosophical and therapeutic approach included a curiosity and focus that
moved him away from the traditional therapeutic milieu of labeling and diagnos-
ing clients. His work emphasized the cultivation of both client and therapist pres-
ence. He developed techniques to assist the client in deepening inner exploration,
or searching. The therapist’s primary task involved helping clients to make new dis-
coveries about themselves in the living moment, as opposed to merely talking about
themselves.
Central to Bugental’s approach is his view of resistance, which from an existential-
humanistic perspective is not resistance to therapy per se but rather to being fully
present both during the therapy hour and in life. Resistance is seen as part of
the self-and-world construct —how a person understands his or her being and rela-
tionship to the world at large. Forms of resistance include intellectualizing, being
argumentative, always seeking to please, and any other life-limiting pattern. As re-
sistance emerges in the therapy sessions, the therapist repeatedly notes, or “tags,”
the resistance so the client increases his or her awareness and ultimately has an
increased range of choices.
Bugental’s theory and practice emphasized the distinction between therapeutic
process and content. He became known for being a masterful teacher and psycho-
therapist, primarily because he lived his work. He was an existentialist at heart,
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 144 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

145
E
X
I
S
T
E
N
T
I
A
L

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
which made him a great model and mentor, not only for clients but also for stu-
dents and professionals. In his workshops, he developed many exercises to help
therapists refi ne and practice their skills. He frequently brought his techniques
to life with live demonstrations, which emphasized therapeutic work taking place
in the moment, impromptu here-and-now dialogue, and exploring in the context
of self as client or therapist. Bugental’s (1987) classic text, The Art of the Psycho-
therapist, is widely recognized for deconstructing the therapy process and moving
beyond theory and generalizations to show what actually occurs moment-to-
moment in the therapeutic encounter. Psychotherapy Isn’t What You Think (Bugental,
1999) is the last book he wrote before he died in 2008, at the age of 93.
ot h e r c o n t r i b u t o r s t o e x i s t e n t i a l t h e r a p y A more recent in-
fl uential fi gure in contemporary existential psychology is Kirk Schneider, who with
colleagues Orah Krug, David Elkins, and Ken Bradford are helping to extend exis-
tential principles to a new generation of practitioners. Schneider and his colleagues
developed an existential-integrative therapy (see Schneider, 2008, 2011; Schneider &
Krug, 2010) mainly because of the need to address today’s ethnically and diagnosti-
cally diverse clinical populations. The existential-integrative approach emphasizes
such areas as personal and interpersonal presence, the working through of resist-
ance, the rediscovery of meaning and awe, and contemplative practices. These
themes are increasingly being incorporated into the therapeutic mainstream.
Signifi cant developments in the existential approach are also occurring in
Britain, largely due to the efforts of Emmy van Deurzen, who is developing aca-
demic and training programs at the New School of Psychotherapy and Counselling
(see Other Resources at the end of the chapter for details). In the past decades the
existential approach has spread rapidly in Britain and is now an alternative to tra-
ditional methods (van Deurzen, 2002b). For a description of the historical context
and development of existential therapy in Britain, see van Deurzen (2002b) and
Cooper (2003); for an excellent overview of the theory and practice of existential
therapy, see van Deurzen (2002a) and Schneider and Krug (2010).
k e y c o n c e p t s
View of Human Nature
The crucial signifi cance of the existential movement is that it reacts against the
tendency to identify therapy with a set of techniques. Instead, it bases therapeu-
tic practice on an understanding of what it means to be human. The existential
movement stands for respect for the person, for exploring new aspects of human
behavior, and for divergent methods of understanding people. It uses numerous
approaches to therapy based on its assumptions about human nature.
The existential tradition seeks a balance between recognizing the limits and
tragic dimensions of human existence on one hand and the possibilities and
opportunities of human life on the other hand. It grew out of a desire to help people
engage the dilemmas of contemporary life, such as isolation, alienation, and mean-
inglessness. The current focus of the existential approach is on the individual’s
experience of being in the world alone and facing the anxiety of this isolation.
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 145 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

146
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
I
X
“No relationship can eliminate existential isolation, but aloneness can be shared in
such a way that love compensates for its pain” (Yalom & Josselson, 2011, p. 326).
The existential view of human nature is captured, in part, by the notion that the
signifi cance of our existence is never fi xed once and for all; rather, we continually
recreate ourselves through our projects. Humans are in a constant state of transi-
tion, emerging, evolving, and becoming in response to the tensions, contradictions,
and confl icts in our lives. Being a person implies that we are discovering and mak-
ing sense of our existence. We continually question ourselves, others, and the world.
Although the specifi c questions we raise vary in accordance with our developmental
stage in life, the fundamental themes do not vary. We pose the same questions
philosophers have pondered throughout Western history: “Who am I?” “What can I
know?” “What ought I to do?” “What can I hope for?” “Where am I going?”
The basic dimensions of the human condition, according to the existential
approach, include (1) the capacity for self-awareness; (2) freedom and responsi-
bility; (3) creating one’s identity and establishing meaningful relationships with
others; (4) the search for meaning, purpose, values, and goals; (5) anxiety as a con-
dition of living; and (6) awareness of death and nonbeing. I develop these proposi-
tions in the following sections by summarizing themes that emerge in the writings
of existential philosophers and psychotherapists, and I also discuss the implica-
tions for counseling practice of each of these propositions.
Proposition 1: The Capacity for Self-Awareness
Freedom, choice, and responsibility constitute the foundation of self-awareness. The
greater our awareness, the greater our possibilities for freedom (see Proposition 2).
Schneider (2008) explains that the core existential position is that we are both free (will-
ful, creative, and expressive) and limited (by environmental and social constraints). We
increase our capacity to live fully as we expand our awareness in the following areas:
• We are fi nite and do not have unlimited time to do what we want in life.
• We have the potential to take action or not to act; inaction is a decision.
• We choose our actions, and therefore we can partially create our own destiny.
• Meaning is the product of discovering how we are “thrown” or situated in the
world and then, through commitment, living creatively.
• As we increase our awareness of the choices available to us, we also increase our
sense of responsibility for the consequences of these choices.
• We are subject to loneliness, meaninglessness, emptiness, guilt, and isolation.
• We are basically alone, yet we have an opportunity to relate to other beings.
We can choose either to expand or to restrict our consciousness. Because self-
awareness is at the root of most other human capacities, the decision to expand it is
fundamental to human growth. Here are some areas of emerging awareness that
individuals may experience in the counseling process:
• They see how they are trading the security of dependence for the anxieties that
accompany choosing for themselves.
• They begin to see that their identity is anchored in someone else’s defi nition of
them; that is, they are seeking approval and confi rmation of their being in others
instead of looking to themselves for affi rmation.
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 146 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

147
E
X
I
S
T
E
N
T
I
A
L

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
• They learn that in many ways they are keeping themselves prisoner by some of
their past decisions, and they realize that they can make new decisions.
• They learn that although they cannot change certain events in their lives they
can change the way they view and react to these events.
• They learn that they are not condemned to a future similar to the past, for they
can learn from their past and thereby reshape their future.
• They realize that they are so preoccupied with suffering, death, and dying that
they are not appreciating living.
• They are able to accept their limitations yet still feel worthwhile, for they under-
stand that they do not need to be perfect to feel worthy.
• They come to realize that they are failing to live in the present moment because
of preoccupation with the past, planning for the future, or trying to do too many
things at once.
Increasing self-awareness—which includes awareness of alternatives, motivations,
factors infl uencing the person, and personal goals—is an aim of all counseling.
Clients need to learn that a price must be paid for increased awareness. As we
become more aware, it is more diffi cult to “go home again.” Ignorance of our
condition may have brought contentment along with a feeling of partial deadness,
but as we open the doors in our world, we can expect more turmoil as well as the
potential for more fulfi llment.
Proposition 2: Freedom and Responsibility
A characteristic existential theme is that people are free to choose among alterna-
tives and therefore play a large role in shaping their own destiny. Schneider and
Krug (2010) write that existential therapy embraces three values: (1) the freedom to
become within the context of natural and self-imposed limitations; (2) the capacity
to refl ect on the meaning of our choices; and (3) the capacity to act on the choices we
make. A central existential concept is that although we long for freedom, we often try
to escape from our freedom by defi ning ourselves as a fi xed or static entity (Russell,
2007). We have no choice about being thrust into the world, yet the manner in
which we live and what we become are the result of our choices. Because of the real-
ity of this freedom, our task is to accept responsibility for directing our lives. How-
ever, it is possible to avoid this reality by making excuses. In speaking about “bad
faith,” the existential philosopher Jean-Paul Sartre (1971) refers to the inauthenticity
of not accepting personal responsibility. Here are two statements that reveal bad
faith: “Since that’s the way I’m made, I couldn’t help what I did” or “Naturally I’m
this way, because I grew up in a dysfunctional family.” An inauthentic mode of
existence consists of lacking awareness of personal responsibility for our lives and
passively assuming that our existence is largely controlled by external forces. Sartre
claims we are constantly confronted with the choice of what kind of person we are
becoming, and to exist is never to be fi nished with this kind of choosing.
Freedom implies that we are responsible for our lives, for our actions, and
for our failures to take action. From Sartre’s perspective people are condemned
to freedom. He calls for a commitment to choosing for ourselves. Existential guilt
is being aware of having evaded a commitment, or having chosen not to choose.
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 147 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

148
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
I
X
This guilt is a condition that grows out of a sense of incompleteness, or a realiza-
tion that we are not what we might have become. Guilt may be a sign that we have
failed to rise to the challenge of our anxiety and that we have tried to evade it by
not doing what we know is possible for us to do (van Deurzen, 2002a). This condi-
tion is not viewed as neurotic, nor is it seen as a symptom that needs to be cured.
Instead, the existential therapist explores it to see what clients can learn about the
ways in which they are living their life. This guilt also results from allowing others
to defi ne us or to make our choices for us. Sartre said, “We are our choices.”
Authenticity implies that we are living by being true to our own evaluation of what
is a valuable existence for ourselves; it is the courage to be who we are.
For existentialists, then, being free and being human are identical. Freedom
and responsibility go hand in hand. We are the authors of our lives in the sense
that we create our destiny, our life situation, and our problems (Russell, 1978).
Assuming responsibility is a basic condition for change. Clients who refuse to
accept responsibility by persistently blaming others for their problems are not
likely to profi t from therapy.
Frankl (1978) also links freedom with responsibility. He suggested that the
Statue of Liberty on the East Coast should be balanced with a Statue of Respon-
sibility on the West Coast. His basic premise is that freedom is bound by certain
limitations. We are not free from conditions, but we are free to take a stand against
these restrictions. Ultimately, these conditions are subject to our decisions, which
means we are responsible.
The therapist assists clients in discovering how they are avoiding freedom
and encourages them to learn to risk using it. Not to do so is to cripple clients
and make them dependent on the therapist. Therapists have the task of teaching
clients that they can explicitly accept that they have choices, even though they may
have devoted most of their life to evading them. Those who are in therapy often
have mixed feelings when it comes to choice. As Russell (2007) puts it: “We resent
it when we don’t have choices, but we get anxious when we do! Existentialism is all
about broadening the vision of our choices” (p. 111).
People often seek psychotherapy because they feel that they have lost control
of how they are living. They may look to the counselor to direct them, give them
advice, or produce magical cures. They may also need to be heard and understood.
Two central tasks of the therapist are inviting clients to recognize how they have
allowed others to decide for them and encouraging them to take steps toward
choosing for themselves. In inviting clients to explore other ways of being that are
more fulfi lling than their present restricted existence, some existential counselors
ask, “Although you have lived in a certain pattern, now that you recognize the price
of some of your ways, are you willing to consider creating new patterns?” Others
may have a vested interest in keeping the client in an old pattern, so the initiative
for changing it will have to come from the client.
Cultural factors need to be taken into account in assisting clients in the process
of examining their choices. A person who is struggling with feeling limited by her
family situation can be invited to look at her part in this process and values that
are a part of her culture. For example, Meta, a Norwegian American, is working to
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 148 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

149
E
X
I
S
T
E
N
T
I
A
L

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
attain a professional identity as a social worker, but her family thinks she is being
selfi sh and neglecting her primary duties. The family is likely to exert pressure on
her to give up her personal interests in favor of what they feel is best for the wel-
fare of the entire family. Meta may feel trapped in the situation and see no way out
unless she rejects what her family wants. In cases such as this, it is useful to
explore the client’s underlying values and to help her determine whether her values
are working for her and for her family. Clients such as Meta have the challenge of
weighing values and balancing behaviors between two cultures. Ultimately, Meta
must decide in what ways she might change her situation, and she needs to assess
values based on her culture. The existential therapist will invite Meta to begin to
explore what she can do and to realize that she can be authentic in spite of pres-
sures on her by her situation. According to Vontress (2008), we can be authentic
in any society, whether we are a part of an individualistic or collectivistic society.
It is essential to respect the purpose that people have in mind when they initiate
therapy. If we pay careful attention to what our clients tell us about what they want,
we can operate within an existential framework. We can encourage individuals to
weigh the alternatives and to explore the consequences of what they are doing with
their lives. Although oppressive forces may be severely limiting the quality of their
lives, we can help people see that they are not solely the victims of circumstances
beyond their control. Even though we sometimes cannot control things that hap-
pen to us, we have complete control over how we choose to perceive and handle
them. Although our freedom to act is limited by external reality, our freedom to
be relates to our internal reality. At the same time that people are learning how to
change their external environment, they can be challenged to look within them-
selves to recognize their own contributions to their problems. Through the therapy
experience, clients may be able to discover new courses of action that will lead to a
change in their situation.
Proposition 3: Striving for Identity
and Relationship to Others
People are concerned about preserving their uniqueness and centeredness, yet at
the same time they have an interest in going outside of themselves to relate to other
beings and to nature. Each of us would like to discover a self or, to put it more authen-
tically, to create our personal identity. This is not an automatic process, and creating
an identity takes courage. As relational beings, we also strive for connectedness with
others. Many existential writers discuss loneliness, uprootedness, and alienation,
which can be seen as the failure to develop ties with others and with nature.
The trouble with so many of us is that we have sought directions, answers,
values, and beliefs from the important people in our world. Rather than trusting
ourselves to search within and fi nd our own answers to the confl icts in our life, we
sell out by becoming what others expect of us. Our being becomes rooted in their
expectations, and we become strangers to ourselves.
t h e c o u r a g e t o b e Paul Tillich (1886–1965), a leading Protestant theolo-
gian of the 20th century, believes awareness of our fi nite nature gives us an appre-
ciation of ultimate concerns. It takes courage to discover the true “ground of our
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 149 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

150
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
I
X
being” and to use its power to transcend those aspects of nonbeing that would de-
stroy us (Tillich, 1952). Courage entails the will to move forward in spite of anxiety-
producing situations, such as facing our death (May, 1975). We struggle to discover,
to create, and to maintain the core deep within our being. One of the greatest fears
of clients is that they will discover that there is no core, no self, no substance, and
that they are merely refl ections of everyone’s expectations of them. A client may
say, “My fear is that I’ll discover I’m nobody, that there really is nothing to me.
I’ll fi nd out that I’m an empty shell, hollow inside, and nothing will exist if I shed
my masks.” If clients demonstrate the courage to confront these fears, they might
well leave therapy with an increased tolerance for the uncertainty of life. By assist-
ing clients in facing the fear that their lives or selves are empty and meaningless,
therapists can help clients to create a self that has meaning and substance that they
have chosen.
Existential therapists may begin by asking their clients to allow themselves to
intensify the feeling that they are nothing more than the sum of others’ expecta-
tions and that they are merely the introjects of parents and parent substitutes.
How do they feel now? Are they condemned to stay this way forever? Is there a way
out? Can they create a self if they fi nd that they are without one? Where can they
begin? Once clients have demonstrated the courage to recognize this fear, to put it
into words and share it, it does not seem so overwhelming. I fi nd that it is best to
begin work by inviting clients to accept the ways in which they have lived outside
themselves and to explore ways in which they are out of contact with themselves.
t h e e x p e r i e n c e o f a lo n e n e s s The existentialists postulate that part
of the human condition is the experience of aloneness. But they add that we can
derive strength from the experience of looking to ourselves and sensing our sepa-
ration. The sense of isolation comes when we recognize that we cannot depend on
anyone else for our own confi rmation; that is, we alone must give a sense of mean-
ing to life, and we alone must decide how we will live. If we are unable to tolerate
ourselves when we are alone, how can we expect anyone else to be enriched by our
company? Before we can have any solid relationship with another, we must have a
relationship with ourselves. We are challenged to learn to listen to ourselves. We
have to be able to stand alone before we can truly stand beside another.
There is a paradox in the proposition that humans are existentially both alone
and related, but this very paradox describes the human condition. To think that
we can cure the condition, or that it should be cured, is erroneous. Ultimately we
are alone, yet our aloneness is set in the context of our inevitable relatedness to
other people.
t h e e x p e r i e n c e o f r e l at e d n e s s We humans depend on relationships
with others. We want to be signifi cant in another’s world, and we want to feel that
another’s presence is important in our world. When we are able to stand alone and
tap into our own strength, our relationships with others are based on our fulfi ll-
ment, not our deprivation. If we feel personally deprived, however, we can expect
little but a clinging and symbiotic relationship with someone else.
Perhaps one of the functions of therapy is to help clients distinguish between a
neurotically dependent attachment to another and a life-affi rming relationship in
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 150 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

151
E
X
I
S
T
E
N
T
I
A
L

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
which both persons are enhanced. The therapist can challenge clients to examine
what they get from their relationships, how they avoid intimate contact, how they
prevent themselves from having equal relationships, and how they might create
therapeutic, healthy, and mature human relationships. Existential therapists speak
of intersubjectivity, which is the fact of our interrelatedness with others and the
need for us to struggle with this in a creative way.
s t r u g g l i n g w i t h o u r i d e n t i t y Because of our fear of dealing with
our aloneness, Farha (1994) points out that some of us get caught up in ritualis-
tic behavior patterns that cement us to an image or identity we acquired in early
childhood. He writes that some of us become trapped in a doing mode to avoid the
experience of being.
Part of the therapeutic journey consists of the therapist challenging clients
to begin to examine the ways in which they have lost touch with their identity,
especially by letting others design their life for them. The therapy process itself
is often frightening for clients when they realize that they have surrendered their
freedom to others and that in the therapy relationship they will have to assume
their freedom again. By refusing to give easy solutions or answers, existential
therapists confront clients with the reality that they alone must fi nd their own
answers.
Proposition 4: The Search for Meaning
A distinctly human characteristic is the struggle for a sense of signifi cance and
purpose in life. In my experience the underlying confl icts that bring people into
counseling and therapy are centered in these existential questions: “Why am I
here?” “What do I want from life?” “What gives my life purpose?” “Where is the
source of meaning for me in life?”
Existential therapy can provide the conceptual framework for helping clients
challenge the meaning in their lives. Questions that the therapist might ask are,
“Do you like the direction of your life?” “Are you pleased with what you now are
and what you are becoming?” “If you are confused about who you are and what you
want for yourself, what are you doing to get some clarity?”
t h e p r o b l e m o f d i s c a r d i n g o l d va l u e s One of the problems in
therapy is that clients may discard traditional (and imposed) values without creat-
ing other, suitable ones to replace them. What does the therapist do when clients
no longer cling to values that they never really challenged or internalized and now
experience a vacuum? Clients may report that they feel like a boat without a rudder.
They seek new guidelines and values that are appropriate for the newly discovered
facets of themselves, and yet for a time they are without them. One of the tasks of
the therapeutic process is to help clients create a value system based on a way of
living that is consistent with their way of being.
The therapist’s job is to trust in the capacity of clients to eventually create an
internally derived value system that provides the foundation for a meaningful life.
They will no doubt fl ounder for a time and experience anxiety as a result of the
absence of clear-cut values. The therapist’s trust is important in helping clients
trust their own capacity to create a new source of values.
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 151 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

152
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
I
X
m e a n i n g l e s s n e s s When the world they live in seems meaningless, clients
may wonder whether it is worth it to continue struggling or even living. Faced with
the prospect of our mortality, we might ask, “Is there any point to what I do now,
since I will eventually die? Will what I do be forgotten when I am gone? Given the
fact of mortality, why should I busy myself with anything?” A man in one of my
groups captured precisely the idea of personal signifi cance when he said, “I feel
like another page in a book that has been turned quickly, and nobody bothered to
read the page.” For Frankl (1978) such a feeling of meaninglessness is the major
existential neurosis of modern life.
Meaninglessness in life can lead to emptiness and hollowness, or a condition
that Frankl calls the existential vacuum. This condition is often experienced when
people do not busy themselves with routine or with work. Because there is no
preordained design for living, people are faced with the task of creating their own
meaning. At times people who feel trapped by the emptiness of life withdraw from
the struggle of creating a life with purpose. Experiencing meaninglessness and
establishing values that are part of a meaningful life are issues that become the
heart of counseling.
c r e at i n g n e w m e a n i n g Logotherapy is designed to help clients fi nd
meaning in life. The therapist’s function is not to tell clients what their particular
meaning in life should be but to point out that they can create meaning even in suf-
fering (Frankl, 1978). This view holds that human suffering (the tragic and negative
aspects of life) can be turned into human achievement by the stand an individual
takes when faced with it. Frankl also contends that people who confront pain, guilt,
despair, and death can effectively deal with their despair and thus triumph.
Yet meaning is not something that we can directly search for and obtain. Para-
doxically, the more rationally we seek it, the more likely we are to miss it. Frankl
(1978) and Yalom and Josselson (2011) are in basic agreement that, like pleasure,
meaning must be pursued obliquely. Finding satisfaction and meaning in life is
a by-product of engagement, which is a commitment to creating, loving, working,
and building. Meaning is created out of an individual’s engagement with what is
valued, and this commitment provides the purpose that makes life worthwhile
(van Deurzen, 2002a). I like the way Vontress (2008) captures the idea that mean-
ing in life is an ongoing process we struggle with throughout our lives: “What
provides meaning one day may not provide meaning the next, and what has been
meaningful to a person throughout life may be meaningless when a person is on
his or her deathbed” (p. 158).
Proposition 5: Anxiety as a Condition of Living
Anxiety arises from one’s personal strivings to survive and to maintain and as-
sert one’s being, and the feelings anxiety generates are an inevitable aspect of the
human condition. Existential anxiety is the unavoidable result of being confronted
with the “givens of existence”—death, freedom, choice, isolation, and meaningless-
ness (Vontress, 2008; Yalom, 1980; Yalom & Josselson, 2011). Existential anxiety
arises as we recognize the realities of our mortality, our confrontation with pain and
suffering, our need to struggle for survival, and our basic fallibility. We experience
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 152 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

153
E
X
I
S
T
E
N
T
I
A
L

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
this anxiety as we become increasingly aware of our freedom and the consequenc-
es of accepting or rejecting that freedom. In fact, when we make a decision that
involves reconstruction of our life, the accompanying anxiety can be a signal that we
are ready for personal change and can be a stimulus for growth. If we learn to listen
to the subtle messages of anxiety, we can dare to take the steps necessary to change
the direction of our lives.
Existential therapists differentiate between normal and neurotic anxiety, and
they see anxiety as a potential source of growth. Normal anxiety is an appropriate
response to an event being faced. Further, this kind of anxiety does not have to
be repressed, and it can be used as a motivation to change. Because we could not
survive without some anxiety, it is not a therapeutic goal to eliminate normal anxi-
ety. Existential philosophers have argued that at the root of our normal (or ontic)
anxiety, which is an appropriate anxiety that relates to concrete things in the world,
is a more fundamental existential (or ontological) anxiety, which is based on our
awareness of our own temporality and is present even when we do not have to face
particularly diffi cult situations. Neurotic anxiety, in contrast, is anxiety about con-
crete things that is out of proportion to the situation. Neurotic anxiety is typically
out of awareness, and it tends to immobilize the person. Being psychologically
healthy entails living with as little neurotic anxiety as possible, while accepting and
struggling with the unavoidable existential anxiety that is a part of living.
Many people who seek counseling want solutions that will enable them to elimi-
nate anxiety. Attempts to avoid anxiety by creating the illusion that there is security
in life may help us cope with the unknown, yet we really know on some level that
we are deceiving ourselves when we think we have found fi xed security. Facing
existential anxiety involves viewing life as an adventure rather than hiding behind
imagined securities that seem to offer protection. Opening up to new life means
opening up to anxiety. We pay a steep price when we short-circuit anxiety.
People who have the courage to face themselves are, nonetheless, frightened. I
am convinced that those who are willing to live with their anxiety for a time profi t
from personal therapy. Those who fl ee too quickly into comfortable patterns might
experience temporary relief but in the long run seem to experience the frustration
of being stuck in old ways.
The existential therapist can help clients recognize that learning how to tolerate
ambiguity and uncertainty and how to live without props can be a necessary phase in
the journey from dependence to autonomy. The therapist and client can explore the
possibility that although breaking away from crippling patterns and building new
ways of living will be fraught with anxiety for a while, anxiety will diminish as the cli-
ent experiences more satisfaction with newer ways of being. When a client becomes
more self-confi dent, the anxiety that results from an expectation of catastrophe is
likely to decrease.
Proposition 6: Awareness of Death and Nonbeing
The existentialist does not view death negatively but holds that awareness of death
as a basic human condition gives signifi cance to living. A distinguishing human
characteristic is the ability to grasp the reality of the future and the inevitability of
death. It is necessary to think about death if we are to think signifi cantly about life.
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 153 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

154
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
I
X
Death should not be considered a threat; death provides the motivation for us to
take advantage of appreciating the present moment. Instead of being frozen by the
fear of death, death can be viewed as a positive force that enables us to live as fully
as possible. Although the notion of death is a wake-up call, it is also something
that we strive to avoid (Russell, 2007). If we defend ourselves against the reality
of our eventual death, life becomes insipid and meaningless. But if we realize that
we are mortal, we know that we do not have an eternity to complete our projects
and that the present is crucial. Our awareness of death is the source of zest for life
and creativity. Death and life are interdependent, and though physical death de-
stroys us, the idea of death saves us (Yalom, 1980, 2003).
Yalom (2008) recommends that therapists talk directly to clients about the
reality of death. He believes the fear of death percolates beneath the surface and
haunts us throughout life. Death is a visitor in the therapeutic process, and Yalom
believes that ignoring its presence sends the message that death is too overwhelm-
ing to explore. Confronting this fear can be the factor that helps us transform an
inauthentic mode of living into a more authentic one. Accepting the reality of our
personal death can result in a massive shift in the way we live in the world (Yalom &
Josselson, 2011). We can turn our fear of death into a positive force when we accept
the reality of our mortality. In Staring at the Sun: Overcoming the Terror of Death,
Yalom (2008) develops the idea that confronting death enables us to live in a more
compassionate way.
One focus in existential therapy is on exploring the degree to which clients
are doing the things they value. Without being morbidly preoccupied by the ever-
present threat of nonbeing, clients can develop a healthy awareness of death as a
way to evaluate how well they are living and what changes they want to make in
their lives. Those who fear death also fear life. When we emotionally accept the
reality of our eventual death, we realize more clearly that our actions do count, that
we do have choices, and that we must accept the ultimate responsibility for how
well we are living (Corey & Corey, 2010).
t h e t h e r a p e u t i c p r o c e s s
Therapeutic Goals
Existential therapy is best considered as an invitation to clients to recognize the
ways in which they are not living fully authentic lives and to make choices that
will lead to their becoming what they are capable of being. An aim of therapy is to
assist clients in moving toward authenticity and learning to recognize when they
are deceiving themselves (van Deurzen, 2002a). The existential orientation holds
that there is no escape from freedom as we will always be held responsible. We can
relinquish our freedom, however, which is the ultimate inauthenticity. Existential
therapy aims at helping clients face anxiety and engage in action that is based on
the authentic purpose of creating a worthy existence.
May (1981) contends that people come to therapy with the self-serving illu-
sion that they are inwardly enslaved and that someone else (the therapist) can free
them. Existential therapists are mainly concerned about helping people to reclaim
and reown their lives. The task of existential therapy is to teach clients to listen to
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 154 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

155
E
X
I
S
T
E
N
T
I
A
L

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
what they already know about themselves, even though they may not be attend-
ing to what they know. Schneider and Krug (2010) identify four essential aims of
existential-humanistic therapy: (1) to help clients become more present to both
themselves and others; (2) to assist clients in identifying ways they block them-
selves from fuller presence; (3) to challenge clients to assume responsibility for de-
signing their present lives; and (4) to encourage clients to choose more expanded
ways of being in their daily lives.
Increased awareness is the central goal of existential therapy, which allows
clients to discover that alternative possibilities exist where none were recognized
before. Clients come to realize that they are able to make changes in their way of
being in the world.
Therapist’s Function and Role
Existential therapists are primarily concerned with understanding the subjective
world of clients to help them come to new understandings and options. Existen-
tial therapists are especially concerned about clients avoiding responsibility; they
consistently invite clients to accept personal responsibility. When clients complain
about the predicaments they are in and blame others, the therapist is likely to ask
them how they contributed to their situation.
Therapists with an existential orientation usually deal with people who have
what could be called a restricted existence. These clients have a limited aware-
ness of themselves and are often vague about the nature of their problems. They
may see few, if any, options for dealing with life situations, and they tend to feel
trapped, helpless, and stuck. For Bugental (1997), a therapist’s function is to assist
clients in seeing the ways in which they constrict their awareness and the cost of
such constrictions. The therapist may hold up a mirror, so to speak, so that clients
can gradually engage in self-confrontation. In this way clients can see how they be-
came the way they are and how they might enlarge the way they live. Once clients
are aware of factors in their past and of stifl ing modes of their present existence,
they can begin to accept responsibility for changing their future.
Existential practitioners may make use of techniques that originate from
diverse theoretical orientations, yet no set of techniques is considered essen-
tial. The therapeutic journey is creative and uncertain and different for each cli-
ent. Russell (2007) captures this notion well when he writes: “There is no one
right way to do therapy, and certainly no rigid doctrine for existentially rooted
techniques. What is crucial is that you create your own authentic way of being
attuned to your clients” (p. 123). Existential therapists encourage experimenta-
tion not only within the therapy offi ce but also outside of the therapy setting,
based on the belief that life outside therapy is what counts. Practitioners often
ask clients to refl ect on or write about problematic events they encounter in daily
life (Schneider, 2011).
Client’s Experience in Therapy
Clients in existential therapy are clearly encouraged to assume responsibility for
how they are currently choosing to be in their world. Effective therapy does not stop
with this awareness itself, for the therapist encourages clients to take action on the
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 155 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

156
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
I
X
basis of the insights they develop through the therapeutic process. Experimentation
with new ways of behaving in the outside world is necessary if clients are to change.
Further, clients must be active in the therapeutic process, for during the sessions
they must decide what fears, guilt feelings, and anxieties they will explore.
Merely deciding to enter psychotherapy is itself a frightening prospect for most
people. The experience of opening the doors to oneself can be frightening, excit-
ing, joyful, depressing, or a combination of all of these. As clients wedge open the
closed doors, they also begin to loosen the deterministic shackles that have kept
them psychologically bound. Gradually, they become aware of what they have been
and who they are now, and they are better able to decide what kind of future they
want. Through the process of their therapy, individuals can explore alternatives for
making their visions real.
When clients plead helplessness and attempt to convince themselves that they
are powerless, May (1981) reminds them that their journey toward freedom began
by putting one foot in front of the other to get to his offi ce. As narrow as their range
of freedom may be, individuals can begin building and augmenting that range by
taking small steps. The therapeutic journey that opens up new horizons is poeti-
cally described by van Deurzen (2010):
Embarking on our existential journey requires us to be prepared to be touched and shaken by
what we fi nd on the way and to not be afraid to discover our own limitations and weaknesses,
uncertainties and doubts. It is only with such an attitude of openness and wonder that we can
encounter the impenetrable everyday mysteries, which take us beyond our own preoccupa-
tions and sorrows and which by confronting us with death, make us rediscover life. (p. 5)
Another aspect of the experience of being a client in existential therapy is confront-
ing ultimate concerns rather than coping with immediate problems. Rather than
being solution-oriented, existential therapy is aimed toward removing roadblocks
to meaningful living and helping clients assume responsibility for their actions
(Yalom & Josselson, 2011). Existential therapists assist people in facing life with
courage, hope, and a willingness to fi nd meaning in life.
Relationship Between Therapist and Client
Existential therapists give central prominence to their relationship with the client.
The relationship is important in itself because the quality of this person-to-person
encounter in the therapeutic situation is the stimulus for positive change. Atten-
tion is given to the client’s immediate, ongoing experience, especially what is go-
ing on in the interaction between the therapist and the client. Therapy is viewed
as a social microcosm in the sense that the interpersonal and existential problems
of the client will become apparent in the here and now of the therapy relationship
(Yalom & Josselson, 2011).
Therapists with an existential orientation believe their basic attitudes toward the
client and their own personal characteristics of honesty, integrity, and courage are
what they have to offer. Therapy is a journey taken by therapist and client that delves
deeply into the world as perceived and experienced by the client. But this type of quest
demands that therapists also be in contact with their own phenomenological world.
Existential therapy is a voyage into self-discovery and a journey of life-discovery
for both client and therapist (van Deurzen, 2010; Yalom & Josselson, 2011).
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 156 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

157
E
X
I
S
T
E
N
T
I
A
L

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Buber’s (1970) conception of the I/Thou relationship has signifi cant implica-
tions here. His understanding of the self is based on two fundamental relation-
ships: the “I/it” and the “I/Thou.” The I/it is the relation to time and space, which
is a necessary starting place for the self. The I/Thou is the relationship essential
for connecting the self to the spirit and, in so doing, to achieve true dialogue. This
form of relationship is the paradigm of the fully human self, the achievement of
which is the goal of Buber’s existential philosophy. Relating in an I/Thou fashion
means that there is direct, mutual, and present interaction. Rather than prizing
therapeutic objectivity and professional distance, existential therapists strive to cre-
ate caring and intimate relationships with clients.
The core of the therapeutic relationship is respect, which implies faith in
clients’ potential to cope authentically with their troubles and in their ability to
discover alternative ways of being. Existential therapists share their reactions to
clients with genuine concern and empathy as one way of deepening the therapeu-
tic relationship. Therapists invite clients to grow by modeling authentic behavior.
If therapists keep themselves hidden during the therapeutic session or if they en-
gage in inauthentic behavior, clients will also remain guarded and persist in their
inauthentic ways.
Bugental (1987) emphasizes the crucial role the presence of the therapist plays
in the therapeutic relationship. In his view many therapists and therapeutic sys-
tems overlook its fundamental importance. He contends that therapists are too
often so concerned with the content of what is being said that they are not aware of
the distance between themselves and their clients:
The therapeutic alliance is the powerful joining of forces which energizes and supports the
long, diffi cult, and frequently painful work of life-changing psychotherapy. The conception
of the therapist here is not of a disinterested observer-technician but of a fully alive human
companion for the client. (p. 49)
Schneider (2011) believes that the therapist’s presence is both a condition and a goal
of therapeutic change. Presence serves the dual functions of reconnecting people
to their pain and to attuning them to the opportunities to transform their pain.
a p p l i c at i o n : t h e r a p e u t i c
t e c h n i q u e s a n d p r o c e d u r e s
The existential approach is unlike most other therapies in that it is not technique-
oriented. Although existentially oriented therapists may incorporate many tech-
niques from other models, these interventions are made within the context of striv-
ing to understand the subjective world of the client. The interventions existential
practitioners employ are based on philosophical views about the nature of human
existence. These practitioners prefer description, understanding, and exploration
of the client’s subjective reality, as opposed to diagnosis, treatment, and prognosis
(van Deurzen, 2002b). As Vontress (2008) puts it: “Existential therapists prefer
to be thought of as philosophical companions, not as people who repair psyches”
(p. 161). Yalom and Josselson (2011) assert that existential therapists are “fel-
low travelers” (p. 332), willing to make themselves known through appropriate
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 157 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

158
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
I
X
self-disclosure. As mentioned earlier, existential therapists are free to draw from
techniques that fl ow from many other orientations. However, they do not employ an
array of unintegrated techniques; they have a set of assumptions and attitudes that
guide their interventions with clients. See Case Approach to Counseling and Psycho-
therapy (Corey, 2013, chap. 4) for an illustration of how Dr. J. Michael Russell works
in an existential way with some key themes in the case of Ruth.
Van Deurzen (2010) identifi es as a primary ground rule of existential work the
openness to the individual creativity of the therapist and the client. She maintains
that existential therapists need to adapt their interventions to their own person-
ality and style, as well as being sensitive to what each client requires. The main
guideline is that the existential practitioner’s interventions are responsive to the
uniqueness of each client.
Van Deurzen (2002a, 2002b) believes that the starting point for existential
work is for practitioners to clarify their views on life and living. She stresses the
importance of therapists reaching suffi cient depth and openness in their own lives
to venture into clients’ murky waters without getting lost. The nature of existential
work is assisting people in the process of living with greater expertise and ease.
Van Deurzen (2010) identifi es how therapists make a difference with clients: “We
help them to get better at refl ecting on their situation, deal with their dilemma,
face their predicament and think for themselves” (p. 236). Van Deurzen reminds
us that existential therapy is a collaborative adventure in which both client and
therapist will be transformed if they allow themselves to be touched by life. When
the deepest self of the therapist meets the deepest part of the client, the counseling
process is at its best. Therapy is a creative, evolving process of discovery that can be
conceptualized in three general phases.
Phases of Existential Counseling
During the initial phase of counseling, therapists assist clients in identifying
and clarifying their assumptions about the world. Clients are invited to defi ne and
question the ways in which they perceive and make sense of their existence. They
examine their values, beliefs, and assumptions to determine their validity. This is
a diffi cult task for many clients because they may initially present their problems
as resulting almost entirely from external causes. They may focus on what other
people “make them feel” or on how others are largely responsible for their actions
or inaction. The counselor teaches them how to refl ect on their own existence and
to examine their role in creating their problems in living.
During the middle phase of existential counseling, clients are assisted in more
fully examining the source and authority of their present value system. This proc-
ess of self-exploration typically leads to new insights and some restructuring of
values and attitudes. Individuals get a better idea of what kind of life they consider
worthy to live and develop a clearer sense of their internal valuing process.
The fi nal phase of existential counseling focuses on helping people take what
they are learning about themselves and put it into action. Transformation is not
limited to what takes place during the therapy hour. The therapeutic hour is a
small contribution to a person’s renewed engagement with life, or a rehearsal
for life (van Deurzen, 2002b). The aim of therapy is to enable clients to discover
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 158 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

159
E
X
I
S
T
E
N
T
I
A
L

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
ways of implementing their examined and internalized values in a concrete way
between sessions and after therapy has terminated. Clients typically discover their
strengths and fi nd ways to put them to the service of living a purposeful existence.
Clients Appropriate for Existential Counseling
Existential practice has been applied in a variety of settings and with a diverse pop-
ulation of clients, including those with substance abuse issues, ethnic and racial
minorities, gay and lesbian clients, and psychiatric inpatients (Schneider, 2011). A
strength of the perspective is its focus on available choices and pathways toward
personal growth. For people who are coping with developmental crises, experienc-
ing grief and loss, confronting death, or facing a major life decision, existential
therapy is especially appropriate. Some examples of these critical turning points
that mark passages from one stage of life into another are the struggle for identity
in adolescence, coping with possible disappointments in middle age, adjusting to
children leaving home, coping with failures in marriage and work, and dealing
with increased physical limitations as one ages. These developmental challenges
involve both dangers and opportunities. Uncertainty, anxiety, and struggling with
decisions are all part of this process.
Van Deurzen (2002b) suggests that this form of therapy is most appropriate
for clients who are committed to dealing with their problems about living, for peo-
ple who feel alienated from the current expectations of society, or for those who
are searching for meaning in their lives. It tends to work well with people who
are at a crossroads and who question the state of affairs in the world and are will-
ing to challenge the status quo. It can be useful for people who are on the edge of
existence, such as those who are dying or contemplating suicide, who are working
through a developmental or situational crisis, who feel that they no longer belong
in their surroundings, or who are starting a new phase of life.
Application to Brief Therapy
The existential approach can focus clients on signifi cant areas such as assuming
personal responsibility, making a commitment to deciding and acting, and ex-
panding their awareness of their current situation. It is possible for a time-limited
approach to serve as a catalyst for clients to become actively and fully involved in
each of their therapy sessions. Strasser and Strasser (1997), who are connected to
the British school of existential analysis, maintain that there are clear benefi ts to
time-limited therapy, which mirrors the time-limited reality of human existence.
Sharp and Bugental (2001) maintain that short-term applications of the existential
approach require more structuring and clearly defi ned and less ambitious goals.
At the termination of short-term therapy, it is important for individuals to evaluate
what they have accomplished and what issues may need to be addressed later. It is
essential that both therapist and client determine that short-term work is appropri-
ate, and that benefi cial outcomes are likely.
Application to Group Counseling
An existential group can be described as people making a commitment to a lifelong
journey of self-exploration with these goals: (1) enabling members to become honest
with themselves, (2) widening their perspectives on themselves and the world
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 159 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

160
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
I
X
around them, and (3) clarifying what gives meaning to their present and future life
(van Deurzen, 2002b). An open attitude toward life is essential, as is the willingness
to explore unknown territory. Recurring universal themes evolve in many groups
and challenge members to seriously explore existential concerns such as choice,
freedom and anxiety, awareness of death, meaning in life, and living fully.
Yalom (1980) contends that the group provides the optimal conditions for
therapeutic work on responsibility. The members are responsible for the way they
behave in the group, and this provides a mirror for how they are likely to act in
the world. A group represents a microcosm of the world in which participants live
and function. Over time the interpersonal and existential problems of the partici-
pants become evident in the here-and-now interactions within the group (Yalom &
Josselson, 2011). Through feedback, members learn to view themselves through
others’ eyes, and they learn the ways in which their behavior affects others. Build-
ing on what members learn about their interpersonal functioning in the group,
they can take increased responsibility for making changes in everyday life. The
group experience provides the opportunity to participants to relate to others in
meaningful ways, to learn to be themselves in the company of other people, and to
establish rewarding, nourishing relationships.
In existential group counseling, members come to terms with the paradoxes of
existence: that life can be undone by death, that success is precarious, that we are
determined to be free, that we are responsible for a world we did not choose, that
we must make choices in the face of doubt and uncertainty. Members experience
anxiety when they recognize the realities of the human condition, including pain
and suffering, the need to struggle for survival, and their basic fallibility. Clients
learn that there are no ultimate answers for ultimate concerns. Through the sup-
port that is within a group, participants are able to tap the strength needed to create
an internally derived value system that is consistent with their way of being.
A group provides a powerful context to look at oneself, and to consider what
choices might be more authentically one’s own. Members can openly share their
fears related to living in unfulfi lling ways and come to recognize how they have
compromised their integrity. Members can gradually discover ways in which they
have lost their direction and can begin to be more true to themselves. Members
learn that it is not in others that they fi nd the answers to questions about signifi –
cance and purpose in life. Existential group leaders help members live in authentic
ways and refrain from prescribing simple solutions. For a more detailed discus-
sion of the existential approach to group counseling, see Corey (2012, chap. 9).
e x i s t e n t i a l t h e r a p y f r o m a
m u lt i c u lt u r a l p e r s p e c t i v e
Strengths From a Diversity Perspective
Because the existential approach does not dictate a particular way of viewing or relat-
ing to reality, and because of its broad perspective, this approach is highly relevant in
working in a multicultural context (van Deurzen, 2002a). Vontress and colleagues
(1999) write about the existential foundation of cross-cultural counseling: “Existential
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 160 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

161
E
X
I
S
T
E
N
T
I
A
L

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
counseling is probably the most useful approach to helping clients of all cultures fi nd
meaning and harmony in their lives, because it focuses on the sober issues each of us
must inevitably face: love, anxiety, suffering, and death” (p. 32). These are the human
experiences that transcend the boundaries that separate cultures.
Existential therapy is useful in working with culturally diverse clients because
of its focus on universality, or the common ground that we all share. This approach
emphasizes presence, the I/Thou relationship, and courage. As such, it can be
effectively applied with diverse client populations with a range of specifi c problems
and in a wide array of settings (Schneider, 2008, 2011; Schneider & Krug, 2010).
Schneider’s (2008) “existential-integrative” model of practice coordinates a variety
of therapeutic modes within an overarching existential or experiential framework.
Vontress (1996) points out that all people are multicultural in the sense that they
are all products of many cultures. He encourages counselors-in-training to focus
on the universal commonalities of clients fi rst and secondarily on areas of differ-
ences. In working with cultural diversity, it is essential to recognize simultaneously
the commonalities and differences of human beings: “Cross-cultural counseling,
in short, does not intend to teach specifi c interventions for each culture, but to
infuse the counselor with a cultural sensitivity and tolerant philosophical outlook
that will befi t all cultures” (p. 164).
The focus on subjective experience, or phenomenology, is a strength from a
multicultural perspective. Another strength of the existential approach is that it
enables clients to examine the degree to which their behavior is being infl uenced
by social and cultural conditioning. Clients can be challenged to look at the price
they are paying for the decisions they have made. Although it is true that some
clients may not feel a sense of freedom, their freedom can be increased if they
recognize the social limits they are facing. Their freedom can be hindered by insti-
tutions and limited by their family. In fact, it may be diffi cult to separate individual
freedom from the context of their family structure.
There is wide-ranging international interest in the existential approach. Several
Scandinavian societies, an East European society (encompassing Estonia, Latvia,
Lithuania, Russia, Ukraine, and Belarus), and Mexican and South American socie-
ties are thriving. In addition, an Internet course, SEPTIMUS, is taught in Ireland,
Iceland, Sweden, Poland, Czech Republic, Romania, Italy, Portugal, France, Belgium,
the United Kingdom, Israel, and Australia. Most recently, the First International East-
West Existential Psychology conference was held in Nanjing, China, with representa-
tives from the United States, Korea, and Japan. These international developments, as
well as the creation of the International Collaborative of Existential Counselors and
Psychotherapists, which has members from all over the world, reveal that existential
therapy has wide appeal to diverse populations in many parts of the world.
Shortcomings From a Diversity Perspective
For those who hold a systemic perspective, the existentialists can be criticized on the
grounds that they are excessively individualistic and that they ignore the social factors
that cause human problems. However, with the advent of the “existential-integrative”
model of practice (Schneider, 2008), this situation is beginning to change. According
to Schneider (2011), existential practitioners are not only concerned with facilitating
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 161 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

162
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
I
X
individual change but with promoting an in-depth inquiry that has implications for
social change: “One cannot simply heal individuals to the neglect of the social con-
text within which they are thrust. To be a responsible practitioner, one must develop
a vision of responsible social change alongside and in coordination with one’s vision
of individual transformation” (p. 281).
Some individuals who seek counseling may operate on the assumption that
they have very little choice because environmental circumstances severely restrict
their ability to infl uence the direction of their lives. Even if they change internal-
ly, they see little hope that the external realities of racism, discrimination, and
oppression will change. They are likely to experience a deep sense of frustration and
feelings of powerlessness when it comes to making changes outside of themselves.
As you will see in Chapter 12, feminist therapists maintain that therapeutic practice
will be effective only to the extent that therapists intervene with some form of social
action to change those factors that are creating clients’ problems. In working with
people of color who come from the barrio or ghetto, for example, it is important to
engage their survival issues. If a counselor too quickly puts across the message to
these clients that they have a choice in making their lives better, they may feel pa-
tronized and misunderstood. These real-life concerns can provide a good focus for
counseling, assuming the therapist is willing to deal with them.
A potential problem within existential theory is that it is highly focused on the
philosophical assumption of self-determination, which may not take into account
the complex factors that many people who have been oppressed must deal with. In
many cultures it is not possible to talk about the self and self-determination apart
from the context of the social network and environmental conditions. However,
a case can be made for the existential approach being instrumental in enabling
clients to make conscious choices when it comes to the values they live by. Existen-
tial therapists do not push autonomy apart from a client’s culture. They do assist
clients in critically evaluating the source of their values and making a choice rather
than uncritically accepting the values of their culture and family.
Many clients expect a structured and problem-oriented approach to counseling
that is not found in the conventional existential approach. Although clients may
feel better if they have an opportunity to talk and to be understood, they are likely to
expect the counselor to do something to bring about a change in their life situation.
A major task for the counselor who practices from an existential perspective is to
provide enough concrete direction for these clients without taking the responsibility
away from them.
As an existentially oriented therapist, I
counsel Stan with the assumption that
he has the capacity to increase his
self-awareness and decide for himself the future
direction of his life. I want him to realize more
than anything else that he does not have to be
the victim of his past conditioning but can be the
architect in redesigning his future. He can free
himself of his deterministic shackles and
accept the responsibility that comes with
directing his own life. This approach emphasizes
the importance of my understanding of Stan’s
Existential Therapy Applied to the Case of Stan
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 162 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

world, primarily by establishing an authentic
relationship as a means to a fuller degree of
self-understanding.
Stan is demonstrating what Sartre would call
“bad faith” by not accepting personal respon-
sibility. I confront Stan with the ways in which
he is attempting to escape from his freedom
through alcohol and drugs. Eventually, I chal-
lenge Stan’s passivity. I reaffirm that he is now
entirely responsible for his life, for his actions,
and for his failure to take action. I do this in a
supportive yet firm manner.
I do not see Stan’s anxiety as something
negative, but as a vital part of living with uncer-
tainty and freedom. Because there are no guar-
antees and because the individual is ultimately
alone, Stan can expect to experience some degree
of healthy anxiety, aloneness, guilt, and even
despair. These conditions are not neurotic in
themselves, but the way in which Stan orients
himself and copes with these conditions is critical.
Stan sometimes talks about his suicidal feel-
ings. Certainly, I investigate further to determine
if he poses an immediate threat to himself. In
addition to this assessment to determine lethality,
I view his thoughts of “being better off dead” as
symbolic. Could it be that Stan feels he is dying
as a person? Is Stan using his human potential?
Is he choosing a way of merely existing instead
of affirming life? Is Stan mainly trying to elicit
sympathy from his family? I invite Stan to explore
the meaning and purpose in his life. Is there any
reason for him to want to continue living? What
are some of the projects that enrich his life? What
can he do to find a sense of purpose that will
make him feel more significant and alive?
Stan needs to accept the reality that he may
at times feel alone. Choosing for oneself and
living from one’s own center accentuates the
experience of aloneness. He is not, however,
condemned to a life of isolation, alienation from
others, and loneliness. I hope to help Stan dis-
cover his own centeredness and live by the values
he chooses and creates for himself. By doing so,
Stan can become a more substantial person and
come to appreciate himself more. When he does,
the chances are lessened that he will have a need
to secure approval from others, particularly his
parents and parental substitutes. Instead of form-
ing a dependent relationship, Stan could choose
to relate to others out of his strength. Only then
would there be the possibility of overcoming his
feelings of separateness and isolation.
Follow-Up: You Continue as
Stan’s Existential Therapist
Use these questions to help you think about
how you would counsel Stan using an existential
approach:
• If Stan resisted your attempts to help him see
that he is responsible for the direction of his
life, how might you intervene?
• Stan experiences a great deal of anxiety. From
an existential perspective, how do you view his
anxiety? How might you work with his anxiety
in helpful ways?
• If Stan talks with you about suicide as a re-
sponse to despair and a life without meaning,
how would you respond?
See the DVD for Theory and Practice of
Counseling and Psychotherapy: The Case
of Stan and Lecturettes (Session 4 on existential
therapy) for a demonstration of my approach
to counseling Stan from this perspective. This
session focuses on the themes of death and the
meaning of life.
163
E
X
I
S
T
E
N
T
I
A
L

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
s u m m a ry a n d e va l u at i o n
Summary
As humans, according to the existentialist view, we are capable of self-awareness,
which is the distinctive capacity that allows us to refl ect and to decide. With this
awareness we become free beings who are responsible for choosing the way we live,
and we infl uence our own destiny. This awareness of freedom and responsibility
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 163 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

164
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
I
X
gives rise to existential anxiety, which is another basic human characteristic. Wheth-
er we like it or not, we are free, even though we may seek to avoid refl ecting on this
freedom. The knowledge that we must choose, even though the outcome is not cer-
tain, leads to anxiety. This anxiety is heightened when we refl ect on the reality that
we are mortal. Facing the inevitable prospect of eventual death gives the present
moment signifi cance, for we become aware that we do not have forever to accom-
plish our projects. Our task is to create a life that has meaning and purpose. As
humans we are unique in that we strive toward fashioning purposes and values that
give meaning to living. Whatever meaning our life has is developed through free-
dom and a commitment to make choices in the face of uncertainty.
Existential therapy places central prominence on the person-to-person relation-
ship. It assumes that client growth occurs through this genuine encounter. It is not
the techniques a therapist uses that make a therapeutic difference; rather, it is the
quality of the client–therapist relationship that heals. It is essential that therapists
reach suffi cient depth and openness in their own lives to allow them to venture
into their clients’ subjective world without losing their own sense of identity. Pres-
ence is both a condition for therapy to occur and a goal of therapy. Existential thera-
pists are fellow travelers, and as such they strive to be authentic and self-disclosing
in their therapy work. Because this approach focuses on the goals of therapy, ba-
sic conditions of being human, and therapy as a shared journey, practitioners are
not bound by specifi c techniques. Although existential therapists may apply tech-
niques from other orientations, their interventions are guided by a philosophical
framework about what it means to be human.
Contributions of the Existential Approach
The existential approach has helped bring the person back into central focus. It
concentrates on the central facts of human existence: self-consciousness and our
consequent freedom. To the existentialist goes the credit for providing a new view
of death as a positive force, not a morbid prospect to fear, for death gives life mean-
ing. Existentialists have contributed a new dimension to the understanding of anx-
iety, guilt, frustration, loneliness, and alienation.
I particularly appreciate the way van Deurzen (2002a) views the existential
practitioner as a mentor and fellow traveler who encourages people to refl ect upon
the problems they encounter in living. What clients need is “some assistance in
surveying the terrain and in deciding on the right route so that they can again fi nd
their way” (p. 18). According to van Deurzen, the existential approach encourages
people to live life by their own standards and values: “The aim of existential work is
to assist people in developing their talents in their own personal way, helping them
in being true to what they value” (p. 21).
One of the major contributions of the existential approach is its emphasis on
the human quality of the therapeutic relationship. This aspect lessens the chances
of dehumanizing psychotherapy by making it a mechanical process. Existential
counselors reject the notions of therapeutic objectivity and professional distance,
viewing them as being unhelpful.
I very much value the existential emphasis on freedom and responsibility
and the person’s capacity to redesign his or her life by choosing with awareness.
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 164 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

165
E
X
I
S
T
E
N
T
I
A
L

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
This perspective provides a sound philosophical base on which to build a personal
and unique therapeutic style because it addresses itself to the core struggles of the
contemporary person.
contributions to the integration of psychotherapies
From my perspective, the key concepts of the existential approach can be inte-
grated into most therapeutic schools. Regardless of a therapist’s orientation, the
foundation for practice can be based on existential themes. Existential psychother-
apy continues to have an enduring impact on a variety of psychological practices.
“Indeed, existential psychotherapy is in the ironic position of being one of the most
widely infl uential yet least offi cially embraced orientations on the professional
scene” (Schneider, 2008, p. 1). Bruce Wampold (2008), a leading researcher in the
psychotherapy fi eld, agrees “that an understanding of the principles of existential
therapy is needed by all therapists, as it adds a perspective that might . . . form the
basis for all effective treatments” (p. 6).
A key contribution is the possibility of a creative integration of the concep-
tual propositions of existential therapy with many other therapeutic orientations
(Bugental & Bracke, 1992; Schneider, 2008, 2011; Schneider & Krug, 2010). One
example of such a creative integration is provided by Dattilio (2002), who inte-
grates cognitive behavioral techniques with the themes of an existential approach.
As a cognitive behavior therapist and author, Dattilio maintains that he directs
much of his efforts to “helping clients make a deep existential shift—to a new
understanding of the world” (p. 75). He uses techniques such as restructuring
of belief systems, relaxation methods, and a variety of cognitive and behavioral
strategies, but he does so within an existential framework that can begin the proc-
ess of real-life transformation. Many of his clients suffer from panic attacks or
depression. Dattilio often explores with these people existential themes of mean-
ing, guilt, hopelessness, anxiety—and at the same time he provides them with cog-
nitive behavioral tools to cope with the problems of daily living. In short, he grounds
symptomatic treatment in an existential approach.
Some people have argued that the new trend toward positive psychology is
similar to the existential approach, but this rests on a superfi cial comparison of
these two approaches. Existential therapists favor intensity and passionate experi-
ence, including that of happiness, but they equally value the darker side of human
nature and would encourage clients to learn to value both sides of their experience
(van Deurzen, 2009).
Limitations and Criticisms of the Existential Approach
A major criticism often aimed at this approach is that it lacks a systematic state-
ment of the principles and practices of psychotherapy. Some practitioners have
trouble with what they perceive as its mystical language and concepts. Some thera-
pists who claim adherence to an existential orientation describe their therapeutic
style in vague and global terms such as self-actualization, dialogic encounter, au-
thenticity, and being in the world. This particular use of language causes confusion
at times and makes it diffi cult to conduct research on the process or outcomes of
existential therapy.
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 165 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

166
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
I
X
Both beginning and advanced practitioners who are not of a philosophical turn
of mind tend to fi nd many of the existential concepts lofty and elusive. As we have
seen, this approach places primary emphasis on a subjective understanding of the
world of clients. It is assumed that techniques follow understanding. The fact that
few techniques are generated by this approach makes it essential for practitioners
to develop their own innovative procedures or to borrow from other schools of
therapy. For counselors who believe they need a specifi c set of techniques to coun-
sel effectively, this approach has limitations (Vontress, 2008).
Practitioners who prefer a counseling practice based on research contend that
the concepts should be empirically sound, that defi nitions should be operational,
that the hypotheses should be testable, and that therapeutic practice should be
based on the results of research into both the process and outcomes of counseling.
Certainly, the notions of manualized therapy and evidence-based practice are not
part of the existential perspective because every psychotherapy experience is unique
(Walsh & McElwain, 2002). According to Cooper (2003), existential practitioners
generally reject the idea that the therapeutic process can be measured and evalu-
ated in quantitative and empirical ways. Although existential practices are gener-
ally upheld by recent research on therapeutic effectiveness (see Elkins, 2009), few
studies directly evaluate and examine the existential approach. To a large extent,
existential therapy makes use of techniques from other theories, which makes it
diffi cult to apply research to this approach to study its effectiveness (Sharf, 2012).
According to van Deurzen (2002b), the main limitation of this approach is
that of the level of maturity, life experience, and intensive training required of
practitioners. Existential therapists need to be wise and capable of profound and
wide-ranging understanding of what it means to be human. Authenticity is a
cardinal characteristic of a competent existential practitioner, which is certainly
more involved than mastering a body of knowledge and acquiring technical skills.
Russell (2007) puts this notion nicely: “Authenticity means being able to sign your
own name on your work and your life. It means you will want to take responsibility
for creating your own way of being a therapist” (p.123).
w h e r e to g o f r o m h e r e
Refer to the DVD for Integrative Counseling: The Case of Ruth and Lecturettes, Ses-
sion 11 (“Understanding How the Past Infl uences the Present and the Future”),
for a demonstration of ways I utilize existential notions in counseling Ruth. We
engage in a role play where Ruth becomes the voice of her church and I take on
a new role as Ruth—one in which I have been willing to challenge certain beliefs
from church. This segment illustrates how I assist Ruth in fi nding new values.
In Session 12 (“Working Toward Decisions and Behavioral Changes”) I challenge
Ruth to make new decisions, which is also an existential concept.
Free Podcasts for ACA Members
You can download ACA Podcasts (prerecorded interviews) at www.counseling.org;
click on the Resource button and then the Podcast Series. For Chapter 6, Existen-
tial Therapy, look for Podcast 14 by Dr. Gerald Corey.
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 166 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

167
E
X
I
S
T
E
N
T
I
A
L

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Other Resources
The American Psychological Association offers a DVD by K. J. Schneider (2009)
titled Existential-Humanistic Therapy in their Systems of Psychotherapy Video Series.
Psychotherapy.net is a comprehensive resource for students and profession-
als that offers videos and interviews on existential therapy featuring Irvin Yalom,
James Bugental, and Rollo May. New video and editorial content is made available
monthly. DVDs relevant to this chapter are available at www.psychotherapy.net
and include the following:
Bugental, J.F.T. (1995). Existential-Humanistic Psychotherapy in Action
Bugental, J. (1997). Existential-Humanistic Psychotherapy (Psychotherapy
with the Experts Series)
Bugental, J. (2008). James Bugental: Live Case Consultation
May, R. (2007). Rollo May on Existential Psychotherapy
Yalom, I. (2002) The Gift of Therapy: A Conversation with Irvin Yalom, M.D.
Yalom, I. (2006). Irvin Yalom: Live Case Consultation
Yalom, I. (2011) Confronting Death and Other Existential Issues in
Psychotherapy
If you are interesting in further information on Irvin Yalom, check out his website
at www.yalom.com.
The Existential-Humanistic Institute, Dr. Kirk Schneider, Orah Krug, and Nader
Shabahangi
Website:www.ehinstitute.org
The Existential-Humanistic Institute’s (EHI) primary focus is training; offering
courses, and in conjunction with Saybrook University, a new certifi cate program
in existential-humanistic therapy and theory. A secondary focus is community
building. EHI was formed as a nonprofi t organization under the auspices of the
Pacifi c Institute in 1997 and provides a home for those mental health profession-
als, scholars, and students who seek in-depth training in existential-humanistic
theory and practice. EHI’s year-long certifi cate program offers graduate and post-
graduate students an opportunity to gain a basic foundation in the theory and
practice of existential-humanistic therapy. EHI offers courses on the principles of
existential-humanistic practice and case seminars in existential-humanistic theory
and practice. Most of EHI’s instructors have studied extensively with such masters
as James Bugental, Irvin Yalom, and Rollo May, and are, like Kirk Schneider and
Orah Krug, acknowledged leaders of the existential-humanistic movement today.
Society for Existential Analysis
Website: www.existentialanalysis.co.uk/
Additional Information: www.dilemmas.org
The Society for Existential Analysis is a professional organization devoted to
exploring issues pertaining to an existential/phenomenological approach to coun-
seling and therapy. Membership is open to anyone interested in this approach
and includes students, trainees, psychotherapists, philosophers, psychiatrists,
counselors, and psychologists. Members receive a regular newsletter and an
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 167 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

168
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
I
X
annual copy of the Journal of the Society for Existential Analysis. The society provides
a list of existentially oriented psychotherapists for referral purposes. The School of
Psychotherapy and Counselling at Regent’s College in London offers an advanced
diploma in existential psychotherapy as well as short courses in the fi eld.
International Society for Existential Psychotherapy and Counselling
Website: www.existentialpsychotherapy.net
The International Society for Existential Psychotherapy and Counselling was cre-
ated in London in July 2006 and was renamed International Collaborative of Exis-
tential Counselors and Psychotherapists soon after (www.icecap.org.uk). It brings
together the existing national societies as well as providing a forum for the devel-
opment and accreditation of the approach.
Psychotherapy Training on the Net: SEPTIMUS
Website: www.septimus.info
Additional Information: www.psychotherapytraining.net
SEPTIMUS is an Internet-based course taught in Ireland, Iceland, Sweden, Po-
land, Czech Republic, Romania, Italy, Portugal, Austria, Belgium, France, Israel,
Australia, and the United Kingdom.
New School of Psychotherapy and Counselling
Royal Waterloo House
51-55 Waterloo Road
London, England SE1 8TX
Telephone: +44 (0) 20 7928 43 44
E-mail: Admin@nspc.org.uk
Website: www.nspc.org.uk
The New School of Psychotherapy and Counselling (NSPC) is set up especially for
training existential therapists. It offers an MA and doctoral program in Existen-
tial Psychotherapy and Counseling together with Middlesex University, as well as
an MSC and professional doctorate in Existential Counseling Psychology and Psy-
chotherapy also jointly with Middlesex University. NSPC offers intensive courses
for distance learners (worldwide student body), including e-learning.
Recommended Supplementary Readings
Everyday Mysteries: A Handbook of Existential Psychotherapy (van Deurzen, 2010) pro-
vides a framework for practicing counseling from an existential perspective. The au-
thor puts into clear perspective topics such as anxiety, authentic living, clarifying one’s
worldview, determining values, discovering meaning, and coming to terms with life.
Existential Therapies (Cooper, 2003) provides a useful and clear introduction to
the existential therapies. There are separate chapters on logotherapy, the British
school of existential analysis, the U.S. existential-humanistic approach, dimen-
sions of existential therapeutic practice, and brief existential therapies.
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 168 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

Existential Psychotherapy (Yalom, 1980) is a superb treatment of the ultimate
human concerns of death, freedom, isolation, and meaninglessness as these
issues relate to therapy. This book has depth and clarity, and it is rich with clini-
cal examples that illustrate existential themes.
Existential-Humanistic Therapy (Schneider & Krug, 2010) is a clear presentation
of the theory and practice of existential-humanistic therapy. This approach incor-
porates techniques from other contemporary therapeutic approaches.
Existential-Integrative Psychotherapy: Guideposts to the Core of Practice (Schneider,
2008) is an edited book that offers recent and future trends in existential-
integrative therapy and case illustrations of this model.
I Never Knew I Had a Choice (Corey & Corey, 2010) is a self-help book written
from an existential perspective. Topics include our struggle to achieve autonomy;
the meaning of loneliness, death, and loss; and how we choose our values and
philosophy of life.
References and Suggested Readings
169
E
X
I
S
T
E
N
T
I
A
L

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
*Books and articles marked with an asterisk are suggested for further study.
Binswanger, L. (1975). Being-in-the-world:
Selected papers of Ludwig Binswanger. London:
Souvenir Press.
Boss, M. (1963). Daseinanalysis and psychoa-
nalysis. New York: Basic Books.
Buber, M. (1970). I and thou (W. Kaufmann,
Trans.). New York: Scribner’s.
Bugental, J.F.T. (1986). Existential-humanistic
psychotherapy. In I. L. Kutash & A. Wolf (Eds.),
Psychotherapist’s casebook (pp. 222–236). San
Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
*Bugental, J.F.T. (1987). The art of the psycho-
therapist. New York: Norton.
Bugental, J.F.T. (1997). There is a fundamental
division in how psychotherapy is conceived. In
J. K. Zeig (Ed.), The evolution of psychotherapy:
The third conference (pp. 185–196). New York:
Brunner/Mazel.
*Bugental, J.F.T. (1999). Psychotherapy isn’t
what you think: Bringing the psychotherapeutic
engagement into the living moment. Phoenix,
AZ: Zeig, Tucker.
Bugental, J.F.T. (2008). Preliminary sketches
for a short-term existential-humanistic
therapy. In K. J. Schneider (Ed.), Existential-
integrative psychotherapy: Guideposts to the
core of practice (pp. 165–168). New York:
Routledge.
Bugental, J.F.T., & Bracke, P. E. (1992). The fu-
ture of existential-humanistic psychotherapy.
Psychotherapy, 29(l), 28–33.
*Cooper, M. (2003). Existential therapies.
London: Sage.
Corey, G. (2012). Theory and practice of group
counseling (8th ed.). Belmont, CA: Brooks/
Cole, Cengage Learning.
*Corey, G. (2013). Case approach to counseling
and psychotherapy (8th ed.). Belmont, CA:
Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning.
*Corey, G., & Corey, M. (2010). I never knew I
had a choice (9th ed.). Belmont, CA: Brooks/
Cole, Cengage Learning.
Dattilio, F. M. (2002, January-February).
Cognitive-behaviorism comes of age: Ground-
ing symptomatic treatment in an existential
approach. The Psychotherapy Networker, 26(1),
75–78.
*Deurzen, E., van. (2002a). Existential counsel-
ling and psychotherapy in practice (2nd ed.).
London: Sage.
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 169 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

170
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
I
X
*Deurzen, E., van. (2002b). Existential therapy.
In W. Dryden (Ed.), Handbook of individual
therapy (4th ed., pp. 179–208). London: Sage.
Deurzen, E., van. (2009). Psychotherapy and
the quest for happiness. London: Sage.
*Deurzen, E., van. (2010). Everyday mysteries: A
handbook of existential psychotherapy (2nd ed).
London: Routledge.
*Elkins, D. N. (2009). Humanistic psychology:
A clinical manifesto. Colorado Springs, CO:
University of the Rockies Press.
Farha, B. (1994). Ontological awareness: An
existential/cosmological epistemology. The
Person-Centered Periodical, 1(1), 15–29.
*Frankl, V. (1963). Man’s search for meaning.
Boston: Beacon.
*Frankl, V. (1965). The doctor and the soul.
New York: Bantam Books.
*Frankl, V. (1978). The unheard cry for
meaning. New York: Simon & Schuster
(Touchstone).
Gould, W. B. (1993). Viktor E. Frankl: Life with
meaning. Pacific Grove, CA: Brooks/Cole.
Heidegger, M. (1962). Being and time.
New York: Harper & Row.
May, R. (1950). The meaning of anxiety.
New York: Ronald Press.
*May, R. (1953). Man’s search for himself.
New York: Dell.
May, R. (1958). The origins and significance
of the existential movement in psychology. In
R. May, E. Angel, & H. R. Ellenberger (Eds.),
Existence: A new dimension in psychiatry and
psychology. New York: Basic Books.
*May, R. (Ed.). (1961). Existential psychology.
New York: Random House.
May, R. (1969). Love and will. New York: Norton.
May, R. (1975). The courage to create.
New York: Norton.
May, R. (1981). Freedom and destiny. New York:
Norton.
*May, R. (1983). The discovery of being:
Writings in existential psychology. New York:
Norton.
May, R., Angel, E., & Ellenberger, H. F. (Eds.).
(1958). Existence: A new dimension in psychiatry
and psychology. New York: Basic Books.
Russell, J. M. (1978). Sartre, therapy, and
expanding the concept of responsibility.
American Journal of Psychoanalysis, 38, 259–269.
*Russell, J. M. (2007). Existential psychother-
apy. In A. B. Rochlen (Ed.), Applying coun-
seling theories: An online case-based approach
(pp. 107–125). Upper Saddle River, NJ: Pear-
son Prentice-Hall.
Sartre, J. P. (1971). Being and nothingness.
New York: Bantam Books.
*Schneider, K. J. (Ed.). (2008). Existential-
integrative psychotherapy: Guideposts to the core
of practice. New York: Routledge.
*Schneider, K. J. (2011). Existential-humanistic
psychotherapies. In S. B. Messer & A. S.
Gurman, (Eds.), Essential psychotherapies:
Theory and practice (3rd ed., pp. 261–294).
New York: Guilford Press.
*Schneider, K. J., & Krug, O. T. (2010). Exis-
tential-humanistic therapy. Washington, DC:
American Psychological Association.
*Schneider, K. J., & May, R. (Eds.). (1995). The
psychology of existence: An integrative, clinical
perspective. New York: McGraw-Hill.
Sharf, R. S. (2012). Theories of psychotherapy
and counseling: Concepts and cases (5th ed.).
Belmont, CA: Brooks/Cole, Cengage
Learning.
*Sharp, J. G., & Bugental, J.F.T. (2001). Existen-
tial-humanistic psychotherapy. In R. J. Corsini
(Ed.), Handbook of innovative therapies (2nd ed.,
pp. 206–217). New York: Wiley.
*Strasser, F., & Strasser, A. (1997). Existential
time-limited therapy: The wheel of existence.
Chichester: Wiley.
Tillich, P. (1952). The courage to be. New
Haven, CT: Yale University Press.
*Vontress, C. E. (1996). A personal retrospec-
tive on cross-cultural counseling. Journal
of Multicultural Counseling and Development,
24(3), 156–166.
*Vontress, C. E. (2008). Existential therapy. In
J. Frew & M. D. Spiegler (Eds.), Contemporary
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 170 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

171
E
X
I
S
T
E
N
T
I
A
L

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
psychotherapies for a diverse world
(pp. 141–176). Boston: Lahaska Press.
*Vontress, C. E., Johnson, J. A., & Epp, L. R.
(1999). Cross-cultural counseling: A casebook.
Alexandria, VA: American Counseling
Association.
*Walsh, R. A., & McElwain, B. (2002). Existen-
tial psychotherapies. In D. J. Cain & J. Seeman
(Eds.), Humanistic psychotherapies: Handbook
of research and practice (pp. 253–278).
Washington, DC: American Psychological
Association.
*Watson, J. C., Goldman, R. N., & Greenberg,
L. S. (2011). Humanistic and experiential
theories in psychotherapy. In J. C. Norcross, G.
R. Vandenbos, & D. K. Freedheim (Eds.), History
of psychotherapy (2nd ed., pp. 141–172).
Washington, DC: American Psychological
Association.
Wampold, B. (2008, February 6). Existential-
integrative psychotherapy comes of age
[Review of Existential-integrative psycho-
therapy: Guideposts to the core of
practice]. PsycCritiques, 53, Release 6,
Article 1, p. 6.
*Yalom, I. D. (1980). Existential psychotherapy.
New York: Basic Books.
*Yalom, I. D. (1987). Love’s executioner: And
other tales of psychotherapy. New York: Harper
Perennial.
Yalom, I. D. (1992). When Nietzche wept.
New York: Basic Books.
*Yalom, I. D. (1997). Lying on the couch: A novel.
New York: Harper Perennial.
*Yalom, I. D. (2000). Momma and the meaning
of life: Tales of psychotherapy. New York: Harper
Perennial.
*Yalom, I. D. (2003). The gift of therapy: An open
letter to a new generation of therapists and their
patients. New York: HarperCollins (Perennial).
Yalom, I. D. (2005a). The Schopenhauer cure: A
novel. New York: HarperCollins.
*Yalom, I. D. (with Leszcz, M). (2005b). The
theory and practice of group psychotherapy (5th
ed.). New York: Basic Books. (Original work
published 1970)
*Yalom, I. D. (2008). Staring at the sun: Overcom-
ing the terror of death. San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
*Yalom, I. D., & Josselson, R. (2011). Existential
psychotherapy. In R. Corsini & D. Wedding (Eds.),
Current psychotherapies (9th ed., pp. 310–341).
Belmont, CA: Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning.
28549_ch06_rev01.indd 171 20/09/11 3:36 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

172
i n t r o d u ct i o n
• Four Periods of Development of the Approach
• Existentialism and Humanism
• Abraham Maslow’s Contributions to
Humanistic Psychology
k e y co n c e p t s
• View of Human Nature
t h e t h e r a p e u t i c p r o c es s
• Therapeutic Goals
• Therapist’s Function and Role
• Client’s Experience in Therapy
• Relationship Between Therapist and Client
a p p l i c at i o n : t h e r a p e u t i c
t ec h n i q u es a n d p r o c e d u r es
• Early Emphasis on Refl ection of Feelings
• Evolution of Person-Centered Methods
• The Role of Assessment
• Application of the Philosophy of the
Person-Centered Approach
• Application to Crisis Intervention
• Application to Group Counseling
p e r s o n – c e n t e r e d e x p r es s i v e
a rt s t h e r a p y
• Principles of Expressive Arts Therapy
• Creativity and Offering Stimulating Experiences
• Contributions of Natalie Rogers
m ot i vat i o n a l i n t e rv i e w i n g
• The MI Spirit
• The Basic Principles of Motivational
Interviewing
• The Stages of Change
p e r s o n – c e n t e r e d t h e r a p y f r o m
a m u lt i c u lt u r a l p e r s p ect i v e
• Strengths From a Diversity Perspective
• Shortcomings From a Diversity
Perspective
p e r s o n – c e n t e r e d t h e r a p y a p p l i e d
to t h e c a s e o f sta n
s u m m a ry a n d e va l u at i o n
• Summary
• Contributions of the Person-Centered
Approach
• Limitations and Criticisms of the Person-
Centered Approach
w h e r e to g o f r o m h e r e
• Recommended Supplementary Readings
• References and Suggested Readings
c h a p t e r 7
Person-Centered Therapy
es
• Recom
• Referenc
mentary Read
and Suggested Readings
cation to Gro
n t e r e d e x
y
essive Arts Th
ring Stimulati
atalie Rogers
n – c
e r a p
es of Exp
y and Of
butions of
172
ati
Contr
f Assessment
cation of the Philosophy of th
son-Centered Approach
plication to Crisis Intervention
plication to Group Counseling
es s i v e p e r s o
a r t s t
• Princ
• Cre
• C
i c at i o n : t h e r a p e
t ec h n i q u es a n d p r o c
• Early Emphasis on Refl ecti
• Evolution of Pe
• The Rol
• App
Pe
• A
App
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 172 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

173
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Carl Rogers
C A R L R O G E R S (1902–1987),
a major spokesperson for
humanistic psychology, led a
life that reflected the ideas he
developed for half a century.
He showed a questioning
stance, a deep openness to
change, and the courage to
forge into unknown territory
both as a person and as a professional. In writ-
ing about his early years, Rogers (1961) recalled
his family atmosphere as characterized by close
and warm relationships but also by strict religious
standards. Play was discouraged, and the virtues
of the Protestant ethic were extolled. His boyhood
was somewhat lonely, and he pursued scholarly
interests instead of social ones. Rogers was an
introverted person, and he spent a lot of time
reading and engaging in imaginative activity and
reflection. During his college years his interests and
academic major changed from agriculture to history,
then to religion, and finally to clinical psychology.
Rogers held academic positions in various
fields, including education, social work, coun-
seling, psychotherapy, group therapy, peace, and
interpersonal relations, and he earned recognition
around the world for originating and developing
the humanistic movement in psychotherapy. His
foundational ideas, especially the central role of the
client–therapist relationship as a means to growth
and change, have been incorporated by many other
theoretical approaches. Rogers was a pioneer
whose groundbreaking discoveries continue to
have far-reaching effects on the field of psycho-
therapy (Cain, 2010).
It is difficult to overestimate the significance
of Rogers’s contributions to clinical and counseling
psychology. He was a courageous pioneer who
“was about 50 years ahead of his time and has
been waiting for us to catch up” (Elkins, 2009,
p. 20). Often called the “father of psychotherapy
research,” Rogers was the first to study the coun-
seling process in depth by analyzing the transcripts
of actual therapy sessions; he was the first clinician
to conduct major studies on psychotherapy using
quantitative methods; he was the first to formulate
a comprehensive theory of personality and psy-
chotherapy grounded in empirical research; and he
contributed to developing a theory of psychother-
apy that de-emphasized pathology and focused on
the strengths and resources of individuals. He was
not afraid to take a strong position and challenged
the status quo throughout his professional career.
During the last 15 years of his life, Rogers ap-
plied the person-centered approach to world peace
by training policymakers, leaders, and groups in
conflict. Perhaps his greatest passion was directed
toward the reduction of interracial tensions and
the effort to achieve world peace, for which he was
nominated for the Nobel Peace Prize.
For a detailed video presentation of the life and
works of Carl Rogers, see Carl Rogers: A Daughter’s
Tribute (CD ROM, 2002), which is described at the
end of this chapter. See also Carl Rogers: The Quiet
Revolutionary (Rogers & Russell, 2002) and The Life
and Work of Carl Rogers (Kirschenbaum, 2009).
©
Ro
ge
rR
es
sm
ey
er
/C
or
bi
s
i n t r o d u c t i o n
Of all the pioneers who have founded a therapeutic approach, for me Carl Rogers
stands out as one of the most infl uential fi gures in revolutionizing the direction of
counseling theory and practice. Rogers has become known as a “quiet revolution-
ary” who both contributed to theory development and whose infl uence continues to
shape counseling practice today (see Cain, 2010; Kirschenbaum, 2009; Rogers &
Russell, 2002).
The person-centered approach shares many concepts and values with the
existential perspective presented in Chapter 6. Rogers’s basic assumptions are
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 173 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

174
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
E
V
E
N
that people are essentially trustworthy, that they have a vast potential for under-
standing themselves and resolving their own problems without direct interven-
tion on the therapist’s part, and that they are capable of self-directed growth if
they are involved in a specifi c kind of therapeutic relationship. From the begin-
ning, Rogers emphasized the attitudes and personal characteristics of the thera-
pist and the quality of the client–therapist relationship as the prime determi-
nants of the outcome of the therapeutic process. He consistently relegated to
a secondary position matters such as the therapist’s knowledge of theory and
techniques. This belief in the client’s capacity for self-healing is in contrast with
many theories that view the therapist’s techniques as the most powerful agents
that lead to change (Bohart & Tallman, 2010). Clearly, Rogers revolutionized the
fi eld of psychotherapy by proposing a theory that centered on the client as the
primary agent for constructive self-change (Bohart & Tallman, 2010; Bozarth,
Zimring, & Tausch, 2002).
Contemporary person-centered therapy is the result of an evolutionary process
that continues to remain open to change and refi nement (see Cain, 2010; Cain &
Seeman, 2002). Rogers did not present the person-centered theory as a fi xed and
completed approach to therapy. He hoped that others would view his theory as
a set of tentative principles relating to how the therapy process develops, not as
dogma. Rogers expected his model to evolve and was open and receptive to change.
See the video program for Chapter 7, DVD for Theory and Practice of Counseling
and Psychotherapy: The Case of Stan and Lecturettes. I suggest that you view
the brief lecture for each chapter prior to reading the chapter.
Four Periods of Development of the Approach
In tracing the major turning points in Rogers’s approach, Zimring and Raskin
(1992) and Bozarth, Zimring, and Tausch (2002) have identifi ed four periods of
development. In the fi rst period, during the 1940s, Rogers developed what was
known as nondirective counseling, which provided a powerful and revolutionary
alternative to the directive and interpretive approaches to therapy then being prac-
ticed. While he was a professor at Ohio State University, Rogers (1942) published
Counseling and Psychotherapy: Newer Concepts in Practice, which described the phi-
losophy and practice of nondirective counseling. Rogers’s theory emphasized the
counselor’s creation of a permissive and nondirective climate. His theory took
power away from the therapist and honored the inherent power of the client. When
he challenged the basic assumption that “the counselor knows best,” he realized
this radical idea would affect the power dynamics and politics of the counseling
profession, and indeed it caused a great furor (Elkins, 2009).
Rogers also challenged the validity of commonly accepted therapeutic proce-
dures such as advice, suggestion, direction, persuasion, teaching, diagnosis, and
interpretation. Based on his conviction that diagnostic concepts and procedures
were inadequate, prejudicial, and often misused, Rogers omitted them from his
approach. Nondirective counselors avoided sharing a great deal about themselves
with clients and instead focused mainly on refl ecting and clarifying the clients’
verbal and nonverbal communications.
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 174 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

175
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
In the second period, during the 1950s, Rogers (1951) wrote Client-Centered
Therapy and renamed his approach client-centered therapy, to refl ect its emphasis
on the client rather than on nondirective methods. In addition, he started the Coun-
seling Center at the University of Chicago. This period was characterized by a shift
from clarifi cation of feelings to a focus on the phenomenological world of the client.
Rogers assumed that the best vantage point for understanding how people behave
was from their own internal frame of reference. He focused more explicitly on the
actualizing tendency as the basic motivational force that leads to client change.
The third period, which began in the late 1950s and extended into the 1970s,
addressed the necessary and suffi cient conditions of therapy. Rogers (1957) set
forth a hypothesis that resulted in three decades of research. A signifi cant pub-
lication was On Becoming a Person (Rogers, 1961), which addressed the nature of
“becoming the self that one truly is,” an idea he borrowed from Kierkegaard. Rogers
published this work during the time that he held joint appointments in the depart-
ments of psychology and psychiatry at the University of Wisconsin. In this book he
described the process of “becoming one’s experience,” which is characterized by
an openness to experience, a trust in one’s experience, an internal locus of evalua-
tion, and the willingness to be in process. During the 1950s and 1960s, Rogers and
his associates continued to test the underlying hypotheses of the client-centered
approach by conducting extensive research on both the process and the outcomes
of psychotherapy. He was interested in how people best progress in psychotherapy,
and he studied the qualities of the client–therapist relationship as a catalyst lead-
ing to personality change. On the basis of this research the approach was further
refi ned and expanded (Rogers, 1961). For example, client-centered philosophy was
applied to education and was called student-centered teaching (Rogers & Freiberg,
1994). The approach was also applied to encounter groups (Rogers, 1970).
The fourth phase, during the 1980s and the 1990s, was marked by considerable
expansion to education, couples and families, industry, groups, confl ict resolution,
politics, and the search for world peace. Because of Rogers’s ever-widening scope
of infl uence, including his interest in how people obtain, possess, share, or surren-
der power and control over others and themselves, his theory became known as the
person-centered approach. This shift in terms refl ected the broadening application
of the approach. Although the person-centered approach has been applied mainly
to individual and group counseling, important areas of further application include
education, family life, leadership and administration, organizational development,
health care, cross-cultural and interracial activity, and international relations. It
was during the 1980s that Rogers directed his efforts toward applying the person-
centered approach to politics, especially to efforts related to the achievement of
world peace.
In a comprehensive review of the research on person-centered therapy over a
period of 60 years, Bozarth, Zimring, and Tausch (2002) concluded the following:
• In the earliest years of the approach, the client rather than the therapist deter-
mined the direction and goals of therapy and the therapist’s role was to help
the client clarify feelings. This style of nondirective therapy was associated with
increased understanding, greater self-exploration, and improved self-concepts.
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 175 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

176
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
E
V
E
N
• Later a shift from clarifi cation of feelings to a focus on the client’s lived experi-
ences took place. Many of Rogers’s hypotheses were confi rmed, and there was
strong evidence for the value of the therapeutic relationship and the client’s
resources as the crux of successful therapy.
• As person-centered therapy developed further, research centered on the core
conditions assumed to be both necessary and suffi cient for successful therapy.
The attitude of the therapist—an empathic understanding of the client’s world
and the ability to communicate a nonjudgmental stance to the client—along
with the therapist’s genuineness were found to be basic to a successful therapy
outcome.
• The main source of successful psychotherapy is the client. The therapist’s atten-
tion to the client’s frame of reference fosters the client’s utilization of inner and
outer resources.
Existentialism and Humanism
In the 1960s and 1970s there was a growing interest among counselors in a “third
force” in therapy as an alternative to the psychoanalytic and behavioral approaches.
Under this heading fall existential therapy (Chapter 6), person-centered therapy
(Chapter 7), Gestalt therapy (Chapter 8), and certain other experiential and rela-
tionship-oriented approaches.
Partly because of this historical connection and partly because representatives
of existentialist thinking and humanistic thinking have not always clearly sorted
out their views, the connections between the terms existentialism and humanism
have tended to be confusing for students and theorists alike. The two viewpoints
have much in common, yet there also are signifi cant philosophical differences
between them. They share a respect for the client’s subjective experience, the
uniqueness and individuality of each client, and a trust in the capacity of the cli-
ent to make positive and constructive conscious choices. They have in common
an emphasis on concepts such as freedom, choice, values, personal responsibility,
autonomy, purpose, and meaning. Both approaches place little value on the role
of techniques in the therapeutic process and emphasize instead the importance of
genuine encounter. They differ in that existentialists take the position that we are
faced with the anxiety of choosing to create an identity in a world that lacks intrinsic
meaning. Existentialists tend to acknowledge the stark realities of human experi-
ence, and their writings often focus on death, anxiety, depression, and isolation.
The humanists, in contrast, take the somewhat less anxiety-evoking position and
more optimistic view that each of us has a natural potential that we can actualize
and through which we can fi nd meaning. Many contemporary existential therapists
refer to themselves as existential-humanistic practitioners, indicating that their roots
are in existential philosophy but that they have incorporated many aspects of North
American humanistic psychotherapies (Cain, 2002a; Schneider & Krug, 2010).
As will become evident in this chapter, the existential and person-centered
approaches have parallel concepts with regard to the client–therapist relationship at
the core of therapy. The phenomenological emphasis that is basic to the existentialist
approach is also fundamental to person-centered theory. Both approaches focus on
the client’s perceptions and call for the therapist to be fully present with the client
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 176 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

177
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
so that it is possible to understand the client’s subjective world, and they both em-
phasize the client’s capacity for self-awareness and self-healing. The therapist aims
to provide the client with a safe, responsive, and caring relationship to facilitate self-
exploration, growth, and healing (Watson, Goldman, & Greenberg, 2011).
Abraham Maslow’s Contributions
to Humanistic Psychology
Abraham Maslow (1970) was a pioneer in the development of humanistic psychol-
ogy and was infl uential in furthering the understanding of self-actualizing indi-
viduals. Many of Carl Rogers’s ideas, especially on the positive aspects of being
human and the fully functioning person, are built on Maslow’s basic philosophy.
Maslow criticized Freudian psychology for what he saw as its preoccupation with
the sick and negative side of human nature. Maslow believed too much research
was being conducted on anxiety, hostility, and neuroses and too little into joy, crea-
tivity, and self-fulfi llment. Self-actualization was the central theme of the work
of Abraham Maslow (1968, 1970, 1971). The positive psychology movement that
recently has come into prominence shares many concepts on the healthy side of
human existence with the humanistic approach.
Maslow studied what he called “self-actualizing people” and found that they
differed in important ways from so-called normal individuals. The core character-
istics of self-actualizing people are self-awareness, freedom, basic honesty and car-
ing, and trust and autonomy. Other characteristics of self-actualizing individuals
include a capacity to welcome uncertainty in their lives, acceptance of themselves
and others, spontaneity and creativity, a need for privacy and solitude, autonomy,
a capacity for deep and intense interpersonal relationships, a genuine caring for
others, an inner-directedness (as opposed to the tendency to live by others’ expec-
tations), the absence of artifi cial dichotomies within themselves (such as work/
play, love/hate, and weak/strong), and a sense of humor (Maslow, 1970). All of
these personal characteristics have been identifi ed by Rogers as being central to
the person-centered philosophy.
Maslow postulated a hierarchy of needs as a source of motivation, with the most
basic needs being physiological needs. If we are hungry and thirsty, our attention
is riveted on meeting these basic needs. Next are the safety needs, which include
a sense of security and stability. Once our physical and safety needs are fulfi lled,
we become concerned with meeting our needs for belonging and love, followed by
working on our need for esteem, both from self and others. We are able to strive
toward self-actualization only after these four basic needs are met. The key factor
determining which need is dominant at a given time is the degree to which those
below it are satisfi ed. We cannot strive toward self-actualization, for example, if our
self-esteem is low.
t h e v i s i o n o f h u m a n i s t i c p h i lo s o p h y The underlying vision of
humanistic philosophy is captured by the metaphor of how an acorn, if provided
with the appropriate conditions, will “automatically” grow in positive ways, pushed
naturally toward its actualization as an oak. In contrast, for many existentialists
there is nothing that we “are,” no internal “nature” we can count on. We are faced
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 177 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

178
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
E
V
E
N
at every moment with a choice about what to make of this condition. Maslow’s em-
phasis on the healthy side of being human and the emphasis on joy, creativity, and
self-fulfi llment are part of the person-centered philosophy. The humanistic phi-
losophy on which the person-centered approach rests is expressed in attitudes and
behaviors that create a growth-producing climate. According to Rogers (1986b),
when this philosophy is lived, it helps people develop their capacities and stimu-
lates constructive change in others. Individuals are empowered, and they are able
to use this power for personal and social transformation.
k e y c o n c e p t s
View of Human Nature
A common theme originating in Rogers’s early writing and continuing to permeate
all of his works is a basic sense of trust in the client’s ability to move forward in a
constructive manner if conditions fostering growth are present. His professional
experience taught him that if one is able to get to the core of an individual, one fi nds
a trustworthy, positive center (Rogers, 1987a). In keeping with the philosophy of
humanistic psychology, Rogers fi rmly maintained that people are trustworthy, re-
sourceful, capable of self-understanding and self-direction, able to make construc-
tive changes, and able to live effective and productive lives. When therapists are able
to experience and communicate their realness, support, caring, and nonjudgmental
understanding, signifi cant changes in the client are most likely to occur.
Rogers maintained that three therapist attributes create a growth-promoting
climate in which individuals can move forward and become what they are capable
of becoming: (1) congruence (genuineness, or realness), (2) unconditional positive
regard (acceptance and caring), and (3) accurate empathic understanding (an ability to
deeply grasp the subjective world of another person). According to Rogers, if thera-
pists communicate these attitudes, those being helped will become less defensive
and more open to themselves and their world, and they will behave in prosocial
and constructive ways.
Brodley (1999) writes about the actualizing tendency, a directional process of
striving toward realization, fulfi llment, autonomy, and self-determination. This nat-
ural inclination of humans is based on Maslow’s (1970) studies of self-actualizing
people. This growth force within us provides an internal source of healing, but it
does not imply a movement away from relationships, interdependence, connec-
tion, or socialization. This humanistic view of human nature has signifi cant im-
plications for the practice of therapy. Because of the belief that the individual has
an inherent capacity to move away from maladjustment and toward psychological
health and growth, the therapist places the primary responsibility on the client.
The person-centered approach rejects the role of the therapist as the authority who
knows best and of the passive client who merely follows the beliefs of the therapist.
Therapy is rooted in the client’s capacity for awareness and self-directed change in
attitudes and behavior.
In the person-centered approach the emphasis is on how clients act in their
world with others, how they can move forward in constructive directions, and how
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 178 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

179
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
they can successfully deal with obstacles (both from within themselves and outside
of themselves) that are blocking their growth. By promoting self-awareness and
self-refl ection, clients learn to exercise choice. Humanistic therapists emphasize
a discovery-oriented approach in which clients are the experts on their own inner
experience (Watson, Goldman, & Greenberg, 2011), and they encourage clients to
make changes that will lead to living fully and authentically, with the realization
that this kind of existence demands a continuing struggle. Maslow taught us that
becoming self-actualizing individuals is an ongoing process rather than a fi nal
destination.
t h e t h e r a p e u t i c p r o c e s s
Therapeutic Goals
The person-centered approach aims toward the client achieving a greater degree
of independence and integration. Its focus is on the person, not on the person’s
presenting problem. Rogers did not believe the goal of therapy was merely to solve
problems. Rather, the goal is to assist clients in their growth process so clients can
better cope with problems as they identify them.
Rogers (1961) wrote that people who enter psychotherapy often ask: “How can
I discover my real self? How can I become what I deeply wish to become? How can
I get behind my facades and become myself?” The underlying aim of therapy is to
provide a climate conducive to helping the individual strive toward self-actualiza-
tion. Before clients are able to work toward that goal, they must fi rst get behind the
masks they wear, which they develop through the process of socialization. Clients
come to recognize that they have lost contact with themselves by using facades. In
a climate of safety in the therapeutic session, they also come to realize that there
are more authentic ways of being.
When the facades are put aside during the therapeutic process, what kind of
person emerges from behind the pretenses? Rogers (1961) described people who
are becoming increasingly actualized as having (1) an openness to experience,
(2) a trust in themselves, (3) an internal source of evaluation, and (4) a willingness
to continue growing. Encouraging these characteristics is the basic goal of person-
centered therapy.
These four characteristics provide a general framework for understanding the
direction of therapeutic movement. The therapist does not choose specifi c goals
for the client. The cornerstone of person-centered theory is the view that clients
in a relationship with a facilitating therapist have the capacity to defi ne and clarify
their own goals. Person-centered therapists are in agreement on the matter of not
setting goals for what clients need to change, yet they differ on the matter of how to
best help clients achieve their own goals and to fi nd their own answers (Bohart &
Watson, 2011).
Therapist’s Function and Role
The role of person-centered therapists is rooted in their ways of being and atti-
tudes, not in techniques designed to get the client to “do something.” Research on
person-centered therapy seems to indicate that the attitude of therapists, rather than
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 179 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

180
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
E
V
E
N
their knowledge, theories, or techniques, facilitate personality change in the client
(Rogers, 1961). Basically, therapists use themselves as an instrument of change.
When they encounter the client on a person-to-person level, their “role” is to be
without roles. They do not get lost in a professional role. It is the therapist’s attitude
and belief in the inner resources of the client that creates the therapeutic climate for
growth (Bozarth et al., 2002).
Thorne (2002a) reinforces the importance of therapists encountering clients
in a person-to-person way, as opposed to being overly reliant on a professional con-
tract. He cautions about retreating into a stance of pseudo-professionalism charac-
terized by presenting a detailed contract to clients, rigid observation of boundaries,
and the commitment to empirically validated methods. He suggests that this over-
emphasis on professionalism is aimed at protecting therapists from overinvolve-
ment with clients, which often results in underinvolvement with them.
Person-centered theory holds that the therapist’s function is to be present and
accessible to clients and to focus on their immediate experience. First and fore-
most, the therapist must be willing to be real in the relationship with clients. By
being congruent, accepting, and empathic, the therapist is a catalyst for change. In-
stead of viewing clients in preconceived diagnostic categories, the therapist meets
them on a moment-to-moment experiential basis and enters their world. Through
the therapist’s attitude of genuine caring, respect, acceptance, support, and un-
derstanding, clients are able to loosen their defenses and rigid perceptions and
move to a higher level of personal functioning. When these therapist attitudes are
present, clients then have the necessary freedom to explore areas of their life that
were either denied to awareness or distorted.
Client’s Experience in Therapy
Therapeutic change depends on clients’ perceptions both of their own experience
in therapy and of the counselor’s basic attitudes. If the counselor creates a cli-
mate conducive to self-exploration, clients have the opportunity to explore the full
range of their experience, which includes their feelings, beliefs, behavior, and
worldview. What follows is a general sketch of clients’ experiences in therapy.
Clients come to the counselor in a state of incongruence; that is, a discrepancy
exists between their self-perception and their experience in reality. For example,
Leon, a college student, may see himself as a future physician, yet his below-aver-
age grades could exclude him from medical school. The discrepancy between how
Leon sees himself (self-concept) or how he would like to view himself (ideal self-
concept) and the reality of his poor academic performance may result in anxiety
and personal vulnerability, which can provide the necessary motivation to enter
therapy. Leon must perceive that a problem exists or, at least, that he is uncomfort-
able enough with his present psychological adjustment to want to explore possibili-
ties for change.
One reason clients seek therapy is a feeling of basic helplessness, powerless-
ness, and an inability to make decisions or effectively direct their own lives. They
may hope to fi nd “the way” through the guidance of the therapist. Within the per-
son-centered framework, however, clients soon learn that they can be responsible
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 180 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

181
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
for themselves in the relationship and that they can learn to be more free by using
the relationship to gain greater self-understanding.
As counseling progresses, clients are able to explore a wider range of beliefs and
feelings. They can express their fears, anxiety, guilt, shame, hatred, anger, and other
emotions that they had deemed too negative to accept and incorporate into their
self-structure. With therapy, people distort less and move to a greater acceptance and
integration of confl icting and confusing feelings. They increasingly discover aspects
within themselves that had been kept hidden. As clients feel understood and accepted,
they become less defensive and become more open to their experience. Because they
feel safer and are less vulnerable, they become more realistic, perceive others with
greater accuracy, and become better able to understand and accept others. Individuals
in therapy come to appreciate themselves more as they are, and their behavior shows
more fl exibility and creativity. They become less concerned about meeting others’
expectations, and thus begin to behave in ways that are truer to themselves. These
individuals direct their own lives instead of looking outside of themselves for
answers. They move in the direction of being more in contact with what they are
experiencing at the present moment, less bound by the past, less determined, freer to
make decisions, and increasingly trusting in themselves to manage their own lives.
In short, their experience in therapy is like throwing off the self-imposed shackles
that had kept them in a psychological prison. With increased freedom they tend to
become more mature psychologically and move toward increased self-actualization.
Person-centered therapy is grounded on the assumption that it is clients who
heal themselves, who create their own self-growth, and who are active self-healers
(Bohart & Tallman, 1999, 2010; Bohart & Watson, 2011). The therapy relationship
provides a supportive structure within which clients’ self-healing capacities are
activated. What clients value most is being understood and accepted, which results
in creating a safe place to explore feelings, thoughts, behaviors, and experiences;
clients also value support for trying out new behaviors (Bohart & Tallman, 2010).
Relationship Between Therapist and Client
Rogers (1957) based his hypothesis of the “necessary and suffi cient conditions for
therapeutic personality change” on the quality of the relationship: “If I can provide
a certain type of relationship, the other person will discover within himself or her-
self the capacity to use that relationship for growth and change, and personal devel-
opment will occur” (Rogers, 1961, p. 33). Rogers (1967) hypothesized further that
“signifi cant positive personality change does not occur except in a relationship”
(p. 73). Rogers’s hypothesis was formulated on the basis of many years of his pro-
fessional experience, and it remains basically unchanged to this day. This hypoth-
esis (cited in Cain 2002a, p. 20) is stated thusly:
1. Two persons are in psychological contact.
2. The fi rst, whom we shall term the client, is in a state of incongruence, being
vulnerable or anxious.
3. The second person, whom we term the therapist, is congruent (real or genuine)
in the relationship.
4. The therapist experiences unconditional positive regard for the client.
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 181 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

182
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
E
V
E
N
5. The therapist experiences an empathic understanding of the client’s internal
frame of reference and endeavors to communicate this experience to the client.
6. The communication to the client of the therapist’s empathic understanding and
unconditional positive regard is to a minimal degree achieved.
Rogers hypothesized that no other conditions were necessary. If the therapeutic
core conditions exist over some period of time, constructive personality change
will occur. The core conditions do not vary according to client type. Further, they
are both necessary and suffi cient for therapeutic change to occur.
From Rogers’s perspective the client–therapist relationship is characterized by
equality. Therapists do not keep their knowledge a secret or attempt to mystify the
therapeutic process. The process of change in the client depends to a large degree
on the quality of this equal relationship. As clients experience the therapist listen-
ing in an accepting way to them, they gradually learn how to listen acceptingly to
themselves. As they fi nd the therapist caring for and valuing them (even the as-
pects that have been hidden and regarded as negative), clients begin to see worth
and value in themselves. As they experience the realness of the therapist, clients
drop many of their pretenses and are real with both themselves and the therapist.
This humanistic approach is perhaps best characterized as a way of being and as
a shared journey in which therapist and client reveal their humanness and partici-
pate in a growth experience. The therapist can be a relational guide on this journey
because he or she is usually more experienced and more psychologically experienced
in this role than the client. Thorne (2002b) delivered this message: “Therapists can-
not confi dently invite their clients to travel further than they have journeyed them-
selves, but for person-centred therapists the quality, depth and continuity of their
own experiencing becomes the very cornerstone of the competence they bring to
their professional activity” (p. 144). Therapists are invested in broadening their own
life experiences and are willing to do what it takes to deepen their self-knowledge.
Rogers admitted that his theory was striking provocative and radical. His for-
mulation has generated considerable controversy, for he maintained that many
conditions other therapists commonly regard as necessary for effective psychother-
apy were nonessential. The core therapist conditions of congruence, unconditional
positive regard, and accurate empathic understanding subsequently have been em-
braced by many therapeutic schools as essential in facilitating therapeutic change.
These core qualities of therapists, along with the therapist’s presence, work holis-
tically to create a safe environment for learning (Cain, 2010). Regardless of theo-
retical orientation, most therapists strive to listen fully and empathically to clients,
especially during the initial stages of therapy. We now turn to a detailed discussion
of how these core conditions are an integral part of the therapeutic relationship.
c o n g r u e n c e , o r g e n u i n e n e s s implies that therapists are real; that is,
they are genuine, integrated, and authentic during the therapy hour. They are with-
out a false front, their inner experience and outer expression of that experience
match, and they can openly express feelings, thoughts, reactions, and attitudes that
are present in the relationship with the client. This communication is done with
careful refl ection and considered judgment on the therapist’s part (Kolden, Klein,
Wang, & Austin, 2011).
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 182 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

183
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Through authenticity the therapist serves as a model of a human being strug-
gling toward greater realness. Being congruent might necessitate expressing a
range of feelings including anger, frustration, liking, concern, and annoyance.
This does not mean that therapists should impulsively share all their reactions, for
self-disclosure must be appropriate, well timed, and have a constructive therapeu-
tic intent. Counselors can try too hard to be genuine; sharing because one thinks
it will be good for the client, without being genuinely moved to express something
regarded as personal, can be incongruent. Person-centered therapy stresses that
counseling will be inhibited if the counselor feels one way about the client but acts
in a different way. For example, if the practitioner dislikes or disapproves of the
client but feigns acceptance, therapy will be impaired. Cain (2010) stresses that
therapists need to be attuned to the emerging needs of the client and to respond in
ways that are in the best interests of the individual. If therapists keep this in mind,
they are likely to make sound clinical decisions most of the time.
Rogers’s concept of congruence does not imply that only a fully self-actualized
therapist can be effective in counseling. Because therapists are human, they can-
not be expected to be fully authentic. Congruence exists on a continuum from
highly congruent to very incongruent. This is true of all three characteristics.
u n c o n d i t i o n a l p o s i t i v e r e g a r d a n d a c c e p ta n c e The second
attitude therapists need to communicate is deep and genuine caring for the client
as a person, or a condition of unconditional positive regard, which can best be
achieved through empathic identifi cation with the client (Farber & Doolin, 2011).
The caring is nonpossessive and is not contaminated by evaluation or judgment of
the client’s feelings, thoughts, and behavior as good or bad. Therapists value and
warmly accept clients without placing stipulations on their acceptance. It is not
an attitude of “I’ll accept you when . . .”; rather, it is one of “I’ll accept you as you
are.” Therapists communicate through their behavior that they value their clients
as they are and that clients are free to have feelings and experiences. Acceptance
is the recognition of clients’ rights to have their own beliefs and feelings; it is not
the approval of all behavior. All overt behavior need not be approved of or accepted.
According to Rogers’s (1977) research, the greater the degree of caring, priz-
ing, accepting, and valuing of the client in a nonpossessive way, the greater the
chance that therapy will be successful. He also makes it clear that it is not possible
for therapists to genuinely feel acceptance and unconditional caring at all times.
However, if therapists have little respect for their clients, or an active dislike or
disgust, it is not likely that the therapeutic work will be fruitful. If therapists’ caring
stems from their own need to be liked and appreciated, constructive change in the
client is inhibited. This notion of positive regard has implications for all therapists,
regardless of their theoretical orientation (Farber & Doolin, 2011).
accurate empathic understanding One of the main tasks of the ther-
apist is to understand clients’ experience and feelings sensitively and accurately as they
are revealed in the moment-to-moment interaction during the therapy session. The
therapist strives to sense clients’ subjective experience, particularly in the here and
now. The aim is to encourage clients to get closer to themselves, to feel more deeply
and intensely, and to recognize and resolve the incongruity that exists within them.
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 183 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

184
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
E
V
E
N
Empathy is a deep and subjective understanding of the client with the client.
Empathy is not sympathy, or feeling sorry for a client. Therapists are able to share the
client’s subjective world by drawing from their own experiences that may be similar
to the client’s feelings. Yet therapists must not lose their own separateness. Rogers
asserts that when therapists can grasp the client’s private world as the client sees
and feels it—without losing the separateness of their own identity—constructive
change is likely to occur. Empathy, particularly emotionally focused empathy,
helps clients (1) pay attention to and value their experiencing, (2) process their
experience both cognitively and bodily, (3) view prior experiences in new ways, and
(4) increase their confi dence in making choices and in pursuing a course of action
(Cain, 2010).
Clark (2010) describes an integral model of empathy in the counseling process
that is based on three ways of knowing: (1) subjective empathy enables practition-
ers to experience what it is like to be the client; (2) interpersonal empathy pertains
to understanding a client’s internal frame of reference and conveying a sense of
the private meanings to the person; and (3) objective empathy relies on knowledge
sources outside of a client’s frame of reference. By using a multiple-perspective
model of empathy, counselors have a broader way to understand clients.
Accurate empathy is the cornerstone of the person-centered approach, and it
is a necessary ingredient of any effective therapy (Cain, 2010). Accurate empathic
understanding implies that the therapist will sense clients’ feelings as if they were
his or her own without becoming lost in those feelings. It is a way for therapists
to hear the meanings expressed by their clients that often lie at the edge of their
awareness. A primary means of determining whether an individual experienc-
es a therapist’s empathy is to secure feedback from the client (Norcross, 2010).
According to Watson (2002), full empathy entails understanding the meaning and
feeling of a client’s experiencing. Therapists need to understand clients on both
emotional and cognitive levels. Empathy is an active ingredient of change that fa-
cilitates clients’ cognitive processes and emotional self-regulation. Watson (2002)
states that 60 years of research has consistently demonstrated that empathy is the
most powerful determinant of client progress in therapy.
Clients’ perceptions of feeling understood by their therapists relate favorably to
outcome. Empathic therapists strive to discover the meaning of the client’s experi-
ence, understand the overall goals of the client, and tailor their responses to the
particular client. Effective empathy is grounded in authentic caring for the client
(Elliott, Bohart, Watson, & Greenberg, 2011).
a p p l i c at i o n : t h e r a p e u t i c
t e c h n i q u e s a n d p r o c e d u r e s
Early Emphasis on Reflection of Feelings
Rogers’s original emphasis was on grasping the world of the client and refl ecting
this understanding. As his view of psychotherapy developed, however, his focus
shifted away from a nondirective stance and emphasized the therapist’s relation-
ship with the client. Many followers of Rogers simply imitated his refl ective style,
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 184 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

185
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
and client-centered therapy has often been identifi ed primarily with the technique
of refl ection despite Rogers’s contention that the therapist’s relational attitudes
and fundamental ways of being with the client constitute the heart of the change
process. Rogers and other contributors to the development of the person-centered
approach have been critical of the stereotypic view that this approach is basically a
simple restatement of what the client just said.
Evolution of Person-Centered Methods
Contemporary person-centered therapy is the result of an evolutionary process of
more than 70 years, and it continues to remain open to change and refi nement.
One of Rogers’s main contributions to the counseling fi eld is the notion that the
quality of the therapeutic relationship, as opposed to administering techniques,
is the primary agent of growth in the client. The therapist’s ability to establish a
strong connection with clients is the critical factor determining successful coun-
seling outcomes.
No techniques are basic to the practice of person-centered therapy; “being with”
clients and entering imaginatively into their world of perceptions and feelings is
suffi cient for facilitating a process of change. Person-centered therapists are not
prohibited from suggesting techniques, but how these suggestions are presented is
crucial. Techniques may be suggested when doing so fosters the process of client
and therapist being together in an empathic way. Techniques are not attempts at
“doing anything” to a client (Bohart & Watson, 2011).
The person-centered philosophy is based on the assumption that clients have
the resourcefulness for positive movement without the counselor assuming an
active, directive, or problem-solving role. Traditional person-centered therapists
would not tend to suggest a technique (Bohart & Watson, 2011). What is essential
for clients’ progress is the therapist’s presence, being completely attentive to and
immersed in the client as well as in the client’s expressed concerns (Cain, 2010).
This way of being is far more powerful than any technique a therapist might use
to bring about change. Qualities and skills such as listening, accepting, respect-
ing, understanding, and responding must be honest expressions by the therapist.
As discussed in Chapter 2, counselors need to evolve as persons, not just acquire
a repertoire of therapeutic strategies. Therapists mainly stay within the client’s
frame of reference and strive to understand and refl ect the client’s communication
and experience.
Rogers expected person-centered therapy to continue to evolve and supported
others in breaking new ground. One of the main ways in which person-centered
therapy has evolved is the diversity, innovation, and individualization in practice.
There is no longer one way of practicing person-centered therapy (Cain, 2010), and
there has been increased latitude for therapists to share their reactions, to confront
clients in a caring way, and to participate more actively and fully in the therapeutic
process (Bozarth et al., 2002). Immediacy, or addressing what is going on between
the client and therapist, is highly valued in this approach. This development en-
courages the use of a wider variety of methods and allows for considerable diversity
in personal style among person-centered therapists. The shift toward genuineness
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 185 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

186
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
E
V
E
N
enables person-centered therapists both to practice in more fl exible and integra-
tive ways that suit their personalities and to have greater fl exibility in tailoring the
counseling relationship to suit different clients (Bohart & Watson, 2011).
Cain (2008, 2010) believes it is essential for therapists to adapt their therapeu-
tic style to accommodate the unique needs of each client. Person-centered thera-
pists have the freedom to use a variety of responses and methods to assist their
clients; a guiding question therapists need to ask is, “Does it fi t?” Cain contends
that, ideally, therapists will continually monitor whether what they are doing fi ts,
especially whether their therapeutic style is compatible with their clients’ way of
viewing and understanding their problems. For an illustration of how Dr. David
Cain works with the case of Ruth in a person-centered style, see Case Approach to
Counseling and Psychotherapy (Corey, 2013, chap. 5).
Today, those who practice a person-centered approach work in diverse ways
that refl ect both advances in theory and practice and a plethora of personal styles.
This is appropriate and fortunate, for none of us can emulate the style of Carl
Rogers and still be true to ourselves. If we strive to model our style after Rogers,
and if that style does not fi t for us, we are not being ourselves and we are not being
fully congruent.
The Role of Assessment
Assessment is frequently viewed as a prerequisite to the treatment process. Many
mental health agencies use a variety of assessment procedures, including diagnos-
tic screening, identifi cation of clients’ strengths and liabilities, and various tests.
Person-centered therapists generally do not fi nd traditional assessment and diag-
nosis to be useful because these procedures encourage an external and expert per-
spective on the client (Bohart & Watson, 2011). What matters is not how the coun-
selor assesses the client but the client’s self-assessment. From a person-centered
perspective, the best source of knowledge about the client is the individual client.
In the early development of nondirective therapy, Rogers (1942) recommend-
ed caution in using psychometric measures or in taking a complete case history
at the outset of counseling. If a counseling relationship began with a battery of
psychological tests and a detailed case history, he believed clients could get the
impression that the counselor would be providing the solutions to their problems.
Assessment seems to be gaining in importance in short-term treatments in most
counseling agencies, and it is imperative that clients be involved in a collaborative
process in making decisions that are central to their therapy. Today it may not be a
question of whether to incorporate assessment into therapeutic practice but of how
to involve clients as fully as possible in their assessment and treatment process.
Application of the Philosophy of the
Person-Centered Approach
The person-centered approach has been applied to working with individuals, groups,
and families. Bozrath, Zimring, and Tausch (2002) cite studies done through the
1990s that revealed the effectiveness of person-centered therapy with a wide range
of client problems including anxiety disorders, alcoholism, psychosomatic problems,
agoraphobia, interpersonal diffi culties, depression, cancer, and personality disorders.
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 186 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

187
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Person-centered therapy has been shown to be as viable as the more goal-oriented
therapies. Furthermore, outcome research conducted in the 1990s revealed that
effective therapy is based on the client–therapist relationship in combination
with the inner and external resources of the client (Duncan, Miller, Wampold, &
Hubble, 2010).
The person-centered approach has been applied extensively in training both
professionals and paraprofessionals who work with people in a variety of settings.
This approach emphasizes staying with clients as opposed to getting ahead of
them with interpretations. People without advanced psychological education are
able to benefi t by translating the therapeutic conditions of genuineness, empathic
understanding, and unconditional positive regard into both their personal and pro-
fessional lives. Learning to listen with acceptance to oneself is a valuable life skill
that enables individuals to be their own therapists. The basic concepts are straight-
forward and easy to comprehend, and they encourage locating power in the person
rather than fostering an authoritarian structure in which control and power are
denied to the person. These core skills also provide an essential foundation for
virtually all of the other therapy systems covered in this book. If counselors are
lacking in these relationship and communication skills, they will not be effective
in carrying out a treatment program for their clients.
The person-centered approach demands a great deal of the therapist. An ef-
fective person-centered therapist must be grounded, centered, genuine, respect-
ful, caring, present, a focused and astute listener, patient, and accepting in a way
that involves maturity. Without a person-centered way of being, mere application
of skills is likely to be hollow. Natalie Rogers (2011) points out that the person-
centered approach is a way of being that is easy to understand intellectually but
is very diffi cult to put into practice. She continues to fi nd the core conditions of
genuineness, positive regard, and empathy most important in developing trust,
safety, and growth in a group.
Application to Crisis Intervention
The person-centered approach is especially applicable in crisis intervention such as
an unwanted pregnancy, an illness, a disastrous event, or the loss of a loved one. Peo-
ple in the helping professions (nursing, medicine, education, the ministry) are often
fi rst on the scene in a variety of crises, and they can do much if the basic attitudes
described in this chapter are present. When people are in crisis, one of the fi rst steps
is to give them an opportunity to fully express themselves. Sensitive listening, hear-
ing, and understanding are essential at this point. Being heard and understood helps
ground people in crises, helps to calm them in the midst of turmoil, and enables
them to think more clearly and make better decisions. Although a person’s crisis is
not likely to be resolved by one or two contacts with a helper, such contacts can pave
the way for being open to receiving help later. If the person in crisis does not feel
understood and accepted, he or she may lose hope of “returning to normal” and may
not seek help in the future. Genuine support, caring, and nonpossessive warmth can
go a long way in building bridges that can motivate people to do something to work
through and resolve a crisis. Communicating a deep sense of understanding should
always precede other more problem-solving interventions.
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 187 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

188
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
E
V
E
N
In crisis situations person-centered therapists may need to provide more struc-
ture and direction than would be the case for clients who are not experiencing a
crisis. Suggestions, guidance, and even direction may be called for if clients are
not able to function effectively. For example, in certain cases it may be necessary
to take action to hospitalize a suicidal client to protect this person from self-harm.
Application to Group Counseling
The person-centered approach emphasizes the unique role of the group counselor
as a facilitator rather than a leader. The primary function of the facilitator is to cre-
ate a safe and healing climate—a place where the group members can interact in
honest and meaningful ways. In this climate members become more appreciative
and trusting of themselves as they are and are able to move toward self-direction
and empowerment. Ultimately, group members make their own choices and bring
about change for themselves. Yet with the presence of the facilitator and the sup-
port of other members, participants realize that they do not have to experience
the struggles of change alone and that groups as collective entities have their own
source of transformation. The facilitator’s way of being can create a productive
climate within a group:
Facilitators cannot make participants trust the group process. Facilitators earn trust by
being respectful, caring, and even loving. Being an effective group facilitator has much to
do with one’s “way of being.” No method or technique can evoke trust unless the facilitator
herself has a capacity to be fully present, considerate, caring, authentic, and responsive.
This includes the ability to challenge people constructively (N. Rogers, 2011, p. 57)
Rogers (1970) clearly believed that groups tend to move forward if the facilitator
exhibits a deep sense of trust in the members and refrains from using techniques
or exercises to get a group moving. The core conditions of person-centered therapy
apply to the process of a group. The role of the facilitator is to empathically under-
stand what an individual is communicating within the group. Instead of leading
the members toward specifi c goals, the group facilitator assists members in de-
veloping attitudes and behaviors of genuineness, acceptance, and empathy, which
enables the members to interact with each other in therapeutic ways to fi nd their
own sense of direction as a group.
From Rogers’s perspective, facilitators should avoid making interpretive com-
ments or group process observations because such comments are apt to make
the group self-conscious and slow the process down. Group process observations
should come from members, a view that is consistent with Rogers’s philosophy of
placing the responsibility for the direction of the group on the members. Accord-
ing to Raskin, Rogers, and Witty (2008), groups are fully capable of articulating
and pursuing their own goals. They assert, “when the therapeutic conditions are
present in a group and when the group is trusted to fi nd its own way of being,
group members tend to develop processes that are right for them and to resolve
confl icts within time constraints in the situation” (p. 143).
Regardless of a group leader’s theoretical orientation, the core conditions that
have been described here are highly applicable to any leader’s style of group facili-
tation. Only when the leader is able to create a person-centered climate will move-
ment take place within a group. All of the theories discussed in this book depend
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 188 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

189
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
on the quality of the therapeutic relationship as a foundation. As you will see, the
cognitive behavioral approaches to group work place emphasis on creating a work-
ing alliance and collaborative relationships. In this way, most effective approaches
to group work share key elements of a person-centered philosophy. For a more
detailed treatment of person-centered group counseling, see Corey (2012, chap.
10). Also see Natalie Rogers’s (2011), The Creative Connection for Groups: Person-
Centered Expressive Arts for Healing and Social Change.
p e r s o n – c e n t e r e d e x p r e s s i v e
a r t s t h e r a p y *
Natalie Rogers (1993, 2011) expanded on her father, Carl Rogers’s (1961), theory
of creativity using the expressive arts to enhance personal growth for individuals
and groups. Rogers’s approach, known as expressive arts therapy, extends the per-
son-centered approach to spontaneous creative expression, which symbolizes deep
and sometimes inaccessible feelings and emotional states. Counselors trained in
person-centered expressive arts offer their clients the opportunity to create move-
ment, visual art, journal writing, sound, and music to express their feelings and
gain insight from these activities.
Principles of Expressive Arts Therapy
Expressive arts therapy uses various artistic forms—movement, drawing, painting,
sculpting, music, writing, and improvisation—toward the end of growth, healing,
and self-discovery. This is a multimodal approach integrating mind, body, emo-
tions, and inner spiritual resources. Methods of expressive arts therapy are based on
humanistic principles but giving fuller form to Carl Rogers’s notions of creativity.
These principles include the following (N. Rogers, 1993):
• All people have an innate ability to be creative.
• The creative process is transformative and healing. The healing aspects involve
activities such as meditation, movement, art, music, and journal writing.
• Personal growth and higher states of consciousness are achieved through self-
awareness, self-understanding, and insight.
• Self-awareness, understanding, and insight are achieved by delving into our
feelings of grief, anger, pain, fear, joy, and ecstasy.
• Our feelings and emotions are an energy source that can be channeled into the
expressive arts to be released and transformed.
• The expressive arts lead us into the unconscious, thereby enabling us to express
previously unknown facets of ourselves and bring to light new information and
awareness.
• One art form stimulates and nurtures the other, bringing us to an inner core or
essence that is our life energy.
*Much of the material in this section is based on key ideas that are more fully developed in two of Natalie
Rogers’s books, The Creative Connection: Expressive Arts as Healing (Rogers, 1993) and The Creative Connec-
tion for Groups: Person-Centered Expressive Arts for Healing and Social Change (Rogers, 2011). This section was
written in close collaboration with Natalie Rogers.
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 189 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

190
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
E
V
E
N
• A connection exists between our life force—our inner core, or soul—and the
essence of all beings.
• As we journey inward to discover our essence or wholeness, we discover our
relatedness to the outer world, and the inner and outer become one.
The various art modes interrelate in what Natalie Rogers calls the “creative connec-
tion.” When we move, it affects how we write or paint. When we write or paint, it
affects how we feel and think.
Natalie Rogers’s approach is based on a person-centered theory of individual
and group process. The same conditions that Carl Rogers and his colleagues found
basic to fostering a facilitative client–counselor relationship also help support crea-
tivity. Personal growth takes place in a safe, supportive environment created by
counselors or facilitators who are genuine, warm, empathic, open, honest, congru-
ent, and caring—qualities that are best learned by fi rst being experienced. Taking
time to refl ect on and evaluate these experiences allows for personal integration at
many levels—intellectual, emotional, physical, and spiritual.
Creativity and Offering Stimulating Experiences
According to Natalie Rogers, this deep faith in the individual’s innate drive to
become fully oneself is basic to the work in person-centered expressive arts. Indi-
viduals have a tremendous capacity for self-healing through creativity if given the
proper environment. When one feels appreciated, trusted, and given support to
use individuality to develop a plan, create a project, write a paper, or to be authen-
tic, the challenge is exciting, stimulating, and gives a sense of personal expansion.
N. Rogers believes the tendency to actualize and become one’s full potential, in-
cluding innate creativity, is undervalued, discounted, and frequently squashed in
our society. Traditional educational institutions tend to promote conformity rather
than original thinking and the creative process.
Person-centered expressive arts therapy utilizes the arts for spontaneous cre-
ative expression that symbolizes deep and sometimes inaccessible feelings and
emotional states. The conditions that foster creativity require acceptance of the
individual, a nonjudgmental setting, empathy, psychological freedom, and availa-
bility of stimulating and challenging experiences. With this type of environment in
place, the facilitative internal conditions of the client are encouraged and inspired:
a nondefensive openness to experience and an internal locus of evaluation that
receives but is not overly concerned with the reactions of others. N. Rogers (1993)
believes that we cheat ourselves out of a fulfi lling and joyous source of creativity if
we cling to the idea that an artist is the only one who can enter the realm of creativ-
ity. Art is not only for the few who develop a talent or master a medium. We all can
use various art forms to facilitate self-expression and personal growth.
Contributions of Natalie Rogers
As is clear from this brief section, Natalie Rogers has built upon a person-centered
philosophy and incorporated expressive and creative arts as a basis for personal
growth. Cain (2010) believes “Natalie Rogers’s expressive arts therapy represents
a major innovation in practice and helped open the way for other person-centered
therapists to expand the variety and range of practice” (p. 60). Sommers-Flanagan
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 190 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

191
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
(2007) notes that person-centered expressive arts therapy may be a solution for
clients who are stuck in linear and rigid ways of being. He concludes: “Using her
own love of creativity and art in combination with her father’s renowned thera-
peutic approach, Natalie Rogers developed a form of therapy that extends person-
centered counseling into a new and exciting domain” (p. 124). Rogers continues
her active professional life, conducting workshops in the United States, Europe,
Japan, Hong Kong, Latin America, and Russia. At the end of this chapter are some
resources for those interested in training in the person-centered approach to ex-
pressive arts therapy.
m ot i vat i o n a l i n t e r v i e w i n g
Motivational Interviewing (MI) is a humanistic, client-centered, psychosocial, di-
rective counseling approach that was developed by William R. Miller and Stephen
Rollnick in the early 1980s. The clinical and research applications of motivational
interviewing have received increased attention in recent years, and MI has been
shown to be effective as a relatively brief intervention (Levensky, Kersh, Cavasos, &
Brooks, 2008). MI has been defi ned as “a directive, client centered counseling
style for eliciting behavior change by helping clients to explore and resolve am-
bivalence” (Rollnick & Miller, 1995, p. 326). Motivational interviewing is based on
humanistic principles, has some basic similarities with person-centered therapy,
and expands the traditional person-centered approach.
Motivational interviewing was initially designed as a brief intervention for
problem drinking, but more recently this approach has been applied to a wide
range of clinical problems including substance abuse, compulsive gambling, eat-
ing disorders, anxiety disorders, depression, suicidality, chronic disease manage-
ment, and health behavior change practices (Arkowitz & Miller, 2008; Arkowitz &
Westra, 2009). MI stresses client self-responsibility and promotes an invitational
style for working cooperatively with clients to generate alternative solutions to
behavioral problems. MI therapists avoid arguing with clients, avoid assuming a
confrontational stance, reframe resistance as a healthy response, express empathy,
and listen refl ectively. MI therapists do not view clients as opponents to be de-
feated but as allies who play a major role in their present and future success. Both
MI and person-centered practitioners believe in the client’s abilities, strengths,
resources, and competencies. The underlying assumption is that clients want to be
healthy and desire positive change.
The MI Spirit
MI is rooted in the philosophy of person-centered therapy, but with a “twist.”
Unlike the nondirective and unstructured person-centered approach, MI is delib-
erately directive and is aimed at reducing client ambivalence about change and
increasing intrinsic motivation (Arkowitz & Miller, 2008). It is essential that thera-
pists function within the spirit of MI, rather than simply applying the strategies of
the approach (Levensky et al., 2008). The attitudes and skills in MI are based on a
person-centered philosophy and include using open-ended questions, employing
refl ective listening, affi rming and supporting the client, responding to resistance
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 191 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

192
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
E
V
E
N
in a nonconfrontational manner, guiding a discussion of ambivalence, summariz-
ing and linking at the end of sessions, and eliciting and reinforcing change talk.
MI works by activating clients’ own motivation for change and adherence to treat-
ment. Practitioners assist clients in becoming their own advocates for change and
the primary agents of change in their lives.
In both person-centered therapy and MI, the counselor provides the condi-
tions for growth and change by communicating attitudes of accurate empathy
and unconditional positive regard. In MI, the therapeutic relationship is as impor-
tant in achieving successful outcomes as the specifi c theoretical model or school
of psychotherapy from which the therapist operates (Miller & Rollnick, 2002).
Both MI and person-centered therapy are based on the premise that individuals
have within themselves the capacity to generate intrinsic motivation to change.
Responsibility for change rests with clients, not with the counselor, and therapist
and client share a sense of hope and optimism that change is possible. Once cli-
ents believe that they have the capacity to change and heal, new possibilities open
up for them.
The Basic Principles of Motivational Interviewing
Miller and Rollnick (2002) formulated fi ve basic principles of MI, which are sum-
marized below:
1. Therapists practicing motivational interviewing strive to experience the world
from the client’s perspective without judgment or criticism. MI emphasizes refl ec-
tive listening, which is a way for practitioners to better understand the subjective
world of clients. Expressing empathy is foundational in creating a safe climate for
clients to explore their ambivalence for change. When clients are slow to change,
it may be assumed that they have compelling reasons to remain as they are as well
as having reasons to change.
2. MI is designed to evoke and explore both discrepancies and ambivalence. Coun-
selors using MI refl ect discrepancies between the behaviors and values of clients to
increase the motivation to change. Counselors pay particular attention to clients’
arguments for changing compared to their arguments for not changing. Thera-
pists elicit and reinforce change talk by employing specifi c strategies to strengthen
discussion about change. MI therapists assume a directive stance by steering the
conversation in the direction of considering change without persuading clients to
change. Clinicians encourage clients to determine whether change will occur, and
if so, what kinds of changes will occur and when.
3. Reluctance to change is viewed as a normal and expected part of the therapeutic
process. Although individuals may see advantages to making life changes, they
also may have many concerns and fears about changing. People who seek therapy
are often ambivalent about change, and their motivation may ebb and fl ow dur-
ing the course of therapy. A central goal of MI is to increase internal motivation
to change based on the personal goals and values of clients (Arkowitz & Miller,
2008). MI therapists assume a respectful view of resistance and work therapeuti-
cally with any reluctance or caution on the part of clients.
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 192 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

193
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
4. Practitioners operating from an MI orientation support clients’ self-effi cacy,
mainly by encouraging them to use their own resources to take necessary actions
that can lead to success in changing. MI clinicians strive to enhance client agency
about change and emphasize the right and inherent ability of clients to formulate
their own personal goals and to make their own decisions. MI focuses on present
and future conditions and empowers clients to fi nd ways to achieve their goals.
5. When clients show signs of readiness to change through decreased resistance
to change and increased talk about change, a critical phase of MI begins. In this
stage, clients may express a desire and ability to change, show an interest in ques-
tions about change, experiment with making changes between sessions, and envi-
sion a future picture of how their life will be different once the desired changes
have been made. At this time therapists shift their focus toward strengthening
clients’ commitments to change and helping them implement a change plan.
The Stages of Change
The stages of change model assumes that people progress through a series of fi ve
identifi able stages in the counseling process. In the precontemplation stage, there is
no intention of changing a behavior pattern in the near future. In the contemplation
stage, people are aware of a problem and are considering overcoming it, but they
have not yet made a commitment to take action to bring about the change. In the
preparation stage, individuals intend to take action immediately and report some
small behavioral changes. In the action stage, individuals are taking steps to modify
their behavior to solve their problems. During the maintenance stage, people work
to consolidate their gains and prevent relapse.
People do not pass neatly through these fi ve stages in linear fashion, and a cli-
ent’s readiness can fl uctuate throughout the change process. If change is initially
unsuccessful, individuals may return to an earlier stage (Prochaska & Norcross,
2010). MI therapists strive to match specifi c interventions with whatever stage of
change clients are experiencing. If there is a mismatch between process and stage,
movement through the stage will be impeded and is likely to be manifested in
reluctant behavior. When clients demonstrate any form of reluctance or resistance,
this could be due to a therapist’s misjudgment of a client’s readiness to change.
Certain behaviors on a therapist’s part may lead to a client feeling invalidated or
misunderstood, which is likely to result in what appears to be a client’s resistive
behavior (Levensky et al., 2008).
Working within the framework of the stages of change model has implica-
tions for the therapist’s role at the different stages. Norcross, Krebs, and Prochaska
(2011) describe the relational stances and roles taken by therapists during the
course of therapy. With clients in the precontemplation stage, the role assumed
is that of a nurturing parent. With clients in contemplation, therapists function as
a Socratic teacher who encourages them to achieve their own insights. For clients
who are in the preparation stage, therapists take the stance of an experienced coach.
With clients who are progressing into action and maintenance, therapists function
in the role of a consultant. As termination approaches, therapists are consulted less
often as a way to foster client autonomy.
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 193 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

194
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
E
V
E
N
Motivational interviewing is but one example of how therapeutic strategies
have been developed based on the foundational principles and philosophy of the
person-centered approach. Indeed, most of the therapeutic models illustrate how
the core therapeutic conditions are necessary aspects leading to client change.
Where many therapeutic approaches, including motivational interviewing, diverge
from traditional person-centered therapy is the assumption that the therapeu-
tic factors are both necessary and suffi cient in bringing about change. Many other
models employ specifi c intervention strategies to address specifi c concerns clients
bring to therapy.
p e r s o n – c e n t e r e d t h e r a p y f r o m
a m u lt i c u lt u r a l p e r s p e c t i v e
Strengths From a Diversity Perspective
One of the strengths of the person-centered approach is its impact on the fi eld of
human relations with diverse cultural groups. Person-centered philosophy and prac-
tice can now be studied in several European countries, South America, and Japan.
Here are some examples of ways in which this approach has been incorporated in
various countries and cultures:
• In several European countries person-centered concepts have had a signifi cant
impact on the practice of counseling as well as on education, cross-cultural com-
munication, and reduction of racial and political tensions. In the 1980s Rogers
(1987b) elaborated on a theory of reducing tension among antagonistic groups
that he began developing in 1948.
• In the 1970s Rogers and his associates began conducting workshops promoting
cross-cultural communication. Well into the 1980s he led large workshops in
many parts of the world. International encounter groups have provided partici-
pants with multicultural experiences.
• Japan, Australia, South America, Mexico, and the United Kingdom have all
been receptive to person-centered concepts and have adapted these practices to
fi t their cultures.
• Shortly before his death, Rogers conducted intensive workshops with profes-
sionals in the former Soviet Union.
Cain (1987c) sums up the reach of the person-centered approach to cultural diver-
sity: “Our international family consists of millions of persons worldwide whose
lives have been affected by Carl Rogers’s writings and personal efforts as well as
his many colleagues who have brought his and their own innovative thinking and
programs to many corners of the earth” (p. 149).
There is no doubt that Carl Rogers has had a global impact. His work has reached
more than 30 countries, and his writings have been translated into 12 languages.
In addition to this global impact, the emphasis on the core conditions makes the
person-centered approach useful in understanding diverse worldviews. The under-
lying philosophy of person-centered therapy is grounded on the importance of hear-
ing the deeper messages of a client. Empathy, being present, and respecting the
values of clients are essential attitudes and skills in counseling culturally diverse
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 194 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

195
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
clients. Cain (2008, 2010) contends that although person-centered therapists are
aware of diversity factors, they do not make initial assumptions about individuals.
They realize that each client’s journey is unique and take steps to tailor their meth-
ods to fi t each individual.
Several writers consider person-centered therapy as being ideally suited to cli-
ents in a diverse world. Cain (2008, 2010) views this approach as being a potent
way of working with individuals representing a wide range of cultural backgrounds
because the core therapeutic conditions are qualities that are universal. Bohart and
Watson (2011) claim that the person-centered philosophy is particularly appropri-
ate for working with diverse client populations because the counselor does not
assume the role of expert who is going to impose a “right way of being” on the cli-
ent. Instead, the therapist is a “fellow explorer” who attempts to understand the cli-
ent’s phenomenological world in an interested, accepting, and open way and checks
with the client to confi rm that the therapist’s perceptions are accurate. Motivational
interviewing, which is based on the philosophy of person-centered therapy, is a cul-
turally sensitive approach that can be effective across population domains, includ-
ing gender, age, ethnicity, and sexual orientation (Levensky et al., 2008).
Shortcomings From a Diversity Perspective
Although the person-centered approach has made signifi cant contributions to
counseling people from diverse social, political, and cultural backgrounds, there
are some shortcomings to practicing exclusively within this framework. Many cli-
ents who come to community mental health clinics or who are involved in outpa-
tient treatment want more structure than this approach provides. Some clients
seek professional help to deal with a crisis, to alleviate emotional problems, or to
learn coping skills in dealing with everyday problems. Because of certain cultural
messages, when these clients do seek professional help, it may be as a last resort.
They often expect a directive counselor and can be put off by a professional who
does not provide suffi cient structure.
A second shortcoming of the person-centered approach is that it is diffi cult to
translate the core therapeutic conditions into actual practice in certain cultures.
Communication of these core conditions must be consistent with the client’s cul-
tural framework. Consider, for example, the expression of therapist congruence
and empathy. Clients accustomed to indirect communication may not be comfort-
able with direct expressions of empathy or self-disclosure on the therapist’s part.
For some clients the most appropriate way to express empathy is for the therapist
to demonstrate it indirectly through respecting their need for distance or through
suggesting task-focused interventions (Bohart & Greenberg, 1997).
A third shortcoming in applying the person-centered approach with clients
from diverse cultures pertains to the fact that this approach extols the value of
an internal locus of evaluation. The humanistic foundation of person-centered
therapy emphasizes dimensions such as self-awareness, freedom, autonomy, self-
acceptance, inner-directedness, and self-actualization. In collectivist cultures, cli-
ents are likely to be highly infl uenced by societal expectations and not simply mo-
tivated by their own personal preferences. The focus on development of individual
autonomy and personal growth may be viewed as being selfi sh in a culture that
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 195 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

196
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
E
V
E
N
stresses the common good. Cain (2010) contends that “persons from collectivistic
cultures are oriented less toward self-actualization and more toward intimacy, con-
nection, and harmony with others and toward what is best for the community and
the common good” (p. 143).
Consider Lupe, a Latina client who values the interests of her family over her
self-interests. From a person-centered perspective she could be viewed as being in
danger of “losing her own identity” by being primarily concerned with her role in
taking care of others in the family. Rather than pushing her to make her personal
wants a priority, the counselor will explore Lupe’s cultural values and her level of
commitment to these values in working with her. It would be inappropriate for the
counselor to impose a vision of the kind of woman she should be. (This topic is
discussed more extensively in Chapter 12.)
Although there may be particular shortcomings in practicing exclusively with-
in a person-centered perspective, it should not be concluded that this approach is
unsuitable for working with clients from diverse cultures. There is great diversity
among any group of people, and therefore, there is room for a variety of thera-
peutic styles. According to Cain (2010), rigid insistence on a nondirective style of
counseling for all clients, regardless of their cultural background or personal pref-
erence, may be perceived as an imposition that does not fi t the client’s interper-
sonal and therapeutic needs. Counseling a culturally different client may require
more activity and structuring than is usually the case in a person-centered frame-
work, but the potential positive impact of a counselor who responds empathically
to a culturally different client cannot be overestimated.
Stan’s autobiography indicates that
he has a sense of what he wants
for his life. As a person-centered
therapist, I rely on his self-report of the way he
views himself rather than on a formal assess-
ment and diagnosis. My concern is with under-
standing him from his internal frame of refer-
ence. Stan has stated goals that are meaningful
for him. He is motivated to change and seems
to have sufficient anxiety to work toward these
desired changes. I have faith in Stan’s ability
to find his own way, and I trust that he has the
necessary resources for reaching his therapy
goals. I encourage Stan to speak freely about
the discrepancy between the person he sees
himself as being and the person he would like
to become; about his feelings of being a failure,
being inadequate; about his fears and uncer-
tainties; and about his hopelessness at
times. I attempt to create an atmosphere of
freedom and security that will encourage Stan
to explore the threatening aspects of his
self-concept.
Stan has a low evaluation of his self-worth.
Although he finds it difficult to believe that
others really like him, he wants to feel loved.
He says, “I hope I can learn to love at least a
few people, most of all, women.” He wants to
feel equal to others and not have to apologize
for his existence, yet most of the time he feels
inferior. By creating a supportive, trusting, and
encouraging atmosphere, I can help Stan learn
to be more accepting of himself, with both his
strengths and limitations. He has the opportu-
nity to openly express his fears of women, of
not being able to work with people, and of feel-
ing inadequate and stupid. He can explore how
he feels judged by his parents and by
Person-Centered Therapy Applied to the Case of Stan
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 196 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

s u m m a ry a n d e va l u at i o n
Summary
Person-centered therapy is based on a philosophy of human nature that postulates
an innate striving for self-actualization. Further, Rogers’s view of human nature
is phenomenological; that is, we structure ourselves according to our perceptions
of reality. We are motivated to actualize ourselves in the reality that we perceive.
Rogers’s theory rests on the assumption that clients can understand the fac-
tors in their lives that are causing them to be unhappy. They also have the capacity
for self-direction and constructive personal change. Change will occur if a con-
gruent therapist makes psychological contact with a client in a state of anxiety or
incongruence. It is essential for the therapist to establish a relationship the cli-
ent perceives as genuine, accepting, and understanding. Therapeutic counseling
is based on an I/Thou, or person-to-person, relationship in the safety and accept-
ance of which clients drop their defenses and come to accept and integrate aspects
that they have denied or distorted. The person-centered approach emphasizes this
authorities. He has an opportunity to express
his guilt—that is, his feelings that he has not
lived up to his parents’ expectations and that
he has let them and himself down. He can
also relate his feelings of hurt over not having
ever felt loved and wanted. He can express the
loneliness and isolation that he so often feels,
as well as the need to numb these feelings with
alcohol or drugs.
Stan is no longer totally alone, for he is taking
the risk of letting me into his private world of
feelings. Stan gradually gets a sharper focus on
his experiencing and is able to clarify his own
feelings and attitudes. He sees that he has the
capacity to make his own decisions. In short, our
therapeutic relationship frees him from his self-
defeating ways. Because of the caring and faith
he experiences from me in our relationship, Stan
is able to increase his own faith and confidence
in himself.
My empathy assists Stan in hearing him-
self and accessing himself at a deeper level.
Stan gradually becomes more sensitive to his
own internal messages and less dependent on
confirmation from others around him. As a result
of the therapeutic venture, Stan discovers that
there is someone in his life whom he can depend
on—himself.
Follow-Up: You Continue as Stan’s Person-
Centered Therapist
Use these questions to help you think about how
you would counsel Stan using a person-centered
approach:
• How would you respond to Stan’s deep feelings
of self-doubt? Could you enter his frame of ref-
erence and respond in an empathic manner that
lets Stan know you hear his pain and struggle
without needing to give advice or suggestions?
• How would you describe Stan’s deeper strug-
gles? What sense do you have of his world?
• To what extent do you think that the relation-
ship you would develop with Stan would help
him move forward in a positive direction?
What, if anything, might get in your way—
either with him or in yourself—in establishing
a therapeutic relationship?
See DVD for Theory and Practice of
Counseling and Psychotherapy: The Case
of Stan and Lecturettes (Session 5 on person-
centered therapy) for a demonstration of my
approach to counseling Stan from this perspec-
tive. This session focuses on exploring the
immediacy of our relationship and assisting
Stan in finding his own way.
197
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 197 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

198
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
E
V
E
N
personal relationship between client and therapist; the therapist’s attitudes are
more critical than are knowledge, theory, or techniques employed. In the context
of this relationship, clients unleash their growth potential and become more of the
person they are capable of becoming.
This approach places primary responsibility for the direction of therapy on the
client. In the therapeutic context, individuals have the opportunity to decide for
themselves and come to terms with their own personal power. The underlying
assumption is that no one knows the client better than the client; in short, the cli-
ent is viewed as an expert on his or her own life (Cain, 2010). The general goals
of therapy are becoming more open to experience, achieving self-trust, developing
an internal source of evaluation, and being willing to continue growing. Specifi c
goals are not suggested for clients; rather, clients choose their own values and
goals. Current applications of the theory emphasize more active participation by
the therapist than was the case earlier. Counselors are now encouraged to be fully
involved as persons in the therapeutic relationship. More latitude is allowed for
therapists to express their reactions and feelings as they are appropriate to what is
occurring in therapy. Person-centered practitioners are willing to be transparent
about persistent feelings that exist in their relationships with clients (Watson et al.,
2011). It is the therapist’s job to adapt and accommodate in a manner that works
best for each client, which means being fl exible in the application of methods in
the counseling process (Cain, 2010).
Contributions of the Person-Centered Approach
When Rogers founded nondirective counseling more than 70 years ago, there
were very few other therapeutic models. The longevity of this approach is certainly
a factor to consider in assessing its infl uence. Cain (2008) states: “An extensive
body of research has been generated and provides support for the effectiveness
of person-centered therapy with a wide range of clients and problems of all age
groups” (p. 214).
Rogers had, and his theory continues to have, a major impact on the fi eld of
counseling and psychotherapy. When he introduced his revolutionary ideas in the
1940s, he provided a powerful and radical alternative to psychoanalysis and to the
directive approaches then practiced. Rogers was a pioneer in shifting the therapeu-
tic focus from an emphasis on technique and reliance on therapist authority to that
of the power of the therapeutic relationship.
Kirschenbaum (2009) contends that the scope and infl uence of Rogers’s work
has continued well beyond his death; the person-centered approach is alive, well,
and expanding. Today there is not one version of person-centered therapy, but a
number of continuously evolving person-centered psychotherapies (Cain, 2010).
Although few psychotherapists claim to have an exclusive person-centered theo-
retical orientation, the philosophy and principles of this approach permeate the
practice of most therapists. Other schools of therapy are increasingly recogniz-
ing the centrality of the therapeutic relationship as a route to therapeutic change
(Kirschenbaum, 2009).
Person-centered therapy is strongly represented in Europe, and there is con-
tinuing interest in this approach in both South America and the Far East. The
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 198 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

199
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
person-centered approach has established a fi rm foothold in British universities.
According to Natalie Rogers (2011), some of the most in-depth training of person-
centered counselors is in the United Kingdom. In addition, British scholars includ-
ing Fairhurst (1999), Keys (2003), Lago and Smith (2003), Mearns and Cooper
(2005), Mearns and Thorne (2000, 2007), Merry (1999), Natiello (2001), Thorne
(2002a, 2002b), and Watson (2003) continue to expand and refi ne this approach.
As we have seen, Natalie Rogers has made a signifi cant contribution to the
application of the person-centered approach by incorporating the expressive arts as
a medium to facilitate healing and social change, primarily in a group setting. She
has been instrumental in the evolution of the person-centered approach by using
nonverbal methods to enable individuals to heal and to develop. Many individu-
als who have diffi culty expressing themselves verbally can fi nd new possibilities
for self-expression through nonverbal channels and through the expressive arts
(N. Rogers, 2011).
e m p h a s i s o n r e s e a r c h One of Rogers’s contributions to the fi eld of psy-
chotherapy was his willingness to state his concepts as testable hypotheses and to
submit them to research. He literally opened the fi eld to research. He was truly a
pioneer in his insistence on subjecting the transcripts of therapy sessions to criti-
cal examination and applying research technology to counselor–client dialogues
(Combs, 1988). Rogers’s basic hypothesis gave rise to a great deal of research and
debate in the fi eld of psychotherapy, perhaps more than any other school of ther-
apy (Cain, 2002a). According to Cain (2010), an enormous body of research, con-
ducted over a period of 70 years, supports the effectiveness of the person-centered
approach. This research is ongoing in many parts of the world and continues to
expand and refi ne our understanding of what constitutes effective psychotherapy.
Cain (2010) concludes, “person centered therapy is as vital and effective as it has
ever been and continues to develop in ways that will make it increasingly so in the
years to come” (p. 169).
Even his critics give Rogers credit for having conducted and inspired others to
conduct extensive studies of counseling process and outcome. Rogers presented a
challenge to psychology to design new models of scientifi c investigation capable of
dealing with the inner, subjective experiences of the person. His theories of ther-
apy and personality change have had a tremendous heuristic effect, and though
much controversy surrounds this approach, his work has challenged practitioners
and theoreticians to examine their own therapeutic styles and beliefs.
t h e i m p o r ta n c e o f e m pat h y Among the major contributions of person-
centered therapy are the implications of empathy for the practice of counseling.
More than any other approach, person-centered therapy has demonstrated that
therapist empathy plays a vital role in facilitating constructive change in the client.
Watson’s (2002) comprehensive review of the research literature on therapeutic
empathy has consistently demonstrated that therapist empathy is the most potent
predictor of client progress in therapy. Indeed, empathy is an essential component
of successful therapy in every therapeutic modality.
Person-centered research has been conducted predominantly on the hypoth-
esized necessary and suffi cient conditions of therapeutic personality change (Cain,
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 199 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

200
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
E
V
E
N
1986, 1987b). Most of the other counseling approaches covered in this book have
incorporated the importance of the therapist’s attitude and behavior in creating a
therapeutic relationship that is conducive to the use of their techniques. For in-
stance, the cognitive behavioral approaches have developed a wide range of strate-
gies designed to help clients deal with specifi c problems, and they recognize that
a trusting and accepting client–therapist relationship is necessary for successful
application of these procedures. In contrast to the person-centered approach, how-
ever, cognitive behavioral practitioners contend that the working relationship is
not suffi cient to produce change. They contend that active procedures, in combina-
tion with a collaborative relationship, are needed to bring about change.
i n n o vat i o n s i n p e r s o n – c e n t e r e d t h e r a p y One of the strengths
of the person-centered approach is “the development of innovative and sophisti-
cated methods to work with an increasingly diffi cult, diverse, and complex range
of individuals, couples, families, and groups” (Cain, 2002b, p. xxii). A number of
people have made signifi cant advancements that are compatible with the essential
values and concepts of person-centered therapy. Table 7.1 describes some of the
innovators who have played a role in the evolution of person-centered therapy.
Rogers consistently opposed the institutionalization of a client-centered
“school.” Likewise, he reacted negatively to the idea of founding institutes, grant-
ing certifi cates, and setting standards for membership. He feared this institution-
alization would lead to an increasingly narrow, rigid, and dogmatic perspective. If
Rogers (1987a) were to give students-in-training advice it would be: “There is one
best school of therapy. It is the school of therapy you develop for yourself based on
a continuing critical examination of the effects of your way of being in the relation-
ship” (p. 185).
e m ot i o n – f o c u s e d t h e r a p y One of the developments associated with
the person-centered approach is the emergence of emotion-focused therapy (EFT).
Leslie Greenberg (2011) is a prominent fi gure in the development of this integra-
tive approach. Emotion-focused therapy is rooted in a person-centered philosophy,
but it is integrative in that it synthesizes aspects of Gestalt therapy and existential
therapy. EFT is a therapeutic practice informed by an understanding of the role of
emotion in psychotherapeutic change. A number of strategies in EFT are aimed
at the goal of strengthening the self, regulating affect, and creating new mean-
ing. Many traditional therapies emphasize conscious understanding and cognitive
and behavioral change, yet they often neglect the foundational role of emotional
change. EFT emphasizes the importance of awareness, acceptance, and under-
standing of emotion and the visceral experience of emotion. In EFT, clients are
assisted to identify, experience, accept, explore, transform, and manage their emo-
tions. A premise of EFT is that we can change only when we accept ourselves as
we are. This approach has a good deal to offer with respect to teaching us about the
role of emotion in personal change and how emotional change can be a primary
pathway to cognitive and behavioral change.
Other therapeutic approaches are increasingly focusing on emotions. For
example, both psychoanalytic and cognitive behavioral approaches are giving more
attention to the role of emotions and are rapidly assimilating many aspects of EFT.
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 200 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

201
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
TA B L E 7.1 Therapists Who Contributed to the Evolution
of Person-Centered Theory
I N N O V A T O R C O N T R I B U T I O N
Natalie Rogers (1993, 1995, 2011) Expanded the theory by developing person-centered
expressive arts therapy in groups.
Virginia Axline (1964, 1969) Made signifi cant contributions to client-centered
therapy with children and play therapy.
Eugene Gendlin (1996) Developed experiential techniques, such as focusing, as
a way to enhance client experiencing.
Laura Rice (Rice & Greenberg,
1984)
Taught therapists to be more evocative in re-creating
crucial experiences that continue to trouble the client.
Peggy Natiello (2001) Works on collaborative power and gender issues.
Art Combs (1988, 1989, 1999) Developed perceptual psychology.
Leslie Greenberg (2011); Greenberg
and colleagues (Greenberg,
Korman, & Paivio, 2002;
Greenberg, Rice, & Elliott, 1993)
Contributed to the development of emotion-focused
therapy. Focused on the importance of facilitating
emotional change in therapy and advanced person-
centered theory and methods. Demonstrated that the
emotional route can be a key to changing cognitions
and behavior.
David Rennie (1998) Provided a glimpse at the inner workings of the
therapeutic process.
Art Bohart (Bohart & Greenberg,
1997; Bohart & Tallman, 1999;
2010; Bohart & Watson, 2011)
Contributed to a deeper understanding of empathy in
therapeutic practice and the active role of the client.
Jeanne Watson (2002) Demonstrated that when empathy is operating on the
cognitive, affective, and interpersonal levels it is one of
the therapist’s most powerful tools.
Dave Mearns and Brian Thorne
(2000, 2007)
Contributed to understanding new frontiers in the
theory and practice of the person-centered approach
and have been signifi cant fi gures in teaching and
supervising in the United Kingdom.
C. H. Patterson (1995) Showed that client-centered therapy is a universal
system of psychotherapy.
Barry Duncan, Scott Miller, Bruce
Wampold, & Mark Hubble (2010)
Demonstrated that the client-centered relationship
and the core conditions are essential to all therapeutic
approaches.
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 201 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

202
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
E
V
E
N
A strength of EFT is that it is an evidence-based approach, an idea that is increas-
ingly being emphasized in graduate programs (Greenberg, 2011).
Limitations and Criticisms of the Person-Centered Approach
Although I applaud person-centered therapists for their willingness to subject their
hypotheses and procedures to empirical scrutiny, some researchers have been crit-
ical of the methodological errors contained in some of these studies. Accusations
of scientifi c shortcomings involve using control subjects who are not candidates
for therapy, failing to use an untreated control group, failing to account for placebo
effects, relying on self-reports as a major way to assess the outcomes of therapy,
and using inappropriate statistical procedures.
There is a similar limitation shared by both the person-centered and existential
(experiential) approaches. Neither of these therapeutic modalities emphasizes the
role of techniques aimed at bringing about change in clients’ behavior. Proponents
of psychotherapy manuals, or manualized treatment methods for specifi c disor-
ders, fi nd serious limitations in the experiential approaches due to their lack of
attention to proven techniques and strategies. Those who call for accountability as
defi ned by evidence-based practices within the fi eld of mental health also are quite
critical of the experiential approaches.
I do not believe manualized treatment methods can be considered the gold
standard in psychotherapy, however. There is good research demonstrating that
techniques account for only 15% of client outcome (see Duncan et al., 2010), whereas
contextual factors have powerful effects on what happens in therapy (Elkins, 2009).
Research points to relational and client factors as the main predictors of effective
therapy. Furthermore, the evaluation of evidence-based practices should be broad-
ened to include best available research, the expertise of the clinician, and client char-
acteristics, culture, and preferences (see Norcross, Hogan, & Koocher, 2008).
A potential limitation of the person-centered approach is that some students-in-
training and practitioners with this orientation may have a tendency to be very support-
ive of clients without being challenging. Out of their misunderstanding of the basic
concepts of the approach, some have limited the range of their responses and coun-
seling styles mainly to refl ections and empathic listening. Although there is value in
really hearing a client and in refl ecting and communicating understanding, counseling
entails more than this. I believe that the therapeutic core conditions are necessary for
therapy to succeed, yet I do not see them as being suffi cient conditions for change for
all clients at all times. From my perspective, these basic attitudes are the foundation on
which counselors must then build the skills of therapeutic intervention. Motivational
interviewing rests on the therapeutic core conditions, for example, but MI employs a
range of strategies that enable clients to develop action plans leading to change.
A related challenge for counselors using this approach is to truly support
clients in fi nding their own way. Counselors sometimes experience diffi culty in
allowing clients to decide their own specifi c goals in therapy. It is easy to give lip
service to the concept of clients’ fi nding their own way, but it takes considerable
respect for clients and faith on the therapist’s part to encourage clients to listen to
themselves and follow their own directions, particularly when they make choices
that are not what the therapist hoped for.
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 202 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

203
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
More than any other quality, the therapist’s genuineness determines the power
of the therapeutic relationship. If therapists submerge their unique identity and style
in a passive and nondirective manner, they are not likely to affect clients in powerful
ways. Therapist authenticity and congruence are so vital to this approach that those
who practice within this framework must feel natural in doing so and must fi nd a
way to express their own reactions to clients. If not, a real possibility is that person-
centered therapy will be reduced to a bland, safe, and ineffectual approach.
w h e r e to g o f r o m h e r e
In the DVD for Integrative Counseling: The Case of Ruth and Lecturettes, you will see
a concrete illustration of how I view the therapeutic relationship as the foundation
for our work together. Refer especially to Session 1 (“Beginning of Counseling”),
Session 2 (“The Therapeutic Relationship”), and Session 3 (“Establishing Thera-
peutic Goals”) for a demonstration of how I apply principles from the person-
centered approach to my work with Ruth.
Free Podcasts for ACA Members
You can download ACA Podcasts (prerecorded interviews) by going to www.coun-
seling.org; click on the Resource button and then select the Podcast Series. For
Chapter 7, Carl Rogers and the Person-Centered Approach, look for Podcast 7 by
by Dr. Howard Kirschenbaum.
Other Resources
The American Psychological Association offers the following DVDs in their Psy-
chotherapy Video Series:
Greenberg, L. S. (2010). Emotion-Focused Therapy Over Time
Cain, D. J. (2010). Person-Centered Therapy Over Time
Psychotherapy.net is a comprehensive resource for students and professionals that
offers videos and interviews featuring Natalie Rogers, Rollo May, and more. New
articles, interviews, blogs, therapy cartoons, and videos are published monthly.
DVDs relevant to this chapter are available at www.psychotherapy.net and include
the following:
Rogers, N. (1997). Person-Centered Expressive Arts Therapy
May, R. (2007). Rollo May on Existential Psychotherapy
Association for the Development of the Person-Centered Approach, Inc. (ADPCA)
P. O. Box 3876
Chicago, IL 60690-3876
E-mail: enquiries@adpca.org
Website: www.adpca.org
Journal Editor: jonmrose@aol.com
The Association for the Development of the Person-Centered Approach (ADPCA)
is an interdisciplinary and international organization that consists of a network of
individuals who support the development and application of the person-centered
approach. Membership includes a subscription to the Person-Centered Journal, the
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 203 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

204
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
E
V
E
N
association’s newsletter, a membership directory, and information about the an-
nual meeting. ADPCA also provides information about continuing education and
supervision and training in the person-centered approach. For information about
the Person-Centered Journal, contact the editor (Jon Rose).
Association for Humanistic Psychology
1516 Oak Street #320A
Alameda, CA 94501-2947
Telephone: (510) 769-6495
Fax: (510) 769-6433
E-mail: AHPOffice@aol.com
Website: www.ahpweb.org
Journal website: http://jhp.sagepub.com
The Association for Humanistic Psychology (AHP) is devoted to promoting per-
sonal integrity, creative learning, and active responsibility in embracing the chal-
lenges of being human in these times. Information about the Journal of Human-
istic Psychology is available from the Association for Humanistic Psychology or at
publisher’s website.
Society for Humanistic Psychology
Website: http://www.societyforhumanisticpsychology.com/
Division 32 of APA, Society for Humanistic Psychology, represents a constellation
of “humanistic psychologies” that includes the earlier Rogerian, transpersonal,
and existential orientations as well as the more recently developing perspectives.
Division 32 seeks to contribute to psychotherapy, education, theory, research, epis-
temological diversity, cultural diversity, organization, management, social respon-
sibility, and change. The division has been at the forefront in the development of
qualitative research methodologies. The Society for Humanistic Psychology offers
journal access to The Humanistic Psychologist. Information about membership,
conferences, and journals is available from the website of Division 32.
Carl Rogers: A Daughter’s Tribute
Website: www.nrogers.com
The Carl Rogers CD-ROM is a visually beautiful and lasting archive of the life
and works of the founder of humanistic psychology. It includes excerpts from his
16 books, over 120 photographs spanning his lifetime, and award-winning video
footage of two encounter groups and Carl’s early counseling sessions. It is an es-
sential resource for students, teachers, libraries, and universities. It is a profound
tribute to one of the most important thinkers, infl uential psychologists, and peace
activists of the 20th century. Developed for Natalie Rogers, PhD, by Mindgarden
Media, Inc.
Center for Studies of the Person
1150 Silverado, Suite #112
La Jolla, CA 92037
Telephone: (858) 459-3861
E-mail: centerfortheperson@yahoo.com
Website: www.centerfortheperson.org
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 204 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

205
The Center for Studies of the Person (CSP) offers workshops, training seminars, ex-
periential small groups, residential workshops, and sharing of learning in community
meetings. The Distance Learning Project and the Carl Rogers Institute for Psychother-
apy Training and Supervision provide experiential and didactic training and supervi-
sion for professionals interested in developing their own person-centered orientation.
Saybrook Graduate School
E-mail: admissions@saybrook.edu
Website: www.nrogers.com
For training in expressive art therapy, you could join Natalie Rogers, PhD, and Shel-
lee Davis, MA, faculty of the certifi cate program at Saybrook Graduate School in
their course, “Expressive Arts for Healing and Social Change: A Person-Centered
Approach.” A 16-unit certifi cate program includes 6 separate weeks spread over 2
years at a retreat center north of San Francisco. Rogers and Davis offer expressive
arts within a person-centered counseling framework. They use counseling demon-
strations, practice counseling sessions, readings, discussions, papers, and a creative
project to teach experiential and theoretical methods.
Recommended Supplementary Readings
On Becoming a Person (Rogers, 1961) is one of the best primary sources for fur-
ther reading on person-centered therapy. This is a collection of Rogers’s articles
on the process of psychotherapy, its outcomes, the therapeutic relationship, edu-
cation, family life, communication, and the nature of the healthy person.
A Way of Being (Rogers, 1980) contains a series of writings on Rogers’s personal
experiences and perspectives, as well as chapters on the foundations and applica-
tions of the person-centered approach.
The Creative Connection: Expressive Arts as Healing (N. Rogers, 1993) is a practical,
spirited book lavishly illustrated with color and action photos and fi lled with fresh
ideas to stimulate creativity, self-expression, healing, and transformation. Natalie
Rogers combines the philosophy of her father with the expressive arts to enhance
communication between client and therapist.
The Life and Work of Carl Rogers (Kirschenbaum, 2009) is a defi nitive biography
of Carl Rogers that follows his life from his early childhood through his death.
This book illustrates the legacy of Carl Rogers and shows his enormous infl uence
on the fi eld of counseling and psychotherapy.
Person-Centered Psychotherapies (Cain, 2010) contains a clear discussion of person-
centered theory, the therapeutic process, evaluation of the approach, and future
developments.
Humanistic Psychology: A Clinical Manifesto (Elkins, 2009) offers an insightful
critique of the medical model of psychotherapy and the myth of empirically
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 205 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

supported treatments. The author calls for a relationship-based approach to psy-
chotherapy that can provide both individual and social transformation.
References and Suggested Readings
206
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
E
V
E
N
*Arkowitz, H., & Miller, W. R. (2008). Learn-
ing, applying, and extending motivational
interviewing. In H. Arkowitiz, H. A. Westra,
W. R. Miller, & S. Rollnick (Eds.), Motivation-
al interviewing in the treatment of psychologi-
cal disorders (pp. 1–25). New York: Guilford
Press.
Arkowitz, H., & Westra, H. A. (2009). Intro-
duction to the special series on motivational
interviewing and psychotherapy. Journal of
Clinical Psychology, 65(11), 1149–1155.
*Arkowitz, H., Westra, H. A., Miller, W. R., &
Rollnick, S. (Eds.). (2008). Motivational
interviewing in the treatment of psychological
problems. New York: Guilford Press.
Axline, V. (1964). Dibs: In search of self.
New York: Ballantine.
Axline, V. (1969). Play therapy (Rev. ed.).
New York: Ballantine.
*Bohart, A. C., & Greenberg, L. S. (Eds.).
(1997). Empathy reconsidered: New directions
in psychotherapy. Washington, DC: American
Psychological Association.
*Bohart, A. C., & Tallman, K. (1999). How
clients make therapy work: The process of active
self-healing. Washington, DC: American
Psychological Association.
*Bohart, A. C., & Tallman, K. (2010). Clients:
The neglected common factor in psychotherapy.
In B. L. Duncan, S. D. Miller, B. E. Wampold, &
M. A. Hubble (Eds.), The heart and soul of
change: Delivering what works in therapy (2nd
ed., pp. 83–111). Washington, DC: American
Psychological Association.
Bohart, A. C., & Watson, J. C. (2011). Person-
centered psychotherapy and related experien-
tial approaches. In S. B. Messer & A. S.
Gurman, (Eds.), Essential psychotherapies:
Theory and practice (3rd ed., pp. 223–260).
New York: Guilford Press.
*Bozarth, J. D., Zimring, F. M., & Tausch, R.
(2002). Client-centered therapy: The evolu-
tion of a revolution. In D. J. Cain & J. Seeman
(Eds.), Humanistic psychotherapies: Handbook of
research and practice (pp. 147–188). Washing-
ton, DC: American Psychological Association.
Brodley, B. T. (1999). The actualizing ten-
dency concept in client-centered theory. The
Person-Centered Journal, 6(2), 108–120.
Cain, D. J. (1986). Editorial: A call for the “write
stuff.” Person-Centered Review, 1(2), 117–124.
Cain, D. J. (1987a). Carl Rogers’ life in review.
Person-Centered Review, 2(4), 476–506.
Cain, D. J. (1987b). Carl R. Rogers: The man,
his vision, his impact. Person-Centered Review,
2(3), 283–288.
Cain, D. J. (1987c). Our international family.
Person-Centered Review, 2(2), 139–149.
*Cain, D. J. (2002a). Defining characteris-
tics, history, and evolution of humanistic
psychotherapies. In D. J. Cain & J. Seeman
(Eds.), Humanistic psychotherapies: Handbook of
research and practice (pp. 3–54). Washington,
DC: American Psychological Association.
Cain, D. J. (2002b). Preface. In D. J. Cain & J.
Seeman (Eds.), Humanistic psychotherapies: Hand-
book of research and practice (pp. xix–xxvi). Wash-
ington, DC: American Psychological Association.
*Cain, D. J. (2008). Person-centered therapy.
In J. Frew & M. D. Spiegler (Eds.), Contempo-
rary psychotherapies for a diverse world
(pp. 177–227). Boston: Lahaska Press.
*Cain, D. J. (2010). Person-centered psychothera-
pies. Washington, DC: American Psychological
Association.
*Cain, D. J., & Seeman, J. (Eds.). (2002). Hu-
manistic psychotherapies: Handbook of research
and practice. Washington, DC: American
Psychological Association.
*Books and articles marked with an asterisk are suggested for further study.
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 206 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

Clark, A. J. (2010). Empathy: An integral
model in the counseling process. Journal
of Counseling & Development, 88(3),
348–356.
Combs, A. W. (1988). Some current issues
for person-centered therapy. Person-Centered
Review, 3(3), 263–276.
Combs, A. W. (1989). A theory of therapy:
Guidelines for counseling practice. Newbury Park,
CA: Sage.
Combs, A. W. (1999). Being and becoming.
New York: Springer.
Corey, G. (2012). Theory and practice of group
counseling (8th ed.). Belmont, CA: Brooks/
Cole, Cengage Learning.
Corey, G. (2013). Case approach to counseling
and psychotherapy (8th ed.). Belmont, CA:
Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning.
*Duncan, B. L., Miller, S. D., Wampold, B. E., &
Hubble, M. A. (Eds.). (2010). The heart and
soul of change (2nd ed.). Washington, DC:
American Psychological Association.
*Elkins, D. N. (2009). Humanistic psychology:
A clinical manifesto. Colorado Springs, CO:
University of the Rockies Press.
Elliott, R., Bohart, A. C., Watson, J. C., &
Greenberg, L. S. (2011). Empathy. In J.C.
Norcross (Ed.), Psychotherapy relationships that
work: Evidence-based responsiveness (2nd ed.,
pp. 132–152). New York: Oxford University
Press.
Farber, B. A., & Doolin, E. M. (2011).
Positive regard and affirmation. In J.C.
Norcross (Ed.), Psychotherapy relationships that
work: Evidence-based responsiveness (2nd ed.,
pp. 168–186). New York: Oxford University
Press.
Fairhurst, I. (Ed.). (1999). Women writing in
the person-centred approach. Ross-on-Wye:
PCCS Books.
*Gendlin, E. T. (1996). Focusing-oriented
psychotherapy: A manual of the experiential
method. New York: Guilford Press.
*Greenberg, L. S. (2011). Emotion-focused
therapy. Washington, DC: American Psycho-
logical Association.
*Greenberg, L. S., Korman, L. M., & Paivio, S. C.
(2002). Emotion in humanistic psychotherapy.
In D. J. Cain & J. Seeman (Eds.), Humanistic
psychotherapies: Handbook of research and
practice (pp. 499–530). Washington, DC:
American Psychological Association.
*Greenberg, L. S., Rice, L. N., & Elliott, R.
(1993). Facilitating emotional change: The
moment-by-moment process. New York:
Guilford Press.
Keys, S. (Ed.). (2003). Idiosyncratic person-
centred therapy: From the personal to the univer-
sal. Ross-on-Wye: PCCS Books.
*Kirschenbaum, H. (2009). The life and work of
Carl Rogers. Alexandria, VA: American Coun-
seling Association.
*Kirschenbaum, H., & Henderson, V. (Eds.).
(1989). The Carl Rogers reader. Boston:
Houghton Mifflin.
Koldon, G. G., Klein, M. H., Wang, C., & Austin,
S. B. (2011). Congruence/genuineness. In J. C.
Norcross (Ed.), Psychotherapy relationships that
work: Evidence-based responsiveness (2nd ed.,
pp. 187–202). New York: Oxford University Press.
Lago, C., & Smith, B. (Eds.). (2003). Anti-dis-
criminatory counselling practice. London: Sage.
Levensky, E. R., Kersh, B. C., Cavasos, L. L., &
Brooks, J. A. (2008). Motivational interview-
ing. In W. O’Donohue, & J. E. Fisher (Eds.),
Cognitive behavior therapy: Applying empirically
supported techniques in your practice (2nd ed.,
pp. 357–366). Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.
Maslow, A. (1968). Toward a psychology of
being. New York: Van Nostrand Reinhold.
Maslow, A. (1970). Motivation and personality
(2nd ed.). New York: Harper & Row.
Maslow, A. (1971). The farther reaches of
human nature. New York: Viking.
Mearns, D. (2003). Developing person-centred
counselling (2nd ed.). London: Sage.
*Mearns, D., & Cooper, M. (2005). Working at
relational depth in counselling and psychotherapy.
London: Sage.
*Mearns, D., & Thorne, B. (2000). Person-
centred therapy today: New frontiers in theory
and practice. London: Sage.
207
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 207 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

*Mearns, D., & Thorne, B. (2007). Person-
centred counselling in action (3rd ed.). London:
Sage.
Merry, T. (1999). Learning and being in person-
centred counselling. Ross-on-Wye: PCCS Books.
*Miller, W. R., & Rollnick, S. (2002). Motiva-
tional interviewing: Preparing people for change
(2nd ed.). New York: Guilford Press.
*Natiello, P. (2001). The person-centred ap-
proach: A passionate presence. Ross-on-Wye:
PCCS Books.
*Norcross, J. C. (2010). The therapeutic
relationship. In B. L. Duncan, S. D. Miller, B. E.
Wampold, & M. A. Hubble (Eds.), The heart
and soul of change: Delivering what works in
therapy (2nd ed., pp. 113–141). Washington,
DC: American Psychological Association.
*Norcross, J. C., Hogan, T. P., & Koocher, G. P.
(2008). Clinician’s guide to evidence-based prac-
tices. New York: Oxford University Press.
Norcross, J. C., Krebs, P. M., & Prochaska, J. O.
(2011). Stages of change. In J.C. Norcross (Ed.),
Psychotherapy relationships that work: Evidence-
based responsiveness (2nd ed., pp. 279–300).
New York: Oxford University Press.
Patterson, C. H. (1995). A universal system
of psychotherapy. The Person-Centered Journal,
2(1), 54–62.
Prochaska, J., & Norcross, J. (2010). Systems
of psychotherapy: A transtheoretical analysis
(7th ed.). Belmont, CA: Brooks/Cole, Cengage
Learning.
Raskin, N. J., Rogers, C. R., & Witty, M. (2008).
Client-centered therapy. In R. Corsini & D.
Wedding (Eds.), Current psychotherapies (8th
ed., pp. 141–186). Belmont, CA: Thomson
Brooks/Cole.
Rennie, D. L. (1998). Person-centered coun-
seling: An experiential approach. London: Sage.
Rice, L. N., & Greenberg, L. (1984). Patterns of
change. New York: Guilford Press.
Rogers, C. (1942). Counseling and psycho-
therapy: Newer concepts in practice. Boston:
Houghton Mifflin.
Rogers, C. (1951). Client-centered therapy.
Boston: Houghton Mifflin.
Rogers, C. (1957). The necessary and sufficient
conditions of therapeutic personality change.
Journal of Consulting Psychology, 21, 95–103.
*Rogers, C. (1961). On becoming a person.
Boston: Houghton Mifflin.
Rogers, C. (1967). The conditions of change
from a client-centered viewpoint. In B.
Berenson & R. Carkhuff (Eds.), Sources of gain
in counseling and psychotherapy. New York: Holt,
Rinehart & Winston.
Rogers, C. (1970). Carl Rogers on encounter
groups. New York: Harper & Row.
Rogers, C. (1977). Carl Rogers on personal
power: Inner strength and its revolutionary
impact. New York: Delacorte Press.
*Rogers, C. (1980). A way of being. Boston:
Houghton Mifflin.
Rogers, C. (1986a). Carl Rogers on the de-
velopment of the person-centered approach.
Person-Centered Review, 1(3), 257–259.
Rogers, C. (1986b). Client-centered therapy.
In I. L. Kutash & A. Wolf (Eds.), Psychothera-
pists casebook (pp. 197–208). San Francisco:
Jossey-Bass.
Rogers, C. R. (1987a). Rogers, Kohut, and
Erickson: A personal perspective on some
similarities and differences. In J. K. Zeig (Ed.),
The evolution of psychotherapy (pp. 179–187).
New York: Brunner/Mazel.
Rogers, C. R. (1987b). Steps toward world
peace, 1948–1986: Tension reduction in theory
and practice. Counseling and Values, 32(1),
12–16.
Rogers, C. R. (1987c). The underlying theory:
Drawn from experiences with individuals and
groups. Counseling and Values, 32(l), 38–45.
*Rogers, C. R., & Freiberg, H. J. (1994). Free-
dom to learn (3rd ed.). Upper Saddle River, NJ:
Prentice-Hall.
*Rogers, C. R., & Russell, D. E. (2002). Carl
Rogers: The quiet revolutionary. Roseville, CA:
Penmarin Books.
*Rogers, N. (1993). The creative connection:
Expressive arts as healing. Palo Alto, CA:
Science & Behavior Books.
208
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

S
E
V
E
N
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 208 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

*Rogers, N. (1995). Emerging woman: A decade
of midlife transitions. Manchester, UK: PCCS
Books.
Rogers, N. (2002). Carl Rogers: A Daughter’s
Tribute (CD ROM). Mingarden Media, Inc.
www.nrogers.com
*Rogers, N. (2011). The creative connection for
groups: Person-centered expressive arts for heal-
ing and social change. Palo Alto, CA: Science
and Behavior Books.
Rollnick, S., & Miller, W. R. (1995). What
is motivational interviewing? Behavioural &
Cognitive Psychotherapy, 23, 325–334.
*Rollnick, S., Miller, W. R., & Butler, C. C.
(2008). Motivational interviewing in health care:
Helping patients change behavior. New York:
Guilford Press.
*Schneider, K. J., & Krug, O. T. (2010).
Existential-humanistic therapy. Washington,
DC: American Psychological Association.
Sommers-Flanagan, J. (2007). The devel-
opment and evolution of person-centered
expressive art therapy: A conversation with
Natalie Rogers. Journal of Counseling and Devel-
opment, 85(1), 120–125.
*Thorne, B. (1992). Carl Rogers. London: Sage.
*Thorne, B. (2002a). The mystical power of
person-centred therapy: Hope beyond despair.
London: Whurr Publishers.
Thorne, B. (2002b). Person-centred therapy.
In W. Dryden (Ed.), Handbook of individual
therapy (4th ed., pp. 131–157). London: Sage.
*Watson, J. C. (2002). Re-visioning empathy.
In D. J. Cain & J. Seeman (Eds.), Humanistic
psychotherapies: Handbook of research and prac-
tice (pp. 445–471). Washington, DC: Ameri-
can Psychological Association.
*Watson, J. C. (Ed.). (2003). Client-centered
and experiential psychotherapy: Advances in
theory research, and practice. Ross-on-Wye:
PCCS Books.
Watson, J. C., Goldman, R. N., & Greenberg,
L. S. (2011). Humanistic and experiential
theories in psychotherapy. In J. C. Norcross,
G. R. Vandenbos, & D. K. Freedheim (Eds.),
History of psychotherapy (2nd ed., pp. 141–172).
Washington, DC: American Psychological
Association.
Zimring, F. M., & Raskin, N. J. (1992). Carl
Rogers and client/person-centered therapy. In
D. K. Freedheim (Ed.), History of psychotherapy:
A century of change (pp. 629–656). Washing-
ton, DC: American Psychological Association.
209
P
E
R
S
O
N

C
E
N
T
E
R
E
D

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
28549_ch07_rev01.indd 209 20/09/11 3:40 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

210
i n t r o d u ct i o n
k e y co n c e p t s
t h e t h e r a p e u t i c p r o c es s
a p p l i c at i o n : t h e r a p e u t i c
t ec h n i q u es a n d p r o c e d u r es
g esta lt t h e r a p y f r o m a
m u lt i c u lt u r a l p e r s p ect i v e
g esta lt t h e r a p y a p p l i e d
to t h e c a s e o f sta n
s u m m a ry a n d e va l u at i o n
w h e r e to g o f r o m h e r e
c h a p t e r 8
Gestalt Therapy
210
a p p l i c at i o n : t h e r a p e
t ec h n i q u es a n d p r o c
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

211
G
E
S
T
A
L
T

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Fritz Perls / LAU R A PE R L S
F R E D E R I C K S . ( “ F R I TZ ” ) P E R L S , M D, P h D
(1893–1970), was the main originator and devel-
oper of Gestalt therapy. Born in Berlin, Germany,
into a lower-middle-class Jewish family, he later
identified himself as a source of much trouble for
his parents. Although he failed the seventh grade
twice and was expelled from school because of
difficulties with the authorities, his brilliance was
never quashed, and he returned—not only to
complete high school but to earn his medical
degree (MD) with a specialization in psychiatry.
In 1916 he joined the German Army and served
as a medic in World War I. His experiences with
soldiers who were gassed on the front lines led to
his interest in mental functioning, which led him to
Gestalt psychology.
After the war Perls worked with Kurt Goldstein
at the Goldstein Institute for Brain-Damaged
Soldiers in Frankfurt. It was through this associa-
tion that he came to see the importance of viewing
humans as a whole rather than as a sum of dis-
cretely functioning parts. It was also through this
association that he met his wife, Laura, who was
earning her PhD with Goldstein. Later he moved to
Vienna and began his psychoanalytic training.
Perls was in analysis with Wilhelm Reich, a
psychoanalyst who pioneered methods of self-
understanding and personality change by working
with the body.
Perls and several of his colleagues established
the New York Institute for Gestalt Therapy in 1952.
Eventually Fritz left New York and settled in Big
Sur, California, where he conducted workshops and
seminars at the Esalen Institute, carving out his
reputation as an innovator in psychotherapy. Here
he had a great impact on people, partly through his
professional writings, but mainly through personal
contact in his workshops.
Personally, Perls was both vital and perplexing.
People typically either responded to him in awe
or found him harshly confrontational and saw him
as meeting his own needs through showmanship.
Having a predilection for the theater since child-
hood, he loved being on stage and putting on a
show. He was viewed variously as insightful, witty,
bright, provocative, manipulative, hostile, demand-
ing, and inspirational. Unfortunately, some of the
people who attended his workshops went on to
mimic the less attractive side of Perls’s personality.
Even though Perls was not happy with this, he did
little to discourage it.
For a firsthand account of the life of Fritz Perls,
I recommend his autobiography, In and Out of the
Garbage Pail (1969b). For a well-researched chap-
ter on the history of Gestalt therapy, see Bowman
(2005).
L A U R A P O S N E R P E R L S , P h D (1905–1990),
was born in Pforzheim, Germany, the daughter
of well-to-do parents. She began playing the
piano at the age of 5 and played with profes-
sional skill by the time she was 18. From the
age of 8 she was involved in modern dance, and
both music and modern dance remained vital
parts of her adult life and were incorporated
into her therapy with some clients. By the time
Laura began her practice as a psychoanalyst she
had prepared for a career as a concert pianist,
had attended law school, achieved a doctoral
degree in Gestalt psychology, and made an
intensive study of existential philosophy with
Paul Tillich and Martin Buber. Clearly, Laura
already had a rich background when she met
Fritz in 1926 and they began their collaboration,
which resulted in the theoretical foundations
of Gestalt therapy. Laura and Fritz were married
in 1930 and had two children while living and
practicing in South Africa. Laura continued to
be the mainstay for the New York Institute
for Gestalt Therapy after Fritz abandoned his
family to become internationally famous as the
traveling minstrel for Gestalt therapy. Laura
also made significant contributions to the
development and maintenance of the Gestalt
therapy movement in the United States and
throughout the world (although in very different
ways) from the late 1940s until her death
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

212
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

E
I
G
H
T
i n t r o d u c t i o n
aware-
ness
relational Gestalt therapy,
in 1990. Laura’s own words make it clear that
Fritz was a generator, not a developer or organ-
izer. At the 25th anniversary of the New York
Institute for Gestalt Therapy, Laura Perls (1990)
stated, “Without the constant support from
his friends, and from me, without the constant
encouragement and collaboration, Fritz would
never have written a line, nor founded
anything” (p. 18).
Laura paid a great deal of attention to
contact and support, which differed from Fritz’s
attention to intrapsychic phenomena and his
focus on awareness. Her emphasis on contact
underscored the role of the interpersonal and
of being responsive at a time when the popular
notion of Gestalt therapy was that it fostered
responsibility only to oneself. She corrected
some of the excesses committed in the name
of Gestalt therapy and adhered to the basic
principles of Gestalt therapy theory as
written in Gestalt Therapy: Excitement and
Growth in the Human Personality (Perls, Heffer-
line, & Goodman, 1951). She taught that every
Gestalt therapist needs to develop his or her
own therapeutic style. From her perspective,
whatever is integrated in our personality
becomes support for what we use technically
(Humphrey, 1986).
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

213
G
E
S
T
A
L
T

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
what how
field
Emotion-focused therapy
Learning Emotion-Focused Therapy: The Process-Experiential Approach to
Change Emotion-Focused Ther-
apy
See the video program for Chapter 8, DVD for Theory and Practice of Counseling
and Psychotherapy: The Case of Stan and Lecturettes. I suggest that you view
the brief lecture for each chapter prior to reading the chapter.
k e y c o n c e p t s
View of Human Nature
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

214
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

E
I
G
H
T
paradoxical theory of change.
Some Principles of Gestalt Therapy Theory
h o l i s m Gestalt
figure
ground
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

215
G
E
S
T
A
L
T

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
f i e l d t h e o ry field theory,
t h e f i g u r e – f o r m at i o n p r o c e s s
figure-formation process
o r g a n i s m i c s e l f – r e g u l at i o n
organismic self-regulation,
The Now
Phenomenological inquiry
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

216
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

E
I
G
H
T
talk about
now.
Unfinished Business
unfinished business,
do seek
impasse,
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

217
G
E
S
T
A
L
T

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Contact and Resistances to Contact
Con-
tact
Introjection
Projection
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

218
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

E
I
G
H
T
Retroflection
Deflection
Confluence
interruptions in contact boundary disturbance
Energy and Blocks to Energy
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

219
G
E
S
T
A
L
T

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
t h e t h e r a p e u t i c p r o c e s s
Therapeutic Goals
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

220
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

E
I
G
H
T
Therapist’s Function and Role
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

221
G
E
S
T
A
L
T

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
It” talk.
“You” talk.
Questions.
Language that denies power.
Listening to clients’ metaphors.
Listening for language that uncovers a story.
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

222
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

E
I
G
H
T
Client’s Experience in Therapy
dis-
covery.
accommodation,
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

223
G
E
S
T
A
L
T

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
assimilation,
Relationship Between Therapist and Client
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

224
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

E
I
G
H
T
a p p l i c at i o n : t h e r a p e u t i c
t e c h n i q u e s a n d p r o c e d u r e s
The Experiment in Gestalt Therapy
Case Approach to Counseling and Psycho-
therapy
Exercises
Experiments,

Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

225
G
E
S
T
A
L
T

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Preparing Clients for Gestalt Experiments
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

226
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

E
I
G
H
T
personally
way
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

227
G
E
S
T
A
L
T

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
The Role of Confrontation
Confrontation
invited
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

228
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

E
I
G
H
T
Gestalt Therapy Interventions
t h e i n t e r n a l d i a lo g u e e x e r c i s e
empty-chair technique
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

229
G
E
S
T
A
L
T

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
m a k i n g t h e r o u n d s
t h e r e v e r s a l e x e r c i s e
t h e r e h e a r s a l e x e r c i s e
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

230
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

E
I
G
H
T
t h e e x a g g e r at i o n e x e r c i s e
s tay i n g w i t h t h e f e e l i n g
t h e g e s ta lt a p p r oa c h t o d r e a m w o r k
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

231
G
E
S
T
A
L
T

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Application to Group Counseling
talking about
talking about
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

232
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

E
I
G
H
T
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

233
G
E
S
T
A
L
T

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
g e s ta lt t h e r a p y f r o m a
m u lt i c u lt u r a l p e r s p e c t i v e
Strengths From a Diversity Perspective
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

234
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

E
I
G
H
T
Shortcomings From a Diversity Perspective
Gestalt-oriented therapy focuses on the
unfinished business Stan has with his
parents, siblings, and ex-wife. It appears
that this unfinished business consists mainly of
feelings of resentment, and Stan turns this resent-
ment on himself. His present life situation is
spotlighted, but he may also need to reexperience
past feelings that could be interfering with his
present attempts to develop intimacy with others.
Although the focus is on Stan’s present
behavior, I guide him toward becoming aware
of how he is carrying old baggage around and
how it interferes with his life today. My task is to
assist him in re-creating the context in which he
made creative adjustments during his childhood
years that no longer serving him well. One of
his cardinal introjections was, “I’m stupid, and it
would be better if I did not exist.”
Gestalt Therapy Applied to the Case of Stan
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

235
G
E
S
T
A
L
T

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Stan has been influenced by cultural mes-
sages that he has accepted. I am interested in
exploring his cultural background, including
his values and the values characteristic of his
culture. With this focus, I assist Stan in identify-
ing some of the following cultural introjections:
“Don’t talk about your family with strangers,
and don’t hang your dirty linen in public.” “Don’t
confront your parents because they deserve re-
spect.” “Don’t be too concerned about yourself.”
“Don’t show your vulnerabilities; hide your feel-
ings and weaknesses.” I invite Stan to examine
those introjections to assess their utility in his
present circumstances. Although he can decide
to retain those aspects of his culture that he
prizes, he is in a position to modify or reject
other cultural expectations. Of course, this will
be done when these issues emerge in the fore-
ground of his work.
I ask Stan to attend to what he becomes
aware of as the session begins: “What are you
experiencing as we are getting started today?”
As I encourage Stan to tune in to his present
experience and selectively make observations, a
number of figures will emerge. The goal is to
focus on a figure of interest, one that seems to
hold the most energy or relevance for Stan. When
a figure is identified, my task is to deepen Stan’s
awareness of this thought, feeling, body sensa-
tion, or insight through related experiments.
In typical Gestalt fashion, Stan deals with
his present struggles within the context of our
relationship and through experimentation. One
possible experiment would involve Stan becom-
ing some of those individuals who told him how
to think, feel, and behave as a child. He can then
become the child that he was and respond to
them from the place where he feels the most
confusion or pain. He experiences in new ways
the feelings that accompany his beliefs about
himself, and he comes to a deeper appreciation
of how his feelings and thoughts influence what
he is doing today.
Stan has learned to hide his emotions rather
than to reveal them. Understanding this about
him, we explore his objections and concerns about
“getting into feelings.” The figure of interest now
is his hesitation to experience or express emotion.
Although I have no agenda to get Stan to experi-
ence his feelings at this point, it is important for
him to increase his awareness of his reluctance
and to explore the meaning it holds for him.
If Stan decides that he wants to experience
his emotions rather than deny them, I ask: “What
are you aware of now having said what you did?”
Stan says that he can’t get his ex-wife out of his
mind. He tells me about the pain he feels over
that relationship and how he is frightened of get-
ting involved again lest he be hurt again. I con-
tinue to ask him to focus inward and get a sense
of what stands out for him at this very moment.
Stan replies: “I’m hurt and angry over all the pain
that I’ve allowed her to inflict on me.” I ask him to
imagine himself in earlier scenes with his ex-wife,
as though the painful situation were occurring
in the here and now. He symbolically relives and
reexperiences the situation by talking “directly”
to his wife. By expressing his resentments and
hurts directly, Stan can begin to complete some
unfinished business that is interfering with his
current functioning. By participating in this
experiment, Stan is attaining more awareness of
what he is now doing and how he keeps himself
locked into his past.
Follow-Up: You Continue as Stan’s
Gestalt Therapist
Use these questions to help you think about how
to work with Stan using the Gestalt approach:
How might you begin a session with Stan?
Would you suggest a direction he should pur-
sue? Would you wait for him to initiate work?
Would you ask him to continue from where he
left off in the previous session? Would you at-
tend to whatever theme or issue becomes fig-
ural to him?
What unfinished business can you identify in
Stan’s case? Does any of his experience of be-
ing stuck remind you of yourself? How might
you work with Stan if he did bring up your own
unfinished business?
What kind of an experiment might you pro-
pose to assist Stan in learning more about his
hesitation and reluctance to access and ex-
press his feelings?
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

236 s u m m a ry a n d e va l u at i o n
Summary
Contributions of Gestalt Therapy
Stan participated in an experiment to deal
with pain, resentment, and hurt over situa-
tions with his ex-wife. How might you have
worked with the material Stan brought up?
What kind of experiment might you design?
How would you decide what kind of experi-
ment to create?
How might you work with Stan’s cultural mes-
sages? Would you be able to respect his cul-
tural values and still encourage him to make
an assessment of some of the ways in which
his culture is affecting him today?
See DVD for Theory and Practice of
Counseling and Psychotherapy: The Case
of Stan and Lecturettes (Session 6 on Gestalt
therapy) for a demonstration of my approach
to counseling Stan from this perspective. This
session consists of Stan exploring one of his
dreams in Gestalt fashion.
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

E
I
G
H
T
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

237
G
E
S
T
A
L
T

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Handbook for Theory, Research and Practice in Gestalt Ther-
apy Becoming a Practitioner Researcher: A Gestalt Approach to
Holistic Inquiry
Limitations and Criticisms of Gestalt Therapy
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

238
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

E
I
G
H
T
facilitating
s o m e c a u t i o n s
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

239
G
E
S
T
A
L
T

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
w h e r e to g o f r o m h e r e
DVD for Integrative Counseling: The Case of Ruth and Lecturettes,
Other Resources
Gestalt Therapy with Children
Psychotherapy With the Unmotivated Patient
Gestalt Institute of Cleveland. Inc.
1588 Hazel Drive
Cleveland, OH 44106-1791
Telephone: (216) 421-0468
Fax: (216) 421-1729
E-mail: registrar@gestaltcleveland.org
Website: www.gestaltcleveland.org
Pacific Gestalt Institute
1626 Westwood Blvd., Suite 104
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

240
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

E
I
G
H
T
Los Angeles, CA 90024
Telephone: (310) 446-9720
Fax: (310) 475-4704
E-mail: info@gestalttherapy.org
Website: www.gestalttherapy.org
Gestalt Center for Psychotherapy and Training
220 Fifth Avenue, Suite 802
New York, NY 10001
Telephone: (212) 387-9429
E-mail: info@gestaltnyc.org
Website: www.gestaltnyc.org
Gestalt International Study Center
1035 Cemetery Road
South Wellfleet, Cape Cod, MA 02667
Telephone: (508) 349-7900
E-mail: office@gisc.org
Website: www.GISC.org
Gestalt Therapy Training Center Northwest
757 SE 34th Avenue
Portland, OR 97214
Telephone: (503) 230-0900
E-mail: gttcnw@aol.com
Website: www.gttcnw.org
Gestalt Associates Training, Los Angeles
1460 Seventh Street, Suite 300
Santa Monica, CA 90401
Telephone/Fax: (310) 395-6844
E-mail: ritaresnick@gatla.org
Website: www.gatla.org
Association for the Advancement of Gestalt Therapy (AAGT)
Website: www.AAGT.org
European Association for Gestalt Therapy (EAGT)
Website: www.EAGT.org
Gestalt Review
Website: www.gestaltreview.com
British Gestalt Journal
Website: www.britishgestaltjournal.com
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

241
Recommended Supplementary Readings
Gestalt Therapy Verbatim (Perls, 1969a) provides a firsthand account of the way Fritz Perls
worked. It contains many verbatim transcripts of workshop demonstrations.
Gestalt Therapy: History, Theory, and Practice (Woldt & Toman, 2005) introduces the historical
underpinnings and key concepts of Gestalt therapy and features applications of those concepts
to therapeutic practice. This is a significant recent publication in the field of Gestalt therapy that
contains pedagogical learning activities and experiments, review questions, and photographs of
all contributors.
Gestalt Therapy Integrated: Contours of Theory and Practice (Polster & Polster, 1973) is a classic in
the field and an excellent source for those who want a more advanced and theoretical treatment
of this model.
References and Suggested Readings
*Barber, P. (2006). Becoming a practitioner
researcher: A Gestalt approach to holistic inquiry.
London: Middlesex University Press.
Beisser, A. R. (1970). The paradoxical theory
of change. In J. Fagan & I. L. Shepherd (Eds.),
Gestalt therapy now (pp. 77–80). New York:
Harper & Row (Colophon).
*Bowman, C. (2005). The history and develop-
ment of Gestalt therapy. In A. Woldt & S. To-
man (Eds.), Gestalt therapy: History, theory, and
practice (pp. 3–20). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Breshgold, E. (1989). Resistance in Gestalt
therapy: An historical theoretical perspective.
The Gestalt Journal, 12(2), 73–102.
*Brown, J. R. (2007). Gestalt therapy. In A. B.
Rochlen (Ed.), Applying counseling theories: An
online case-based approach (pp. 127–141).
Upper Saddle River, NJ: Pearson Prentice-Hall.
*Brownell, P. (2008). Handbook for theory,
research and practice in Gestalt therapy.
Newcastle, UK: Cambridge Scholar Publishing.
*Cain, D. J. (2002). Defining characteristics,
history, and evolution of humanistic psycho-
therapies. In D. J. Cain & J. Seeman (Eds.),
Humanistic psychotherapies: Handbook of
research and practice (pp. 3–54). Washington,
DC: American Psychological Association.
Clarkson, P., & Mackewn, J. (1993). Fritz Perls.
Newbury Park, CA: Sage.
Corey, G. (2012). Theory and practice of group
counseling (8th ed.). Belmont, CA: Brooks/
Cole, Cengage Learning.
*Corey, G. (2013). Case approach to counseling
and psychotherapy (8th ed.). Belmont, CA:
Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning.
Elliott, R., Watson, J. C., Goldman, R. N., &
Greenberg, L. S. (2004). Learning emotion-
focused therapy: A process-experiential approach
to change. Washington, DC: American Psycho-
logical Association.
*Feder. B. (2006). Gestalt group therapy: A prac-
tical guide. New Orleans: Gestalt Institute Press.
*Feder, B., & Frew, J. (Eds.). (2008). Beyond the
hot seat revisited: Gestalt approaches to group.
New Orleans: Gestalt Institute Press.
Feder, B., & Ronall, R. (Eds.). (1996). A living
legacy of Fritz and Laura Perls: Contemporary
case studies. Montclair, NJ: Walden.
Fernbacher, S., & Plummer, D. (2005).
Cultural influences and considerations in
Gestalt therapy. In A. Woldt & S. Toman (Eds.),
Gestalt therapy: History, theory, and practice (pp.
117–132). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Frew, J. E. (1986). The functions and patterns
of occurrence of individual contact styles
during the development phase of the Gestalt
group. The Gestalt Journal, 9(l), 55–70.
Frew, J. E. (1997). A Gestalt therapy theory
application to the practice of group leadership.
Gestalt Review, 1(2), 131–149.
241
G
E
S
T
A
L
T

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

*Frew, J. (2008). Gestalt therapy. In J. Frew &
M. D. Spiegler (Eds.), Contemporary psychother-
apies for a diverse world (pp. 228–274). Boston:
Lahaska Press.
*Greenberg, L. S. (2011). Emotion-focused
therapy. Washington, DC: American Psycho-
logical Association.
Humphrey, K. (1986). Laura Perls: A biograph-
ical sketch. The Gestalt Journal, 9(l), 5–11.
*Hycner, R., & Jacobs, L. (1995). The healing
relationship in Gestalt therapy. Highland, NY:
Gestalt Journal Press.
Jacobs, L. (1989). Dialogue in Gestalt theory
and therapy. The Gestalt Journal, 12(l), 25–67.
*Latner, J. (1986). The Gestalt therapy book.
Highland, NY: Center for Gestalt Development.
*Lee, R. G. (Ed.). (2004). The values of connec-
tion: A relational approach to ethics. Cambridge,
MA: Gestalt Press.
Levitsky, A., & Perls, F. (1970). The rules and
games of Gestalt therapy. In J. Fagan & I.
Shepherd (Eds.), Gestalt therapy now (pp. 140–
149). New York: Harper & Row (Colophon).
Maurer, R. (2005). Gestalt approaches with
organizations and large systems. In A. Woldt
& S. Toman (Eds.), Gestalt therapy: History,
theory, and practice. (pp. 237–256). Thousand
Oaks, CA: Sage.
Melnick, J., & Nevis, S. (2005). Gestalt
therapy methodology. In A. Woldt & S. Toman
(Eds.), Gestalt therapy: History, theory, and prac-
tice. (pp. 101–116). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Parlett, M. (2005). Contemporary Gestalt
therapy: Field theory. In A. Woldt & S. Toman
(Eds.), Gestalt therapy: History, theory, and prac-
tice (pp. 41–64). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Passons, W. R. (1975). Gestalt approaches in
counseling. New York: Holt, Rinehart & Winston.
*Perls, F. (1969a). Gestalt therapy verbatim.
Moab, UT: Real People Press.
Perls, F. (1969b). In and out of the garbage pail.
Moab, UT: Real People Press.
Perls, F., Hefferline, R., & Goodman, R. (1951).
Gestalt therapy: Excitement and growth in the
human personality. New York: Dell.
Perls, L. (1976). Comments on new direc-
tions. In E.W.L. Smith (Ed.), The growing edge
of Gestalt therapy (pp. 221–226). New York:
Brunner/Mazel.
Perls, L. (1990). A talk for the 25th anniver-
sary. The Gestalt Journal, 13(2), 15–22.
Polster, E. (1987a). Escape from the present:
Transition and storyline. In J. K. Zeig (Ed.), The
evolution of psychotherapy (pp. 326–340). New
York: Brunner/Mazel.
*Polster, E. (1987b). Every person’s life is worth
a novel: How to cut through emotional pain and
discover the fascinating core of life. New York:
Norton.
*Polster, E. (1995). A population of selves: A
therapeutic exploration of personality diversity.
San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
*Polster, E., & Polster, M. (1973). Gestalt
therapy integrated: Contours of theory and prac-
tice. New York: Brunner/Mazel.
Polster, E., & Polster, M. (1976). Therapy with-
out resistance: Gestalt therapy. In A. Burton
(Ed.), What makes behavior change possible?
(pp. 259–277). New York: Brunner/Mazel.
Polster, M. (1987). Gestalt therapy: Evolution
and application. In J. K. Zeig (Ed.), The evolu-
tion of psychotherapy (pp. 312–325). New York:
Brunner/Mazel.
Polster, M., & Polster, E. (1990). Gestalt thera-
py. In J. K. Zeig & W. M. Munion (Eds.), What
is psychotherapy? Contemporary perspectives
(pp. 103–107). San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
*Strumpfel, U., & Goldman, R. (2002). Con-
tacting Gestalt therapy. In D. J. Cain & J.
Seeman (Eds.), Humanistic psychotherapies:
Handbook of research and practice (pp. 189–
219). Washington, DC: American Psychologi-
cal Association.
Watson, J. C., Goldman, R. N., & Greenberg,
L. S. (2011). Humanistic and experiential theo-
ries in psychotherapy. In J. C. Norcross, G. R.
Vandenbos, & D. K. Freedheim (Eds.), History of
psychotherapy (2nd ed., pp. 141–172). Washing-
ton, DC: American Psychological Association.
*Woldt, A., & Toman, S. (Eds.). (2005). Gestalt
therapy: History, theory, and practice. Thousand
Oaks, CA: Sage.
242
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

E
I
G
H
T
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

*Yontef, G. M. (1993). Awareness, dialogue and
process: Essays on Gestalt therapy. Highland,
NY: Gestalt Journal Press.
*Yontef, G. (1995). Gestalt therapy. In A. S.
Gurman & S. B. Messer (Eds.), Essential psy-
chotherapies: Theory and practice (pp. 261–303).
New York: Guilford Press.
Yontef, G. (1999). Awareness, dialogue and
process: Preface to the 1998 German edition.
The Gestalt Journal, 22(1), 9–20.
*Yontef, G. M. (2005). Gestalt therapy theory
of change. In A. Woldt & S. Toman (Eds.),
Gestalt therapy: History, theory, and practice
(pp. 81–100). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
*Yontef, G., & Jacobs, L. (2011). Gestalt
therapy. In R. Corsini & D. Wedding (Eds.),
Current psychotherapies (9th ed., pp. 342–382).
Belmont, CA: Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning.
Zahm, S. (1998). Therapist self-disclosure in
the practice of Gestalt therapy. The Gestalt
Journal, 21, 21–52.
*Zinker, J. (1978). Creative process in Gestalt
therapy. New York: Random House (Vintage).
243
G
E
S
T
A
L
T

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

244
i n t r o d u ct i o n
• Historical Background
• Four Areas of Development
k e y co n c e p t s
• View of Human Nature
• Basic Characteristics and Assumptions
t h e t h e r a p e u t i c p r o c es s
• Therapeutic Goals
• Therapist’s Function and Role
• Client’s Experience in Therapy
• Relationship Between Therapist and Client
a p p l i c at i o n : t h e r a p e u t i c
t ec h n i q u es a n d p r o c e d u r es
• Applied Behavioral Analysis: Operant
Conditioning Techniques
• Progressive Muscle Relaxation
• Systematic Desensitization
• In Vivo Exposure and Flooding
• Eye Movement Desensitization and
Reprocessing
• Social Skills Training
• Self-Management Programs and Self-Directed
Behavior
• Multimodal Therapy: Clinical Behavior
Therapy
• Mindfulness and Acceptance-Based Cognitive
Behavior Therapy
• Application to Group Counseling
b e h av i o r t h e r a p y f r o m a
m u lt i c u lt u r a l p e r s p ect i v e
• Strengths From a Diversity Perspective
• Shortcomings From a Diversity Perspective
b e h av i o r t h e r a p y a p p l i e d to t h e
c a s e o f sta n
s u m m a ry a n d e va l u at i o n
• Summary
• Contributions of Behavior Therapy
• Limitations and Criticisms of Behavior
Therapy
w h e r e to g o f r o m h e r e
• Recommended Supplementary Readings
• References and Suggested Readings
c h a p t e r 9
Behavior Therapy
• Recomm
• References
ntary Readin
Suggested ReadingsSkills Training
244
Muscle Relaxati
atic Desensitization
ivo Exposure and Flooding
e Movement Desensitization and
processing
• Socia
r a p e
t ec h n i q u es a n d p r o c
• Applied Behavioral Analysi
Conditioning Techniques
• Progressive
• System
• In
• Ey
Re
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 244 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

245
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
B. F. Skinner / Albert Bandura / Arnold Lazarus
B . F. S K I N N E R (1904–
1990) reported that he was
brought up in a warm, stable
family environment.* As he
was growing up, Skinner was
greatly interested in building
all sorts of things, an interest
that followed him through-
out his professional life. He
received his PhD in psychol-
ogy from Harvard University in 1931 and eventu-
ally returned to Harvard after teaching in several
universities. He had two daughters, one of whom is
an educational psychologist and the other an artist.
Skinner was a prominent spokesperson for
behaviorism and can be considered the father of
the behavioral approach to psychology. Skinner
championed radical behaviorism, which places
primary emphasis on the effects of environment
on behavior. Skinner was also a determinist; he
did not believe that humans had free choice. He
acknowledged that feelings and thoughts exist, but
he denied that they caused our actions. Instead,
he stressed the cause-and-effect links between
objective, observable environmental conditions
and behavior. Skinner maintained that too much
attention had been given to internal states of
mind and motives, which cannot be observed and
changed directly, and that too little focus had been
given to environmental factors that can be directly
observed and changed. He was extremely inter-
ested in the concept of reinforcement, which he
applied to his own life. For example, after working
for many hours, he would go into his constructed
cocoon (like a tent), put on headphones, and listen
to classical music (Frank Dattilio, personal commu-
nication, September 24, 2010).
Most of Skinner’s work was of an experimental
nature in the laboratory, but others have applied his
ideas to teaching, managing human problems, and
social planning. Science and Human Behavior
(Skinner, 1953) best illustrates how Skinner thought
behavioral concepts could be applied to every
domain of human behavior. In Walden II (1948)
Skinner describes a utopian community in which
his ideas, derived from the laboratory, are applied
to social issues. His 1971 book, Beyond Freedom and
Dignity, addressed the need for drastic changes if
our society was to survive. Skinner believed that
science and technology held the promise for a
better future.
*This biography is based largely on Nye’s (2000)
discussion of B. F. Skinner’s radical behaviorism.
A
P
Ph
ot
o
A L B E RT B A N D U R A
(b. 1925) was born in a
small town in northern
Alberta, Canada; he was
the youngest of six children
in a family of Eastern Eu-
ropean descent.* Bandura
spent his elementary and
high school years in the one
school in town, which was
short of teachers and resources. These meager
educational resources proved to be an asset
rather than a liability as Bandura early on learned
the skills of self-directedness, which would later
become one of his research themes. He earned his
PhD in clinical psychology from the University of
Iowa in 1952, and a year later he joined the faculty
at Stanford University. Bandura and his colleagues
did pioneering work in the area of social modeling
and demonstrated that modeling is a powerful
process that explains diverse forms of learning
(see Bandura 1971a, 1971b; Bandura & Walters,
1963). In his research programs at Stanford
University, Bandura and his colleagues explored
social learning theory and the prominent role of
observational learning and social modeling in
human motivation, thought, and action. By the
mid-1980s Bandura had renamed his theoretical
approach social cognitive theory, which shed light
on how we function as self-organizing, proactive,
self-reflective, and self-regulating beings (see
Bandura, 1986). This notion that we are not simply
reactive organisms shaped by environmental
forces or driven by inner impulses represented
a dramatic shift in the development of behavior
therapy. Bandura broadened the scope of behavior
therapy by exploring the inner cognitive-affective
forces that motivate human behavior.
Co
ur
te
sy
,D
r.
A
lb
er
tB
an
du
ra
,S
ta
nf
or
d
U
ni
ve
rs
ity
,P
al
o
A
lto
,C
A
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 245 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

246
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
A R N O L D A . L A Z A R U S
(b. 1932) was born and
educated in Johannesburg,
South Africa. The young-
est of four children, he
grew up in a neighborhood
where there were very few
children, and he remembers
being lonely and frightened.
He learned to play the piano at an early age and
recalls, “When I was 7 I used to play like a talented
12-year-old, but when I turned 14 and still played
like a 12-year-old, I decided to quit!” His interests
then changed to bodybuilding, weight lifting, box-
ing, and wrestling. He adds, “I was a pathetically
skinny kid, often beaten up and bullied, so I started
training rather frantically” (personal communica-
tion, April 15, 2011). Through sheer determination
he ended up winning boxing and weight-lifting
competitions and planned to own and operate a
gym or health center.
Although Lazarus grew up in South Africa,
he strongly identified with the United States. At
an early age he felt that racism and discrimina-
tion were totally unacceptable. He entered col-
lege intending to major in English with a view to
journalism as a career but soon switched majors
to psychology. He obtained his master’s degree
in experimental psychology in 1957 and a PhD in
clinical psychology in 1960, and then went into full-
time private practice in Johannesburg. In 1963 he
was invited by Albert Bandura to teach at Stanford
University. Later he held teaching positions at
Temple University Medical School, Yale University,
and Rutgers University.
He has received many honors and won numer-
ous awards, including two Distinguished Profes-
sional Contributions Awards from the American
Psychological Association and the prestigious
Cummings PSYCHE AWARD. Lazarus has written
17 books and more than 300 professional articles.
He is a pioneer in clinical behavior therapy and
the developer of multimodal therapy, which is
a comprehensive, systematic, holistic approach
to behavior therapy. Although the assessment
process is multimodal, the treatment is cognitive
behavioral and draws on empirically supported
methods. In terms of clinical practice, behavior
therapy and multimodal therapy are very similar.
He is recognized as an authority on brief, efficient,
and effective psychotherapy.
In addition to his contribution to the develop-
ment of behavior therapy, Lazarus has shown a
keen interest in the subject of dual and multiple
relationships in psychotherapy. Through his writing
and lecturing on this topic, he has done a great deal
to challenge the rigidity of a rule-based approach
to practicing psychotherapy. One significant book
Co
ur
te
sy
of
th
e
La
za
ru
s
In
st
itu
te
There are some existential qualities inherent
in Bandura’s social cognitive theory. Bandura has
produced a wealth of empirical evidence that dem-
onstrates the life choices we have in all aspects
of our lives. In Self-Efficacy: The Exercise of Control
(Bandura, 1997), Bandura shows the compre-
hensive applications of his theory of self-efficacy
to areas such as human development, psychol-
ogy, psychiatry, education, medicine and health,
athletics, business, social and political change, and
international affairs.
Bandura has concentrated on four areas of
research: (1) the power of psychological modeling
in shaping thought, emotion, and action; (2) the
mechanisms of human agency, or the ways people
influence their own motivation and behavior
through choice; (3) people’s perceptions of their
efficacy to exercise influence over the events that
affect their lives; and (4) how stress reactions and
depressions are caused. Bandura has created one
of the few mega-theories that still thrive at the
beginning of the 21st century. He has shown that
people need a sense of self-efficacy and resilience
to create a successful life and to meet the inevita-
ble obstacles and adversities they encounter.
To date Bandura has written nine books, many
of which have been translated into various lan-
guages. In 2004 he received the Outstanding Life-
time Contribution to Psychology Award from the
American Psychological Association. In his early
80s, Bandura continues to teach and do research
at Stanford University and to travel throughout the
world. He still makes time for hiking, opera, being
with his family, and wine tasting in the Napa and
Sonoma valleys.
*This biography is based largely on Pajares’s
(2004) discussion of Bandura’s life and work.
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 246 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

247
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
i n t r o d u c t i o n
Behavior therapy practitioners focus on directly observable behavior, current de-
terminants of behavior, learning experiences that promote change, tailoring treat-
ment strategies to individual clients, and rigorous assessment and evaluation.
Behavior therapy has been used to treat a wide range of psychological disorders
with different client populations. Anxiety disorders, depression, posttraumatic
stress disorder, substance abuse, eating and weight disorders, sexual problems,
pain management, and hypertension have all been successfully treated using this
approach (Wilson, 2011). Behavioral procedures are used in the fi elds of develop-
mental disabilities, mental illness, education and special education, community
psychology, clinical psychology, rehabilitation, business, self-management, sports
psychology, health-related behaviors, medicine, and gerontology (Miltenberger,
2012; Wilson, 2011).
Historical Background
The behavioral approach had its origin in the 1950s and early 1960s, and it was
a radical departure from the dominant psychoanalytic perspective. The behavior
therapy movement differed from other therapeutic approaches in its application of
principles of classical and operant conditioning (which will be explained shortly)
to the treatment of a variety of problem behaviors. Today, it is diffi cult to fi nd
a consensus on the defi nition of behavior therapy because the fi eld has grown,
become more complex, and is marked by a diversity of views. Contemporary
behavior therapy is no longer limited to treatments based on traditional learning
theory (Antony & Roemer, 2011b). Indeed, as behavior therapy has evolved and
developed, it has increasingly overlapped in some ways with other psychotherapeutic
approaches (Wilson, 2011). Behavior therapists now use a variety of evidence-based
techniques in their practices, including cognitive therapy, social skills training,
relaxation training, and mindfulness strategies—all of which are discussed in this
chapter. The following historical sketch of behavior therapy is largely based on
Spiegler and Guevremont (2010).
Traditional behavior therapy arose simultaneously in the United States, South
Africa, and Great Britain in the 1950s. In spite of harsh criticism and resistance
from psychoanalytic psychotherapists, the approach has survived. Its focus was on
demonstrating that behavioral conditioning techniques were effective and were a
viable alternative to psychoanalytic therapy.
In the 1960s Albert Bandura developed social learning theory, which combined
classical and operant conditioning with observational learning. Bandura made
cognition a legitimate focus for behavior therapy. During the 1960s a number of
is Dual Relationships and Psychotherapy, (Lazarus &
Zur, 2002). Arnold Lazarus is currently the presi-
dent of The Lazarus Institute in Skillman, New
Jersey, where his son (Clifford N. Lazarus, PhD)
is the executive director and his daughter-in-law
(Donna Astor-Lazarus, MSW, LCSW) is the
clinical director.
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 247 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

248
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
cognitive behavioral approaches sprang up, which focus on cognitive representations
of the environment rather than on characteristics of the objective environment.
Contemporary behavior therapy emerged as a major force in psychology during
the 1970s, and it had a signifi cant impact on education, psychology, psychotherapy,
psychiatry, and social work. Behavioral techniques were expanded to provide solu-
tions for business, industry, and child-rearing problems as well. Behavior therapy
techniques were viewed as the treatment of choice for many psychological problems.
The 1980s were characterized by a search for new horizons in concepts and
methods that went beyond traditional learning theory. Behavior therapists con-
tinued to subject their methods to empirical scrutiny and to consider the impact
of the practice of therapy on both their clients and the larger society. Increased
attention was given to the role of emotions in therapeutic change, as well as to the
role of biological factors in psychological disorders. Two of the most signifi cant
developments in the fi eld were (1) the continued emergence of cognitive behavior
therapy as a major force and (2) the application of behavioral techniques to the
prevention and treatment of health-related disorders.
By the late 1990s the Association for Behavioral and Cognitive Therapies (ABCT)
(formerly known as the Association for Advancement of Behavior Therapy) claimed
a membership of about 4,500. Currently, ABCT includes approximately 6,000
mental health professionals and students who are interested in empirically based
behavior therapy or cognitive behavior therapy. This name change and description
reveals the current thinking of integrating behavioral and cognitive therapies.
By the early 2000s, the behavioral tradition had broadened considerably, which
involved enlarging the scope of research and practice. This newest development,
sometimes known as the “third wave” of behavior therapy, includes dialectical
behavior therapy (DBT), mindfulness-based stress reduction (MBSR), mindfulness-
based cognitive therapy (MBCT), and acceptance and commitment therapy (ACT).
See the video program for Chapter 9, DVD for Theory and Practice of Counseling
and Psychotherapy: The Case of Stan and Lecturettes. I suggest that you view
the brief lecture for each chapter prior to reading the chapter.
Four Areas of Development
Contemporary behavior therapy can be understood by considering four major
areas of development: (1) classical conditioning, (2) operant conditioning, (3) social-
cognitive theory, and (4) cognitive behavior therapy.
Classical conditioning (respondent conditioning) refers to what happens prior
to learning that creates a response through pairing. A key fi gure in this area is
Ivan Pavlov who illustrated classical conditioning through experiments with dogs.
Placing food in a dog’s mouth leads to salivation, which is respondent behavior.
When food is repeatedly presented with some originally neutral stimulus (some-
thing that does not elicit a particular response), such as the sound of a bell, the dog
will eventually salivate to the sound of the bell alone. However, if a bell is sounded
repeatedly but not paired again with food, the salivation response will eventually
diminish and become extinct. An example of a procedure that is based on the clas-
sical conditioning model is Joseph Wolpe’s systematic desensitization, which is
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 248 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

249
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
described later in this chapter. This technique illustrates how principles of learn-
ing derived from the experimental laboratory can be applied clinically. Desensiti-
zation can be applied to people who, through classical conditioning, developed an
intense fear of fl ying after having a frightening experience while fl ying.
Technically one can develop an intense fear of fl ying without having a frighten-
ing experience personally. For example, someone may see visual images of a plane
crashing off the coast of Brazil and develop a fear of fl ying even though that person
has never fl own anywhere. Some researchers hold a different view and believe
that fear of fl ying may be due primarily to claustrophobia (Frank Dattilio, personal
communication, September 24, 2010).
Most of the signifi cant responses we make in everyday life are examples of
operant behaviors, such as reading, writing, driving a car, and eating with uten-
sils. Operant conditioning involves a type of learning in which behaviors are infl u-
enced mainly by the consequences that follow them. If the environmental changes
brought about by the behavior are reinforcing—that is, if they provide some reward
to the organism or eliminate aversive stimuli—the chances are increased that the
behavior will occur again. If the environmental changes produce no reinforcement
or produce aversive stimuli, the chances are lessened that the behavior will recur.
Positive and negative reinforcement, punishment, and extinction techniques, de-
scribed later in this chapter, illustrate how operant conditioning in applied settings
can be instrumental in developing prosocial and adaptive behaviors. Operant tech-
niques are used by behavioral practitioners in parent education programs and with
weight management programs.
The behaviorists of both the classical and operant conditioning models excluded
any reference to mediational concepts, such as the role of thinking processes,
attitudes, and values. This focus is perhaps due to a reaction against the insight-
oriented psychodynamic approaches. The social learning approach (or the social-
cognitive approach) developed by Albert Bandura and Richard Walters (1963) is
interactional, interdisciplinary, and multimodal (Bandura, 1977, 1982). Social-
cognitive theory involves a triadic reciprocal interaction among the environment,
personal factors (beliefs, preferences, expectations, self-perceptions, and interpre-
tations), and individual behavior. In the social-cognitive approach the environmen-
tal events on behavior are mainly determined by cognitive processes governing
how environmental infl uences are perceived by an individual and how these events
are interpreted (Wilson, 2011). A basic assumption is that people are capable of self-
directed behavior change and that the person is the agent of change. For Bandura
(1982, 1997), self-effi cacy is the individual’s belief or expectation that he or she can
master a situation and bring about desired change. An example of social learning
is ways people can develop effective social skills after they are in contact with other
people who effectively model interpersonal skills.
Cognitive behavior therapy (CBT) represents the mainstream of contemporary
behavior therapy and is a popular theoretical orientation among psychologists.
Cognitive behavioral therapy operates on the assumption that what people believe
infl uences how they act and feel. Since the early 1970s, the behavioral movement
has conceded a legitimate place to thinking, even to the extent of giving cognitive
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 249 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

250
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
factors a central role in understanding and treating emotional and behavioral prob-
lems. By the mid-1970s cognitive behavior therapy had replaced behavior therapy as
the accepted designation, and the fi eld began emphasizing the interaction among
affective, behavioral, and cognitive dimensions (Lazarus, 2008a; Wilson, 2011).
Today only the integrative therapies are more popular than CBT (Hollon &
DiGiuseppe, 2011). A good example of this more integrative approach of cognitive
and behavioral dimensions is multimodal therapy, which is discussed later in this
chapter. Many techniques, particularly those developed within the last three dec-
ades, emphasize cognitive processes that involve private events such as the client’s
self-talk as mediators of behavior change (see Bandura, 1969, 1986; Beck, 1976;
Beck & Weishaar, 2011).
Contemporary behavior therapy has much in common with cognitive behavior
therapy in which the mechanism of change is both cognitive (modifying thoughts
to change behaviors) and behavioral (altering external factors that lead to behav-
ior change) (Follette & Callaghan, 2011). Considered broadly, the term “behavior
therapy” refers to practices based primarily on social-cognitive theory and encom-
passes a range of cognitive principles and procedures (Wilson, 2011). This chapter
goes beyond the traditional behavioral perspective and deals mainly with applied
aspects of this model. Chapter 10 is devoted to the cognitive behavioral approaches,
which focus on changing clients’ cognitions (thoughts and beliefs) that maintain
psychological problems.
k e y c o n c e p t s
View of Human Nature
Modern behavior therapy is grounded on a scientifi c view of human behavior that
accommodates a systematic and structured approach to counseling. This view does
not rest on a deterministic assumption that humans are a mere product of their
sociocultural conditioning. Rather, the current view is that the person is the pro-
ducer and the product of his or her environment.
The current trend in behavior therapy is toward developing procedures that
give control to clients and thus increase their range of freedom. Behavior therapy
aims to increase people’s skills so that they have more options for responding. By
overcoming debilitating behaviors that restrict choices, people are freer to select
from possibilities that were not available to them earlier, which increases individ-
ual freedom. People have the capacity to choose how they will respond to external
events in their environment, which makes it possible for therapists to use behavio-
ral methods to attain humanistic ends (Kazdin, 1978, 2001).
Basic Characteristics and Assumptions
Seven key characteristics of behavior therapy are described below.
1. Behavior therapy is based on the principles and procedures of the scientifi c meth-
od. Experimentally derived principles of learning are systematically applied to help
people change their maladaptive behaviors. The distinguishing characteristic of
behavioral practitioners is their systematic adherence to precision and to empirical
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 250 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

251
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
evaluation. Behavior therapists state treatment goals in concrete objective terms
to make replication of their interventions possible. Treatment goals are agreed
upon by the client and the therapist. Throughout the course of therapy, the thera-
pist assesses problem behaviors and the conditions that are maintaining them.
Evaluation methods are used to discern the effectiveness of both assessment and
treatment procedures. Therapeutic techniques employed must have demonstrated
effectiveness. In short, behavioral concepts and procedures are stated explicitly,
tested empirically within a conceptual framework, and revised continually.
2. Behavior is not limited to overt actions a person engages in that we can observe;
behavior also includes internal processes such as cognitions, images, beliefs, and
emotions. The key characteristic of a behavior is that it is something that can be
operationally defi ned.
3. Behavior therapy deals with the client’s current problems and the factors
infl uencing them, as opposed to an analysis of possible historical determinants.
Emphasis is on specifi c factors that infl uence present functioning and what fac-
tors can be used to modify performance. At times understanding of the past may
offer useful information about environmental events related to present behavior.
Behavior therapists look to the current environmental events that maintain prob-
lem behaviors and help clients produce behavior change by changing environmen-
tal events, through a process called functional assessment, or what Wolpe (1990)
referred to as a “behavioral analysis.” Behavior therapy recognizes the importance
of the individual, the individual’s environment, and the interaction between the
person and the environment in facilitating change.
4. Clients involved in behavior therapy are expected to assume an active role by en-
gaging in specifi c actions to deal with their problems. Rather than simply talking
about their condition, clients are required to do something to bring about change.
Clients monitor their behaviors both during and outside the therapy sessions,
learn and practice coping skills, and role-play new behavior. Therapeutic tasks that
clients carry out in daily life, or homework assignments, are a basic part of this ap-
proach. Behavior therapy is an action-oriented and an educational approach, and
learning is viewed as being at the core of therapy. Clients learn new and adaptive
behaviors to replace old and maladaptive behaviors.
5. This approach assumes that change can take place without insight into underly-
ing dynamics and without understanding the origins of a psychological problem.
Behavior therapists operate on the premise that changes in behavior can occur prior
to or simultaneously with understanding of oneself, and that behavioral chang-
es may well lead to an increased level of self-understanding. While it is true that
insight and understanding about the contingencies that exacerbate one’s problems
can supply motivation to change, knowing that one has a problem and knowing
how to change it are two different things (Martell, 2007).
6. Assessment is an ongoing process of observation and self-monitoring that
focuses on the current determinants of behavior, including identifying the problem
and evaluating the change; assessment informs the treatment process. Therapists
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 251 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

252
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
also assess their clients’ cultures as part of their social environments, including
social support networks relating to target behaviors (Tanaka-Matsumi, Higgin-
botham, & Chang, 2002). Critical to behavioral approaches is the careful assess-
ment and evaluation of the interventions used to determine whether the behavior
change resulted from the procedure.
7. Behavioral treatment interventions are individually tailored to specifi c prob-
lems experienced by the client. Several therapy techniques may be used to treat an
individual client’s problems. An important question that serves as a guide for this
choice is, “What treatment, by whom, is the most effective for this individual with
that specifi c problem and under which set of circumstances?” (Paul, 1967, p. 111).
t h e t h e r a p e u t i c p r o c e s s
Therapeutic Goals
Goals occupy a place of central importance in behavior therapy. The general goals
of behavior therapy are to increase personal choice and to create new conditions
for learning. The client, with the help of the therapist, defi nes specifi c treatment
goals at the outset of the therapeutic process. Although assessment and treatment
occur together, a formal assessment takes place prior to treatment to determine
behaviors that are targets of change. Continual assessment throughout therapy
determines the degree to which identifi ed goals are being met. It is important to
devise a way to measure progress toward goals based on empirical validation.
Contemporary behavior therapy stresses clients’ active role in deciding about
their treatment. The therapist assists clients in formulating specifi c measurable
goals. Goals must be clear, concrete, understood, and agreed on by the client and
the counselor. The counselor and client discuss the behaviors associated with the
goals, the circumstances required for change, the nature of subgoals, and a plan of
action to work toward these goals. This process of determining therapeutic goals
entails a negotiation between client and counselor that results in a contract that
guides the course of therapy. Behavior therapists and clients alter goals throughout
the therapeutic process as needed.
Therapist’s Function and Role
Behavior therapists conduct a thorough functional assessment (or behavioral anal-
ysis) to identify the maintaining conditions by systematically gathering informa-
tion about situational antecedents (A), the dimensions of the problem behavior
(B), and the consequences (C) of the problem. This is known as the ABC model,
and the goal of a functional assessment of a client’s behavior is to understand the
ABC sequence. This model of behavior suggests that behavior (B) is infl uenced by
some particular events that precede it, called antecedents (A), and by certain events
that follow it, called consequences (C). Antecedent events cue or elicit a certain
behavior. For example, with a client who has trouble going to sleep, listening to a
relaxation tape may serve as a cue for sleep induction. Turning off the lights and
removing the television from the bedroom may elicit sleep behaviors as well. Con-
sequences are events that maintain a behavior in some way, either by increasing
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 252 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

253
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
or decreasing it. For example, a client may be more likely to return to counseling
after the counselor offers verbal praise or encouragement for having come in or
for having completed some homework. A client may be less likely to return if
the counselor is consistently late to sessions. In doing a behavioral assessment
interview, the therapist’s task is to identify the particular antecedent and conse-
quent events that infl uence, or are functionally related to, an individual’s behavior
(Cormier, Nurius, & Osborn, 2013).
Behaviorally oriented practitioners tend to be active and directive and to func-
tion as consultants and problem solvers. They rely heavily on empirical evidence
about the effi cacy of the techniques they apply to particular problems. Behavio-
ral practitioners must possess intuitive skills and clinical judgment in selecting
appropriate treatment methods and in determining when to implement specifi c
techniques (Wilson, 2011). They pay close attention to the clues given by clients,
and they are willing to follow their clinical hunches. They use some techniques
common to other approaches, such as summarizing, refl ection, clarifi cation, and
open-ended questioning. However, behavioral clinicians perform other functions
as well (Miltenberger, 2012; Spiegler & Guevremont, 2010):
• The therapist strives to understand the function of client behaviors, including
how certain behaviors originated and how they are sustained. With this under-
standing, the therapist formulates initial treatment goals and designs and
implements a treatment plan to accomplish these goals.
• The behavioral clinician uses strategies that have research support for use with
a particular kind of problem. These evidence-based strategies promote generali-
zation and maintenance of behavior change. A number of these strategies are
described later in this chapter.
• The clinician evaluates the success of the change plan by measuring progress
toward the goals throughout the duration of treatment. Outcome measures are
given to the client at the beginning of treatment (called a baseline) and collected
again periodically during and after treatment to determine whether the strategy
and treatment plan are working. If not, adjustments are made in the strategies
being used.
• A key task of the therapist is to conduct follow-up assessments to see whether
the changes are durable over time. Clients learn how to identify and cope with
potential setbacks. The emphasis is on helping clients maintain changes over
time and acquire behavioral and cognitive coping skills to prevent relapses.
Let’s examine how a behavior therapist might perform these functions. A client
comes to therapy to reduce her anxiety, which is preventing her from leaving the
house. The therapist is likely to begin with a specifi c analysis of the nature of her
anxiety. The therapist will ask how she experiences the anxiety of leaving her house,
including what she actually does in these situations. Systematically, the therapist
gathers information about this anxiety. When did the problem begin? In what
situations does it arise? What does she do at these times? What are her feelings
and thoughts in these situations? Who is present when she experiences anxiety?
What does she do to reduce the anxiety? How do her present fears interfere with
living effectively? After this assessment, specifi c behavioral goals are developed,
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 253 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

254
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
and strategies such as relaxation training, systematic desensitization, and exposure
therapy are designed to help the client reduce her anxiety to a manageable level.
The therapist will get a commitment from the client to work toward the specifi ed
goals, and the two of them will evaluate the client’s progress toward meeting these
goals throughout the duration of therapy.
For a description of applying a behavioral approach to the assessment and treat-
ment of an individual client, see Dr. Sherry Cormier’s behavioral interventions
with Ruth in Case Approach to Counseling and Psychotherapy (Corey, 2013a, chap. 7).
Client’s Experience in Therapy
One of the unique contributions of behavior therapy is that it provides the therapist
with a well-defi ned system of procedures to employ. Both therapist and client have
clearly defi ned roles, and the importance of client awareness and participation in
the therapeutic process is stressed. Behavior therapy is characterized by an active
role for both therapist and client. A large part of the therapist’s role is to teach
concrete skills through the provision of instructions, modeling, and performance
feedback. The client engages in behavioral rehearsal with feedback until skills are
well learned and generally receives active homework assignments (such as self-
monitoring of problem behaviors) to complete between therapy sessions. Behavior
clinicians emphasize that changes clients make in therapy need to be translated
into their daily lives. It is important for clients to be motivated to change, and they
are expected to cooperate in carrying out therapeutic activities, both during therapy
sessions and in everyday life. If clients are not involved in this way, the chances
are slim that therapy will be successful. However, if clients are not motivated, an-
other behavioral strategy that has considerable empirical support is motivational
interviewing (Miller & Rollnick, 2002). This strategy involves honoring the client’s
resistance in such a way that his or her motivation to change is increased over time
(Cormier et al., 2013).
Clients are encouraged to experiment for the purpose of enlarging their rep-
ertoire of adaptive behaviors. Counseling is not complete unless actions follow
verbalizations. Behavioral practitioners make the assumption that it is only when
the transfer of changes is made from the sessions to everyday life that the effects
of therapy can be considered successful. Clients are as aware as the therapist is
regarding when the goals have been accomplished and when it is appropriate to
terminate treatment. It is clear that clients are expected to do more than merely
gather insights; they need to be willing to make changes and to continue imple-
menting new behavior once formal treatment has ended.
Relationship Between Therapist and Client
The charge is often made that the importance of the relationship between client
and therapist is discounted in behavior therapy. Antony and Roemer (2011b) ac-
knowledge that examining the effi cacy of particular behavioral techniques has been
given more emphasis than the quality of the therapeutic relationship in behavior
therapy. However, behavioral practitioners have increasingly recognized the role
of the therapeutic relationship and therapist behavior as critical factors related to
the process and outcome of treatment. Today, most behavioral practitioners stress
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 254 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

255
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
the value of establishing a collaborative working relationship with their clients. For
example, Lazarus (1993) believes a fl exible repertoire of relationship styles, plus a
wide range of techniques, enhances treatment outcomes. He emphasizes the need
for therapeutic fl exibility and versatility above all else. Lazarus contends that the
cadence of client–therapist interaction differs from individual to individual and
even from session to session. The skilled behavior therapist conceptualizes prob-
lems behaviorally and makes use of the client–therapist relationship in facilitating
change.
As you will recall, the experiential therapies (existential therapy, person-centered
therapy, and Gestalt therapy) place primary emphasis on the nature of the en-
gagement between counselor and client. In contrast, most behavioral practitioners
contend that factors such as warmth, empathy, authenticity, permissiveness, and
acceptance are necessary, but not suffi cient, for behavior change to occur. The client–
therapist relationship is a foundation on which therapeutic strategies are built to
help clients change in the direction they wish.
a p p l i c at i o n : t h e r a p e u t i c
t e c h n i q u e s a n d p r o c e d u r e s
A strength of the behavioral approaches is the development of specifi c therapeutic
procedures that must be shown to be effective through objective means. The re-
sults of behavioral interventions become clear because therapists receive continual
direct feedback from their clients. A hallmark of the behavioral approaches is that
the therapeutic techniques are empirically supported and evidence-based practice
is highly valued. To its credit, the effectiveness of behavior therapy has been re-
searched with different populations and a wide array of disorders.
According to Lazarus (1989, 1992b, 1996b, 1997a, 2005, 2008a, 2008b),
behavioral practitioners can incorporate into their treatment plans any technique
that can be demonstrated to effectively change behavior. Lazarus advocates the
use of diverse techniques, regardless of their theoretical origin. It is clear that
behavior therapists do not have to restrict themselves only to methods derived from
learning theory. Likewise, behavioral techniques can be incorporated into other
approaches. This is illustrated later in this chapter in the sections on the incorpora-
tion of mindfulness and acceptance-based approaches into the practice of behavior
therapy.
The therapeutic procedures used by behavior therapists are specifi cally designed
for a particular client rather than being randomly selected from a “bag of tech-
niques.” Therapists are often quite creative in their interventions. In the following
sections I describe a range of behavioral techniques available to the practitioner:
applied behavioral analysis, relaxation training, systematic desensitization, expo-
sure therapies, eye movement desensitization and reprocessing, social skills train-
ing, self-management programs and self-directed behavior, multimodal therapy,
and mindfulness and acceptance-based approaches. These techniques do not
encompass the full spectrum of behavioral procedures, but they do represent a
sample of the approaches used in the practice of contemporary behavior therapy.
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 255 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

256
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
Applied Behavioral Analysis: Operant
Conditioning Techniques
This section describes a few key principles of operant conditioning: positive rein-
forcement, negative reinforcement, extinction, positive punishment, and negative
punishment. For a detailed treatment of the wide range of operant conditioning
methods that are part of contemporary behavior modifi cation, I recommend
Miltenberger (2012).
In applied behavior analysis, operant conditioning techniques and methods of
assessment and evaluation are applied to a wide range of problems in many differ-
ent settings (Kazdin, 2001). The most important contribution of applied behavior
analysis is that it offers a functional approach to understanding clients’ problems
and addresses these problems by changing antecedents and consequences (the
ABC model).
Behaviorists believe we respond in predictable ways because of the gains we
experience (positive reinforcement) or because of the need to escape or avoid
unpleasant consequences (negative reinforcement). Once clients’ goals have been
assessed, specifi c behaviors are targeted. The goal of reinforcement, whether posi-
tive or negative, is to increase the target behavior. Positive reinforcement involves
the addition of something of value to the individual (such as praise, attention,
money, or food) as a consequence of certain behavior. The stimulus that follows
the behavior is the positive reinforcer. For example, a child earns excellent grades
and is praised for studying by her parents. If she values this praise, it is likely that
she will have an investment in studying in the future. When the goal of a program
is to decrease or eliminate undesirable behaviors, positive reinforcement is often
used to increase the frequency of more desirable behaviors, which replace undesir-
able behaviors. In the above example, the parental praise functions as the positive
reinforcer and makes it more likely that the child will maintain or even increase
the frequency of studying and earning good grades. Note that if a child did not
value parental praise, this would not serve as a reinforcer. The reinforcer is not
defi ned by the form or substance that it takes but rather by the function it serves:
namely, to maintain or increase the frequency of a desired behavior.
Negative reinforcement involves the escape from or the avoidance of aversive
(unpleasant) stimuli. The individual is motivated to exhibit a desired behavior to
avoid the unpleasant condition. For example, a friend of mine does not appreci-
ate waking up to the shrill sound of an alarm clock. She has trained herself to
wake up a few minutes before the alarm sounds to avoid the aversive stimulus of
the alarm buzzer.
Another operant method of changing behavior is extinction, which refers to
withholding reinforcement from a previously reinforced response. In applied
settings, extinction can be used for behaviors that have been maintained by posi-
tive reinforcement or negative reinforcement. For example, in the case of chil-
dren who display temper tantrums, parents often reinforce this behavior by the
attention they give to it. An approach to dealing with problematic behavior is
to eliminate the connection between a certain behavior (tantrums) and positive
reinforcement (attention). In this example a parent uses extinction when during
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 256 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

257
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
and after a child’s temper tantrum, the parent ignores the child’s tantrum-related
behaviors. Doing so can decrease or eliminate such behaviors through the ex-
tinction process. It should be noted that extinction might well have negative side
effects, such as anger and aggression. Also note that initially when using extinc-
tion that unwanted behaviors may increase temporarily. Extinction can reduce or
eliminate certain behaviors, but extinction does not replace those responses that
have been extinguished. For this reason, extinction is most often used in behav-
ior modifi cation programs in conjunction with various reinforcement strategies
(Kazdin, 2001).
Another way behavior is controlled is through punishment, sometimes re-
ferred to as aversive control, in which the consequences of a certain behavior result
in a decrease of that behavior. The goal of reinforcement is to increase target behav-
ior, but the goal of punishment is to decrease target behavior. Miltenberger (2012)
describes two kinds of punishment that may occur as a consequence of behavior:
positive punishment and negative punishment. In positive punishment an aver-
sive stimulus is added after the behavior to decrease the frequency of a behavior
(such as a time-out procedure with a child who is displaying misbehavior).
In negative punishment a reinforcing stimulus is removed following the behav-
ior to decrease the frequency of a target behavior (such as deducting money from
a worker’s salary for missing time at work, or taking television time away from a
child for misbehavior). In both kinds of punishment, the behavior is less likely to
occur in the future. These four operant procedures form the basis of behavior ther-
apy programs for parent skills training and are also used in the self-management
procedures that are discussed later in this chapter.
Some behavioral practitioners are opposed to using aversive control or punish-
ment, and recommended substituting positive reinforcement. The key principle in
the applied behavior analysis approach is to use the least aversive means possible
to change behavior, and positive reinforcement is known to be the most powerful
change agent. In everyday life, punishment often is used as a means of getting
revenge or expressing frustration. However, as Kazdin (2001) has noted, “punish-
ment in everyday life is not likely to teach lessons or suppress intolerable behavior
because of the specifi c punishments that are used and how they are applied” (p. 231).
Even in those cases when punishment suppresses undesirable responses, punish-
ment does not result in teaching desirable behaviors. Punishment should be used
only after nonaversive approaches have been implemented and found to be inef-
fective in changing problematic behavior (Kazdin, 2001; Miltenberger, 2012). It is
essential that reinforcement be used as a way to develop appropriate behaviors that
replace the behaviors that are suppressed.
Progressive Muscle Relaxation
Progressive muscle relaxation has become increasingly popular as a method of
teaching people to cope with the stresses produced by daily living. It is aimed at
achieving muscle and mental relaxation and is easily learned. After clients learn
the basics of relaxation procedures, it is essential that they practice these exercises
daily to obtain maximum results.
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 257 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

258
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
Jacobson (1938) is credited with initially developing the progressive muscle
relaxation procedure. It has since been refi ned and modifi ed, and relaxation pro-
cedures are frequently used in combination with a number of other behavioral
techniques. These include systematic desensitization, assertion training, self-
management programs, audiotape recordings of guided relaxation procedures,
computer simulation programs, biofeedback-induced relaxation, hypnosis, medi-
tation, and autogenic training (teaching control of bodily and imaginal functions
through autosuggestion).
Progressive muscle relaxation involves several components. Clients are given
a set of instructions that teaches them to relax. They assume a passive and
relaxed position in a quiet environment while alternately contracting and relax-
ing muscles. This progressive muscle relaxation is explicitly taught to the client
by the therapist. Deep and regular breathing also is associated with producing
relaxation. At the same time clients learn to mentally “let go,” perhaps by focus-
ing on pleasant thoughts or images. Clients are instructed to actually feel and
experience the tension building up, to notice their muscles getting tighter and
study this tension, and to hold and fully experience the tension. It is useful for
clients to experience the difference between a tense and a relaxed state. The
client is then taught how to relax all the muscles while visualizing the various
parts of the body, with emphasis on the facial muscles. The arm muscles are
relaxed fi rst, followed by the head, the neck and shoulders, the back, abdo-
men, and thorax, and then the lower limbs. Relaxation becomes a well-learned
response, which can become a habitual pattern if practiced daily for about
25 minutes each day.
Relaxation procedures have been applied to a variety of clinical problems, ei-
ther as a separate technique or in conjunction with related methods. The most
common use has been with problems related to stress and anxiety, which are often
manifested in psychosomatic symptoms. Relaxation training has benefi ts in areas
such as preparing patients for surgery, teaching clients how to cope with chron-
ic pain, and reducing the frequency of migraine attacks (Ferguson & Sgambati,
2008). Some other ailments for which progressive muscle relaxation is helpful
include asthma, headache, hypertension, insomnia, irritable bowel syndrome, and
panic disorder (Cormier et al., 2013).
For an exercise of the phases of the progressive muscle relaxation procedure
that you can apply to yourself, see Student Manual for Theory and Practice of Coun-
seling and Psychotherapy (Corey, 2013b). For an excellent audiotape demonstration
of progressive muscle relaxation, see Dattilio (2006). For a more detailed discus-
sion of progressive muscle relaxation, see Ferguson and Sgambati (2008).
Systematic Desensitization
Systematic desensitization, which is based on the principle of classical condition-
ing, is a basic behavioral procedure developed by Joseph Wolpe, one of the pio-
neers of behavior therapy. Clients imagine successively more anxiety-arousing
situations at the same time that they engage in a behavior that competes with
anxiety. Gradually, or systematically, clients become less sensitive (desensitized) to
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 258 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

259
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
the anxiety-arousing situation. This procedure can be considered a form of expo-
sure therapy because clients are required to expose themselves to anxiety-arousing
images as a way to reduce anxiety.
Systematic desensitization is an empirically researched behavior therapy pro-
cedure that is time consuming, yet it is clearly effective and effi cient in reducing
maladaptive anxiety and treating anxiety-related disorders, particularly in the area
of specifi c phobias (Cormier et al., 2013; Head & Gross, 2008; Spiegler & Guevre-
mont, 2010). Before implementing the desensitization procedure, the therapist
conducts an initial interview to identify specifi c information about the anxiety
and to gather relevant background information about the client. This interview,
which may last several sessions, gives the therapist a good understanding of who
the client is. The therapist questions the client about the particular circumstances
that elicit the conditioned fears. For instance, under what circumstances does the
client feel anxious? If the client is anxious in social situations, does the anxiety
vary with the number of people present? Is the client more anxious with women
or men? The client is asked to begin a self-monitoring process consisting of
observing and recording situations during the week that elicit anxiety responses.
Some therapists also administer a questionnaire to gather additional data about
situations leading to anxiety.
If the decision is made to use the desensitization procedure, the therapist gives
the client a rationale for the procedure and briefl y describes what is involved. Once
it has been determined that systematic desensitization is an appropriate form of
treatment, a three-step process unfolds: (1) relaxation training, (2) development
of a graduated anxiety hierarchy, and (3) systematic desensitization proper that
involves the presentation of hierarchy items while the client is in a deeply relaxed
state (Head & Gross, 2008).
The steps in progressive muscle relaxation, which were described earlier, are pre-
sented to the client. The therapist uses a very quiet, soft, and pleasant voice to teach
progressive muscular relaxation. The client is asked to create imagery of previously
relaxing situations, such as sitting by a lake or wandering through a beautiful fi eld.
It is important that the client reach a state of calm and peacefulness. The client is
instructed to practice relaxation both as a part of the desensitization procedure and
also outside the session on a daily basis.
The therapist then works with the client to develop an anxiety hierarchy for
each of the identifi ed areas. Stimuli that elicit anxiety in a particular area, such as
rejection, jealousy, criticism, disapproval, or any phobia, are analyzed. The thera-
pist constructs a ranked list of situations that elicit increasing degrees of anxiety
or avoidance. The hierarchy is arranged in order from the most anxiety-provoking
situation the client can imagine down to the situation that evokes the least anxiety.
If it has been determined that the client has anxiety related to fear of rejection, for
example, the highest anxiety-producing situation might be rejection by the spouse,
next, rejection by a close friend, and then rejection by a coworker. The least dis-
turbing situation might be a stranger’s indifference toward the client at a party.
Desensitization does not begin until several sessions after the initial interview
has been completed. Enough time is allowed for clients to learn relaxation in therapy
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 259 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

260
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
sessions, to practice it at home, and to construct their anxiety hierarchy. The de-
sensitization process begins with the client reaching complete relaxation with eyes
closed. A neutral scene is presented, and the client is asked to imagine it. If the
client remains relaxed, he or she is asked to imagine the least anxiety-arousing
scene on the hierarchy of situations that has been developed. The therapist moves
progressively up the hierarchy until the client signals that he or she is experiencing
anxiety, at which time the scene is terminated. Relaxation is then induced again,
and the scene is reintroduced again until little anxiety is experienced to it. Treat-
ment ends when the client is able to remain in a relaxed state while imagining
the scene that was formerly the most disturbing and anxiety-producing. The core
of systematic desensitization is repeated exposure in the imagination to anxiety-
evoking situations without experiencing any negative consequences.
Homework and follow-up are essential components of successful desensiti-
zation. Clients are encouraged to practice selected relaxation procedures daily, at
which time they visualize scenes completed in the previous session. Gradually,
they can expose themselves to daily-life situations as a further way to manage their
anxieties. Clients tend to benefi t the most when they have a variety of ways to cope
with anxiety-arousing situations that they can continue to use once therapy has
ended (Head & Gross, 2008).
Systematic desensitization is among the most empirically supported therapy
methods available, especially for the treatment of anxiety (Head & Gross, 2008).
Not only does systematic desensitization have a good track record in dealing with
fears, it also has been used to treat a variety of conditions including anger, asth-
matic attacks, insomnia, motion sickness, nightmares, and sleepwalking (Spiegler,
2008). Systematic desensitization is often acceptable to clients because they are
gradually and symbolically exposed to anxiety-evoking situations.
For a more detailed discussion of systematic desensitization, see Head and
Gross (2008) and Cormier et al. (2013).
In Vivo Exposure and Flooding
Exposure therapies are designed to treat fears and other negative emotional
responses by introducing clients, under carefully controlled conditions, to the situ-
ations that contributed to such problems. Exposure is a key process in treating a
wide range of problems associated with fear and anxiety. Exposure therapy involves
systematic confrontation with a feared stimulus, either through imagination or in
vivo (live). Imaginal exposure can be used prior to implementing in vivo exposure
when a client’s fears are so severe that the client is unable to participate in live
exposure (Hazlett-Stevens & Craske, 2008). Whatever route is used, exposure in-
volves contact by clients with what they fi nd fearful. Desensitization is one type
of exposure therapy, but there are others. Two variations of traditional systematic
desensitization are in vivo exposure and fl ooding.
i n v i v o e x p o s u r e In vivo exposure involves client exposure to the ac-
tual anxiety-evoking events rather than simply imagining these situations. Live
exposure has been a cornerstone of behavior therapy for decades. Hazlett-
Stevens and Craske (2008) describe the key elements of the process of in vivo
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 260 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

261
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
exposure. Typically, treatment begins with a functional analysis of objects or situ-
ations a person avoids or fears. Together, the therapist and the client generate a
hierarchy of situations for the client to encounter in ascending order of diffi culty.
In vivo exposure involves repeated systematic exposure to fear items, beginning
from the bottom of the hierarchy. Clients engage in a brief, graduated series
of exposures to feared events. As is the case with systematic desensitization,
clients learn responses incompatible with anxiety, such as responses involving
muscle relaxation. Clients are encouraged eventually to experience their full fear
response during exposure without engaging in avoidance. Between therapy ses-
sions, clients carry out self-directed exposure exercises. Clients’ progress with
home practice is reviewed, and the therapist provides feedback on how the client
could deal with any diffi culties encountered.
In some cases the therapist may accompany clients as they encounter feared
situations. For example, a therapist could go with clients in an elevator if they had
phobias of using elevators. Of course, when this kind of out-of-offi ce procedure is
used, matters of safety and appropriate ethical boundaries are always considered.
People who have extreme fears of certain animals could be exposed to these ani-
mals in real life in a safe setting with a therapist. Self-managed in vivo exposure—a
procedure in which clients expose themselves to anxiety-evoking events on their
own—is an alternative when it is not practical for a therapist to be with clients in
real-life situations.
f lo o d i n g Another form of exposure therapy is fl ooding, which refers to either
in vivo or imaginal exposure to anxiety-evoking stimuli for a prolonged period of
time. As is characteristic of all exposure therapies, even though the client experi-
ences anxiety during the exposure, the feared consequences do not occur.
In vivo fl ooding consists of intense and prolonged exposure to the actual anxiety-
producing stimuli. Remaining exposed to feared stimuli for a prolonged period
without engaging in any anxiety-reducing behaviors allows the anxiety to decrease
on its own. Generally, highly fearful clients tend to curb their anxiety through the
use of maladaptive behaviors. In fl ooding, clients are prevented from engaging in
their usual maladaptive responses to anxiety-arousing situations. In vivo fl ooding
tends to reduce anxiety rapidly.
Imaginal fl ooding is based on similar principles and follows the same proce-
dures except the exposure occurs in the client’s imagination instead of in daily life.
An advantage of using imaginal fl ooding over in vivo fl ooding is that there are no re-
strictions on the nature of the anxiety-arousing situations that can be treated. In vivo
exposure to actual traumatic events (airplane crash, rape, fi re, fl ood) is often not
possible nor is it appropriate for both ethical and practical reasons. Imaginal fl ood-
ing can re-create the circumstances of the trauma in a way that does not bring about
adverse consequences to the client. Survivors of an airplane crash, for example, may
suffer from a range of debilitating symptoms. They are likely to have nightmares
and fl ashbacks to the disaster; they may avoid travel by air or have anxiety about
travel by any means; and they probably have a variety of distressing symptoms such
as guilt, anxiety, and depression. In vivo and imaginal exposure, as well as fl ooding,
are frequently used in the behavioral treatment for anxiety-related disorders, specifi c
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 261 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

262
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
phobia, social phobia, panic disorder, obsessive-compulsive disorder, posttraumatic
stress disorder, and agoraphobia (Hazlett-Stevens & Craske, 2008).
Because of the discomfort associated with prolonged and intense exposure,
some clients may not elect these exposure treatments. It is important for the behav-
ior therapist to work with the client to create motivation and readiness for exposure.
From an ethical perspective, clients should have adequate information about pro-
longed and intense exposure therapy before agreeing to participate. It is important
that they understand that anxiety will be induced as a way to reduce it. Clients need
to make informed decisions after considering the pros and cons of subjecting them-
selves to temporarily stressful aspects of treatment. Clients should be informed that
they can terminate exposure if they experience a high level of anxiety.
The repeated success of exposure therapy in treating various disorders has re-
sulted in exposure being used as a part of most behavioral treatments for anxiety
disorders. Spiegler and Guevremont (2010) conclude that exposure therapies are
the single most potent behavioral procedures available for anxiety-related disor-
ders, and they can have long-lasting effects. However, they add, using exposure as
a sole treatment procedure is not always suffi cient. In cases involving severe and
multifaceted disorders, more than one behavioral intervention is often required.
Increasingly, imaginal and in vivo exposure are being used in combination, which
fi ts with the trend in behavior therapy to use treatment packages as a way to en-
hance the effectiveness of therapy.
Eye Movement Desensitization and Reprocessing
Eye movement desensitization and reprocessing (EMDR) is a form of exposure
therapy that entails assessment and preparation, imaginal fl ooding, and cognitive
restructuring in the treatment of individuals with traumatic memories. The treat-
ment involves the use of rapid, rhythmic eye movements and other bilateral stimu-
lation to treat clients who have experienced traumatic stress. Developed by Francine
Shapiro (2001), this therapeutic procedure draws from a wide range of behavio-
ral interventions. Designed to assist clients in dealing with posttraumatic stress
disorders, EMDR has been applied to a variety of populations including children,
couples, sexual abuse victims, combat veterans, victims of crime, rape survivors,
accident victims, and individuals dealing with anxiety, panic, depression, grief, ad-
dictions, and phobias. The treatment consists of three basic phases involving as-
sessment and preparation, imaginal fl ooding, and cognitive restructuring.
Shapiro (2001) emphasizes the importance of the safety and welfare of the
client when using this approach. EMDR may appear simple to some, but the
ethical use of the procedure demands training and clinical supervision, as is
true of using exposure therapies in general. Because of the powerful reactions
from clients, it is essential that practitioners know how to safely and effectively
manage these occurrences. Therapists should not use this procedure unless they
receive proper training and supervision from an authorized EMDR instructor. A
more complete discussion of this behavioral procedure can be found in Shapiro
(2001, 2002a).
There is some controversy over whether the eye movements themselves create
change or the application of cognitive techniques paired with eye movements act
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 262 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

263
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
as change agents. The role of lateral eye movements has yet to be clearly demon-
strated, and some evidence indicates that the eye movement component may not
be integral to the treatment (Prochaska & Norcross, 2010; Spiegler & Guevremont,
2010). In a review of controlled studies of EMDR in the treatment of trauma, Sha-
piro (2002b) reports that EMDR clearly outperforms no treatment and achieves
similar or superior results as other methods of treating trauma. When it comes
to the overall effectiveness of EMDR, Prochaska and Norcross (2010) note that
“in its 20-year history, EMDR has garnered more controlled research than any
other method used to treat trauma” (p. 236). In writing about the future of EMDR,
Prochaska and Norcross make several predictions: increasing numbers of practi-
tioners will receive training in EMDR; outcome research will shed light on EMDR’s
effectiveness compared to other current therapies for trauma; and further research
and practice will provide a sense of its effectiveness with disorders besides post-
traumatic stress disorder.
Social Skills Training
Social skills training is a broad category that deals with an individual’s ability to
interact effectively with others in various social situations; it is used to help clients
develop and achieve skills in interpersonal competence. Social skills involve being
able to communicate with others in a way that is both appropriate and effective.
Individuals who experience psychosocial problems that are partly caused by inter-
personal diffi culties are good candidates for social skills training. Typically, social
skills training involves various behavioral techniques such as psychoeducation,
modeling, behavior rehearsal, and feedback (Antony & Roemer, 2011b). Social
skills training is effective in treating psychosocial problems by increasing clients’
interpersonal skills (Segrin, 2008). Social skills involve the ability to relate to oth-
ers in appropriate and effective ways. Some of the desirable aspects of this training
are that it has a very broad base of applicability and that it can easily be tailored to
suit the particular needs of individual clients.
Segrin (2008) identifi es these key elements of social skills training, which entail
a collection of techniques: assessment, direct instruction and coaching, modeling,
role-playing, and homework assignments. Clients learn information that they can
apply to various interpersonal situations, and skills are modeled for them so they
can actually see how skills can be used. A key step involves the necessity of clients
putting into action the information they are acquiring. It is through role-playing
that individuals actively practice desired behaviors that are observed. Segrin notes
that by monitoring clients’ successes and failures therapists can fi ne-tune clients’
performances. The feedback and reinforcement clients receive assists them in con-
ceptualizing and using a new set of social skills that enables them to communicate
more effectively. A follow-up phase is critical for clients in establishing a range of
effective behaviors that can be applied to many social situations.
A few examples of evidence-based applications of social skills training include
alcohol/substance abuse, attention-defi cit/hyperactivity disorder, bullying, social
anxiety, emotional and behavioral problems in children, behavioral treatment for
couples, and depression (Antony & Roemer, 2011b; Segrin, 2008). A popular vari-
ation of social skills training is anger management training, which is designed for
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 263 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

264
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
individuals who have trouble with aggressive behavior. Assertion training, which is
described next, is useful for people who lack assertive skills.
a s s e r t i o n t r a i n i n g One specialized form of social skills training consists
of teaching people how to be assertive in a variety of social situations. Many people
have diffi culty feeling that it is appropriate or right to assert themselves. People
who lack social skills frequently experience interpersonal diffi culties at home, at
work, at school, and during leisure time. Assertion training can be useful for those
(1) who have diffi culty expressing anger or irritation, (2) who have diffi culty saying
no, (3) who are overly polite and allow others to take advantage of them, (4) who
fi nd it diffi cult to express affection and other positive responses, (5) who feel they
do not have a right to express their thoughts, beliefs, and feelings, or (6) who have
social phobias.
The basic assumption underlying assertion training is that people have the
right (but not the obligation) to express themselves. One goal of assertion train-
ing is to increase people’s behavioral repertoire so that they can make the choice
of whether to behave assertively in certain situations. It is important that clients
replace maladaptive social skills with new skills. Another goal is teaching people
to express themselves in ways that refl ect sensitivity to the feelings and rights of
others. Assertion does not mean aggression; truly assertive people do not stand up
for their rights at all costs, ignoring the feelings of others.
Generally, the therapist both teaches and models desired behaviors the client
wants to acquire. These behaviors are practiced in the therapy offi ce and then en-
acted in everyday life. Most assertion training programs focus on clients’ negative
self-statements, self-defeating beliefs, and faulty thinking. People often behave in
unassertive ways because they don’t think they have a right to state a viewpoint or
ask for what they want or deserve. Thus their thinking leads to passive behavior.
Effective assertion training programs do more than give people skills and techniques
for dealing with diffi cult situations. These programs challenge people’s beliefs that
accompany their lack of assertiveness and teach them to make constructive self-state-
ments and to adopt a new set of beliefs that will result in assertive behavior.
Assertion training is often conducted in groups. When a group format is used,
the modeling and instructions are presented to the entire group, and members
rehearse behavioral skills in role-playing situations. After the rehearsal, the mem-
ber is given feedback that consists of reinforcing the correct aspects of the behavior
and instructions on how to improve the behavior. Each member engages in fur-
ther rehearsals of assertive behaviors until the skills are performed adequately in a
variety of simulated situations (Miltenberger, 2012).
Because assertion training is based on Western notions of the value of assert-
iveness, it may not be suited for clients with a cultural background that places
more emphasis on harmony than on being assertive. This approach is not a pana-
cea, but it can be an effective treatment for clients who have skill defi cits in asser-
tive behavior or for individuals who experience diffi culties in their interpersonal
relationships. Although counselors can adapt this form of social skills training
procedures to suit their own style, it is important to include behavioral rehearsal
and continual assessment as basic aspects of the program. If you are interested in
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 264 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

265
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
learning more assertion training, consult Your Perfect Right: A Guide to Assertive
Behavior (Alberti & Emmons, 2008).
Self-Management Programs and Self-Directed Behavior
For some time there has been a trend toward “giving psychology away.” This involves
psychologists being willing to share their knowledge so that “consumers” can
increasingly lead self-directed lives and not be dependent on experts to deal with
their problems. Psychologists who share this perspective are primarily concerned
with teaching people the skills they will need to manage their own lives effectively.
An advantage of self-management techniques is that treatment can be extended
to the public in ways that cannot be done with traditional approaches to therapy.
Another advantage is that costs are minimal. Because clients have a direct role in
their own treatment, techniques aimed at self-change tend to increase involvement
and commitment to their treatment.
Self-management strategies include self-monitoring, self-reward, self-contract-
ing, and stimulus control. The basic idea of self-management assessments and in-
terventions is that change can be brought about by teaching people to use coping
skills in problematic situations. Generalization and maintenance of the outcomes are
enhanced by encouraging clients to accept the responsibility for carrying out these
strategies in daily life.
In self-management programs people make decisions concerning specifi c behav-
iors they want to control or change. People frequently discover that a major reason
they do not attain their goals is the lack of certain skills or unrealistic expectations of
change. Hope can be a therapeutic factor that leads to change, but unrealistic hope
can pave the way for a pattern of failures in a self-change program. A self-directed
approach can provide the guidelines for change and a plan that will lead to change.
For people to succeed in such a program, a careful analysis of the context of the
behavior pattern is essential, and people must be willing to follow some basic steps
such as those provided by Watson and Tharp (2007):
1. Selecting goals. Goals should be established one at a time, and they should be
measurable, attainable, positive, and signifi cant for you. It is essential that expecta-
tions be realistic.
2. Translating goals into target behaviors. Identify behaviors targeted for change.
Once targets for change are selected, anticipate obstacles and think of ways to
negotiate them.
3. Self-monitoring. Deliberately and systematically observe your own behavior, and
keep a behavioral diary, recording the behavior along with comments about the
relevant antecedent cues and consequences.
4. Working out a plan for change. Devise an action program to bring about actual
change. Various plans for the same goal can be designed, each of which can be
effective. Some type of self-reinforcement system is necessary in this plan because
reinforcement is the cornerstone of modern behavior therapy. Self-reinforcement
is a temporary strategy used until the new behaviors have been implemented in
everyday life. Take steps to ensure that the gains made will be maintained.
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 265 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

266
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
5. Evaluating an action plan. Evaluate the plan for change to determine whether
goals are being achieved, and adjust and revise the plan as other ways to meet goals
are learned. Evaluation is an ongoing process rather than a one-time occurrence,
and self-change is a lifelong practice.
Self-management strategies have been successfully applied to many popula-
tions and problems, a few of which include coping with panic attacks, helping
children to cope with fear of the dark, increasing creative productivity, managing
anxiety in social situations, encouraging speaking in front of a class, increasing
exercise, control of smoking, and dealing with depression (Watson & Tharp, 2007).
Research on self-management has been conducted in a wide variety of health prob-
lems, a few of which include arthritis, asthma, cancer, cardiac disease, substance
abuse, diabetes, headaches, vision loss, depression, nutrition, and self-health care
(Cormier et al., 2013).
Multimodal Therapy: Clinical Behavior Therapy
Multimodal therapy is a comprehensive, systematic, holistic approach to behav-
ior therapy developed by Arnold Lazarus (1989, 1997a, 2005, 2008a). Lazarus
(2008a) claims that the term “multimodal behavior therapy” is somewhat of a mis-
nomer. Although the assessment process is multimodal, the treatment is cognitive
behavioral and draws upon empirically supported methods. In terms of clinical
practice, behavior therapy and multimodal therapy are very similar (Wilson, 2011).
Multimodal therapy is grounded in social-cognitive theory and applies diverse be-
havioral techniques to a wide range of problems. This approach serves as a major
link between some behavioral principles and the cognitive behavioral approach
that has largely replaced traditional behavioral therapy.
Multimodal therapy is an open system that encourages technical eclecticism in
that it applies diverse behavioral techniques to a wide range of problems. Multi-
modal therapists borrow techniques from many other therapy systems (Lazarus,
2008b). New techniques are constantly being introduced and existing techniques
refi ned, but they are never used in a shotgun manner. Multimodal therapists take
great pains to determine precisely what relationship and what treatment strategies
will work best with each client and under which particular circumstances. The
underlying assumption of this approach is that because individuals are troubled
by a variety of specifi c problems it is appropriate that a multitude of treatment
strategies be used in bringing about change. Therapeutic fl exibility and versatility,
along with breadth over depth, are highly valued, and multimodal therapists are
constantly adjusting their procedures to achieve the client’s goals. Therapists need
to decide when and how to be challenging or supportive and how to adapt their
relationship style to the needs of the client (Lazarus, 1993, 1997a). Multimodal
therapists tend to be very active during therapist sessions, functioning as train-
ers, educators, consultants, coaches, and role models. They provide information,
instruction, and feedback as well as modeling assertive behaviors. They offer sug-
gestions, positive reinforcements, and are appropriately self-disclosing.
t h e b a s i c i . d . The essence of Lazarus’s multimodal approach is the premise
that the complex personality of human beings can be divided into seven major areas
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 266 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

267
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
of functioning: B 5 behavior; A 5 affective responses; S 5 sensations; I 5 images; C
5 cognitions; I 5 interpersonal relationships; and D 5 drugs, biological functions,
nutrition, and exercise (Lazarus, 1989, 1992a, 1992b, 1997a, 1997b, 2000, 2006).
Multimodal therapy begins with a comprehensive assessment of the seven mo-
dalities of human functioning and the interaction among them. A complete assess-
ment and treatment program must account for each modality of the BASIC I.D.,
which is the cognitive map linking each aspect of personality. Table 9.1 outlines
this process using questions Lazarus typically asks.
TA B L E 9 .1 The BASIC I.D. Assessment Process
M O D A L I T Y B E H A V I O R S Q U E S T I O N S T O A S K
Behavior Overt behaviors,
including acts, habits,
and reactions that
are observable and
measurable
What would you like to change?
How active are you?
What would you like to start doing?
What would you like to stop doing?
What are some of your main strengths?
What specifi c behaviors keep you from getting
what you want?
Affect Emotions, moods, and
strong feelings
What emotions do you experience most often?
What makes you laugh?
What makes you cry?
What makes you sad, mad, glad, scared?
What emotions are problematic for you?
Sensation Basic senses of touch,
taste, smell, sight, and
hearing
Do you suffer from unpleasant sensations,
such as pains, aches, dizziness, and so forth?
What do you particularly like or dislike in the
way of seeing, smelling, hearing, touching,
and tasting?
Imagery How we picture
ourselves, including
memories, dreams, and
fantasies
What are some bothersome recurring dreams
and vivid memories?
Do you have a vivid imagination?
How do you view your body?
How do you see yourself now?
How would you like to be able to see yourself
in the future?
Cognition Insights, philosophies,
ideas, opinions, self-
talk, and judgments
that constitute one’s
fundamental values,
attitudes, and beliefs
What are some ways in which you meet your
intellectual needs?
How do your thoughts affect your emotions?
What are the values and beliefs you most
cherish?
What are some negative things you say to
yourself?
What are some of your central faulty beliefs?
What are the main ‘shoulds,’ ‘oughts,’ and
‘musts’ in your life? How do they get in the
way of effective living?
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 267 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

268
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
Interpersonal
relationships
Interactions with other
people
How much of a social being are you?
To what degree do you desire intimacy with
others?
What do you expect from the signifi cant
people in your life?
What do they expect from you?
Are there any relationships with others that
you would hope to change?
If so, what kinds of changes do you want?
Drugs/biology Drugs, nutritional
habits, and exercise
patterns
Are you healthy and health conscious?
Do you have any concerns about your health?
Do you take any prescribed drugs?
What are your habits pertaining to diet,
exercise, and physical fi tness?
Source: Lazarus 1989, 1997a, 2000.
A major premise of multimodal therapy is that breadth is often more important
than depth. The more coping responses a client learns in therapy, the less chance
there is for a relapse. Therapists identify one specifi c issue from each aspect of the
BASIC I.D. framework as a target for change and teach clients a range of tech-
niques they can use to combat faulty thinking, to learn to relax in stressful situ-
ations, and to acquire effective interpersonal skills. Clients can then apply these
skills to a broad range of problems in their everyday lives.
The preliminary investigation of the BASIC I.D. framework brings out some
central and signifi cant themes that can be productively explored using a detailed
life-history questionnaire. (See Lazarus and Lazarus, 2005, for the Multimodal
Life-History Inventory.) Once the main profi le of a person’s BASIC I.D. has been
established, the next step consists of an examination of the interactions among
the different modalities. It is essential that therapists start where the client is and
then move into other productive areas for exploration. Failure to comprehend the
client’s situation can easily leave the client feeling alienated and misunderstood
(Lazarus, 2000). For an illustration of how Dr. Lazarus applies the BASIC I.D.
assessment model to the case of Ruth, along with examples of various techniques
he uses, see Case Approach to Counseling and Psychotherapy (Corey, 2013a, chap. 7).
Mindfulness and Acceptance-Based
Cognitive Behavior Therapy
Over the last decade behavior therapy has evolved, resulting in an expansion of the
behavioral tradition. Newer facets of cognitive behavior therapy, labeled the “third
wave” of behavior therapy, emphasize considerations that were considered off
limits for behavior therapists until recently, including mindfulness, acceptance,
the therapeutic relationship, spirituality, values, meditation, being in the present
moment, and emotional expression (Hayes, Follette, & Linehan, 2004; Herbert &
Forman, 2011). Third-generation behavior therapies have been developed that
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 268 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

269
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
center around fi ve interrelated core themes: (1) an expanded view of psychologi-
cal health, (2) a broad view of acceptable outcomes in therapy, (3) acceptance, (4)
mindfulness, and (5) creating a life worth living (Spiegler & Guevremont, 2010).
Mindfulness involves being aware of our experiencing in a receptive way and
engaging in activity based on this nonjudgmental awareness (Robins & Rosenthal,
2011). In mindfulness practice, clients train themselves to intentionally focus on their
present experience while at the same time achieving a distance from it. Mindfulness
involves developing an attitude of curiosity and compassion to present experience.
Clients learn to focus on one thing at a time and to bring their attention back to the
present moment when distractions arise.
As a clinical intervention, mindfulness shows promise across a broad range of
clinical problems, including for depression, generalized anxiety disorder, relation-
ship problems, and borderline personality disorder (Dimidjian & Linehan, 2008)
as well as being useful in the treatment of posttraumatic stress disorder among
military veterans. Through mindfulness exercises, veterans may be better able to
observe repetitive negative thinking and prevent extensive engagement with mala-
daptive ruminative processes (Vujanovic, Niles, Pietrefesa, Schmertz, & Potter,
2011). Many therapeutic approaches are incorporating mindfulness, meditation,
and other Eastern practices in the counseling process, and this trend seems likely
to continue (Worthington, 2011).
Acceptance is a process involving receiving one’s present experience without
judgment or preference, but with curiosity and kindness, and striving for full
awareness of the present moment (Germer, 2005b). Acceptance is not resigning
oneself to life’s problems; rather, it is an active process of self-affi rmation (Wilson,
2011). Acceptance is an alternative way of responding to our internal experience.
By replacing judgment, criticism, and avoidance with acceptance, the likely result
is increased adaptive functioning (Antony & Roemer, 2011b). The mindfulness and
acceptance approaches are good avenues for the integration of spirituality in the
counseling process.
The subjects of mindfulness and acceptance are only briefl y described in this
chapter. For a useful and extensive discussion of these topics, see Herbert and For-
man (2011), Acceptance and Mindfulness in Cognitive Behavior Therapy: Understand-
ing and Applying the New Therapies.
The four major approaches in the recent development of the behavioral tra-
dition include (1) dialectical behavior therapy (Linehan, 1993a, 1993b), which has
become a recognized treatment for borderline personality disorder; (2) mindfulness-
based stress reduction (Kabat-Zinn, 1990, 2003), which involves an 8- to 10-week
group program applying mindfulness techniques to coping with stress and pro-
moting physical and psychological health; (3) mindfulness-based cognitive therapy
(Segal et al., 2002), which is aimed primarily at treating depression; and (4) accept-
ance and commitment therapy (Hayes, Strosahl, & Houts, 2005; Hayes, Strosahl, &
Wilson, 2011), which is based on encouraging clients to accept, rather than
attempt to control or change, unpleasant sensations. All four of these approaches
use mindfulness strategies that have been subjected to empirical scrutiny, which
is a hallmark of the behavioral tradition.
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 269 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

270
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
d i a l e c t i c a l b e h av i o r t h e r a p y ( d b t ) Formulated by Linehan
(1993a, 1993b), DBT is a promising blend of behavioral and psychoanalytic tech-
niques for treating borderline personality disorders. Like analytic therapy, DBT
emphasizes the importance of the psychotherapeutic relationship, validation of the
client, the etiologic importance of the client having experienced an “invalidating
environment” as a child, and confrontation of resistance.
DBT treatment strategies include both acceptance- and change-oriented strate-
gies. The treatment program is geared toward helping clients make changes in
their behavior and environment, and at the same time communicating accept-
ance of their current state (Robins & Rosenthal, 2011). To help clients who have
particular problems with emotional regulation, DBT teaches clients to recognize
and accept the existence of simultaneous, opposing forces. By acknowledging this
fundamental dialectic relationship—such as not wanting to engage in a certain
behavior, yet knowing they have to engage in the behavior if they want to achieve
a desired goal—clients can learn to integrate the opposing notions of acceptance
and change, and the therapist can teach clients how to regulate their emotions and
behaviors. Mindfulness procedures are taught and practiced to develop an attitude
of acceptance (Fishman, Rego, & Muller, 2011).
DBT employs behavioral and cognitive behavioral techniques, including a form
of exposure therapy in which the client learns to tolerate painful emotions without
enacting self-destructive behaviors. DBT integrates its cognitive behaviorism not
only with analytic concepts but also with the mindfulness training of “Eastern psy-
chological and spiritual practices (primarily Zen practice)” (Linehan, 1993b, p. 6).
Many of the treatment strategies used and skills taught in DBT have roots in Zen
Buddhist principles and practices. These include being aware of the present
moment, seeing reality without distortion, accepting reality without judgment, let-
ting go of attachments that result in suffering, developing a greater degree of accept-
ance of self and others, and entering fully into present activities without separating
oneself from ongoing events and interactions (Robins & Rosenthal, 2011).
DBT is highly structured, but goals are tailored to each individual. Therapists
assist clients in using whatever skills they possess or are learning to navigate crises
more effectively and to address problem behaviors (Robins & Rosenthal, 2011).
Skills are taught in four modules: mindfulness, interpersonal effectiveness, emo-
tional regulation, and distress tolerance (Simpson, 2011). Mindfulness is a funda-
mental skill in DBT and is considered the basis for other skills taught. Mindful-
ness helps clients to embrace and tolerate the intense emotions they experience
when facing distressing situations. Interpersonal effectiveness involves learning to
ask for what one needs and learning to cope with interpersonal confl ict. This skill
entails increasing the chances that a client’s goals will be met, while at the same
time not damaging the relationship. Emotion regulation includes identifying emo-
tions, identifying obstacles to changing emotions, reducing vulnerability, and in-
creasing positive emotions. Clients learn the benefi ts of regulating emotions such
as anger, depression, and anxiety. Distress tolerance is aimed at helping individuals
to calmly recognizing emotions associated with negative situations without be-
coming overwhelmed by these situations. Clients learn how to tolerate pain or
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 270 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

271
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
discomfort skillfully. These skills are the route clients can take in achieving their
goals. “The therapy aims to assist clients to learn to control behavior, fully experi-
ence emotions, improve daily living skills, and achieve a sense of completeness”
(Simpson, 2011, p. 230).
DBT skills training is not a “quick fi x” approach. It generally involves a mini-
mum of one year of treatment and includes both individual therapy and skills train-
ing done in a group. DBT requires a behavioral contract. To competently practice
DBT, it is essential to obtain training in this approach. Because DBT places heavy
emphasis on didactic instruction and teaching mindfulness skills, therapists must
be competent in applying these skills and be able to model specifi c strategies and
attitudes for clients. Therapists who want to employ mindfulness strategies must
also have personal understanding and experience of these interventions to be able
to effectively use them with clients (Dimidjian & Linehan, 2008). A useful resource
for a more detailed discussion of DBT is Robins and Rosenthal (2011).
m i n d f u l n e s s – b a s e d s t r e s s r e d u c t i o n ( m b s r ) The essence of
mindfulness-based stress reduction (MBSR) consists of the notion that much of
our distress and suffering results from continually wanting things to be different
from how they actually are (Salmon, Sephton, & Dreeben, 2011). MBSR aims to
assist people in learning how to live more fully in the present rather than ruminating
about the past or being overly concerned about the future. MBSR does not actively
teach cognitive modifi cation techniques, nor does it label certain cognitions as
“dysfunctional,” because this is not consistent with the nonjudgmental attitude
one strives to cultivate in mindfulness practice.
The approach adopted in the MBSR program is to develop the capacity for
sustained directed attention through formal meditation practice. The skills taught
include sitting meditation and mindful yoga, which are aimed at cultivating mind-
fulness. The program includes a body scan meditation, which helps clients to
observe all the sensations in their body. Clients are encouraged to bring mindful-
ness into all of their daily activities, including standing, walking, and eating. Those
who are involved in the program are encouraged to practice formal mindfulness
meditation for 45 minutes daily. The MBSR program is designed to teach partici-
pants to relate to external and internal sources of stress in constructive ways. MBSR
places a heavy emphasis on experiential learning and the process of client self-
discovery (Dimidjian & Linehan, 2008). MBSR has many clinical applications, and
it is expected that the approach will evolve to address a range of negative psychologi-
cal states, such as anxiety, stress, and depression. This approach has many applica-
tions in the area of health and wellness and in promoting healthy lifestyle changes.
An excellent resource for a more detailed treatment of MBSR is Salmon, Sephton,
and Dreeben (2011).
m i n d f u l n e s s – b a s e d c o g n i t i v e t h e r a p y ( m b c t ) This program
is a comprehensive integration of the principles and skills of mindfulness applied
to the treatment of depression (Segal, Williams, & Teasdale, 2002). MBCT is an
8-week group treatment program adapted from Kabat-Zinn’s (1990) mindfulness-
based stress reduction program, and it includes components of cognitive behavior
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 271 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

272
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
therapy. MBCT represents an integration of techniques from MBSR and teaching
cognitive behavioral interventions to clients. The primary aim is to change clients’
awareness of and relation to their negative thoughts. Participants are taught how
to respond in skillful and intentional ways to their automatic negative thought pat-
terns. Fesco, Flynn, Mennin, and Haigh (2011) describe the essence of the seven
sessions in the MBCT program:
• Therapy begins by identifying negative automatic thinking of people experienc-
ing depression and by introducing some basic mindfulness practices.
• In the second session, participants learn about the reactions they have to life
experiences and learn more about mindfulness practices.
• The third session is devoted to teaching breathing techniques and focused atten-
tion on their present experiencing.
• In session four, the emphasis is on learning to experience the moment without
becoming attached to outcomes as a way to prevent relapse.
• The fi fth session teaches participants how to accept their experiencing without
holding on.
• Session six is used to describe thoughts as “merely thoughts;” clients learn that
they do not have to act on their thoughts. They can tell themselves, “I am not my
thoughts” and “Thoughts are not facts.”
• In the fi nal sessions, participants learn how to take care of themselves, to pre-
pare for relapse, and to generalize their mindfulness practices to daily life.
MBCT emphasizes experiential learning, in-session practice, learning from feed-
back, completing homework assignments, and applying what is learned in the pro-
gram to challenging situations encountered outside of the sessions. The brevity of
MBCT makes this approach an effi cient and cost-effective treatment. For a more
detailed review of MBCT, see Fresco, Flynn, Mennin, and Haigh (2011).
acceptance and commitment therapy (act) Another mindfulness-
based approach is acceptance and commitment therapy (Hayes et al., 2005, 2011),
which involves fully accepting present experience and mindfully letting go of ob-
stacles. In this approach “acceptance is not merely tolerance—rather it is the active
nonjudgmental embracing of experience in the here and now” (Hayes, 2004, p.
32). Acceptance is a stance or posture from which to conduct therapy and from
which a client can conduct life that provides an alternative to contemporary forms
of cognitive behavioral therapy (Eifert & Forsyth, 2005). In contrast to the cognitive
behavioral approaches discussed in Chapter 10, in which dysfunctional thoughts
are identifi ed and challenged, in ACT there is little emphasis on changing the
content of a client’s thoughts. Instead, the emphasis is on acceptance (nonjudg-
mental awareness) of cognitions. The goal is for individuals to become aware of
and examine their thoughts. Clients learn how to change their relationship to their
thoughts. They learn how to accept and distance themselves from the thoughts
and feelings they may have been trying to deny. Hayes has found that confronting
maladaptive cognitions actually strengthens rather than reduces these cognitions.
The goal of ACT is to allow for increased psychological fl exibility. Values are a basic
part of the therapeutic process, and ACT practitioners might ask clients, “What do
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 272 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

273
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
you want your life to stand for?” Therapy involves assisting clients to choose values
they want to live by, designing specifi c goals, and taking steps to achieve their goals
(Wilson, 2011).
In addition to acceptance, commitment to action is essential. Commitment
involves making mindful decisions about what is important in life and what the
person is willing to do to live a valued and meaningful life (Wilson, 2011). ACT
makes use of concrete homework and behavioral exercises as a way to create larger
patterns of effective action that will help clients live by their values (Hayes, 2004).
For example, one form of homework given to clients is asking them to write down
life goals or things they value in various aspects of their lives. The focus of ACT is
allowing experience to come and go while pursuing a meaningful life.
ACT is an effective form of therapy (Eifert & Forsyth, 2005) that continues to
infl uence the practice of behavior therapy. Germer (2005a) suggests “mindfulness
might become a construct that draws clinical theory, research, and practice closer
together, and helps integrate the private and professional lives of therapists” (p. 11).
According to Wilson (2011), ACT emphasizes common processes across clinical
disorders, which makes it easier to learn basic treatment skills. Practitioners can
then implement basic principles in diverse and creative ways. ACT has been effec-
tive for treatment of a variety of disorders, including for substance abuse, depres-
sion, anxiety, phobias, posttraumatic stress disorder, and panic disorder (Eifert &
Forsyth, 2005).
For an in-depth discussion of the role of mindfulness in psychotherapeutic prac-
tice, three highly recommended readings are Acceptance and Mindfulness in Cognitive
Behavior Therapy: Understanding and Applying the New Therapies (Herbert & Forman,
2011), Mindfulness and Acceptance: Expanding the Cognitive-Behavioral Tradition (Hay-
es et al., 2004), and Mindfulness and Psychotherapy (Germer et al., 2005).
Application to Group Counseling
Group-based behavioral approaches emphasize teaching clients self-management
skills and a range of new coping behaviors, as well as how to restructure their
thoughts. Clients can learn to use these techniques to control their lives, deal ef-
fectively with present and future problems, and function well after they complete
their group experience. Many groups are designed primarily to increase the cli-
ent’s degree of control and freedom in specifi c aspects of daily life.
Group leaders who function within a behavioral framework may develop tech-
niques from various theoretical viewpoints. Behavioral practitioners make use of a
brief, active, directive, structured, collaborative, psychoeducational model of ther-
apy that relies on empirical validation of its concepts and techniques. The leader
follows the progress of group members through the ongoing collection of data be-
fore, during, and after all interventions. Such an approach provides both the group
leader and the members with continuous feedback about therapeutic progress.
Today, many groups in community agencies demand this kind of accountability.
Behavioral group therapy has some unique characteristics that set it apart from
most of the other group approaches. A distinguishing characteristic of behavioral
practitioners is their systematic adherence to specifi cation and measurement. The
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 273 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

274
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
specifi c unique characteristics of behavioral group therapy include (1) conducting
a behavioral assessment, (2) precisely spelling out collaborative treatment goals,
(3) formulating a specifi c treatment procedure appropriate to a particular problem,
and (4) objectively evaluating the outcomes of therapy. Behavior therapists tend to
utilize short-term, time-limited interventions aimed at effi ciently and effectively
solving problems and assisting members in developing new skills.
Behavioral group leaders assume the role of teacher and encourage members to
learn and practice skills in the group that they can apply to everyday living. Group
leaders typically assume an active, directive, and supportive role in the group and
apply their knowledge of behavioral principles and skills to the resolution of prob-
lems. They model active participation and collaboration by their involvement with
members in creating an agenda, designing homework, and teaching skills and
new behaviors. Leaders carefully observe and assess behavior to determine the
conditions that are related to certain problems and the conditions that will facili-
tate change. Members in behavioral groups identify specifi c skills that they lack
or would like to enhance. Assertiveness and social skills training fi t well into a
group format (Wilson, 2011). Relaxation procedures, behavioral rehearsal, mod-
eling, coaching, meditation, and mindfulness techniques are often incorporated
in behavioral groups. The experience of being mindful is expanded in the group
setting where people meditate and are still in the presence of others. Most of the
other techniques described earlier in this chapter can be applied to group work.
There are many different types of groups with a behavioral twist, or groups that
blend both behavioral and cognitive methods for specifi c populations. Structured
groups, with a psychoeducational focus, are especially popular in various settings
today. At least fi ve general approaches can be applied to the practice of behavioral
groups: (1) social skills training groups, (2) psychoeducational groups with spe-
cifi c themes, (3) stress management groups, (4) multimodal group therapy, and
(5) mindfulness and acceptance-based behavior therapy in groups.
For a more detailed discussion of cognitive behavioral approaches to groups,
see Corey (2012, chap.13).
b e h av i o r t h e r a p y f r o m a
m u lt i c u lt u r a l p e r s p e c t i v e
Strengths From a Diversity Perspective
Behavior therapy has some clear advantages over many other theories in coun-
seling culturally diverse clients. Because of their cultural and ethnic backgrounds,
some clients hold values that are contrary to the free expression of feelings and the
sharing of personal concerns. Behavioral counseling does not generally place em-
phasis on experiencing catharsis. Rather, it stresses changing specifi c behaviors
and developing problem-solving skills. Some potential strengths of the behavioral
approaches in working with diverse client populations include its specifi city, task
orientation, focus on objectivity, focus on cognition and behavior, action orienta-
tion, dealing with the present more than the past, emphasis on brief interventions,
teaching coping strategies, and problem-solving orientation. The attention given to
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 274 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

275
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
transfer of learning and the principles and strategies for maintaining new behavior
in daily life are crucial. Clients who are looking for action plans and specifi c behav-
ioral change are likely to cooperate with this approach because they can see that it
offers them concrete methods for dealing with their problems of living.
Behavior therapy focuses on environmental conditions that contribute to a client’s
problems. Social and political infl uences can play a signifi cant role in the lives of
people of color through discriminatory practices and economic problems, and the
behavioral approach takes into consideration the social and cultural dimensions of
the client’s life. Behavior therapy is based on an experimental analysis of behavior in
the client’s own social environment and gives special attention to a number of spe-
cifi c conditions: the client’s cultural conception of problem behaviors, establishing
specifi c therapeutic goals, arranging conditions to increase the client’s expectation of
successful therapeutic outcomes, and employing appropriate social infl uence agents
(Tanaka-Matsumi et al., 2002). The foundation of ethical practice involves a thera-
pist’s familiarity with the client’s culture, as well as the competent application of this
knowledge in formulating assessment, diagnostic, and treatment strategies.
The behavioral approach has moved beyond treating clients for a specifi c symptom
or behavioral problem. Instead, it stresses a thorough assessment of the person’s life
circumstances to ascertain not only what conditions give rise to the client’s problems
but also whether the target behavior is amenable to change and whether such a change
is likely to lead to a signifi cant improvement in the client’s total life situation.
In designing a change program for clients from diverse backgrounds, effective
behavioral practitioners conduct a functional analysis of the problem situation.
This assessment includes the cultural context in which the problem behavior
occurs, the consequences both to the client and to the client’s sociocultural envi-
ronment, the resources within the environment that can promote change, and the
impact that change is likely to have on others in the client’s social surroundings.
Assessment methods should be chosen with the client’s cultural background in
mind (Spiegler & Guevremont, 2010; Tanaka-Matsumi et al., 2002). Counselors
must be knowledgeable as well as open and sensitive to issues such as these: What
is considered normal and abnormal behavior in the client’s culture? What are the
client’s culturally based conceptions of his or her problems? What is the potential
role of spirituality or religion in the client’s life? What kind of information about
the client is essential in making an accurate assessment?
Shortcomings From a Diversity Perspective
According to Spiegler and Guevremont (2010), a future challenge for behavior ther-
apists is to develop empirically based recommendations for how behavior therapy
can optimally serve culturally diverse clients. Although behavior therapy is sensi-
tive to differences among clients in a broad sense, behavior therapists need to be-
come more responsive to specifi c issues pertaining to all forms of diversity. Because
race, gender, ethnicity, and sexual orientation are critical variables that infl uence
the process and outcome of therapy, it is essential that behavior therapists pay
careful attention to these factors and address social justice issues as they arise in a
client’s therapy.
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 275 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

276
In Stan’s case many specific and
interrelated problems can be identi-
fied through an assessment process.
Behaviorally, he is defensive, avoids eye contact,
speaks hesitantly, uses alcohol excessively, has a
poor sleep pattern, and displays various avoid-
ance behaviors in social and interpersonal situ-
ations. In the emotional area, Stan has a number
of specific problems, some of which include
anxiety, panic attacks, depression, fear of criti-
cism and rejection, feeling worthless and stupid,
and feeling isolated and alienated. He experi-
ences a range of physiological complaints such
as dizziness, heart palpitations, and headaches.
Cognitively, he worries about death and dying,
has many self-defeating thoughts and beliefs, is
governed by categorical imperatives (“shoulds,”
“oughts,” “musts”), engages in fatalistic thinking,
and compares himself negatively with others. In
the interpersonal area, Stan is unassertive, has an
unsatisfactory relationship with his parents, has
few friends, is afraid of contact with women and
fears intimacy, and feels socially inferior.
After completing this assessment, I focus on
helping Stan define the specific areas where he
would like to make changes. Before developing
a treatment plan, I assist Stan in understanding
the purposes of his behavior. I then educate Stan
about how the therapy sessions (and his work
outside of the sessions) can help him reach his
goals. Early during treatment I help Stan trans-
late some of his general goals into concrete and
measurable ones. When Stan says, “I want to
feel better about myself,” I help him define more
specific goals. When he says, “I want to get rid
of my inferiority complex,” I reply: “What exactly
do you mean by this?” “What are some situa-
tions in which you feel inferior?” “What do you
actually do that leads to feelings of inferiority?”
Stan’s concrete aims include his desire to func-
tion without drugs or alcohol. I suggest that he
keep a record of when he drinks and what events
lead to drinking. My hope is that Stan will estab-
lish goals that are based on positive markers, not
negative goals. Instead of focusing on what Stan
would like to get rid of, I am more interested in
what he would like to acquire and develop.
Stan indicates that he does not want to
feel apologetic for his existence. I introduce
behavioral skills training because he has trouble
talking with his boss and coworkers. I demon-
strate specific skills that he can use in
approaching them more directly and confidently.
This procedure includes modeling, role playing,
Behavior Therapy Applied to the Case of Stan
Some behavioral counselors may focus on using a variety of techniques in nar-
rowly treating specifi c behavioral problems. Instead of viewing clients in the con-
text of their sociocultural environment, these practitioners concentrate too much
on problems within the individual. In doing so they may overlook signifi cant
issues in the lives of clients. Such practitioners are not likely to bring about benefi –
cial changes for their clients.
The fact that behavioral interventions often work well raises an interesting
issue in multicultural counseling. When clients make signifi cant personal changes,
it is very likely that others in their environment will react to them differently.
Before deciding too quickly on goals for therapy, the counselor and client need to
discuss the complexity inherent in change. It is essential for therapists to conduct a
thorough assessment of the interpersonal and cultural dimensions of the problem.
Clients should be helped in assessing the possible consequences of some of their
newly acquired social skills. Once goals are determined and therapy is under way,
clients should have opportunities to talk about the problems they encounter as they
bring new skills and behaviors into their home and work settings.
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 276 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

and behavior rehearsal. He then tries more
effective behaviors with me as I play the role of
the boss. I give him feedback on how strong or
apologetic he seemed.
Imaginal exposure and systematic desensi-
tization are appropriate in working with Stan’s
fear of failing. Before using these procedures,
I explain the procedure to Stan and get his in-
formed consent. Stan first learns relaxation pro-
cedures during the sessions and then practices
them daily at home. Next, he lists his specific
fears relating to failure, and he then generates a
hierarchy of fear items. Stan identifies his great-
est fear as fear of dating and interacting with
women. The least fearful situation he identifies
is being with a female student for whom he does
not feel an attraction. I first do some systematic
desensitization on Stan’s hierarchy. Stan begins
repeated, systematic exposure to items that
he finds frightening, beginning at the bottom
of the fear hierarchy. He continues with
repeated exposure to the next fear hierarchy
item when exposure to the previous item gener-
ates only mild fear. Part of the process involves
exposure exercises for practice in various
situations away from the therapy office.
The goal of therapy is to help Stan modify the
behavior that results in his feelings of guilt and
anxiety. By learning more appropriate coping
behaviors, eliminating unrealistic anxiety and
guilt, and acquiring more adaptive responses,
Stan’s presenting symptoms decrease, and he
reports a greater degree of satisfaction.
Follow-Up: You Continue as Stan’s
Behavior Therapist
Use these questions to help you think about how
you would work with Stan using a behavioral
approach:
• How would you collaboratively work with Stan
in identifying specific behavioral goals to give
a direction to your therapy?
• What behavioral techniques might be most
appropriate in helping Stan with his problems?
• Stan indicates that he does not want to feel
apologetic for his existence. How might you
help him translate this wish into a specific
behavioral goal? What behavioral techniques
might you draw on in helping him in this area?
• What homework assignments are you likely to
suggest for Stan?
See DVD for Theory and Practice of
Counseling and Psychotherapy: The Case
of Stan and Lecturettes (Session 7 on behavior
therapy) for a demonstration of my approach
to counseling Stan from this perspective. This
session involves collaboratively working on
homework and behavior rehearsals to experi-
ment with assertive behavior.
s u m m a ry a n d e va l u at i o n
Summary
Behavior therapy is diverse with respect not only to basic concepts but also to tech-
niques that can be applied in coping with specifi c problems with a wide range of
clients. The behavioral movement includes four major areas of development: clas-
sical conditioning, operant conditioning, social-cognitive theory, and increasing
attention to the cognitive factors infl uencing behavior (see Chapter 10). A unique
characteristic of behavior therapy is its strict reliance on the principles of the sci-
entifi c method. Concepts and procedures are stated explicitly, tested empirically,
and revised continually. Treatment and assessment are interrelated and occur si-
multaneously. Research is considered to be a basic aspect of the approach, and
therapeutic techniques are continually refi ned.
277
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 277 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

278
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
A cornerstone of behavior therapy is identifying specifi c goals at the outset of
the therapeutic process. In helping clients achieve their goals, behavior therapists
typically assume an active and directive role. Although the client generally deter-
mines what behavior will be changed, the therapist typically determines how this
behavior can best be modifi ed. In designing a treatment plan, behavior therapists
employ techniques and procedures from a wide variety of therapeutic systems and
apply them to the unique needs of each client.
Contemporary behavior therapy places emphasis on the interplay between the
individual and the environment. Behavioral strategies can be used to attain both
individual goals and societal goals. Because cognitive factors have a place in the
practice of behavior therapy, techniques from this approach can be used to attain
humanistic ends. It is clear that bridges can connect humanistic and behavioral
therapies, especially with the current focus of attention on self-management ap-
proaches and also with the incorporation of mindfulness and acceptance-based
approaches into behavioral practice. Mindfulness practices rely of experiential
learning as opposed to didactic instruction and client discovery rather than formal
teaching (Dimidjian & Linehan, 2008).
Contributions of Behavior Therapy
Behavior therapy challenges us to reconsider our global approach to counseling.
Some may assume they know what a client means by the statement, “I feel unloved;
life has no meaning.” A humanist might nod in acceptance to such a statement,
but the behaviorist may respond with: “Who specifi cally do you feel is not loving
you?” “What is going on in your life to make you think it has no meaning?” “What
are some specifi c things you might be doing that contribute to the state you are in?”
“What would you most like to change?” The specifi city of the behavioral approaches
helps clients translate unclear goals into concrete plans of action, and it helps both
the counselor and the client to keep these plans clearly in focus. Ledley and col-
leagues (2010) state that therapists can help clients to learn about the contingencies
that maintain their problematic thoughts and behaviors and then teach them ways
to make the changes they want. Techniques such as role playing, relaxation proce-
dures, behavioral rehearsal, coaching, guided practice, modeling, feedback, learning
by successive approximations, mindfulness skills, and homework assignments can
be included in any therapist’s repertoire, regardless of theoretical orientation.
An advantage behavior therapists have is the wide variety of specifi c behavioral
techniques at their disposal. Because behavior therapy stresses doing, as opposed
to merely talking about problems and gathering insights, practitioners use many
behavioral strategies to assist clients in formulating a plan of action for chang-
ing behavior. The basic therapeutic conditions stressed by person-centered thera-
pists—active listening, accurate empathy, positive regard, genuineness, respect,
and immediacy—need to be integrated in a behavioral framework.
A major contribution of behavior therapy is its emphasis on research into
and assessment of treatment outcomes. It is up to practitioners to demonstrate
that therapy is working. If progress is not being made, therapists look carefully
at the original analysis and treatment plan. Of all the therapies presented in this
book, this approach and its techniques have been subjected to the most empirical
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 278 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

279
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
research. Behavioral practitioners are put to the test of identifying specifi c inter-
ventions that have been demonstrated to be effective. Fishman, Rego, and Muller
(2011) acknowledge the evolving nature of these therapies but conclude:
We believe the core of behavior therapy will endure in a commitment to theory that is
scholarly, logically clear, directly linked to data, and primarily rooted in the interactional
worldview; to therapy principles and procedures that are evidenced-based; to measurement
methods designed to ensure accountability; and to a focus on outcomes that result in con-
crete improvement in patients’ lives. (p. 135)
Evidence-based therapies (EBT) are a hallmark of both behavior therapy and cog-
nitive behavior therapy. To their credit, behavior therapists are willing to examine
the effectiveness of their procedures in terms of the generalizability, meaningful-
ness, and durability of change. Most studies show that behavior therapy methods
are more effective than no treatment. Moreover, a number of behavioral and cogni-
tive behavioral procedures are currently the best treatment strategies available for
depression, obsessive-compulsive disorder, panic disorder, social phobia, hypochon-
driasis, generalized anxiety disorder, posttraumatic stress disorder, eating disorders,
borderline personality disorder, bipolar disorder, and childhood disorders (Hollon &
DiGiuseppe, 2011).
A strength of the behavioral approaches is the emphasis on ethical accountabil-
ity. Behavior therapy is ethically neutral in that it does not dictate whose behavior
or what behavior should be changed. At least in cases of voluntary counseling, the
behavioral practitioner only specifi es how to change those behaviors the client tar-
gets for change. Clients have a good deal of control and freedom in deciding what
the goals of therapy will be.
Limitations and Criticisms of Behavior Therapy
Behavior therapy has been criticized for a variety of reasons. Let’s examine four
common criticisms and misconceptions people often have about behavior therapy,
together with my reactions.
1. Behavior therapy may change behaviors, but it does not change feelings. Some critics
argue that feelings must change before behavior can change. Behavioral practition-
ers hold that empirical evidence has not shown that feelings must be changed fi rst,
and behavioral clinicians do in actual practice deal with feelings as an overall part
of the treatment process. A general criticism of both the behavioral and the cogni-
tive approaches is that clients are not encouraged to experience their emotions. In
concentrating on how clients are behaving or thinking, some behavior therapists
tend to play down the working through of emotional issues. Generally, I favor
initially focusing on what clients are feeling and then working with the behavioral
and cognitive dimensions. My reasoning here is that I fi nd when clients are feeling
they are engaged and this seems to me to be a good point of departure. I can still
tie a discussion of what clients are feeling with how this is affecting their behavior
and I can later inquire about their cognitions.
2. Behavior therapy does not provide insight. If this assertion is indeed true, behav-
ior therapists would probably respond that insight is not a necessary requisite for
behavior change. Follette and Callaghan (2011) state that contemporary behavior
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 279 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

280
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
therapists tend to be leery of the role of insight in favor of alterable, controllable,
causal variables. It is possible for therapy to proceed without a client knowing how
change is taking place. Although change may be taking place, clients often can-
not explain precisely why. Furthermore, insights may result after clients make a
change in behavior. Behavioral shifts often lead to a change in understanding or to
insight, which may lead to emotional changes as well.
3. Behavior therapy treats symptoms rather than causes. The psychoanalytic assumption
is that early traumatic events are at the root of present dysfunction. Behavior therapists
may acknowledge that deviant responses have historical origins, but they contend that
history is less important in the maintenance of current problems than environmental
events such as antecedents and consequences. However, behavior therapists empha-
size changing current environmental circumstances to change behavior.
Related to this criticism is the notion that, unless historical causes of present
behavior are therapeutically explored, new symptoms will soon take the place of
those that were “cured.” Behaviorists rebut this assertion on both theoretical and
empirical grounds. They contend that behavior therapy directly changes the main-
taining conditions, which are the causes of problem behaviors (symptoms). Fur-
thermore, they assert that there is no empirical evidence that symptom substitution
occurs after behavior therapy has successfully eliminated unwanted behavior be-
cause they have changed the conditions that give rise to those behaviors (Kazdin &
Wilson, 1978; Spiegler & Guevremont, 2010).
4. Behavior therapy involves control and social infl uence by the therapist. All thera-
pists have a power relationship with the client and thus have control. According to
Wilson (2011), all forms of therapy involve social infl uence; the ethical issue relates
to the therapist’s degree of awareness of this infl uence and how it is addressed in
therapy. Behavior therapy recognizes the importance of making the social infl u-
ence process explicit, and it emphasizes client-oriented behavioral goals. Thera-
pists collaborate with clients to make sure there is a mutual agreement regarding
treatment goals (Antony & Roemer, 2011b), and the client is encouraged to become
an active participant in his or her therapy. Therapy progress is continually assessed
and treatment is modifi ed to ensure that the client’s goals are being met.
Behavior therapists address ethical issues by stating that therapy is basically
a psychoeducational process (Tanaka-Matsumi et al., 2002). At the outset of be-
havior therapy, clients learn about the nature of counseling, the procedures that
may be employed, and the benefi ts and risks. Clients are given information about
the specifi c therapy procedures appropriate for their particular problems. To some
extent, they also participate in the choice of techniques that will be used in dealing
with their problems. With this information clients become informed, fully enfran-
chised partners in the therapeutic venture.
The literature in the fi eld of behavior therapy is so extensive and diverse that it is not
possible in one brief survey chapter to present a comprehensive, in-depth discussion
of behavioral techniques. I hope I have encouraged you to examine any misconcep-
tions you may hold about behavior therapy. I urge you to examine some of the selected
sources in the following section to further your knowledge of this complex approach.
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 280 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

281
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
w h e r e to g o f r o m h e r e
In the DVD for Integrative Counseling: The Case of Ruth and Lecturettes, Session 8
(“Behavioral Focus in Counseling”), I demonstrate a behavioral way to assist Ruth
in developing an exercise program. It is crucial that Ruth makes her own decisions
about specifi c behavioral goals she wants to pursue. This applies to my attempts
to work with her in developing methods of relaxation, increasing her self-effi cacy,
and designing an exercise plan.
Other Resources
DVDs offered by the American Psychological Association that are relevant to this
chapter include the following:
Antony, M. M. (2009). Behavioral Therapy Over Time (APA Psychotherapy
Video Series)
Hayes, S. C. (2011). Acceptance and Commitment Therapy (Systems of Psy-
chotherapy Video Series)
Psychotherapy.net is a comprehensive resource for students and professionals that
offers videos and interviews on behavior therapy. New video and editorial content
is made available monthly. DVDs relevant to this chapter are available at www.
psychotherapy.net and include the following:
Stuart, R. (1998). Behavioral Couples Therapy (Couples Therapy With the
Experts Series)
Association for Behavioral and Cognitive Therapies (ABCT)
305 Seventh Avenue, 16th Floor
New York, NY 10001-6008
Telephone: (212) 647-1890
Fax: (212) 647-1865
E-mail: membership@abct.org
Website: www.abct.org
If you have an interest in further training in behavior therapy, the Association
for Behavioral and Cognitive Therapies (ABCT) is an excellent resource. ABCT
(formerly AABT) is a membership organization of more than 4,500 mental health
professionals and students who are interested in behavior therapy, cognitive
behavior therapy, behavioral assessment, and applied behavioral analysis. Full and
associate memberships are $199 and include one journal subscription (to either
Behavior Therapy or Cognitive and Behavioral Practice), and a subscription to the
Behavior Therapist (a newsletter with feature articles, training updates, and associa-
tion news). Membership also includes reduced registration and continuing educa-
tion course fees for ABCT’s annual convention held in November, which features
workshops, master clinician programs, symposia, and other educational presenta-
tions. Student memberships are $49. Members receive discounts on all ABCT
publications, some of which are:
• Directory of Graduate Training in Behavior Therapy and Experimental-Clinical
Psychology is an excellent source for students and job seekers who want infor-
mation on programs with an emphasis on behavioral training.
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 281 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

• Directory of Psychology Internships: Programs Offering Behavioral Training describes
training programs having a behavioral component.
• Behavior Therapy is an international quarterly journal focusing on original
experimental and clinical research, theory, and practice.
• Cognitive and Behavioral Practice is a quarterly journal that features clinically
oriented articles.
Recommended Supplementary Readings
Contemporary Behavior Therapy (Spiegler & Guevremont, 2010) is a comprehen-
sive and up-to-date treatment of basic principles and applications of the behavior
therapies, as well as a fi ne discussion of ethical issues. Specifi c chapters deal with
procedures that can be usefully applied to a range of client populations: behavio-
ral assessment, modeling therapy, systematic desensitization, exposure therapies,
cognitive restructuring, and cognitive coping skills.
Interviewing and Change Strategies for Helpers (Cormier, Nurius, & Osborn, 2013)
is a comprehensive and clearly written textbook dealing with training experiences
and skill development. Its excellent documentation offers practitioners a wealth
of material on a variety of topics, such as assessment procedures, selection of
goals, development of appropriate treatment programs, and methods of evaluat-
ing outcomes.
Cognitive Behavior Therapy: Applying Empirically Supported Techniques in Your
Practice (O’Donohue & Fisher, 2008) is a useful collection of edited short chap-
ters describing empirically supported techniques for working with a wide range
of presenting problems.
Behavior Therapy (Antony & Roemer, 2011a) offers a useful and updated overview
of behavior therapy.
Behavior Modifi cation: Principles and Procedures (Miltenberger, 2012) is an excel-
lent resource for learning more about basic principles such as reinforcement,
extinction, punishment, and procedures to establish new behavior.
Acceptance and Mindfulness in Cognitive Behavior Therapy: Understanding and
Applying the New Therapies (Herbert & Forman, 2011) is one of the best resources
for discussion of new developments in the behavior therapy tradition and the
future trends of these therapies.
References and Suggested Readings
*Alberti, R. E., & Emmons, M. L. (2008). Your
perfect right: A guide to assertive behavior
(9th ed.). Atascadero, CA: Impact.
*Antony, M. M., & Roemer, L. (2011a).
Behavior therapy. Washington, DC: American
Psychological Association.
282
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
*Books and articles marked with an asterisk are suggested for further study.
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 282 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

Antony, M. M., & Roemer, L. (2011b). Behav-
ior therapy: Traditional approaches. In S.
B. Messer & A. S. Gurman (Eds.), Essential
psychotherapies: Theory and practice (3rd ed.,
pp. 107–142). New York: Guilford Press.
Bandura, A. (1969). Principles of behavior
modification. New York: Holt, Rinehart &
Winston.
Bandura, A. (Ed.). (1971a). Psychological
modeling: Conflicting theories. Chicago:
Aldine-Atherton.
Bandura, A. (1971b). Psychotherapy based
upon modeling principles. In A. E. Bergin &
S. L. Garfield (Eds.), Handbook of psychother-
apy and behavior change. New York: Wiley.
Bandura, A. (1977). Social learning theory.
Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
Bandura, A. (1982). Self-efficacy mecha-
nisms in human agency. American Psycholo-
gist, 37, 122–147.
Bandura, A. (1986). Social foundations of
thought and action: A social cognitive theory.
Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
*Bandura, A. (1997). Self-efficacy: The exer-
cise of self-control. New York: Freeman.
Bandura, A., & Walters, R. H. (1963). Social
learning and personality development.
New York: Holt, Rinehart & Winston.
*Beck, A. T. (1976). Cognitive therapy and
emotional disorders. New York: New
American Library.
Beck, A. T., & Weishaar, M. E. (2011).
Cognitive therapy. In R. J. Corsini & D.
Wedding (Eds.), Current psychotherapies
(9th ed., pp. 276–309). Belmont, CA:
Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning.
*Corey, G. (2012). Theory and practice of
group counseling (8th ed.). Belmont, CA:
Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning.
*Corey, G. (2013a). Case approach to coun-
seling and psychotherapy (8th ed.). Belmont,
CA: Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning.
*Corey, G. (2013b). Student manual for theory
and practice of counseling and psychotherapy
(9th ed.). Belmont, CA: Brooks/Cole, Cen-
gage Learning.
*Cormier, S., Nurius, P. S., & Osborn, C.
(2013). Interviewing and change strategies for
helpers (7th ed.). Belmont, CA: Brooks/Cole,
Cengage Learning.
Dattilio, F. M. (2006). Progressive muscle
relaxation (CD). www.dattilio.com
Dimidjian, S., & Linehan, M. M. (2008).
Mindfulness practice. In W. O’Donohue & J.
E. Fisher (Eds.), Cognitive behavior therapy:
Applying empirically supported techniques in
your practice (2nd ed., pp. 327–336). Hobo-
ken, NJ: Wiley.
Dobson, D., & Dobson, K. S. (2009).
Evidence-based practice of cognitive-behavioral
therapy. New York: Guilford Press.
Dobson, K. S. (2010). Handbook of cognitive-
behavioral therapies (3rd ed.). New York:
Guilford Press.
Eifert, G. H., & Forsyth, J. P. (2005).
Acceptance and commitment therapy for anxiety
disorders: A practitioner’s treatment guide to
using mindfulness, acceptance, and values-
based behavior change strategies. Oakland, CA:
New Harbinger Publications.
Ferguson, K. E., & Sgambati, R. E. (2008).
Relaxation. In W. O’Donohue & J. E. Fisher
(Eds.), Cognitive behavior therapy: Applying
empirically supported techniques in your practice
(2nd ed., pp. 434–444). Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.
*Fishman, D. B., Rego, S. A., & Muller, K. L.
(2011). Behavioral theories in psychotherapy.
In J. C. Norcross, G. R. Vandenbos, & D. K.
Freedheim (Eds.), History of psychotherapy
(2nd ed., pp. 101–140). Washington, DC:
American Psychological Association.
Follette, W. C., & Callaghan, G. M. (2011).
Behavior therapy: Functional-contextual
approaches. In S. B. Messer & A. S. Gurman,
(Eds.), Essential psychotherapies: Theory and
practice (3rd ed., pp. 184–220). New York:
Guilford Press.
*Fresco, D. M., Flynn, J. J., Mennin, D. S., &
Haigh, A. P. (2011). Mindfulness-based cog-
nitive therapy. In J. D. Hebert & E. M. Forman
(Eds.), Acceptance and mindfulness in cognitive
behavior therapy: Understanding and applying
the new therapies (pp. 57–82). Hoboken, NJ:
Wiley.
283
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 283 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

284
C
H
A
P
T
E
R

N
I
N
E
Germer, C. K. (2005a). Mindfulness: What is
it: What does it matter? In C. K. Germer, R. D.
Siegel, & P. R. Fulton (Eds.), Mindfulness and
psychotherapy (pp. 3–27). New York: Guilford
Press.
Germer, C. K. (2005b). Teaching mindfulness
in therapy. In C. K. Germer, R. D. Siegel, & P. R.
Fulton (Eds.), Mindfulness and psychotherapy
(pp. 113–129). New York: Guilford Press.
*Germer, C. K., Siegel, R. D., & Fulton, P. R.
(Eds.). (2005). Mindfulness and psychotherapy.
New York: Guilford Press.
Hayes, S. C. (2004). Acceptance and commit-
ment therapy and the new behavior therapies:
Mindfulness, acceptance, and relationship. In
S. C. Hayes, V. M. Follette, & M. M. Linehan
(Eds.), Mindfulness and acceptance: Expanding
the cognitive-behavioral tradition (pp. 1–29).
New York: Guilford Press.
*Hayes, S. C., Follette, V. M., & Linehan, M. M.
(Eds.). (2004). Mindfulness and acceptance:
Expanding the cognitive-behavioral tradition.
New York: Guilford Press.
*Hayes, S. C., Strosahl, K. D., & Houts, A.
(Eds.). (2005). A practical guide to acceptance
and commitment therapy. New York: Springer.
*Hayes, S. C., Strosahl, K. D., & Wilson, K. G.
(Eds.). (2011). Acceptance and commitment
therapy: The process and practice of mindful
change (2nd ed.). New York: Guilford Press.
Hazlett-Stevens, H., & Craske, M. G. (2008).
Live (in vivo) exposure. In W. O’Donohue &
J. E. Fisher (Eds.), Cognitive behavior therapy:
Applying empirically supported techniques in your
practice (2nd ed., pp. 309–316). Hoboken,
NJ: Wiley.
Head, L. S., & Gross, A. M. (2008). Systematic
desensitization. In W. O’Donohue & J. E. Fisher
(Eds.), Cognitive behavior therapy: Applying
empirically supported techniques in your practice
(2nd ed., pp. 542–549). Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.
Herbert, J. D., & Forman, E. M. (2011).
Acceptance and mindfulness in cognitive behavior
therapy: Understanding and applying the new
therapies. Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.
Hollon, S. D., & Digiuseppe, R. (2011).
Cognitive theories in psychotherapy. In J. C.
Norcross, G. R. Vandenbos, & D. K. Freedheim
(Eds.), History of psychotherapy (2nd ed.,
pp. 203–242). Washington, DC: American
Psychological Association.
Jacobson, E. (1938). Progressive relaxation.
Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
*Kabat-Zinn, J. (1990). Full catastrophe living:
Using the wisdom of your body and mind to face
stress, pain, and illness. New York: Dell.
*Kabat-Zinn, J. (1994). Wherever you go there
you are: Mindfulness meditation in everyday life.
New York: Hyperion.
Kabat-Zinn, J. (2003). Mindfulness-based
interventions in context: Past, present and
future. Clinical Psychology: Science and Practice,
10, 144–156.
Kazdin, A. E. (1978). History of behavior modi-
fication: Experimental foundations of contempo-
rary research. Baltimore: University Park Press.
*Kazdin, A. E. (2001). Behavior modification in
applied settings (6th ed.). Pacific Grove, CA:
Brooks/Cole.
Kazdin, A. E., & Wilson, G. T. (1978). Evalu-
ation of behavior therapy: Issues, evidence, and
research strategies. Cambridge, MA: Ballinger.
Lazarus, A. A. (1989). The practice of
multimodal therapy. Baltimore: Johns Hopkins
University Press.
Lazarus, A. A. (1992a). The multimodal ap-
proach to the treatment of minor depression.
American Journal of Psychotherapy, 46(l), 50–57.
Lazarus, A. A. (1992b). Multimodal therapy:
Technical eclecticism with minimal integra-
tion. In J. C. Norcross & M. R. Goldfried (Eds.),
Handbook of psychotherapy integration
(pp. 231–263). New York: Basic Books.
*Lazarus, A. A. (1993). Tailoring the therapeu-
tic relationship, or being an authentic chame-
leon. Psychotherapy, 30, 404–407.
*Lazarus, A. A. (1996a). Some reflections after
40 years of trying to be an effective psycho-
therapist. Psychotherapy, 33(1), 142–145.
*Lazarus, A. A. (1996b). The utility and futility of
combining treatments in psychotherapy. Clinical
Psychology: Science and Practice, 3(1), 59–68.
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 284 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

285
B
E
H
A
V
I
O
R

T
H
E
R
A
P
Y
*Lazarus, A. A. (1997a). Brief but comprehensive
psychotherapy: The multimodal way. New York:
Springer.
Lazarus, A. A. (1997b). Can psychotherapy
be brief, focused, solution-oriented, and yet
comprehensive? A personal evolutionary
perspective. In J. K. Zeig (Ed.), The evolution
of psychotherapy: The third conference
(pp. 83–94). New York: Brunner/Mazel.
Lazarus, A. A. (2000). Multimodal strategies
with adults. In J. Carlson & L. Sperry (Eds.),
Brief therapy with individuals and couples
(pp. 106–124). Phoenix: Zeig & Tucker.
*Lazarus, A. A. (2005). Multimodal therapy.
In J. C. Norcross & M. R. Goldfried (Eds.),
Handbook of psychotherapy integration (2nd ed.,
pp. 105–120). New York: Oxford University
Press.
Lazarus, A. A. (2006). Multimodal therapy:
A seven-point integration. In G. Stricker &
J. Gold (Eds.), A casebook of psychotherapy inte-
gration (pp. 17–28). Washington DC: American
Psychological Association.
Lazarus, A. A. (2008a). Multimodal behavior
therapy. In W. O’Donohue & J. E. Fisher (Eds.),
Cognitive behavior therapy: Applying empirically
supported techniques in your practice (2nd ed.,
pp. 342–346). Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.
Lazarus, A. A. (2008b). Technical eclecticism
and multimodal therapy. In J. L. Lebow (Ed.),
Twenty-first century psychotherapies
(pp. 424–452). Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.
Lazarus, A. A., & Lazarus, C. N. (2005). Mul-
timodal life-history inventory. In G. P. Koocher,
J. C. Norcross, & S. S. Hill III (Eds.), Psycholo-
gist’s desk reference (2nd ed. pp. 16–23) Oxford:
Oxford University Press.
Lazarus, A. A., & Zur, O. (2002). Dual
relationships and psychotherapy. New York:
Springer.
*Ledley, D. R., Marx, B. P., & Heimberg, R. G.
(2010). Making cognitive-behavioral therapy
work: Clinical processes for new practitioners
(2nd ed.). New York: Guilford Press.
Linehan, M. M. (1993a). Cognitive-behavioral
treatment of borderline personality disorder. New
York: Guilford Press.
Linehan, M. M. (1993b). Skills training manual
for treating borderline personality disorder.
New York: Guilford Press.
Martell, C. R. (2007). Behavioral therapy. In A.
B. Rochlen (Ed.), Applying counseling theories:
An online case-based approach (pp. 143–156).
Upper Saddle River, NJ: Pearson Prentice-Hall.
*Messer, S. B., & Gurman, A. S. (2011).
Essential psychotherapies: Theory and practice
(3rd ed.). New York: Guilford Press.
Miller, W. R. & Rollnick, S. (2002). Motiva-
tional interviewing: Preparing people for change
(2nd ed.). New York: Guilford Press.
*Miltenberger, R. G. (2012). Behavior modi-
fication: Principles and procedures (5th ed.).
Belmont, CA: Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning.
*Norcross, J. C., Beutler, L. E., & Levant, R. F.
(2006). Evidence-based practices in mental
health: Debate and dialogue on the fundamental
questions. Washington, DC: American Psycho-
logical Association.
Nye, R. D. (2000). Three psychologies: Perspec-
tives from Freud, Skinner, and Rogers (6th ed.).
Belmont, CA: Brooks/Cole, Cengage Learning.
*O’Donohue, W., & Fisher, J. E. (Eds.). (2008).
Cognitive behavior therapy: Applying empirically
supported techniques in your practice (2nd ed.).
Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.
Panjares, F. (2004). Albert Bandura: Biographi-
cal sketch. Retrieved from http://des.emory.
edu/mfp/bandurabio.html
Paul, G. L. (1967). Outcome research in psy-
chotherapy. Journal of Consulting Psychology, 31,
109–188.
Prochaska, J. O., & Norcross, J. C. (2010).
Systems of psychotherapy: A transtheoretical
analysis (7th ed.). Belmont, CA: Brooks/Cole,
Cengage Learning.
*Robins, C. J., & Rosenthal, M. Z. (2011).
Dialectical behavior therapy. In J. D. Hebert &
E. M. Forman (Eds.), Acceptance and mindful-
ness in cognitive behavior therapy: Understanding
and applying the new therapies (pp. 164–209).
Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.
*Salmon, P. G., Sephton, S. E., & Dreeben, S. J.
(2011). Mindfulness-based stress reduction.
28549_ch09_rev01.indd 285 20/09/11 3:52 PM
Copyright 2011 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Due to electronic rights, some third party content may be suppressed from the eBook and/or eChapter(s).
Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. Cengage Learning reserves the right to remove additional content at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it.

In J. D. Hebert & E. M. Forman (Eds.),
Acceptance and mindfulness in cognitive behavior
therapy: Understanding and applying the new
therapies (pp. 132–163). Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.
*Segal, Z. V., Williams, J. M. G., & Teasdale,
J. D. (2002). Mindfulness-based cognitive ther-
apy for depression: A new approach to preventing
relapse. New York: Guilford Press.
Segrin, C. (2008). Social skills training. In
W. O’Donohue & J. E. Fisher (Eds.), Cognitive
behavior therapy: Applying empirically supported
techniques in your practice (2nd ed.,
pp. 502–509). Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.
*Shapiro, F. (2001). Eye movement desensitiza-
tion and reprocessing: Basic principles, protocols,